28254c9e68c54dd3f4d26ab97036df46ee458b8d
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
550 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
551 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
552 Stafford Horne.
553
554 @node Sample Session
555 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
556
557 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
558 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
559 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
560
561 @iftex
562 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
563 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
564 @end iftex
565
566 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
567 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
568
569 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
570 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
571 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
572 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
573 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
574 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
575 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
576 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
577 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
578
579 @smallexample
580 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
581 $ @b{./m4}
582 @b{define(foo,0000)}
583
584 @b{foo}
585 0000
586 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
587
588 @b{bar}
589 0000
590 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
591
592 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
593 @b{baz}
594 @b{Ctrl-d}
595 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
600
601 @smallexample
602 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
603 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
604 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
605 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
606 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
607 the conditions.
608 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
609 for details.
610
611 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
612 (@value{GDBP})
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
617 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
618 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
619 that examples fit in this manual.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
627 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
628 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
629 @code{break} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
638 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
639 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
643 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
644 @b{define(foo,0000)}
645
646 @b{foo}
647 0000
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
652 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
653 context where it stops.
654
655 @smallexample
656 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
657
658 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
659 at builtin.c:879
660 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
665 the next line of the current function.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
669 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
670 : nil,
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
675 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
676 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
677 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
678
679 @smallexample
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
681 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
682 at input.c:530
683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
688 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
689 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
690 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
691 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
692 stack frame for each active subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
696 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
697 at input.c:530
698 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
699 at builtin.c:882
700 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
701 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
702 at macro.c:71
703 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
704 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
709 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
710 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
714 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
716 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
717 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
719 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
720 : xstrdup(rq);
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
722 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
728 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
729 (@code{print}) to see their values.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
733 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
735 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
740 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
741 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
745 533 xfree(rquote);
746 534
747 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
748 : xstrdup (lq);
749 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
750 : xstrdup (rq);
751 537
752 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 540 @}
755 541
756 542 void
757 @end smallexample
758
759 @noindent
760 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
761 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
762
763 @smallexample
764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
765 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
767 540 @}
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
769 $3 = 9
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
771 $4 = 7
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
776 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
777 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
778 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
779 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
780 assignments.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
784 $5 = 7
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
786 $6 = 9
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
791 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
792 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
793 example that caused trouble initially:
794
795 @smallexample
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
797 Continuing.
798
799 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
800
801 baz
802 0000
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
807 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
808 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @b{Ctrl-d}
812 Program exited normally.
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
817 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
818 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
819
820 @smallexample
821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @node Invocation
825 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
826
827 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
828 The essentials are:
829 @itemize @bullet
830 @item
831 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
832 @item
833 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
834 @end itemize
835
836 @menu
837 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
838 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
839 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
840 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
841 @end menu
842
843 @node Invoking GDB
844 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
845
846 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
847 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
848
849 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
850 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
851
852 The command-line options described here are designed
853 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
854 options may effectively be unavailable.
855
856 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
857 specifying an executable program:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
865 specified:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
869 @end smallexample
870
871 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
872 to debug a running process:
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
880 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
881
882 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
883 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
884 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
885 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
886 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
887
888 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
889 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
890 option processing.
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
893 @end smallexample
894 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
895 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
896
897 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
898 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
899 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} --silent
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
907 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
908
909 @noindent
910 Type
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} -help
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
918 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
919
920 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
921 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
922 @samp{-x} option is used.
923
924
925 @menu
926 * File Options:: Choosing files
927 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
928 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
929 @end menu
930
931 @node File Options
932 @subsection Choosing Files
933
934 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
935 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
936 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
937 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
938 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
939 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
940 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
941 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
942 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
943 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
944 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
945 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
946 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
947
948 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
949 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
950 argument and ignore it.
951
952 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
953 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
954 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
955 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
956 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
957
958 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
959 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
960 @c it.
961
962 @table @code
963 @item -symbols @var{file}
964 @itemx -s @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--symbols}
966 @cindex @code{-s}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
968
969 @item -exec @var{file}
970 @itemx -e @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--exec}
972 @cindex @code{-e}
973 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
974 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
975
976 @item -se @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--se}
978 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
979 file.
980
981 @item -core @var{file}
982 @itemx -c @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--core}
984 @cindex @code{-c}
985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
986
987 @item -pid @var{number}
988 @itemx -p @var{number}
989 @cindex @code{--pid}
990 @cindex @code{-p}
991 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
992
993 @item -command @var{file}
994 @itemx -x @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--command}
996 @cindex @code{-x}
997 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
998 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
999 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1000
1001 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1002 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1003 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1004 @cindex @code{-ex}
1005 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1006
1007 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1008 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1009
1010 @smallexample
1011 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1012 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1013 @end smallexample
1014
1015 @item -init-command @var{file}
1016 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1017 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1018 @cindex @code{-ix}
1019 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1020 after loading gdbinit files).
1021 @xref{Startup}.
1022
1023 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1024 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1025 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1026 @cindex @code{-iex}
1027 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1028 after loading gdbinit files).
1029 @xref{Startup}.
1030
1031 @item -directory @var{directory}
1032 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1033 @cindex @code{--directory}
1034 @cindex @code{-d}
1035 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1036
1037 @item -r
1038 @itemx -readnow
1039 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1040 @cindex @code{-r}
1041 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1042 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1043 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1044
1045 @item --readnever
1046 @anchor{--readnever}
1047 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1048 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1049 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1050 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1051 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1052 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1053 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1054 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1055 @end table
1056
1057 @node Mode Options
1058 @subsection Choosing Modes
1059
1060 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1061 batch mode or quiet mode.
1062
1063 @table @code
1064 @anchor{-nx}
1065 @item -nx
1066 @itemx -n
1067 @cindex @code{--nx}
1068 @cindex @code{-n}
1069 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1070 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1071
1072 @table @code
1073 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1074 This is the system-wide init file.
1075 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1076 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1077 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1078 have been processed.
1079 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1080 This is the init file in your home directory.
1081 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1082 command options have been processed.
1083 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1084 This is the init file in the current directory.
1085 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1086 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1087 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1091 For documentation on how to write command files,
1092 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1093
1094 @anchor{-nh}
1095 @item -nh
1096 @cindex @code{--nh}
1097 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1098 in your home directory.
1099 @xref{Startup}.
1100
1101 @item -quiet
1102 @itemx -silent
1103 @itemx -q
1104 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1105 @cindex @code{--silent}
1106 @cindex @code{-q}
1107 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1108 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch
1111 @cindex @code{--batch}
1112 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1113 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1114 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1115 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1116 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1117 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1118 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1119
1120 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1121 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1122 make this more useful, the message
1123
1124 @smallexample
1125 Program exited normally.
1126 @end smallexample
1127
1128 @noindent
1129 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1130 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1131 mode.
1132
1133 @item -batch-silent
1134 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1135 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1136 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1137 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1138 for an interactive session.
1139
1140 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1141 messages, for example.
1142
1143 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1144 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1145
1146 @item -return-child-result
1147 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1148 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1149 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152 @item
1153 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1154 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1155 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1156 @item
1157 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1158 @item
1159 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1160 the exit code will be -1.
1161 @end itemize
1162
1163 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1164 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1165 interface.
1166
1167 @item -nowindows
1168 @itemx -nw
1169 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1170 @cindex @code{-nw}
1171 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1172 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1173 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1174
1175 @item -windows
1176 @itemx -w
1177 @cindex @code{--windows}
1178 @cindex @code{-w}
1179 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1180 used if possible.
1181
1182 @item -cd @var{directory}
1183 @cindex @code{--cd}
1184 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1185 instead of the current directory.
1186
1187 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1188 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1190 @cindex @code{-D}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1192 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1193 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1194
1195 @item -fullname
1196 @itemx -f
1197 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1198 @cindex @code{-f}
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1200 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1201 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1202 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1203 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1204 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1205 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1206 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1207 frame.
1208
1209 @item -annotate @var{level}
1210 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1211 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1212 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1213 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1214 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1215 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1216 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1217 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1218 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1219
1220 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1221 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1222
1223 @item --args
1224 @cindex @code{--args}
1225 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1226 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1227 This option stops option processing.
1228
1229 @item -baud @var{bps}
1230 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1231 @cindex @code{--baud}
1232 @cindex @code{-b}
1233 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1234 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -l @var{timeout}
1237 @cindex @code{-l}
1238 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1239 for remote debugging.
1240
1241 @item -tty @var{device}
1242 @itemx -t @var{device}
1243 @cindex @code{--tty}
1244 @cindex @code{-t}
1245 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1246 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1247
1248 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1249 @item -tui
1250 @cindex @code{--tui}
1251 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1252 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1253 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1254 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1255 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1256 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1257
1258 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1259 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1260 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1261 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1262 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1263 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1264
1265 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1266 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1267 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1268 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1269 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1270 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1271
1272 @item -write
1273 @cindex @code{--write}
1274 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1275 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1276 (@pxref{Patching}).
1277
1278 @item -statistics
1279 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1281 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1282
1283 @item -version
1284 @cindex @code{--version}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1286 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1287
1288 @item -configuration
1289 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1290 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1291 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1292 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1293
1294 @end table
1295
1296 @node Startup
1297 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1298 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1299
1300 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1301
1302 @enumerate
1303 @item
1304 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1305 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1306
1307 @item
1308 @cindex init file
1309 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1310 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1311 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1312 that file.
1313
1314 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1315 @item
1316 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1317 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1318 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1322 @item
1323 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1324 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1325 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1326 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1327 gets loaded.
1328
1329 @item
1330 Processes command line options and operands.
1331
1332 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1333 @item
1334 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1335 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1336 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1337 This is only done if the current directory is
1338 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1339 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1340 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1341 @value{GDBN}.
1342
1343 @item
1344 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1345 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1346 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1347 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1348
1349 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1350 you must do something like the following:
1351
1352 @smallexample
1353 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1354 @end smallexample
1355
1356 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1357 off too late.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1361 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1362 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1366 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1367 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1371 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1372 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1373 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1374 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1375 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1376
1377 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1378 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1379
1380 @cindex init file name
1381 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1382 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1383 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1384 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1385 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1386 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1387 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1388 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1389
1390
1391 @node Quitting GDB
1392 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1393 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1394 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1395
1396 @table @code
1397 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1398 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1399 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1400 @itemx q
1401 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1402 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1403 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1404 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1405 error code.
1406 @end table
1407
1408 @cindex interrupt
1409 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1410 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1411 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1412 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1413 until a time when it is safe.
1414
1415 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1416 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1417 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1418
1419 @node Shell Commands
1420 @section Shell Commands
1421
1422 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1423 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1424 just use the @code{shell} command.
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex shell
1428 @kindex !
1429 @cindex shell escape
1430 @item shell @var{command-string}
1431 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1432 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1433 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1434 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1435 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1436 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1437 @end table
1438
1439 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1440 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1441 @value{GDBN}:
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex make
1445 @cindex calling make
1446 @item make @var{make-args}
1447 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1448 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1449 @end table
1450
1451 @node Logging Output
1452 @section Logging Output
1453 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1454 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1455
1456 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1457 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1458
1459 @table @code
1460 @kindex set logging
1461 @item set logging on
1462 Enable logging.
1463 @item set logging off
1464 Disable logging.
1465 @cindex logging file name
1466 @item set logging file @var{file}
1467 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1468 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1469 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1470 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1471 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1472 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1473 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1474 @kindex show logging
1475 @item show logging
1476 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1477 @end table
1478
1479 @node Commands
1480 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1481
1482 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1483 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1484 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1485 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1486 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1487
1488 @menu
1489 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1490 * Completion:: Command completion
1491 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1492 @end menu
1493
1494 @node Command Syntax
1495 @section Command Syntax
1496
1497 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1498 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1499 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1500 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1501 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1502 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1503
1504 @cindex abbreviation
1505 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1506 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1507 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1508 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1509 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1510 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1511 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1512
1513 @cindex repeating commands
1514 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1515 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1516 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1517 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1518 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1519 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1520 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1521
1522 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1523 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1524 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1525
1526 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1527 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1528 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1529 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1530 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1531
1532 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1533 @cindex comment
1534 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1535 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1536 Files,,Command Files}).
1537
1538 @cindex repeating command sequences
1539 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1540 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1541 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1542 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1543 for editing.
1544
1545 @node Completion
1546 @section Command Completion
1547
1548 @cindex completion
1549 @cindex word completion
1550 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1551 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1552 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1553 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1554
1555 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1556 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1557 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1558 enter it). For example, if you type
1559
1560 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1561 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1562 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1563 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1566 @end smallexample
1567
1568 @noindent
1569 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1570 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1578 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1579 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1580 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1581 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1582 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1583
1584 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1585 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1586 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1587 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1588 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1589 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1590 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1591 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1592 example:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1596 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1597 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1598 make_abs_section make_function_type
1599 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1600 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1601 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1602 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1607 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1608 command.
1609
1610 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1611 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1612 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1613 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1614 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1615
1616 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1617 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1618 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1622 main
1623 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1624 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent
1629 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex set max-completions
1633 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1634 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1635 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1636 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1637 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1638 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1639 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1640 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1641 completion slow.
1642 @kindex show max-completions
1643 @item show max-completions
1644 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1645 during completion.
1646 @end table
1647
1648 @cindex quotes in commands
1649 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1650 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1651 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1652 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1653 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1654 @value{GDBN} commands.
1655
1656 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1657 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1658 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1659 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1660 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1661 Operators}).
1662
1663 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1664 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1665 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1666 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1667 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1668 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1669 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1670 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1671 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1675 func<int>() func<float>()
1676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1680 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1681 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1682 function:
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1686 func<int>() func<float>()
1687 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1691 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1692 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1693 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1694 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1695 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1699 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1700 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1701 bubble(double)
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1705 require quoting.
1706
1707 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1708 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1709 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1710 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1711
1712 @cindex completion of structure field names
1713 @cindex structure field name completion
1714 @cindex completion of union field names
1715 @cindex union field name completion
1716 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1717 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1718 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1719 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1720 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1721 left-hand-side:
1722
1723 @smallexample
1724 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1725 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1726 to_data to_isatty to_write
1727 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1728 to_flush to_read
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1733 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1734 follows:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 struct ui_file
1738 @{
1739 int *magic;
1740 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1741 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1742 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1743 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1744 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1745 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1746 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1747 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1748 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1749 void *to_data;
1750 @}
1751 @end smallexample
1752
1753
1754 @node Help
1755 @section Getting Help
1756 @cindex online documentation
1757 @kindex help
1758
1759 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1760 using the command @code{help}.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1764 @item help
1765 @itemx h
1766 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1767 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help
1771 List of classes of commands:
1772
1773 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1774 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1775 data -- Examining data
1776 files -- Specifying and examining files
1777 internals -- Maintenance commands
1778 obscure -- Obscure features
1779 running -- Running the program
1780 stack -- Examining the stack
1781 status -- Status inquiries
1782 support -- Support facilities
1783 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1784 stopping the program
1785 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1786
1787 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1788 commands in that class.
1789 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1790 documentation.
1791 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1792 (@value{GDBP})
1793 @end smallexample
1794 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1795
1796 @item help @var{class}
1797 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1798 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1799 help display for the class @code{status}:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1803 Status inquiries.
1804
1805 List of commands:
1806
1807 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1808 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1809 info -- Generic command for showing things
1810 about the program being debugged
1811 show -- Generic command for showing things
1812 about the debugger
1813
1814 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1815 documentation.
1816 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1817 (@value{GDBP})
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @item help @var{command}
1821 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1822 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1823
1824 @kindex apropos
1825 @item apropos @var{args}
1826 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1827 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1828 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 apropos alias
1832 @end smallexample
1833
1834 @noindent
1835 results in:
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @c @group
1839 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1840 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1841 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1842 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1843 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1844 @c @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 @kindex complete
1848 @item complete @var{args}
1849 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1850 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1851 command you want completed. For example:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 complete i
1855 @end smallexample
1856
1857 @noindent results in:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 @group
1861 if
1862 ignore
1863 info
1864 inspect
1865 @end group
1866 @end smallexample
1867
1868 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1872 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1873 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1874 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1875 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1876 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1877 Index}.
1878
1879 @c @group
1880 @table @code
1881 @kindex info
1882 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1883 @item info
1884 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1885 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1886 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1887 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1888 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1889 @w{@code{help info}}.
1890
1891 @kindex set
1892 @item set
1893 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1894 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1895 @code{set prompt $}.
1896
1897 @kindex show
1898 @item show
1899 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1900 @value{GDBN} itself.
1901 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1902 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1903 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1904 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1905
1906 @kindex info set
1907 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1908 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1909 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1910 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1911 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1912 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1913 @end table
1914 @c @end group
1915
1916 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1917 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @kindex show version
1921 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1922 @item show version
1923 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1924 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1925 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1926 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1927 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1928 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1929 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1930 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1931 @value{GDBN}.
1932
1933 @kindex show copying
1934 @kindex info copying
1935 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1936 @item show copying
1937 @itemx info copying
1938 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1939
1940 @kindex show warranty
1941 @kindex info warranty
1942 @item show warranty
1943 @itemx info warranty
1944 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1945 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1946
1947 @kindex show configuration
1948 @item show configuration
1949 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1950 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1951 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1952 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1953 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1954 your report.
1955
1956 @end table
1957
1958 @node Running
1959 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1960
1961 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1962 debugging information when you compile it.
1963
1964 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1965 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1966 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1967 kill a child process.
1968
1969 @menu
1970 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1971 * Starting:: Starting your program
1972 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1973 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1974
1975 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1976 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1977 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1978 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1979
1980 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1981 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1982 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1983 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1984 @end menu
1985
1986 @node Compilation
1987 @section Compiling for Debugging
1988
1989 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1990 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1991 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1992 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1993 and addresses in the executable code.
1994
1995 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1996 the compiler.
1997
1998 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1999 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2000 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2001 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2002 executables containing debugging information.
2003
2004 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2005 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2006 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2007 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2008 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2009
2010 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2011 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2012 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2013
2014 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2015 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2016 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2017 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2018 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2019 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2020
2021 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2022 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2023 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2024
2025 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2026 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2027 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2028 format in @value{GDBN}.
2029
2030 @need 2000
2031 @node Starting
2032 @section Starting your Program
2033 @cindex starting
2034 @cindex running
2035
2036 @table @code
2037 @kindex run
2038 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2039 @item run
2040 @itemx r
2041 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2042 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2043 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2044 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2045 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2050 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2051 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2052 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2053 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2054 message like this one:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2058 Try "help target" or "continue".
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @noindent
2062 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2063 first (@pxref{load}).
2064
2065 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2066 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2067 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2068 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2069 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2070 divided into four categories:
2071
2072 @table @asis
2073 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2074 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2075 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2076 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2077 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2078 the arguments.
2079 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2080 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2081 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2082 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2083 below for details).
2084
2085 @item The @emph{environment.}
2086 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2087 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2088 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2089 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2090
2091 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2092 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2093 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2094 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2095 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2096 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2097 Directory}.
2098
2099 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2100 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2101 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2102 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2103 set a different device for your program.
2104 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2105
2106 @cindex pipes
2107 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2108 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2109 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2110 wrong program.
2111 @end table
2112
2113 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2114 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2115 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2116 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2117 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2118
2119 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2120 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2121 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2122 your current breakpoints.
2123
2124 @table @code
2125 @kindex start
2126 @item start
2127 @cindex run to main procedure
2128 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2129 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2130 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2131 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2132 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2133 procedure, depending on the language used.
2134
2135 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2136 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2137 the @samp{run} command.
2138
2139 @cindex elaboration phase
2140 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2141 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2142 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2143 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2144 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2145 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2146 will remain to halt execution.
2147
2148 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2149 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2150 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2151 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2152 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2153
2154 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2155 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2156 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2157 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2158 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2159 use the @code{starti} command.
2160
2161 @kindex starti
2162 @item starti
2163 @cindex run to first instruction
2164 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2165 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2166 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2167 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2168 the start of the elaboration phase.
2169
2170 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2171 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2172 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2173 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2174 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2175 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2176 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2177 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2178 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2179 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2180 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2181 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2182
2183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2187
2188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2190 environment:
2191
2192 @smallexample
2193 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2194 (@value{GDBP}) run
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2198 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2199
2200 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2201 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2202 @item set startup-with-shell
2203 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2204 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2205 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2206 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2207 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2208 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2209 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2210 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2211 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2212 startup failures such as:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Starting program: ./a.out
2217 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @noindent
2221 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2222 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2223 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2224 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2225 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2226 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2227
2228 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2229 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2230 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2231 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2232 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2233 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2234
2235 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2236 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2237 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2238 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2239 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2240 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2241
2242 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2243 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2244 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2245
2246 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2247 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2248
2249 @smallexample
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2255 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2256
2257 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2258 @code{target native} command. For example,
2259
2260 @smallexample
2261 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2262 (@value{GDBP}) run
2263 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2264 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2265 (@value{GDBP}) run
2266 Starting program: ./a.out
2267 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2268 @end smallexample
2269
2270 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2271 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2272 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2273 disconnect.
2274
2275 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2276 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2277 proc}, @code{info os}.
2278
2279 @kindex set disable-randomization
2280 @item set disable-randomization
2281 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2282 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2283 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2284 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2285 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2286
2287 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2288 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2292 @end smallexample
2293
2294 @item set disable-randomization off
2295 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2296 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2297 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2298 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2299 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2300 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2301
2302 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2303 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2304 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2305 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2306 a code at its expected addresses.
2307
2308 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2309 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2310 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2311 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2312 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2313 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2314 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2315 a randomly chosen address.
2316
2317 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2318 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2319 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2320 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2321 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2322
2323 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2324 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2325
2326 @item show disable-randomization
2327 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2328 the virtual address space of the started program.
2329
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Arguments
2333 @section Your Program's Arguments
2334
2335 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2336 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2337 @code{run} command.
2338 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2339 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2340 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2341 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2342 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2343
2344 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2345 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2346 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2347 the program, not by the shell.
2348
2349 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2350 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2351
2352 @table @code
2353 @kindex set args
2354 @item set args
2355 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2356 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2357 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2358 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2359 it again without arguments.
2360
2361 @kindex show args
2362 @item show args
2363 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2364 @end table
2365
2366 @node Environment
2367 @section Your Program's Environment
2368
2369 @cindex environment (of your program)
2370 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2371 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2372 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2373 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2374 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2375 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2376 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2377
2378 @table @code
2379 @kindex path
2380 @item path @var{directory}
2381 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2382 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2383 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2384 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2385 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2386 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2387 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2388
2389 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2390 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2391 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2392 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2393 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2394 @var{directory} to the search path.
2395 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2396 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2397
2398 @kindex show paths
2399 @item show paths
2400 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2401 environment variable).
2402
2403 @kindex show environment
2404 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2405 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2406 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2407 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2408 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2409
2410 @kindex set environment
2411 @anchor{set environment}
2412 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2413 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2414 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2415 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2416 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2417 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2418 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2419 null value.
2420 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2421 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2422
2423 For example, this command:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 set env USER = foo
2427 @end smallexample
2428
2429 @noindent
2430 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2431 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2432 are not actually required.)
2433
2434 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2435 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2436 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2437 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2438 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2439
2440 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2441 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2442 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2443
2444 @kindex unset environment
2445 @anchor{unset environment}
2446 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2447 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2448 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2449 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2450 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2451
2452 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2453 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2454 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2458 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2459 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2460 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2461 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2462 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2463 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2464 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2465 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2466 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2467
2468 @node Working Directory
2469 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2470
2471 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2472 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2473 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2474 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2475 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2476 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2477 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2478 debugging.
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex set cwd
2482 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2483 @anchor{set cwd command}
2484 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2485 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2486 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2487 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2488 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2489 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2490 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2491 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2492 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2493 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2494 fallback.
2495
2496 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2497 the @code{cd} command.
2498 @xref{cd command}.
2499
2500 @kindex show cwd
2501 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2502 @item show cwd
2503 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2504 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2505 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2506
2507 @kindex cd
2508 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2509 @anchor{cd command}
2510 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2511 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2512 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2513
2514 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2515 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2516 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2517 @xref{set cwd command}.
2518
2519 @kindex pwd
2520 @item pwd
2521 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2522 @end table
2523
2524 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2525 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2526 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2527 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2528 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2529 current working directory of the debuggee.
2530
2531 @node Input/Output
2532 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2533
2534 @cindex redirection
2535 @cindex i/o
2536 @cindex terminal
2537 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2538 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2539 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2540 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2541 running your program.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info terminal
2545 @item info terminal
2546 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2547 program is using.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2551 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 run > outfile
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2559
2560 @kindex tty
2561 @cindex controlling terminal
2562 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2563 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2564 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2565 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2566 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 tty /dev/ttyb
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2574 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2575 that as their controlling terminal.
2576
2577 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2578 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2579 terminal.
2580
2581 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2582 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2583 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2584 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2585
2586 @cindex inferior tty
2587 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2588 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2589 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2590 program.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2594 @kindex set inferior-tty
2595 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2596 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2597 @value{GDBN}.
2598
2599 @item show inferior-tty
2600 @kindex show inferior-tty
2601 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @node Attach
2605 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2606 @kindex attach
2607 @cindex attach
2608
2609 @table @code
2610 @item attach @var{process-id}
2611 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2612 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2613 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2614 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2615 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2616
2617 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2618 executing the command.
2619 @end table
2620
2621 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2622 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2623 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2624 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2625
2626 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2627 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2628 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2629 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2630 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2631 Specify Files}.
2632
2633 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2634 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2635 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2636 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2637 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2638 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2639 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex detach
2643 @item detach
2644 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2645 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2646 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2647 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2648 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2649 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2650 executing the command.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2654 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2655 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2656 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2657 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2658 Messages}).
2659
2660 @node Kill Process
2661 @section Killing the Child Process
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @kindex kill
2665 @item kill
2666 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2670 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2671 is running.
2672
2673 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2674 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2675 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2676 outside the debugger.
2677
2678 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2679 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2680 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2681 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2682 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2683 breakpoint settings).
2684
2685 @node Inferiors and Programs
2686 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2687
2688 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2689 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2690 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2691 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2692 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2693 from multiple executables.
2694
2695 @cindex inferior
2696 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2697 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2698 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2699 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2700 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2701 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2702 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2703 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2704 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2705 threads running in it.
2706
2707 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2708 inferiors}}:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex info inferiors
2712 @item info inferiors
2713 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2714
2715 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2716
2717 @enumerate
2718 @item
2719 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2720
2721 @item
2722 the target system's inferior identifier
2723
2724 @item
2725 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2726
2727 @end enumerate
2728
2729 @noindent
2730 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2731 indicates the current inferior.
2732
2733 For example,
2734 @end table
2735 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2736
2737 @smallexample
2738 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2739 Num Description Executable
2740 2 process 2307 hello
2741 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2742 @end smallexample
2743
2744 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2745
2746 @table @code
2747 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2748 @item inferior @var{infno}
2749 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2750 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2751 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2752 @end table
2753
2754 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2755 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2756 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2757 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2758 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2759 information on convenience variables.
2760
2761 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2762 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2763 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2764 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2765 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2766 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2767
2768 @table @code
2769 @kindex add-inferior
2770 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2771 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2772 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2773 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2774 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2775 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2776
2777 @kindex clone-inferior
2778 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2779 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2780 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2781 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2782 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2783
2784 @smallexample
2785 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2786 Num Description Executable
2787 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2788 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2789 Added inferior 2.
2790 1 inferiors added.
2791 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2792 Num Description Executable
2793 2 <null> helloworld
2794 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2795 @end smallexample
2796
2797 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2798
2799 @kindex remove-inferiors
2800 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2801 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2802 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2803 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2804
2805 @end table
2806
2807 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2808 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2809 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2810 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2811
2812 @table @code
2813 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2814 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2815 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2816 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2817 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2818 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2819
2820 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2821 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2822 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2823 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2824 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2825 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2826 @end table
2827
2828 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2829 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2830 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2831 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2832
2833
2834 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2835 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2836
2837 @table @code
2838 @kindex set print inferior-events
2839 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2840 @item set print inferior-events
2841 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2842 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2843 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2844 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2845 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2846 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2847
2848 @kindex show print inferior-events
2849 @item show print inferior-events
2850 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2851 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2852 @end table
2853
2854 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2855 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2856 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2857
2858
2859 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2860 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2861 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2862 info program-spaces}} command.
2863
2864 @table @code
2865 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2866 @item maint info program-spaces
2867 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2868 @value{GDBN}.
2869
2870 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2871
2872 @enumerate
2873 @item
2874 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2875
2876 @item
2877 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2878 the @code{file} command.
2879
2880 @end enumerate
2881
2882 @noindent
2883 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2884 indicates the current program space.
2885
2886 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2887 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2888 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2889
2890 @smallexample
2891 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2892 Id Executable
2893 * 1 hello
2894 2 goodbye
2895 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2896 @end smallexample
2897
2898 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2899 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2900 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2901 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2902 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2903
2904 @smallexample
2905 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2906 Id Executable
2907 * 1 vfork-test
2908 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2909 @end smallexample
2910
2911 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2912 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2913 @end table
2914
2915 @node Threads
2916 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2917
2918 @cindex threads of execution
2919 @cindex multiple threads
2920 @cindex switching threads
2921 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2922 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2923 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2924 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2925 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2926 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2927 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2928
2929 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2930 programs:
2931
2932 @itemize @bullet
2933 @item automatic notification of new threads
2934 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2935 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2936 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2937 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2938 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2939 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2940 messages on thread start and exit.
2941 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2942 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2943 isn't compatible with the program.
2944 @end itemize
2945
2946 @cindex focus of debugging
2947 @cindex current thread
2948 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2949 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2950 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2951 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2952 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2953
2954 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2955 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2956 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2957 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2958 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2959 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2960 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2961 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2962 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2963 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2964
2965 @smallexample
2966 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2967 @end smallexample
2968
2969 @noindent
2970 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2971 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2972 further qualifier.
2973
2974 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2975 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2976 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2977 @c program?
2978 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2979 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2980 @c threads ab initio?
2981
2982 @anchor{thread numbers}
2983 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2984 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2985 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2986 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2987 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2988 between threads of different inferiors.
2989
2990 @cindex qualified thread ID
2991 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2992 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2993 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2994 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2995 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2996 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
2997 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
2998 inferior.
2999
3000 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3001 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3002 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3003 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3004
3005 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3006 @cindex thread ID lists
3007 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3008 argument. A list element can be:
3009
3010 @enumerate
3011 @item
3012 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3013 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3014 @samp{1}.
3015
3016 @item
3017 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3018 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3019 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3020
3021 @item
3022 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3023 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3024 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3025 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3026 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3027
3028 @end enumerate
3029
3030 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3031 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3032 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3033 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3034 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3035 7.1}.
3036
3037
3038 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3039 @cindex global thread number
3040 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3041 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3042 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3043 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3044 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3045 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3046
3047 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3048 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3049 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3050
3051 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3052 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3053 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3054 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3055 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3056 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3057 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3058 general information on convenience variables.
3059
3060 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3061 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3062 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3063
3064 @smallexample
3065 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3066 @end smallexample
3067
3068 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3069
3070 @smallexample
3071 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3072 @end smallexample
3073
3074 @table @code
3075 @kindex info threads
3076 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3077
3078 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3079 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3080 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3081 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3082
3083 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3084
3085 @enumerate
3086 @item
3087 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3088
3089 @item
3090 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3091 option was specified
3092
3093 @item
3094 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3095
3096 @item
3097 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3098 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3099 program itself.
3100
3101 @item
3102 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3103 @end enumerate
3104
3105 @noindent
3106 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3107 indicates the current thread.
3108
3109 For example,
3110 @end table
3111 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3112
3113 @smallexample
3114 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3115 Id Target Id Frame
3116 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3117 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3118 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3119 at threadtest.c:68
3120 @end smallexample
3121
3122 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3123 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3124 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3125
3126 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3127 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3128
3129 @smallexample
3130 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3131 Id GId Target Id Frame
3132 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3133 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3134 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3135 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3136 @end smallexample
3137
3138 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3139 Solaris-specific command:
3140
3141 @table @code
3142 @item maint info sol-threads
3143 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3144 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3145 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3146 @end table
3147
3148 @table @code
3149 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3150 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3151 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3152 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3153 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3154 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3155
3156 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3157 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3158
3159 @smallexample
3160 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3161 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3162 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3163 8 printf ("hello\n");
3164 @end smallexample
3165
3166 @noindent
3167 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3168 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3169 threads.
3170
3171 @kindex thread apply
3172 @cindex apply command to several threads
3173 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
3174 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3175 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3176 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3177 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3178 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3179 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3180 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3181
3182
3183 @kindex thread name
3184 @cindex name a thread
3185 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3186 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3187 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3188 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3189
3190 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3191 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3192 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3193 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3194 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3195
3196 @kindex thread find
3197 @cindex search for a thread
3198 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3199 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3200 matches the supplied regular expression.
3201
3202 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3203 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3204 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3205 is the LWP id.
3206
3207 @smallexample
3208 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3209 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3210 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3211 Id Target Id Frame
3212 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3213 @end smallexample
3214
3215 @kindex set print thread-events
3216 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3217 @item set print thread-events
3218 @itemx set print thread-events on
3219 @itemx set print thread-events off
3220 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3221 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3222 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3223 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3224 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3225
3226 @kindex show print thread-events
3227 @item show print thread-events
3228 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3229 have started and exited.
3230 @end table
3231
3232 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3233 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3234 programs with multiple threads.
3235
3236 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3237 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3238
3239 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3240 @table @code
3241 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3242 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3243 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3244 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3245 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3246 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3247 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3248 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3249 macro.
3250
3251 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3252 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3253 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3254 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3255 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3256 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3257
3258 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3259 refers to the default system directories that are
3260 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3261 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3262 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3263
3264 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3265 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3266 was loaded in the inferior process.
3267
3268 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3269 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3270 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3271 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3272 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3273 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3274 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3275
3276 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3277 only on some platforms.
3278
3279 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3280 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3281 Display current libthread_db search path.
3282
3283 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3284 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3285 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3286 @item set debug libthread-db
3287 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3288 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3289 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3290 @end table
3291
3292 @node Forks
3293 @section Debugging Forks
3294
3295 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3296 @cindex multiple processes
3297 @cindex processes, multiple
3298 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3299 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3300 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3301 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3302 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3303 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3304 will cause it to terminate.
3305
3306 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3307 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3308 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3309 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3310 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3311 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3312 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3313 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3314 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3315 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3316
3317 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3318 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3319 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3320 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3321
3322 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3323 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3324 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3325
3326 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3327 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3328
3329 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3330 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3331
3332 @table @code
3333 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3334 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3335 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3336 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3337 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3338
3339 @table @code
3340 @item parent
3341 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3342 unimpeded. This is the default.
3343
3344 @item child
3345 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3346 unimpeded.
3347
3348 @end table
3349
3350 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3351 @item show follow-fork-mode
3352 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3353 @end table
3354
3355 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3356 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3357 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3358
3359 @table @code
3360 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3361 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3362 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3363 retain debugger control over them both.
3364
3365 @table @code
3366 @item on
3367 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3368 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3369 independently. This is the default.
3370
3371 @item off
3372 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3373 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3374 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3375 is held suspended.
3376
3377 @end table
3378
3379 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3380 @item show detach-on-fork
3381 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3382 @end table
3383
3384 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3385 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3386 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3387 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3388 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3389 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3390
3391 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3392 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3393 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3394 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3395 and Programs}.
3396
3397 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3398 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3399 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3400 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3401 the child process's @code{main}.
3402
3403 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3404 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3405
3406 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3407 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3408 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3409 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3410 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3411 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3412 command.
3413
3414 @table @code
3415 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3416 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3417
3418 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3419 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3420
3421 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3422
3423 @table @code
3424 @item new
3425 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3426 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3427 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3428 original inferior.
3429
3430 For example:
3431
3432 @smallexample
3433 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3434 (gdb) info inferior
3435 Id Description Executable
3436 * 1 <null> prog1
3437 (@value{GDBP}) run
3438 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3439 Program exited normally.
3440 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3441 Id Description Executable
3442 1 <null> prog1
3443 * 2 <null> prog2
3444 @end smallexample
3445
3446 @item same
3447 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3448 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3449 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3450 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3451 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3452
3453 For example:
3454
3455 @smallexample
3456 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3457 Id Description Executable
3458 * 1 <null> prog1
3459 (@value{GDBP}) run
3460 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3461 Program exited normally.
3462 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3463 Id Description Executable
3464 * 1 <null> prog2
3465 @end smallexample
3466
3467 @end table
3468 @end table
3469
3470 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3471 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3472
3473 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3474 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3475 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3476
3477 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3478 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3479
3480 @cindex checkpoint
3481 @cindex restart
3482 @cindex bookmark
3483 @cindex snapshot of a process
3484 @cindex rewind program state
3485
3486 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3487 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3488 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3489 later.
3490
3491 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3492 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3493 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3494 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3495 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3496
3497 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3498 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3499 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3500 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3501 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3502 start again from there.
3503
3504 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3505 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3506
3507 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3508
3509 @table @code
3510 @kindex checkpoint
3511 @item checkpoint
3512 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3513 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3514 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3515
3516 @kindex info checkpoints
3517 @item info checkpoints
3518 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3519 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3520 listed:
3521
3522 @table @code
3523 @item Checkpoint ID
3524 @item Process ID
3525 @item Code Address
3526 @item Source line, or label
3527 @end table
3528
3529 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3530 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3531 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3532 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3533 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3534 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3535 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3536
3537 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3538 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3539 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3540 the debugger.
3541
3542 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3543 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3544 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3545
3546 @end table
3547
3548 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3549 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3550 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3551 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3552 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3553 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3554 previously read data can be read again.
3555
3556 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3557 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3558 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3559 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3560 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3561 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3562
3563 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3564 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3565 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3566 different execution path this time.
3567
3568 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3569 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3570 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3571 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3572 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3573 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3574 potentially pose a problem.
3575
3576 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3577
3578 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3579 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3580 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3581 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3582 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3583 next.
3584
3585 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3586 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3587 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3588 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3589 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3590
3591 @node Stopping
3592 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3593
3594 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3595 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3596 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3597
3598 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3599 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3600 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3601 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3602 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3603 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3604 explicitly request this information at any time.
3605
3606 @table @code
3607 @kindex info program
3608 @item info program
3609 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3610 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3611 @end table
3612
3613 @menu
3614 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3615 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3616 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3617 Skipping over functions and files
3618 * Signals:: Signals
3619 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3620 @end menu
3621
3622 @node Breakpoints
3623 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3624
3625 @cindex breakpoints
3626 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3627 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3628 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3629 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3630 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3631 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3632 program.
3633
3634 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3635 the executable is run.
3636
3637 @cindex watchpoints
3638 @cindex data breakpoints
3639 @cindex memory tracing
3640 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3641 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3642 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3643 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3644 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3645 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3646 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3647 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3648 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3649 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3650 same commands.
3651
3652 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3653 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3654 Automatic Display}.
3655
3656 @cindex catchpoints
3657 @cindex breakpoint on events
3658 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3659 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3660 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3661 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3662 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3663 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3664 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3665
3666 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3667 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3668 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3669 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3670 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3671 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3672 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3673 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3674 enable it again.
3675
3676 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3677 @cindex breakpoint lists
3678 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3679 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3680 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3681 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3682 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3683 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3684 are operated on.
3685
3686 @menu
3687 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3688 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3689 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3690 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3691 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3692 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3693 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3694 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3695 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3696 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3697 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3698 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3699 @end menu
3700
3701 @node Set Breaks
3702 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3703
3704 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3705 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3706 @c
3707 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3708
3709 @kindex break
3710 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3711 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3712 @cindex latest breakpoint
3713 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3714 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3715 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3716 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3717 convenience variables.
3718
3719 @table @code
3720 @item break @var{location}
3721 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3722 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3723 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3724 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3725 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3726
3727 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3728 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3729 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3730 that situation.
3731
3732 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3733 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3734 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3735
3736 @item break
3737 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3738 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3739 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3740 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3741 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3742 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3743 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3744 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3745 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3746 inside loops.
3747
3748 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3749 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3750 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3751 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3752 existed when your program stopped.
3753
3754 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3755 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3756 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3757 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3758 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3759 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3760 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3761
3762 @kindex tbreak
3763 @item tbreak @var{args}
3764 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3765 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3766 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3767 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3768
3769 @kindex hbreak
3770 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3771 @item hbreak @var{args}
3772 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3773 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3774 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3775 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3776 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3777 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3778 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3779 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3780 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3781 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3782 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3783 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3784 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3785 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3786 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3787 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3788 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3789 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3790
3791 @kindex thbreak
3792 @item thbreak @var{args}
3793 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3794 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3795 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3796 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3797 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3798 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3799 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3800 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3801
3802 @kindex rbreak
3803 @cindex regular expression
3804 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3805 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3806 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3807 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3808 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3809 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3810 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3811 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3812 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3813
3814 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3815 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3816 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3817 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3818 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3819 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3820
3821 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3822 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3823 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3824 classes.
3825
3826 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3827 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3828 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3829
3830 @smallexample
3831 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3832 @end smallexample
3833
3834 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3835 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3836 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3837 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3838 every function in a given file:
3839
3840 @smallexample
3841 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3842 @end smallexample
3843
3844 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3845 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3846
3847 @kindex info breakpoints
3848 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3849 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3850 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3851 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3852 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3853 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3854 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3855
3856 @table @emph
3857 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3858 @item Type
3859 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3860 @item Disposition
3861 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3862 @item Enabled or Disabled
3863 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3864 that are not enabled.
3865 @item Address
3866 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3867 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3868 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3869 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3870 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3871 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3872 @item What
3873 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3874 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3875 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3876 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3877 @end table
3878
3879 @noindent
3880 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3881 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3882 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3883 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3884 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3885 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3886
3887 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3888 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3889 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3890 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3891
3892 @noindent
3893 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3894 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3895 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3896 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3897 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3898
3899 @noindent
3900 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3901 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3902 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3903 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3904 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3905 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3906
3907 @noindent
3908 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3909 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3910
3911 @end table
3912
3913 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3914 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3915 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3916 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3917
3918 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3919 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3920 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3921 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3922
3923 @itemize @bullet
3924 @item
3925 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3926
3927 @item
3928 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3929 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3930
3931 @item
3932 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3933 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3934
3935 @item
3936 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3937 several places where that function is inlined.
3938 @end itemize
3939
3940 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3941 the relevant locations.
3942
3943 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3944 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3945 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3946 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3947 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3948 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3949 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3950
3951 For example:
3952
3953 @smallexample
3954 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3955 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3956 stop only if i==1
3957 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3958 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3959 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3960 @end smallexample
3961
3962 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
3963 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3964 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3965 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
3966 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
3967 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
3968 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
3969 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
3970 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
3971 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
3972 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
3973
3974 @cindex pending breakpoints
3975 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3976 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3977 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3978 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3979 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3980 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3981 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3982 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3983 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3984 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3985 is not yet resolved.
3986
3987 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3988 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3989 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3990 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3991 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3992 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3993
3994 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3995 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3996 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3997 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3998
3999 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4000 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4001 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4002
4003 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4004 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4005 address specification to an address:
4006
4007 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4008 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4009 @table @code
4010 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4011 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4012 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4013
4014 @item set breakpoint pending on
4015 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4016 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4017
4018 @item set breakpoint pending off
4019 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4020 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4021 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4022
4023 @item show breakpoint pending
4024 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4025 @end table
4026
4027 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4028 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4029 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4030
4031 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4032 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4033 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4034 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4035 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4036 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4037 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4038 breakpoints.
4039
4040 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4041
4042 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4043 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4044 @table @code
4045 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4046 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4047 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4048 breakpoint must be used.
4049
4050 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4051 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4052 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4053 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4054 @end table
4055
4056 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4057 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4058 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4059 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4060 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4061 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4062 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4063 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4064 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4065
4066 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4067 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4068 @table @code
4069 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4070 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4071 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4072 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4073
4074 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4075 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4076 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4077 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4078 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4079 @end table
4080
4081 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4082 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4083 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4084
4085 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4086 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4087
4088 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4089
4090 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4091 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4092 @table @code
4093 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4094 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4095 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4096 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4097 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4098
4099 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4100 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4101 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4102 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4103 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4104 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4105 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4106 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4107 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4108 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4109 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4110 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4111 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4112
4113 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4114 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4115 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4116 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4117 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4118 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4119 @end table
4120
4121
4122 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4123 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4124 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4125 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4126 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4127 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4128 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4129 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4130
4131
4132 @node Set Watchpoints
4133 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4134
4135 @cindex setting watchpoints
4136 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4137 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4138 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4139 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4140 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4141
4142 @itemize @bullet
4143 @item
4144 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4145
4146 @item
4147 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4148 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4149 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4150
4151 @item
4152 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4153 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4154 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4155 @end itemize
4156
4157 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4158 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4159 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4160 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4161 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4162 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4163 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4164 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4165 the expression changes.
4166
4167 @cindex software watchpoints
4168 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4169 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4170 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4171 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4172 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4173 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4174 culprit.)
4175
4176 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4177 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4178 slow down the running of your program.
4179
4180 @table @code
4181 @kindex watch
4182 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4183 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4184 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4185 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4186 to watch the value of a single variable:
4187
4188 @smallexample
4189 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4190 @end smallexample
4191
4192 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4193 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4194 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4195 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4196 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4197 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4198
4199 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4200 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4201 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4202 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4203 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4204 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4205 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4206 error.
4207
4208 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4209 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4210 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4211 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4212 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4213 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4214 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4215 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4216 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4217 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4218 Examples:
4219
4220 @smallexample
4221 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4222 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4223 @end smallexample
4224
4225 @kindex rwatch
4226 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4227 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4228 by the program.
4229
4230 @kindex awatch
4231 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4232 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4233 or written into by the program.
4234
4235 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4236 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4237 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4238 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4239 @end table
4240
4241 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4242 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4243 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4244 a never-changing value:
4245
4246 @smallexample
4247 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4248 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4249 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4250 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4251 @end smallexample
4252
4253 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4254 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4255 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4256 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4257 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4258 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4259
4260 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4261 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4262 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4263 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4264 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4265 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4266 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4267 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4268
4269 @table @code
4270 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4271 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4272 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4273
4274 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4275 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4276 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4277 @end table
4278
4279 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4280 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4281 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4282
4283 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4284
4285 @smallexample
4286 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 @noindent
4290 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4291
4292 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4293 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4294 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4295 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4296 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4297 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4298 will print a message like this:
4299
4300 @smallexample
4301 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4302 @end smallexample
4303
4304 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4305 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4306 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4307 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4308 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4309 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4310 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4311 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4312
4313 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4314 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4315 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4316 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4317 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4318 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4319
4320 @smallexample
4321 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4322 @end smallexample
4323
4324 @noindent
4325 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4326
4327 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4328 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4329 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4330 expression with separately allocated resources.
4331
4332 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4333 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4334 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4335
4336 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4337 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4338 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4339 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4340 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4341 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4342 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4343 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4344 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4345
4346 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4347 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4348 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4349 watched expression from every thread.
4350
4351 @quotation
4352 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4353 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4354 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4355 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4356 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4357 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4358 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4359 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4360 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4361 @end quotation
4362
4363 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4364
4365 @node Set Catchpoints
4366 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4367 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4368 @cindex exception handlers
4369 @cindex event handling
4370
4371 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4372 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4373 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4374
4375 @table @code
4376 @kindex catch
4377 @item catch @var{event}
4378 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4379
4380 @table @code
4381 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4382 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4383 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4384 @kindex catch throw
4385 @kindex catch rethrow
4386 @kindex catch catch
4387 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4388 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4389
4390 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4391 regular expression will be caught.
4392
4393 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4394 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4395 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4396 exception being thrown.
4397
4398 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4399 @value{GDBN}:
4400
4401 @itemize @bullet
4402 @item
4403 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4404 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4405 supported.
4406
4407 @item
4408 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4409 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4410 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4411 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4412 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4413 built.
4414
4415 @item
4416 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4417 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4418
4419 @item
4420 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4421 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4422 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4423 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4424
4425 @item
4426 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4427 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4428 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4429 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4430 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4431 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4432 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4433 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4434 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4435
4436 @item
4437 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4438
4439 @item
4440 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4441 @end itemize
4442
4443 @item exception
4444 @kindex catch exception
4445 @cindex Ada exception catching
4446 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4447 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4448 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4449 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4450 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4451
4452 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4453 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4454 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4455 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4456 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4457 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4458 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4459 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4460
4461 @item handlers
4462 @kindex catch handlers
4463 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4464 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4465 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4466 specified at the end of the command
4467 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4468 only when this specific exception is handled.
4469 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4470
4471 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4472 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4473 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4474 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4475 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4476 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4477 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4478 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4479 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4480
4481 @item exception unhandled
4482 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4483 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4484
4485 @item assert
4486 @kindex catch assert
4487 A failed Ada assertion.
4488
4489 @item exec
4490 @kindex catch exec
4491 @cindex break on fork/exec
4492 A call to @code{exec}.
4493
4494 @item syscall
4495 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4496 @kindex catch syscall
4497 @cindex break on a system call.
4498 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4499 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4500 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4501 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4502 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4503 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4504 will be caught.
4505
4506 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4507 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4508 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4509 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4510
4511 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4512 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4513 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4514 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4515
4516 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4517 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4518 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4519 available choices.
4520
4521 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4522 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4523 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4524 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4525 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4526 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4527 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4528 behind the OS upgrades).
4529
4530 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4531 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4532 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4533 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4534 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4535 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4536 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4537 syscall groups available on your environment.
4538
4539 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4540 arguments to it:
4541
4542 @smallexample
4543 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4544 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4545 (@value{GDBP}) r
4546 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4547
4548 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4549 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4550 (@value{GDBP}) c
4551 Continuing.
4552
4553 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4554 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4555 (@value{GDBP})
4556 @end smallexample
4557
4558 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4559
4560 @smallexample
4561 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4562 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4563 (@value{GDBP}) r
4564 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4565
4566 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4567 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4568 (@value{GDBP}) c
4569 Continuing.
4570
4571 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4572 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4573 (@value{GDBP})
4574 @end smallexample
4575
4576 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4577 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4578 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4579
4580 @smallexample
4581 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4582 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4583 (@value{GDBP}) r
4584 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4585
4586 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4587 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4588 (@value{GDBP}) c
4589 Continuing.
4590
4591 Program exited normally.
4592 (@value{GDBP})
4593 @end smallexample
4594
4595 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4596
4597 @smallexample
4598 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4599 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4600 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4601 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4602 (@value{GDBP}) r
4603 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4604
4605 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4606 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4607
4608 (@value{GDBP}) c
4609 Continuing.
4610 @end smallexample
4611
4612 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4613 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4614 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4615 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4616
4617 @smallexample
4618 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4619 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4620 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4621 (@value{GDBP})
4622 @end smallexample
4623
4624 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4625 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4626 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4627 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4628 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4629 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4630
4631 @smallexample
4632 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4633 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4634 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4635 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4636 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4637 (@value{GDBP})
4638 @end smallexample
4639
4640 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4641
4642 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4643 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4644
4645 @smallexample
4646 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4647 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4648 @end smallexample
4649
4650 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4651
4652 @item fork
4653 @kindex catch fork
4654 A call to @code{fork}.
4655
4656 @item vfork
4657 @kindex catch vfork
4658 A call to @code{vfork}.
4659
4660 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4661 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4662 @kindex catch load
4663 @kindex catch unload
4664 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4665 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4666 matches one of the affected libraries.
4667
4668 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4669 @kindex catch signal
4670 The delivery of a signal.
4671
4672 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4673 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4674 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4675
4676 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4677 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4678 signal names.
4679
4680 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4681 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4682 will be caught.
4683
4684 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4685 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4686 catchpoint.
4687
4688 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4689 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4690 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4691 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4692 commands.
4693
4694 @end table
4695
4696 @item tcatch @var{event}
4697 @kindex tcatch
4698 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4699 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4700
4701 @end table
4702
4703 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4704
4705
4706 @node Delete Breaks
4707 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4708
4709 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4710 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4711 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4712 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4713 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4714 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4715
4716 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4717 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4718 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4719 their breakpoint numbers.
4720
4721 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4722 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4723 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4724
4725 @table @code
4726 @kindex clear
4727 @item clear
4728 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4729 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4730 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4731 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4732
4733 @item clear @var{location}
4734 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4735 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4736 most useful ones are listed below:
4737
4738 @table @code
4739 @item clear @var{function}
4740 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4741 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4742
4743 @item clear @var{linenum}
4744 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4745 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4746 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4747 @end table
4748
4749 @cindex delete breakpoints
4750 @kindex delete
4751 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4752 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4753 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4754 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4755 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4756 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4757 @end table
4758
4759 @node Disabling
4760 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4761
4762 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4763 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4764 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4765 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4766 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4767
4768 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4769 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4770 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4771 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4772 do not know which numbers to use.
4773
4774 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4775 affects all of its locations.
4776
4777 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4778 different states of enablement:
4779
4780 @itemize @bullet
4781 @item
4782 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4783 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4784 @item
4785 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4786 @item
4787 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4788 disabled.
4789 @item
4790 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4791 N times, then becomes disabled.
4792 @item
4793 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4794 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4795 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4796 @end itemize
4797
4798 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4799 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4800
4801 @table @code
4802 @kindex disable
4803 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4804 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4805 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4806 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4807 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4808 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4809 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4810
4811 @kindex enable
4812 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4813 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4814 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4815
4816 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4817 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4818 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4819
4820 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4821 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4822 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4823 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4824 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4825 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4826 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4827
4828 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4829 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4830 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4831 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4832 @end table
4833
4834 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4835 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4836 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4837 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4838 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4839 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4840 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4841 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4842 Stepping}.)
4843
4844 @node Conditions
4845 @subsection Break Conditions
4846 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4847 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4848
4849 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4850 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4851 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4852 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4853 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4854 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4855 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4856 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4857
4858 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4859 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4860 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4861 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4862 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4863
4864 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4865 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4866 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4867 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4868 one.
4869
4870 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4871 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4872 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4873 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4874 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4875 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4876 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4877 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4878 conditions for the
4879 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4880 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4881
4882 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4883 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4884 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4885 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4886 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4887 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4888
4889 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4890 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4891 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4892 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4893 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4894
4895 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4896 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4897 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4898 with the @code{condition} command.
4899
4900 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4901 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4902 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4903 catchpoint.
4904
4905 @table @code
4906 @kindex condition
4907 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4908 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4909 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4910 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4911 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4912 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4913 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4914 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4915 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4916 prints an error message:
4917
4918 @smallexample
4919 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4920 @end smallexample
4921
4922 @noindent
4923 @value{GDBN} does
4924 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4925 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4926 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4927
4928 @item condition @var{bnum}
4929 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4930 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4931 @end table
4932
4933 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4934 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4935 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4936 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4937 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4938 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4939 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4940 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4941 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4942 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4943 your program reaches it.
4944
4945 @table @code
4946 @kindex ignore
4947 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4948 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4949 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4950 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4951 takes no action.
4952
4953 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4954 a count of zero.
4955
4956 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4957 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4958 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4959 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4960
4961 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4962 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4963 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4964
4965 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4966 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4967 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4968 Variables}.
4969 @end table
4970
4971 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4972
4973
4974 @node Break Commands
4975 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4976
4977 @cindex breakpoint commands
4978 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4979 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4980 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4981 enable other breakpoints.
4982
4983 @table @code
4984 @kindex commands
4985 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4986 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4987 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4988 @itemx end
4989 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4990 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4991 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4992
4993 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4994 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4995
4996 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4997 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4998 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4999 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5000 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5001 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5002 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5003 Expressions}).
5004 @end table
5005
5006 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5007 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5008
5009 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5010 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5011 that resumes execution.
5012
5013 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5014 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5015 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5016 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5017 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5018
5019 @kindex silent
5020 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5021 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5022 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5023 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5024 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5025 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5026
5027 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5028 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5029 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5030
5031 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5032 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5033
5034 @smallexample
5035 break foo if x>0
5036 commands
5037 silent
5038 printf "x is %d\n",x
5039 cont
5040 end
5041 @end smallexample
5042
5043 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5044 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5045 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5046 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5047 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5048 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5049 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5050
5051 @smallexample
5052 break 403
5053 commands
5054 silent
5055 set x = y + 4
5056 cont
5057 end
5058 @end smallexample
5059
5060 @node Dynamic Printf
5061 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5062
5063 @cindex dynamic printf
5064 @cindex dprintf
5065 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5066 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5067 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5068 having to recompile it.
5069
5070 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5071 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5072 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5073 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5074 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5075 redirects to files and so forth.
5076
5077 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5078 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5079 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5080 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5081 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5082 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5083 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5084
5085 @table @code
5086 @kindex dprintf
5087 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5088 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5089 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5090 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5091
5092 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5093 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5094 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5095 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5096 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5097 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5098
5099 @table @code
5100 @item gdb
5101 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5102 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5103
5104 @item call
5105 @kindex dprintf-style call
5106 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5107 @code{printf}).
5108
5109 @item agent
5110 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5111 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5112 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5113 support running commands on the target.
5114 @end table
5115
5116 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5117 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5118 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5119 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5120 command.
5121
5122 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5123 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5124 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5125 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5126 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5127 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5128
5129 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5130 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5131 you could do the following:
5132
5133 @example
5134 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5135 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5136 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5137 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5138 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5139 (gdb) info break
5140 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5141 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5142 continue
5143 (gdb)
5144 @end example
5145
5146 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5147 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5148 the variable settings.
5149
5150 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5151 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5152 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5153 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5154 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5155 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5156
5157 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5158 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5159 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5160
5161 @end table
5162
5163 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5164 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5165 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5166 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5167 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5168 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5169
5170 @node Save Breakpoints
5171 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5172
5173 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5174 breakpoints}} command.
5175
5176 @table @code
5177 @kindex save breakpoints
5178 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5179 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5180 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5181 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5182 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5183 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5184 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5185 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5186 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5187 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5188 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5189 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5190 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5191 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5192 that can no longer be recreated.
5193 @end table
5194
5195 @node Static Probe Points
5196 @subsection Static Probe Points
5197
5198 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5199 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5200 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5201 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5202 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5203
5204 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5205 ELF-compatible systems:
5206
5207 @itemize @bullet
5208
5209 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5210 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5211 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5212 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5213 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5214 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5215 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5216 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5217
5218 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5219 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5220 C@t{++} languages.
5221 @end itemize
5222
5223 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5224 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5225 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5226 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5227 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5228 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5229 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5230 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5231 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5232
5233 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5234 probes}, with optional arguments:
5235
5236 @table @code
5237 @kindex info probes
5238 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5239 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5240 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5241 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5242
5243 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5244 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5245 probes from all providers are listed.
5246
5247 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5248 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5249 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5250
5251 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5252 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5253 given, all object files are considered.
5254
5255 @item info probes all
5256 List the available static probes, from all types.
5257 @end table
5258
5259 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5260 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5261 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5262 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5263 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5264
5265 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5266 commands, with optional arguments:
5267
5268 @table @code
5269 @kindex enable probes
5270 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5271 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5272 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5273 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5274
5275 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5276 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5277 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5278
5279 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5280 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5281 given, all object files are considered.
5282
5283 @kindex disable probes
5284 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5285 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5286 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5287 @end table
5288
5289 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5290 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5291 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5292 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5293 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5294 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5295 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5296 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5297 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5298 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5299 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5300 at the current probe point.
5301
5302 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5303 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5304 an error message.
5305
5306
5307 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5308 @node Error in Breakpoints
5309 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5310
5311 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5312 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5313
5314 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5315 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5316 @smallexample
5317 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5318 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5319 @end smallexample
5320
5321 @noindent
5322 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5323 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5324 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5325
5326 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5327 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5328
5329 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5330 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5331 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5332
5333 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5334 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5335 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5336 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5337
5338 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5339 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5340 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5341 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5342 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5343 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5344 first in the bundle.
5345
5346 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5347 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5348 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5349 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5350 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5351 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5352 is hit.
5353
5354 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5355 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5356
5357 @smallexample
5358 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5359 @end smallexample
5360
5361 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5362 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5363 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5364 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5365 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5366 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5367 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5368 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5369
5370 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5371 adjusted breakpoints:
5372
5373 @smallexample
5374 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5375 to 0x00010410.
5376 @end smallexample
5377
5378 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5379 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5380 frequently than expected.
5381
5382 @node Continuing and Stepping
5383 @section Continuing and Stepping
5384
5385 @cindex stepping
5386 @cindex continuing
5387 @cindex resuming execution
5388 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5389 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5390 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5391 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5392 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5393 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5394 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5395 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5396 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5397 handlers}).)
5398
5399 @table @code
5400 @kindex continue
5401 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5402 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5403 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5404 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5405 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5406 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5407 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5408 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5409 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5410 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5411
5412 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5413 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5414 @code{continue} is ignored.
5415
5416 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5417 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5418 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5419 @code{continue}.
5420 @end table
5421
5422 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5423 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5424 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5425 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5426
5427 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5428 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5429 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5430 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5431 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5432 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5433
5434 @table @code
5435 @kindex step
5436 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5437 @item step
5438 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5439 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5440 abbreviated @code{s}.
5441
5442 @quotation
5443 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5444 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5445 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5446 @c distinction here.
5447 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5448 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5449 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5450 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5451 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5452 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5453 below.
5454 @end quotation
5455
5456 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5457 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5458 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5459 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5460 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5461 called within the line.
5462
5463 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5464 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5465 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5466 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5467 was any debugging information about the routine.
5468
5469 @item step @var{count}
5470 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5471 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5472 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5473
5474 @kindex next
5475 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5476 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5477 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5478 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5479 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5480 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5481 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5482 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5483
5484 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5485
5486
5487 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5488 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5489 @c
5490 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5491 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5492 @c function are executed without stopping.
5493
5494 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5495 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5496 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5497
5498 @kindex set step-mode
5499 @item set step-mode
5500 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5501 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5502 @itemx set step-mode on
5503 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5504 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5505 information rather than stepping over it.
5506
5507 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5508 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5509 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5510
5511 @item set step-mode off
5512 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5513 debug information. This is the default.
5514
5515 @item show step-mode
5516 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5517 source line debug information.
5518
5519 @kindex finish
5520 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5521 @item finish
5522 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5523 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5524 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5525
5526 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5527 ,Returning from a Function}).
5528
5529 @kindex until
5530 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5531 @cindex run until specified location
5532 @item until
5533 @itemx u
5534 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5535 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5536 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5537 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5538 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5539 than the address of the jump.
5540
5541 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5542 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5543 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5544 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5545 through the next iteration.
5546
5547 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5548 stack frame.
5549
5550 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5551 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5552 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5553 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5554 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5555
5556 @smallexample
5557 (@value{GDBP}) f
5558 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5559 206 expand_input();
5560 (@value{GDBP}) until
5561 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5562 @end smallexample
5563
5564 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5565 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5566 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5567 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5568 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5569 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5570 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5571
5572 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5573 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5574 argument.
5575
5576 @item until @var{location}
5577 @itemx u @var{location}
5578 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5579 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5580 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5581 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5582 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5583 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5584 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5585 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5586 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5587 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5588 invocations have returned.
5589
5590 @smallexample
5591 94 int factorial (int value)
5592 95 @{
5593 96 if (value > 1) @{
5594 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5595 98 @}
5596 99 return (value);
5597 100 @}
5598 @end smallexample
5599
5600
5601 @kindex advance @var{location}
5602 @item advance @var{location}
5603 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5604 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5605 @ref{Specify Location}.
5606 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5607 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5608 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5609 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5610
5611
5612 @kindex stepi
5613 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5614 @item stepi
5615 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5616 @itemx si
5617 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5618
5619 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5620 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5621 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5622 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5623
5624 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5625
5626 @need 750
5627 @kindex nexti
5628 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5629 @item nexti
5630 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5631 @itemx ni
5632 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5633 proceed until the function returns.
5634
5635 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5636
5637 @end table
5638
5639 @anchor{range stepping}
5640 @cindex range stepping
5641 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5642 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5643 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5644 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5645 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5646 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5647 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5648 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5649 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5650 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5651 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5652 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5653 if necessary:
5654
5655 @table @code
5656 @kindex set range-stepping
5657 @kindex show range-stepping
5658 @item set range-stepping
5659 @itemx show range-stepping
5660 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5661
5662 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5663 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5664 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5665 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5666 default is @code{on}.
5667
5668 @end table
5669
5670 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5671 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5672 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5673
5674 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5675 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5676 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5677 a particular file when stepping.
5678
5679 For example, consider the following C function:
5680
5681 @smallexample
5682 101 int func()
5683 102 @{
5684 103 foo(boring());
5685 104 bar(boring());
5686 105 @}
5687 @end smallexample
5688
5689 @noindent
5690 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5691 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5692 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5693 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5694
5695 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5696 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5697 is called from many places.
5698
5699 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5700 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5701 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5702 @code{foo}.
5703
5704 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5705 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5706 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5707
5708 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5709 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5710 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5711 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5712 the underlying system.
5713 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5714 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5715
5716 @table @code
5717 @kindex skip
5718 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5719 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5720 that specify what to skip.
5721 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5722
5723 @table @code
5724 @item -file @var{file}
5725 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5726 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5727
5728 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5729 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5730 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5731 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5732 over when stepping.
5733
5734 @smallexample
5735 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5736 @end smallexample
5737
5738 @item -function @var{linespec}
5739 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5740 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5741 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5742 @xref{Specify Location}.
5743
5744 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5745 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5746 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5747 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5748
5749 This form is useful for complex function names.
5750 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5751 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5752 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5753 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5754 regular expression makes this easier.
5755
5756 @smallexample
5757 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5758 @end smallexample
5759
5760 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5761 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5762
5763 @smallexample
5764 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5765 @end smallexample
5766 @end table
5767
5768 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5769 will be skipped.
5770
5771 @kindex skip function
5772 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5773 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5774 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5775 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5776
5777 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5778 will be skipped.
5779
5780 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5781 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5782
5783 @kindex skip file
5784 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5785 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5786 will be skipped over when stepping.
5787
5788 @smallexample
5789 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5790 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5791 @end smallexample
5792
5793 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5794 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5795 @end table
5796
5797 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5798 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5799
5800 @table @code
5801 @kindex info skip
5802 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5803 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5804 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5805 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5806
5807 @table @emph
5808 @item Identifier
5809 A number identifying this skip.
5810 @item Enabled or Disabled
5811 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5812 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5813 @item Glob
5814 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5815 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5816 @item File
5817 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5818 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5819 @item RE
5820 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5821 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5822 @item Function
5823 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5824 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5825 @end table
5826
5827 @kindex skip delete
5828 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5829 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5830 skips.
5831
5832 @kindex skip enable
5833 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5834 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5835 skips.
5836
5837 @kindex skip disable
5838 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5839 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5840 skips.
5841
5842 @end table
5843
5844 @node Signals
5845 @section Signals
5846 @cindex signals
5847
5848 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5849 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5850 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5851 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5852 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5853 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5854 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5855 requested an alarm).
5856
5857 @cindex fatal signals
5858 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5859 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5860 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5861 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5862 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5863 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5864
5865 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5866 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5867 signal.
5868
5869 @cindex handling signals
5870 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5871 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5872 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5873 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5874 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5875
5876 @table @code
5877 @kindex info signals
5878 @kindex info handle
5879 @item info signals
5880 @itemx info handle
5881 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5882 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5883 the defined types of signals.
5884
5885 @item info signals @var{sig}
5886 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5887
5888 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5889
5890 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5891 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5892 for details about this command.
5893
5894 @kindex handle
5895 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5896 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5897 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5898 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5899 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5900 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5901 say what change to make.
5902 @end table
5903
5904 @c @group
5905 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5906 Their full names are:
5907
5908 @table @code
5909 @item nostop
5910 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5911 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5912
5913 @item stop
5914 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5915 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5916
5917 @item print
5918 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5919
5920 @item noprint
5921 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5922 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5923
5924 @item pass
5925 @itemx noignore
5926 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5927 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5928 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5929
5930 @item nopass
5931 @itemx ignore
5932 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5933 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5934 @end table
5935 @c @end group
5936
5937 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5938 program until you
5939 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5940 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5941 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5942 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5943 program sees that signal when you continue.
5944
5945 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5946 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5947 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5948 erroneous signals.
5949
5950 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5951 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5952 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5953 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5954 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5955 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5956 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5957 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5958 Program a Signal}.
5959
5960 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5961 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5962
5963 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5964 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5965 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5966 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5967 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5968 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5969 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5970 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5971 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5972 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5973 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5974 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5975 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5976
5977 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5978
5979 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5980 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5981 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5982 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5983
5984 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5985 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5986 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5987 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5988
5989 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5990 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5991
5992 @smallexample
5993 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5994 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5995 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5996 (@value{GDBP}) c
5997 Continuing.
5998
5999 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6000 main () sigusr1.c:28
6001 28 p = 0;
6002 (@value{GDBP}) si
6003 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6004 9 @{
6005 @end smallexample
6006
6007 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6008 program to receive the signal first:
6009
6010 @smallexample
6011 (@value{GDBP}) n
6012 28 p = 0;
6013 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6014 (@value{GDBP}) si
6015 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6016 9 @{
6017 (@value{GDBP})
6018 @end smallexample
6019
6020 @cindex extra signal information
6021 @anchor{extra signal information}
6022
6023 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6024 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6025 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6026 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6027 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6028 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6029 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6030 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6031 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6032 system header.
6033
6034 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6035 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6036
6037 @smallexample
6038 @group
6039 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6040 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6041 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6042 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6043 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6044 type = struct @{
6045 int si_signo;
6046 int si_errno;
6047 int si_code;
6048 union @{
6049 int _pad[28];
6050 struct @{...@} _kill;
6051 struct @{...@} _timer;
6052 struct @{...@} _rt;
6053 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6054 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6055 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6056 @} _sifields;
6057 @}
6058 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6059 type = struct @{
6060 void *si_addr;
6061 @}
6062 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6063 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6064 @end group
6065 @end smallexample
6066
6067 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6068
6069 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6070 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6071 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6072 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6073 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6074 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6075 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6076 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6077 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6078 information is displayed.
6079
6080 The usual output of a segfault is:
6081 @smallexample
6082 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6083 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6084 68 value = *(p + len);
6085 @end smallexample
6086
6087 While a bound violation is presented as:
6088 @smallexample
6089 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6090 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6091 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6092 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6093 68 value = *(p + len);
6094 @end smallexample
6095
6096 @node Thread Stops
6097 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6098
6099 @cindex stopped threads
6100 @cindex threads, stopped
6101
6102 @cindex continuing threads
6103 @cindex threads, continuing
6104
6105 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6106 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6107 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6108 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6109 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6110 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6111 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6112 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6113 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6114
6115 @menu
6116 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6117 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6118 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6119 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6120 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6121 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6122 @end menu
6123
6124 @node All-Stop Mode
6125 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6126
6127 @cindex all-stop mode
6128
6129 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6130 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6131 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6132 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6133 underfoot.
6134
6135 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6136 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6137 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6138
6139 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6140 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6141 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6142 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6143 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6144 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6145 stops.
6146
6147 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6148 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6149 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6150 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6151
6152 @cindex automatic thread selection
6153 @cindex switching threads automatically
6154 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6155 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6156 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6157 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6158 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6159 thread.
6160
6161 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6162 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6163
6164 @table @code
6165 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6166 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6167 @cindex lock scheduler
6168 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6169 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6170 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6171 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6172 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6173 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6174 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6175 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6176 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6177 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6178 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6179 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6180 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6181 @code{on} in replay mode.
6182
6183 @item show scheduler-locking
6184 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6185 @end table
6186
6187 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6188 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6189 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6190 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6191 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6192 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6193 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6194 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6195 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6196 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6197 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6198 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6199 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6200 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6201
6202 @table @code
6203 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6204 @item set schedule-multiple
6205 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6206 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6207 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6208 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6209 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6210 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6211
6212 @item show schedule-multiple
6213 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6214 multiple processes.
6215 @end table
6216
6217 @node Non-Stop Mode
6218 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6219
6220 @cindex non-stop mode
6221
6222 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6223 @c with more details.
6224
6225 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6226 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6227 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6228 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6229 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6230 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6231
6232 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6233 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6234 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6235 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6236 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6237 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6238 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6239 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6240 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6241 independently and simultaneously.
6242
6243 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6244 or attach to your program:
6245
6246 @smallexample
6247 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6248 set pagination off
6249
6250 # Finally, turn it on!
6251 set non-stop on
6252 @end smallexample
6253
6254 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6255
6256 @table @code
6257 @kindex set non-stop
6258 @item set non-stop on
6259 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6260 @item set non-stop off
6261 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6262 @kindex show non-stop
6263 @item show non-stop
6264 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6265 @end table
6266
6267 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6268 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6269 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6270 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6271 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6272 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6273 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6274 default.
6275
6276 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6277 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6278 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6279
6280 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6281 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6282 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6283 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6284 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6285
6286 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6287 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6288 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6289 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6290 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6291
6292 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6293
6294 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6295 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6296 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6297 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6298 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6299 previously current thread.
6300
6301 @node Background Execution
6302 @subsection Background Execution
6303
6304 @cindex foreground execution
6305 @cindex background execution
6306 @cindex asynchronous execution
6307 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6308
6309 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6310 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6311 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6312 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6313 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6314 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6315
6316 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6317 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6318
6319 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6320 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6321 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6322 are:
6323
6324 @table @code
6325 @kindex run&
6326 @item run
6327 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6328
6329 @item attach
6330 @kindex attach&
6331 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6332
6333 @item step
6334 @kindex step&
6335 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6336
6337 @item stepi
6338 @kindex stepi&
6339 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6340
6341 @item next
6342 @kindex next&
6343 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6344
6345 @item nexti
6346 @kindex nexti&
6347 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6348
6349 @item continue
6350 @kindex continue&
6351 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6352
6353 @item finish
6354 @kindex finish&
6355 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6356
6357 @item until
6358 @kindex until&
6359 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6360
6361 @end table
6362
6363 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6364 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6365 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6366 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6367 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6368 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6369
6370 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6371 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6372
6373 @table @code
6374 @kindex interrupt
6375 @item interrupt
6376 @itemx interrupt -a
6377
6378 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6379 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6380 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6381 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6382 @end table
6383
6384 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6385 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6386
6387 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6388 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6389 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6390
6391 @table @code
6392 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6393 @cindex thread breakpoints
6394 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6395 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6396 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6397 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6398 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6399 specify some source line.
6400
6401 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6402 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6403 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6404 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6405 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6406
6407 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6408 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6409 program.
6410
6411 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6412 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6413 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6414
6415 @smallexample
6416 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6417 @end smallexample
6418
6419 @end table
6420
6421 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6422 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6423 thread list. For example:
6424
6425 @smallexample
6426 (@value{GDBP}) c
6427 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6428 @end smallexample
6429
6430 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6431 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6432 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6433 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6434 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6435 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6436 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6437 command.
6438
6439 @node Interrupted System Calls
6440 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6441
6442 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6443 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6444 @cindex premature return from system calls
6445 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6446 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6447 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6448 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6449 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6450 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6451 stop execution.
6452
6453 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6454 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6455 style anyways.
6456
6457 For example, do not write code like this:
6458
6459 @smallexample
6460 sleep (10);
6461 @end smallexample
6462
6463 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6464 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6465
6466 Instead, write this:
6467
6468 @smallexample
6469 int unslept = 10;
6470 while (unslept > 0)
6471 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6472 @end smallexample
6473
6474 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6475 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6476 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6477 @value{GDBN}.
6478
6479 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6480 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6481 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6482 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6483
6484 @node Observer Mode
6485 @subsection Observer Mode
6486
6487 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6488 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6489 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6490 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6491 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6492
6493 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6494 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6495 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6496 mode.
6497
6498 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6499 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6500 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6501 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6502 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6503
6504 @table @code
6505
6506 @kindex observer
6507 @item set observer on
6508 @itemx set observer off
6509 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6510 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6511 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6512 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6513
6514 @item show observer
6515 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6516
6517 @kindex may-write-registers
6518 @item set may-write-registers on
6519 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6520 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6521 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6522 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6523
6524 @item show may-write-registers
6525 Show the current permission to write registers.
6526
6527 @kindex may-write-memory
6528 @item set may-write-memory on
6529 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6530 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6531 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6532 defaults to @code{on}.
6533
6534 @item show may-write-memory
6535 Show the current permission to write memory.
6536
6537 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6538 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6539 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6540 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6541 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6542 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6543
6544 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6545 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6546
6547 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6548 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6549 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6550 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6551 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6552 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6553 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6554
6555 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6556 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6557
6558 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6559 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6560 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6561 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6562 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6563 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6564 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6565
6566 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6567 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6568
6569 @kindex may-interrupt
6570 @item set may-interrupt on
6571 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6572 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6573 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6574 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6575 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6576
6577 @item show may-interrupt
6578 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6579
6580 @end table
6581
6582 @node Reverse Execution
6583 @chapter Running programs backward
6584 @cindex reverse execution
6585 @cindex running programs backward
6586
6587 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6588 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6589 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6590 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6591
6592 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6593 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6594 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6595 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6596 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6597 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6598
6599 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6600 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6601 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6602 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6603 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6604 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6605 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6606 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6607 prior values@footnote{
6608 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6609 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6610 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6611
6612 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6613 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6614 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6615 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6616 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6617 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6618 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6619 }.
6620
6621 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6622 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6623
6624 @table @code
6625 @kindex reverse-continue
6626 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6627 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6628 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6629 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6630 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6631 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6632 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6633
6634 @kindex reverse-step
6635 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6636 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6637 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6638 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6639
6640 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6641 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6642 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6643 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6644 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6645 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6646
6647 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6648 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6649
6650 @kindex reverse-stepi
6651 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6652 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6653 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6654 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6655 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6656 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6657 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6658
6659 @kindex reverse-next
6660 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6661 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6662 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6663 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6664 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6665 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6666 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6667 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6668 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6669 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6670
6671 @kindex reverse-nexti
6672 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6673 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6674 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6675 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6676 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6677 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6678 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6679 frame) is reached.
6680
6681 @kindex reverse-finish
6682 @item reverse-finish
6683 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6684 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6685 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6686 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6687
6688 @kindex set exec-direction
6689 @item set exec-direction
6690 Set the direction of target execution.
6691 @item set exec-direction reverse
6692 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6693 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6694 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6695 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6696 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6697 @item set exec-direction forward
6698 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6699 This is the default.
6700 @end table
6701
6702
6703 @node Process Record and Replay
6704 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6705 @cindex process record and replay
6706 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6707
6708 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6709 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6710 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6711
6712 @cindex replay mode
6713 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6714 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6715 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6716 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6717 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6718 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6719 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6720 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6721 execution log.
6722
6723 @cindex record mode
6724 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6725 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6726 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6727 for future replay.
6728
6729 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6730 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6731 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6732 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6733 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6734 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6735
6736 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6737 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6738 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6739 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6740
6741 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6742 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6743
6744 @table @code
6745 @kindex target record
6746 @kindex target record-full
6747 @kindex target record-btrace
6748 @kindex record
6749 @kindex record full
6750 @kindex record btrace
6751 @kindex record btrace bts
6752 @kindex record btrace pt
6753 @kindex record bts
6754 @kindex record pt
6755 @kindex rec
6756 @kindex rec full
6757 @kindex rec btrace
6758 @kindex rec btrace bts
6759 @kindex rec btrace pt
6760 @kindex rec bts
6761 @kindex rec pt
6762 @item record @var{method}
6763 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6764 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6765 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6766 recording methods are available:
6767
6768 @table @code
6769 @item full
6770 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6771 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6772 execution.
6773
6774 @item btrace @var{format}
6775 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6776 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6777 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6778 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6779 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6780 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6781 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6782
6783 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6784 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6785 formats are available:
6786
6787 @table @code
6788 @item bts
6789 @cindex branch trace store
6790 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6791 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6792 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6793
6794 @item pt
6795 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6796 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6797 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6798 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6799
6800 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6801 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6802 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6803
6804 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6805 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6806 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6807 buffer-size with care.
6808 @end table
6809
6810 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6811 @end table
6812
6813 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6814 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6815 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6816 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6817
6818 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6819 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6820 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6821 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6822 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6823
6824 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6825 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6826 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6827 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6828 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6829 does not support these two modes.
6830
6831 @kindex record stop
6832 @kindex rec s
6833 @item record stop
6834 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6835 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6836 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6837
6838 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6839 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6840 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6841 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6842 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6843
6844 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6845 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6846 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6847 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6848 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6849
6850 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6851 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6852
6853 @kindex record goto
6854 @item record goto
6855 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6856 ways to specify the location to go to:
6857
6858 @table @code
6859 @item record goto begin
6860 @itemx record goto start
6861 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6862
6863 @item record goto end
6864 Go to the end of the execution log.
6865
6866 @item record goto @var{n}
6867 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6868 @end table
6869
6870 @kindex record save
6871 @item record save @var{filename}
6872 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6873 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6874 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6875
6876 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6877
6878 @kindex record restore
6879 @item record restore @var{filename}
6880 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6881 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6882
6883 @kindex set record full
6884 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6885 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6886 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6887 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6888
6889 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6890 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6891 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6892 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6893 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6894 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6895 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6896 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6897
6898 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6899 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6900 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6901
6902 @kindex show record full
6903 @item show record full insn-number-max
6904 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6905 recording method.
6906
6907 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6908 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6909 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6910 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6911 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6912 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6913 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6914 oldest one to be deleted.
6915
6916 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6917 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6918
6919 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6920 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6921
6922 @item set record full memory-query
6923 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6924 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6925 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6926 case.
6927
6928 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6929 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6930 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6931 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6932 results.
6933
6934 @item show record full memory-query
6935 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6936
6937 @kindex set record btrace
6938 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6939 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6940 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6941 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6942 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6943 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6944 You can use the following command for that:
6945
6946 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6947 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6948 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6949 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6950 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6951 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6952 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6953 position.
6954
6955 @kindex show record btrace
6956 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6957 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6958
6959 @kindex set record btrace bts
6960 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6961 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6962 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6963 format. Default is 64KB.
6964
6965 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6966 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6967 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6968 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6969 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6970 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6971 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6972
6973 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6974 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6975
6976 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6977 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6978
6979 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6980 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6981 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6982
6983 @kindex set record btrace pt
6984 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
6985 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
6986 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
6987 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
6988
6989 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6990 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6991 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
6992 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
6993 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
6994 actual buffer size for each thread.
6995
6996 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6997 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6998
6999 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7000 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7001
7002 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7003 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7004 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7005
7006 @kindex info record
7007 @item info record
7008 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7009 method:
7010
7011 @table @code
7012 @item full
7013 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7014 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7015
7016 @itemize @bullet
7017 @item
7018 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7019 @item
7020 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7021 @item
7022 Highest recorded instruction number.
7023 @item
7024 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7025 @item
7026 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7027 @item
7028 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7029 @end itemize
7030
7031 @item btrace
7032 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7033
7034 @itemize @bullet
7035 @item
7036 Recording format.
7037 @item
7038 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7039 @item
7040 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7041 instructions.
7042 @item
7043 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7044 @end itemize
7045
7046 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7047 @itemize @bullet
7048 @item
7049 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7050 @end itemize
7051
7052 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7053 @itemize @bullet
7054 @item
7055 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7056 @end itemize
7057 @end table
7058
7059 @kindex record delete
7060 @kindex rec del
7061 @item record delete
7062 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7063 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7064 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7065 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7066
7067 @kindex record instruction-history
7068 @kindex rec instruction-history
7069 @item record instruction-history
7070 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7071 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7072 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7073 are printed in execution order.
7074
7075 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7076 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7077 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7078
7079 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7080 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7081 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7082 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7083 @code{/p} modifier.
7084
7085 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7086 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7087 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7088
7089 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7090 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7091
7092 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7093 disassemble:
7094
7095 @table @code
7096 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7097 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7098 @var{insn}.
7099
7100 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7101 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7102 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7103 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7104 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7105 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7106
7107 @item record instruction-history
7108 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7109
7110 @item record instruction-history -
7111 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7112
7113 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7114 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7115 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7116 number @var{end} is included.
7117 @end table
7118
7119 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7120
7121 @kindex set record
7122 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7123 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7124 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7125 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7126 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7127
7128 @kindex show record
7129 @item show record instruction-history-size
7130 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7131 instruction-history} command.
7132
7133 @kindex record function-call-history
7134 @kindex rec function-call-history
7135 @item record function-call-history
7136 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7137 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7138 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7139 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7140 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7141 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7142 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7143 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7144 given together.
7145
7146 @smallexample
7147 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7148 1 void foo (void)
7149 2 @{
7150 3 @}
7151 4
7152 5 void bar (void)
7153 6 @{
7154 7 ...
7155 8 foo ();
7156 9 ...
7157 10 @}
7158 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7159 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7160 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7161 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7162 @end smallexample
7163
7164 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7165 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7166 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7167 to print:
7168
7169 @table @code
7170 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7171 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7172
7173 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7174 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7175 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7176 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7177 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7178
7179 @item record function-call-history
7180 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7181
7182 @item record function-call-history -
7183 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7184
7185 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7186 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7187 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7188 @end table
7189
7190 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7191
7192 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7193 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7194 Define how many lines to print in the
7195 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7196 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7197
7198 @item show record function-call-history-size
7199 Show how many lines to print in the
7200 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7201 @end table
7202
7203
7204 @node Stack
7205 @chapter Examining the Stack
7206
7207 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7208 stopped and how it got there.
7209
7210 @cindex call stack
7211 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7212 is generated.
7213 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7214 the arguments of the call,
7215 and the local variables of the function being called.
7216 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7217 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7218 stack}.
7219
7220 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7221 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7222
7223 @cindex selected frame
7224 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7225 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7226 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7227 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7228 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7229 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7230
7231 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7232 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7233 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7234
7235 @menu
7236 * Frames:: Stack frames
7237 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7238 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7239 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7240 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7241
7242 @end menu
7243
7244 @node Frames
7245 @section Stack Frames
7246
7247 @cindex frame, definition
7248 @cindex stack frame
7249 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7250 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7251 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7252 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7253 which the function is executing.
7254
7255 @cindex initial frame
7256 @cindex outermost frame
7257 @cindex innermost frame
7258 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7259 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7260 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7261 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7262 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7263 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7264 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7265 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7266
7267 @cindex frame pointer
7268 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7269 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7270 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7271 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7272 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7273 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7274
7275 @cindex frame number
7276 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7277 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7278 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7279 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7280 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7281
7282 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7283 @c underflow problems.
7284 @cindex frameless execution
7285 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7286 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7287 @smallexample
7288 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7289 @end smallexample
7290 generates functions without a frame.)
7291 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7292 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7293 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7294 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7295 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7296 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7297 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7298
7299 @node Backtrace
7300 @section Backtraces
7301
7302 @cindex traceback
7303 @cindex call stack traces
7304 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7305 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7306 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7307 stack.
7308
7309 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7310 @kindex backtrace
7311 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7312 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7313 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7314 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7315 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7316 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7317
7318 @table @code
7319 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7320 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7321 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7322 be one of the following:
7323
7324 @table @code
7325 @item @var{n}
7326 @itemx @var{n}
7327 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7328 number.
7329
7330 @item -@var{n}
7331 @itemx -@var{n}
7332 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7333 number.
7334
7335 @item full
7336 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7337 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7338
7339 @item no-filters
7340 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7341 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7342 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7343 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7344 support.
7345 @end table
7346 @end table
7347
7348 @kindex where
7349 @kindex info stack
7350 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7351 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7352
7353 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7354 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7355 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7356 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7357 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7358 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7359 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7360 multi-threaded program.
7361
7362 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7363 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7364 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7365 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7366 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7367 line number.
7368
7369 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7370 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7371
7372 @smallexample
7373 @group
7374 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7375 at builtin.c:993
7376 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7377 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7378 at macro.c:71
7379 (More stack frames follow...)
7380 @end group
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 @noindent
7384 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7385 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7386 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7387
7388 @noindent
7389 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7390 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7391 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7392 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7393 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7394
7395 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7396 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7397 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7398 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7399 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7400 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7401 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7402 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7403 such a backtrace might look like:
7404
7405 @smallexample
7406 @group
7407 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7408 at builtin.c:993
7409 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7410 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7411 at macro.c:71
7412 (More stack frames follow...)
7413 @end group
7414 @end smallexample
7415
7416 @noindent
7417 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7418 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7419
7420 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7421 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7422 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7423
7424 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7425 @cindex program entry point
7426 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7427 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7428 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7429 @code{main}@footnote{
7430 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7431 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7432 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7433 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7434 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7435 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7436
7437 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7438 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7439
7440 @table @code
7441 @item set backtrace past-main
7442 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7443 @kindex set backtrace
7444 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7445
7446 @item set backtrace past-main off
7447 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7448 default.
7449
7450 @item show backtrace past-main
7451 @kindex show backtrace
7452 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7453
7454 @item set backtrace past-entry
7455 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7456 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7457 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7458 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7459
7460 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7461 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7462 application. This is the default.
7463
7464 @item show backtrace past-entry
7465 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7466
7467 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7468 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7469 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7470 @cindex backtrace limit
7471 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7472 or zero means unlimited levels.
7473
7474 @item show backtrace limit
7475 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7476 @end table
7477
7478 You can control how file names are displayed.
7479
7480 @table @code
7481 @item set filename-display
7482 @itemx set filename-display relative
7483 @cindex filename-display
7484 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7485
7486 @item set filename-display basename
7487 Display only basename of a filename.
7488
7489 @item set filename-display absolute
7490 Display an absolute filename.
7491
7492 @item show filename-display
7493 Show the current way to display filenames.
7494 @end table
7495
7496 @node Selection
7497 @section Selecting a Frame
7498
7499 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7500 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7501 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7502 of the stack frame just selected.
7503
7504 @table @code
7505 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7506 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7507 @item frame @var{n}
7508 @itemx f @var{n}
7509 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7510 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7511 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7512 @code{main}.
7513
7514 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7515 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7516 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7517 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7518 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7519 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7520 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7521 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7522
7523 @kindex up
7524 @item up @var{n}
7525 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7526 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7527 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7528
7529 @kindex down
7530 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7531 @item down @var{n}
7532 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7533 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7534 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7535 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7536 @end table
7537
7538 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7539 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7540 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7541 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7542
7543 @need 1000
7544 For example:
7545
7546 @smallexample
7547 @group
7548 (@value{GDBP}) up
7549 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7550 at env.c:10
7551 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7552 @end group
7553 @end smallexample
7554
7555 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7556 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7557 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7558 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7559 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7560 for details.
7561
7562 @table @code
7563 @kindex select-frame
7564 @item select-frame
7565 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7566 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7567 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7568 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7569
7570 @kindex down-silently
7571 @kindex up-silently
7572 @item up-silently @var{n}
7573 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7574 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7575 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7576 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7577 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7578 distracting.
7579 @end table
7580
7581 @node Frame Info
7582 @section Information About a Frame
7583
7584 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7585 stack frame.
7586
7587 @table @code
7588 @item frame
7589 @itemx f
7590 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7591 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7592 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7593 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7594 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7595
7596 @kindex info frame
7597 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7598 @item info frame
7599 @itemx info f
7600 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7601 including:
7602
7603 @itemize @bullet
7604 @item
7605 the address of the frame
7606 @item
7607 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7608 @item
7609 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7610 @item
7611 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7612 @item
7613 the address of the frame's arguments
7614 @item
7615 the address of the frame's local variables
7616 @item
7617 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7618 @item
7619 which registers were saved in the frame
7620 @end itemize
7621
7622 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7623 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7624 the usual conventions.
7625
7626 @item info frame @var{addr}
7627 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7628 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7629 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7630 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7631 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7632 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7633
7634 @kindex info args
7635 @item info args
7636 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7637
7638 @item info locals
7639 @kindex info locals
7640 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7641 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7642 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7643
7644 @end table
7645
7646 @node Frame Filter Management
7647 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7648 @cindex managing frame filters
7649
7650 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7651 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7652
7653 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7654 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7655
7656 @table @code
7657 @kindex info frame-filter
7658 @item info frame-filter
7659 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7660 their name, priority and enabled status.
7661
7662 @kindex disable frame-filter
7663 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7664 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7665 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7666 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7667 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7668 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7669 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7670 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7671 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7672 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7673 may be enabled again later.
7674
7675 @kindex enable frame-filter
7676 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7677 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7678 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7679 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7680 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7681 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7682 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7683 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7684 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7685
7686 Example:
7687
7688 @smallexample
7689 (gdb) info frame-filter
7690
7691 global frame-filters:
7692 Priority Enabled Name
7693 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7694 100 Yes Reverse
7695
7696 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7697 Priority Enabled Name
7698 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7699
7700 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7701 Priority Enabled Name
7702 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7703
7704 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7705 (gdb) info frame-filter
7706
7707 global frame-filters:
7708 Priority Enabled Name
7709 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7710 100 Yes Reverse
7711
7712 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7713 Priority Enabled Name
7714 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7715
7716 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7717 Priority Enabled Name
7718 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7719
7720 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7721 (gdb) info frame-filter
7722
7723 global frame-filters:
7724 Priority Enabled Name
7725 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7726 100 Yes Reverse
7727
7728 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7729 Priority Enabled Name
7730 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7731
7732 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7733 Priority Enabled Name
7734 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7735 @end smallexample
7736
7737 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7738 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7739 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7740 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7741 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7742 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7743 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7744
7745 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7746 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7747 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7748 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7749 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7750 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7751 dictionary resides.
7752
7753 Example:
7754
7755 @smallexample
7756 (gdb) info frame-filter
7757
7758 global frame-filters:
7759 Priority Enabled Name
7760 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7761 100 Yes Reverse
7762
7763 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7764 Priority Enabled Name
7765 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7766
7767 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7768 Priority Enabled Name
7769 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7770
7771 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7772 (gdb) info frame-filter
7773
7774 global frame-filters:
7775 Priority Enabled Name
7776 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7777 50 Yes Reverse
7778
7779 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7780 Priority Enabled Name
7781 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7782
7783 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7784 Priority Enabled Name
7785 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7786 @end smallexample
7787 @end table
7788
7789 @node Source
7790 @chapter Examining Source Files
7791
7792 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7793 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7794 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7795 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7796 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7797 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7798 source files by explicit command.
7799
7800 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7801 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7802 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7803
7804 @menu
7805 * List:: Printing source lines
7806 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7807 * Edit:: Editing source files
7808 * Search:: Searching source files
7809 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7810 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7811 @end menu
7812
7813 @node List
7814 @section Printing Source Lines
7815
7816 @kindex list
7817 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7818 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7819 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7820 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7821 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7822
7823 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7824
7825 @table @code
7826 @item list @var{linenum}
7827 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7828 current source file.
7829
7830 @item list @var{function}
7831 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7832 @var{function}.
7833
7834 @item list
7835 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7836 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7837 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7838 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7839 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7840
7841 @item list -
7842 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7843 @end table
7844
7845 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7846 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7847 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7848
7849 @table @code
7850 @kindex set listsize
7851 @item set listsize @var{count}
7852 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7853 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7854 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7855 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7856
7857 @kindex show listsize
7858 @item show listsize
7859 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7860 @end table
7861
7862 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7863 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7864 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7865 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7866 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7867
7868 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7869 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
7870 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7871 to specify some source line.
7872
7873 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7874
7875 @table @code
7876 @item list @var{location}
7877 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
7878
7879 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7880 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7881 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
7882 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
7883 the same source file as the first location.
7884
7885 @item list ,@var{last}
7886 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7887
7888 @item list @var{first},
7889 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7890
7891 @item list +
7892 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7893
7894 @item list -
7895 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7896
7897 @item list
7898 As described in the preceding table.
7899 @end table
7900
7901 @node Specify Location
7902 @section Specifying a Location
7903 @cindex specifying location
7904 @cindex location
7905 @cindex source location
7906
7907 @menu
7908 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
7909 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
7910 * Address Locations:: Address locations
7911 @end menu
7912
7913 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7914 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7915 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
7916 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
7917 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
7918
7919 @node Linespec Locations
7920 @subsection Linespec Locations
7921 @cindex linespec locations
7922
7923 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
7924 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
7925 specifying a linespec:
7926
7927 @table @code
7928 @item @var{linenum}
7929 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7930
7931 @item -@var{offset}
7932 @itemx +@var{offset}
7933 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7934 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7935 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7936 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7937 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7938 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7939 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7940 linespec.
7941
7942 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7943 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7944 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7945 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7946 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7947 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7948 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7949
7950 @item @var{function}
7951 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7952 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7953
7954 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
7955 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
7956 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
7957 means in all packages.
7958
7959 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
7960 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
7961 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
7962
7963 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
7964 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
7965 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
7966 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
7967
7968 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
7969
7970 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7971 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7972
7973 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7974 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7975 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7976 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7977 functions in different source files.
7978
7979 @item @var{label}
7980 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
7981 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
7982 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
7983 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7984
7985 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7986 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7987 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7988 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7989 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7990 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7991
7992 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7993 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7994 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7995 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7996 each one of those probes.
7997 @end table
7998
7999 @node Explicit Locations
8000 @subsection Explicit Locations
8001 @cindex explicit locations
8002
8003 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8004 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8005
8006 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8007 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8008 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8009 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8010 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8011
8012 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8013 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8014 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8015 the symbol table to know.
8016
8017 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8018 following table:
8019
8020 @table @code
8021 @item -source @var{filename}
8022 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8023 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8024 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8025 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8026 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8027
8028 @item -function @var{function}
8029 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8030 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8031 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8032 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8033
8034 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8035 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8036 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8037 means in all packages.
8038
8039 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8040 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8041 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8042 breakpoint on both symbols.
8043
8044 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8045
8046 @item -qualified
8047
8048 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8049 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8050
8051 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8052 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8053 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8054
8055 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8056 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8057 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8058
8059 @item -label @var{label}
8060 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8061 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8062 selected stack frame.
8063
8064 @item -line @var{number}
8065 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8066 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8067 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8068 relative to the current line.
8069 @end table
8070
8071 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8072 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8073
8074 @node Address Locations
8075 @subsection Address Locations
8076 @cindex address locations
8077
8078 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8079 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8080
8081 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8082 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8083 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8084 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8085 source files.
8086
8087 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8088 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8089 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8090 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8091 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8092 of @var{address}:
8093
8094 @table @code
8095 @item @var{expression}
8096 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8097
8098 @item @var{funcaddr}
8099 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8100 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8101 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8102 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8103 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8104 (although the Pascal form also works).
8105
8106 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8107 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8108
8109 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8110 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8111 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8112 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8113 functions with identical names in different source files.
8114 @end table
8115
8116 @node Edit
8117 @section Editing Source Files
8118 @cindex editing source files
8119
8120 @kindex edit
8121 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8122 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8123 The editing program of your choice
8124 is invoked with the current line set to
8125 the active line in the program.
8126 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8127 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8128
8129 @table @code
8130 @item edit @var{location}
8131 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8132 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8133 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8134 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8135 command most commonly used:
8136
8137 @table @code
8138 @item edit @var{number}
8139 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8140
8141 @item edit @var{function}
8142 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8143 @end table
8144
8145 @end table
8146
8147 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8148 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8149 @footnote{
8150 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8151 following command-line syntax:
8152 @smallexample
8153 ex +@var{number} file
8154 @end smallexample
8155 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8156 the file where to start editing.}.
8157 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8158 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8159 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8160 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8161 @smallexample
8162 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8163 export EDITOR
8164 gdb @dots{}
8165 @end smallexample
8166 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8167 @smallexample
8168 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8169 gdb @dots{}
8170 @end smallexample
8171
8172 @node Search
8173 @section Searching Source Files
8174 @cindex searching source files
8175
8176 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8177 regular expression.
8178
8179 @table @code
8180 @kindex search
8181 @kindex forward-search
8182 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8183 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8184 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8185 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8186 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8187 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8188 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8189 @code{fo}.
8190
8191 @kindex reverse-search
8192 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8193 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8194 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8195 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8196 this command as @code{rev}.
8197 @end table
8198
8199 @node Source Path
8200 @section Specifying Source Directories
8201
8202 @cindex source path
8203 @cindex directories for source files
8204 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8205 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8206 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8207 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8208 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8209 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8210 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8211
8212 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8213 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8214 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8215 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8216 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8217 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8218 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8219 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8220 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8221 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8222 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8223
8224 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8225 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8226 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8227 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8228 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8229 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8230
8231 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8232 source files.
8233
8234 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8235 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8236 each line is in the file.
8237
8238 @kindex directory
8239 @kindex dir
8240 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8241 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8242 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8243
8244 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8245 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8246
8247 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8248 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8249 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8250 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8251 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8252 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8253 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8254 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8255 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8256 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8257 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8258 name to look up the sources.
8259
8260 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8261 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8262 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8263 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8264 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8265 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8266 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8267 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8268
8269 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8270 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8271 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8272 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8273 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8274 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8275 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8276
8277 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8278 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8279 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8280 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8281 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8282 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8283 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8284 command.
8285
8286 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8287 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8288 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8289 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8290 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8291 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8292 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8293
8294 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8295 @cindex default source path substitution
8296 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8297 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8298 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8299 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8300 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8301 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8302 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8303 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8304 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8305 together.
8306
8307 @table @code
8308 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8309 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8310 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8311 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8312 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8313 part of absolute file names) or
8314 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8315 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8316
8317 @kindex cdir
8318 @kindex cwd
8319 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8320 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8321 @cindex compilation directory
8322 @cindex current directory
8323 @cindex working directory
8324 @cindex directory, current
8325 @cindex directory, compilation
8326 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8327 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8328 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8329 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8330 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8331 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8332
8333 @item directory
8334 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8335
8336 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8337 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8338
8339 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8340 @kindex set directories
8341 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8342 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8343
8344 @item show directories
8345 @kindex show directories
8346 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8347
8348 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8349 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8350 @kindex set substitute-path
8351 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8352 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8353 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8354
8355 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8356 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8357
8358 @smallexample
8359 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8360 @end smallexample
8361
8362 @noindent
8363 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8364 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8365 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8366
8367 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8368 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8369 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8370 the substitution.
8371
8372 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8373
8374 @smallexample
8375 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8376 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8377 @end smallexample
8378
8379 @noindent
8380 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8381 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8382 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8383 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8384
8385
8386 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8387 @kindex unset substitute-path
8388 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8389 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8390 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8391
8392 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8393
8394 @item show substitute-path [path]
8395 @kindex show substitute-path
8396 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8397 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8398
8399 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8400 rules.
8401
8402 @end table
8403
8404 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8405 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8406 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8407
8408 @enumerate
8409 @item
8410 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8411
8412 @item
8413 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8414 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8415 directories in one command.
8416 @end enumerate
8417
8418 @node Machine Code
8419 @section Source and Machine Code
8420 @cindex source line and its code address
8421
8422 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8423 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8424 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8425 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8426 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8427 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8428 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8429 well as hex.
8430
8431 @table @code
8432 @kindex info line
8433 @item info line
8434 @itemx info line @var{location}
8435 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8436 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8437 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8438 information about the current source line is printed.
8439 @end table
8440
8441 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8442 the object code for the first line of function
8443 @code{m4_changequote}:
8444
8445 @smallexample
8446 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8447 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8448 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8449 @end smallexample
8450
8451 @noindent
8452 @cindex code address and its source line
8453 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8454 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8455 @smallexample
8456 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8457 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8458 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8459 @end smallexample
8460
8461 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8462 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8463 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8464 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8465 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8466 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8467 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8468 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8469 Variables}).
8470
8471 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8472 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8473 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8474 line.
8475
8476 @table @code
8477 @kindex disassemble
8478 @cindex assembly instructions
8479 @cindex instructions, assembly
8480 @cindex machine instructions
8481 @cindex listing machine instructions
8482 @item disassemble
8483 @itemx disassemble /m
8484 @itemx disassemble /s
8485 @itemx disassemble /r
8486 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8487 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8488 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8489 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8490 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8491 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8492 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8493 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8494 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8495 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8496
8497 @table @code
8498 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8499 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8500 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8501 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8502 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8503 @end table
8504
8505 @noindent
8506 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8507 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8508
8509 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8510 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8511
8512 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8513 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8514 @end table
8515
8516 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8517 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8518
8519 @smallexample
8520 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8521 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8522 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8523 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8524 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8525 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8526 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8527 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8528 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8529 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8530 End of assembler dump.
8531 @end smallexample
8532
8533 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8534 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8535 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8536
8537 @smallexample
8538 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8539 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8540 5 @{
8541 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8542 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8543 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8544 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8545 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8546
8547 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8548 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8549 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8550
8551 7 return 0;
8552 8 @}
8553 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8554 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8555 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8556
8557 End of assembler dump.
8558 @end smallexample
8559
8560 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8561 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8562 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8563 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8564 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8565 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8566 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8567 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8568 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8569
8570 @file{foo.h}:
8571
8572 @smallexample
8573 int
8574 foo (int a)
8575 @{
8576 if (a < 0)
8577 return a * 2;
8578 if (a == 0)
8579 return 1;
8580 return a + 10;
8581 @}
8582 @end smallexample
8583
8584 @file{foo.c}:
8585
8586 @smallexample
8587 #include "foo.h"
8588 volatile int x, y;
8589 int
8590 main ()
8591 @{
8592 x = foo (y);
8593 return 0;
8594 @}
8595 @end smallexample
8596
8597 @smallexample
8598 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8599 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8600 5 @{
8601
8602 6 x = foo (y);
8603 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8604 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8605
8606 7 return 0;
8607 8 @}
8608 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8609 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8610 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8611 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8612
8613 End of assembler dump.
8614 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8615 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8616 foo.c:
8617 5 @{
8618 6 x = foo (y);
8619 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8620
8621 foo.h:
8622 4 if (a < 0)
8623 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8624 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8625
8626 6 if (a == 0)
8627 7 return 1;
8628 8 return a + 10;
8629 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8630 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8631 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8632 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8633
8634 foo.c:
8635 6 x = foo (y);
8636 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8637
8638 7 return 0;
8639 8 @}
8640 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8641 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8642
8643 foo.h:
8644 5 return a * 2;
8645 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8646 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8647 End of assembler dump.
8648 @end smallexample
8649
8650 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8651
8652 @smallexample
8653 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8654 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8655 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8656 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8657 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8658 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8659 End of assembler dump.
8660 @end smallexample
8661
8662 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8663 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8664 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8665 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8666
8667 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8668 mnemonics or other syntax.
8669
8670 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8671 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8672 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8673 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8674 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8675
8676 @table @code
8677 @kindex set disassembler-options
8678 @cindex disassembler options
8679 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8680 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8681 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8682 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8683 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8684 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8685 The default value is the empty string.
8686
8687 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8688 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8689 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, PowerPC
8690 and S/390.
8691
8692 @kindex show disassembler-options
8693 @item show disassembler-options
8694 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8695 @end table
8696
8697 @table @code
8698 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8699 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8700 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8701 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8702 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8703 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8704
8705 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8706 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8707 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8708 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8709
8710 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8711 @item show disassembly-flavor
8712 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8713 @end table
8714
8715 @table @code
8716 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8717 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8718 @item set disassemble-next-line
8719 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8720 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8721 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8722 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8723 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8724 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8725 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8726 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8727 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8728 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8729 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8730 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8731 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8732 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8733 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8734 instruction.
8735 @end table
8736
8737
8738 @node Data
8739 @chapter Examining Data
8740
8741 @cindex printing data
8742 @cindex examining data
8743 @kindex print
8744 @kindex inspect
8745 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8746 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8747 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8748 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8749 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8750 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8751
8752 @table @code
8753 @item print @var{expr}
8754 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8755 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8756 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8757 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8758 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8759 Formats}.
8760
8761 @item print
8762 @itemx print /@var{f}
8763 @cindex reprint the last value
8764 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8765 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8766 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8767 @end table
8768
8769 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8770 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8771 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8772
8773 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8774 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8775 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8776 Table}.
8777
8778 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8779 @kindex explore
8780 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8781 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8782 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8783 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8784 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8785 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8786 embedded in the higher level data types.
8787
8788 @table @code
8789 @item explore @var{arg}
8790 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8791 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8792 @end table
8793
8794 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8795 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8796 C program as
8797
8798 @smallexample
8799 struct SimpleStruct
8800 @{
8801 int i;
8802 double d;
8803 @};
8804
8805 struct ComplexStruct
8806 @{
8807 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8808 int arr[10];
8809 @};
8810 @end smallexample
8811
8812 @noindent
8813 followed by variable declarations as
8814
8815 @smallexample
8816 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8817 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8818 @end smallexample
8819
8820 @noindent
8821 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8822 @code{explore} command as follows.
8823
8824 @smallexample
8825 (gdb) explore cs
8826 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8827 the following fields:
8828
8829 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8830 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8831
8832 Enter the field number of choice:
8833 @end smallexample
8834
8835 @noindent
8836 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8837 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8838 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8839 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8840 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8841 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8842 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8843 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8844
8845 @smallexample
8846 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8847 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8848 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8849 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8850
8851 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8852 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8853
8854 Press enter to return to parent value:
8855 @end smallexample
8856
8857 @noindent
8858 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8859 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8860 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8861 to explore.
8862
8863 @smallexample
8864 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8865 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8866
8867 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8868
8869 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8870
8871 Press enter to return to parent value:
8872 @end smallexample
8873
8874 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8875 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8876 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8877 level data structure).
8878
8879 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8880 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8881 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8882 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8883 same example as above, your can explore the type
8884 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8885 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8886
8887 @smallexample
8888 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8889 @end smallexample
8890
8891 @noindent
8892 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8893 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8894 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8895 example.
8896
8897 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8898 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8899 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8900 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8901 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8902
8903 @table @code
8904 @item explore value @var{expr}
8905 @cindex explore value
8906 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8907 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8908 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8909 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8910 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8911
8912 @item explore type @var{arg}
8913 @cindex explore type
8914 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8915 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8916 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8917 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8918 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8919 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8920 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8921 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8922 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8923 @end table
8924
8925 @menu
8926 * Expressions:: Expressions
8927 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8928 * Variables:: Program variables
8929 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8930 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8931 * Memory:: Examining memory
8932 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8933 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8934 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8935 * Value History:: Value history
8936 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8937 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8938 * Registers:: Registers
8939 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8940 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8941 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8942 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8943 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8944 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8945 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8946 character set than GDB does
8947 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8948 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8949 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
8950 @end menu
8951
8952 @node Expressions
8953 @section Expressions
8954
8955 @cindex expressions
8956 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8957 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8958 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8959 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8960 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8961 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8962 @ref{Compilation}.
8963
8964 @cindex arrays in expressions
8965 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8966 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8967 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8968 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8969 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8970 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8971
8972 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8973 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8974 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8975 languages.
8976
8977 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8978 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8979
8980 @cindex casts, in expressions
8981 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8982 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8983 at that address in memory.
8984 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8985
8986 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8987 to programming languages:
8988
8989 @table @code
8990 @item @@
8991 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8992 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8993
8994 @item ::
8995 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8996 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8997
8998 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8999 @cindex type casting memory
9000 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9001 @cindex casts, to view memory
9002 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9003 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9004 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9005 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9006 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9007 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9008 @end table
9009
9010 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9011 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9012 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9013
9014 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9015 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9016 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9017 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9018 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9019 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9020 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9021
9022 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9023 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9024 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9025 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9026 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9027 as well.
9028
9029 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9030 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9031 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9032 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9033 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9034 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9035 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9036 choices.
9037
9038 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9039 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9040 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9041
9042 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9043 @smallexample
9044 @group
9045 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9046 [0] cancel
9047 [1] all
9048 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9049 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9050 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9051 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9052 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9053 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9054 > 2 4 6
9055 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9056 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9057 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9058 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9059 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9060 breakpoints.
9061 (@value{GDBP})
9062 @end group
9063 @end smallexample
9064
9065 @table @code
9066 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9067 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9068 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9069
9070 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9071 is ambiguous.
9072
9073 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9074 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9075 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9076 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9077 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9078 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9079 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9080 in the use of the menu.
9081
9082 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9083 when an ambiguity is detected.
9084
9085 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9086 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9087
9088 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9089 @item show multiple-symbols
9090 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9091 @end table
9092
9093 @node Variables
9094 @section Program Variables
9095
9096 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9097 in your program.
9098
9099 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9100 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9101
9102 @itemize @bullet
9103 @item
9104 global (or file-static)
9105 @end itemize
9106
9107 @noindent or
9108
9109 @itemize @bullet
9110 @item
9111 visible according to the scope rules of the
9112 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9113 @end itemize
9114
9115 @noindent This means that in the function
9116
9117 @smallexample
9118 foo (a)
9119 int a;
9120 @{
9121 bar (a);
9122 @{
9123 int b = test ();
9124 bar (b);
9125 @}
9126 @}
9127 @end smallexample
9128
9129 @noindent
9130 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9131 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9132 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9133 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9134
9135 @cindex variable name conflict
9136 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9137 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9138 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9139 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9140 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9141 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9142 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9143
9144 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9145 @ifnotinfo
9146 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9147 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9148 @end ifnotinfo
9149 @smallexample
9150 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9151 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9152 @end smallexample
9153
9154 @noindent
9155 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9156 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9157 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9158 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9159
9160 @smallexample
9161 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9162 @end smallexample
9163
9164 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9165 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9166 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9167 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9168 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9169
9170 @smallexample
9171 void
9172 foo (int a)
9173 @{
9174 if (a < 10)
9175 bar (a);
9176 else
9177 process (a); /* Stop here */
9178 @}
9179
9180 int
9181 bar (int a)
9182 @{
9183 foo (a + 5);
9184 @}
9185 @end smallexample
9186
9187 @noindent
9188 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9189 here is what you might see
9190 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9191
9192 @smallexample
9193 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9194 $1 = 10
9195 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9196 $2 = 5
9197 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9198 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9199 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9200 $3 = 5
9201 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9202 $4 = 0
9203 @end smallexample
9204
9205 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9206 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9207 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9208 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9209 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9210
9211 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9212 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9213 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9214 @code{some_global}.
9215
9216 @smallexample
9217 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9218 $1 = 23
9219 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9220 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9221 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9222 $2 = 27
9223 @end smallexample
9224
9225 @cindex wrong values
9226 @cindex variable values, wrong
9227 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9228 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9229 @quotation
9230 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9231 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9232 scope, and just before exit.
9233 @end quotation
9234 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9235 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9236 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9237 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9238 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9239 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9240 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9241 variable definitions may be gone.
9242
9243 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9244 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9245 when compiling.
9246
9247 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9248 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9249 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9250 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9251 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9252 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9253 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9254
9255 @smallexample
9256 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9257 @end smallexample
9258
9259 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9260 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9261 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9262 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9263 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9264
9265 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9266 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9267 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9268 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9269
9270 @cindex no debug info variables
9271 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9272 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9273 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9274 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9275 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9276 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9277 example, in a C program:
9278
9279 @smallexample
9280 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9281 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9282 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9283 $1 = 3.14
9284 @end smallexample
9285
9286 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9287 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9288 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9289 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9290 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9291
9292 @smallexample
9293 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9294 29 i++;
9295 (gdb) next
9296 30 e (i);
9297 (gdb) print i
9298 $1 = 31
9299 (gdb) print i@@entry
9300 $2 = 30
9301 @end smallexample
9302
9303 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9304 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9305 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9306 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9307 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9308 For program code
9309
9310 @smallexample
9311 char var0[] = "A";
9312 signed char var1[] = "A";
9313 @end smallexample
9314
9315 You get during debugging
9316 @smallexample
9317 (gdb) print var0
9318 $1 = "A"
9319 (gdb) print var1
9320 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9321 @end smallexample
9322
9323 @node Arrays
9324 @section Artificial Arrays
9325
9326 @cindex artificial array
9327 @cindex arrays
9328 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9329 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9330 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9331 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9332 program.
9333
9334 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9335 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9336 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9337 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9338 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9339 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9340 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9341 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9342 example. If a program says
9343
9344 @smallexample
9345 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9346 @end smallexample
9347
9348 @noindent
9349 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9350
9351 @smallexample
9352 p *array@@len
9353 @end smallexample
9354
9355 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9356 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9357 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9358 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9359 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9360
9361 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9362 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9363 The value need not be in memory:
9364 @smallexample
9365 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9366 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9367 @end smallexample
9368
9369 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9370 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9371 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9372 @smallexample
9373 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9374 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9375 @end smallexample
9376
9377 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9378 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9379 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9380 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9381 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9382 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9383 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9384 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9385 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9386 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9387
9388 @smallexample
9389 set $i = 0
9390 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9391 @key{RET}
9392 @key{RET}
9393 @dots{}
9394 @end smallexample
9395
9396 @node Output Formats
9397 @section Output Formats
9398
9399 @cindex formatted output
9400 @cindex output formats
9401 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9402 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9403 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9404 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9405 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9406
9407 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9408 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9409 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9410 letters supported are:
9411
9412 @table @code
9413 @item x
9414 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9415 hexadecimal.
9416
9417 @item d
9418 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9419
9420 @item u
9421 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9422
9423 @item o
9424 Print as integer in octal.
9425
9426 @item t
9427 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9428 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9429 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9430 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9431
9432 @item a
9433 @cindex unknown address, locating
9434 @cindex locate address
9435 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9436 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9437 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9438
9439 @smallexample
9440 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9441 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9442 @end smallexample
9443
9444 @noindent
9445 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9446 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9447
9448 @item c
9449 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9450 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9451 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9452 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9453
9454 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9455 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9456 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9457 data.
9458
9459 @item f
9460 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9461 using typical floating point syntax.
9462
9463 @item s
9464 @cindex printing strings
9465 @cindex printing byte arrays
9466 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9467 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9468 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9469 natural types.
9470
9471 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9472 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9473 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9474 array.
9475
9476 @item z
9477 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9478 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9479 to the size of the integer type.
9480
9481 @item r
9482 @cindex raw printing
9483 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9484 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9485 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9486 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9487 pretty-printer which might exist.
9488 @end table
9489
9490 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9491
9492 @smallexample
9493 p/x $pc
9494 @end smallexample
9495
9496 @noindent
9497 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9498 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9499
9500 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9501 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9502 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9503
9504 @node Memory
9505 @section Examining Memory
9506
9507 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9508 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9509
9510 @cindex examining memory
9511 @table @code
9512 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9513 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9514 @itemx x @var{addr}
9515 @itemx x
9516 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9517 @end table
9518
9519 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9520 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9521 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9522 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9523 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9524
9525 @table @r
9526 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9527 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9528 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9529 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9530 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9531 @c 4.1.2.
9532
9533 @item @var{f}, the display format
9534 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9535 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9536 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9537 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9538 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9539
9540 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9541 The unit size is any of
9542
9543 @table @code
9544 @item b
9545 Bytes.
9546 @item h
9547 Halfwords (two bytes).
9548 @item w
9549 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9550 @item g
9551 Giant words (eight bytes).
9552 @end table
9553
9554 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9555 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9556 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9557 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9558 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9559 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9560 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9561 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9562 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9563 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9564 be altered.
9565
9566 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9567 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9568 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9569 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9570 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9571 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9572 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9573 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9574 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9575 a value from memory).
9576 @end table
9577
9578 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9579 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9580 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9581 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9582 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9583
9584 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9585 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9586 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9587
9588 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9589 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9590 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9591 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9592 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9593
9594 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9595 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9596 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9597 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9598 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9599 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9600 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9601 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9602 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9603
9604 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9605 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9606 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9607 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9608 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9609 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9610
9611 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9612 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9613 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9614 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9615 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9616 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9617 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9618
9619 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9620 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9621
9622 @smallexample
9623 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9624 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9625 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9626 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9627 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9628 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9629 @end smallexample
9630
9631 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9632 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9633 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9634 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9635 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9636 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9637 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9638 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9639 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9640
9641 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9642 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9643 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9644
9645 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9646 @cindex addressable memory unit
9647 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9648 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9649 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9650 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9651 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9652 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9653 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9654 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9655 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9656
9657 @cindex remote memory comparison
9658 @cindex target memory comparison
9659 @cindex verify remote memory image
9660 @cindex verify target memory image
9661 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9662 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9663 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9664 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9665 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9666 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9667
9668 @table @code
9669 @kindex compare-sections
9670 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9671 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9672 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9673 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9674 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9675 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9676
9677 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9678 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9679 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9680 @end table
9681
9682 @node Auto Display
9683 @section Automatic Display
9684 @cindex automatic display
9685 @cindex display of expressions
9686
9687 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9688 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9689 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9690 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9691 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9692 The automatic display looks like this:
9693
9694 @smallexample
9695 2: foo = 38
9696 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9697 @end smallexample
9698
9699 @noindent
9700 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9701 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9702 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9703 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9704 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9705 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9706
9707 @table @code
9708 @kindex display
9709 @item display @var{expr}
9710 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9711 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9712
9713 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9714
9715 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9716 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9717 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9718 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9719 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9720
9721 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9722 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9723 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9724 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9725 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9726 @end table
9727
9728 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9729 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9730 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9731
9732 @table @code
9733 @kindex delete display
9734 @kindex undisplay
9735 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9736 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9737 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9738 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9739 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9740 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9741 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9742
9743 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9744 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9745
9746 @kindex disable display
9747 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9748 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9749 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9750 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9751 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9752 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9753 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9754 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9755
9756 @kindex enable display
9757 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9758 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9759 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9760 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9761 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9762 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9763 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9764
9765 @item display
9766 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9767 done when your program stops.
9768
9769 @kindex info display
9770 @item info display
9771 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9772 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9773 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9774 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9775 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9776 @end table
9777
9778 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9779 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9780 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9781 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9782 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9783 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9784 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9785 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9786 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9787 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9788 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9789
9790 @node Print Settings
9791 @section Print Settings
9792
9793 @cindex format options
9794 @cindex print settings
9795 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9796 and symbols are printed.
9797
9798 @noindent
9799 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9800
9801 @table @code
9802 @kindex set print
9803 @item set print address
9804 @itemx set print address on
9805 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9806 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9807 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9808 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9809 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9810 @code{set print address on}:
9811
9812 @smallexample
9813 @group
9814 (@value{GDBP}) f
9815 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9816 at input.c:530
9817 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9818 @end group
9819 @end smallexample
9820
9821 @item set print address off
9822 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9823 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9824
9825 @smallexample
9826 @group
9827 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9828 (@value{GDBP}) f
9829 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9830 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9831 @end group
9832 @end smallexample
9833
9834 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9835 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9836 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9837 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9838
9839 @kindex show print
9840 @item show print address
9841 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9842 @end table
9843
9844 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9845 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9846 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9847 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9848 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9849 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9850 it prints a symbolic address:
9851
9852 @table @code
9853 @item set print symbol-filename on
9854 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9855 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9856 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9857 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9858
9859 @item set print symbol-filename off
9860 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9861 default.
9862
9863 @item show print symbol-filename
9864 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9865 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9866 @end table
9867
9868 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9869 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9870 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9871
9872 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9873 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9874
9875 @table @code
9876 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9877 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9878 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9879 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9880 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9881 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9882 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9883 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9884
9885 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9886 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9887 symbolic address.
9888 @end table
9889
9890 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9891 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9892 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9893 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9894 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9895 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9896 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9897 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9898
9899 @smallexample
9900 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9901 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9902 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9903 @end smallexample
9904
9905 @quotation
9906 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9907 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9908 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9909 @end quotation
9910
9911 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9912 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9913
9914 @table @code
9915 @item set print symbol on
9916 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9917 one exists.
9918
9919 @item set print symbol off
9920 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9921 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9922 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9923
9924 @item show print symbol
9925 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9926 address.
9927 @end table
9928
9929 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9930
9931 @table @code
9932 @item set print array
9933 @itemx set print array on
9934 @cindex pretty print arrays
9935 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9936 but uses more space. The default is off.
9937
9938 @item set print array off
9939 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9940
9941 @item show print array
9942 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9943 arrays.
9944
9945 @cindex print array indexes
9946 @item set print array-indexes
9947 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9948 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9949 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9950 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9951
9952 @item set print array-indexes off
9953 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9954
9955 @item show print array-indexes
9956 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9957 arrays.
9958
9959 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9960 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9961 @cindex number of array elements to print
9962 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9963 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9964 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9965 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9966 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9967 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9968 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9969 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9970
9971 @item show print elements
9972 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9973 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9974
9975 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9976 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9977 @cindex printing frame argument values
9978 @cindex print all frame argument values
9979 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9980 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9981 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9982 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9983 values are:
9984
9985 @table @code
9986 @item all
9987 The values of all arguments are printed.
9988
9989 @item scalars
9990 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9991 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9992 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9993 only scalar arguments are shown:
9994
9995 @smallexample
9996 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9997 at frame-args.c:23
9998 @end smallexample
9999
10000 @item none
10001 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10002 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10003
10004 @smallexample
10005 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10006 at frame-args.c:23
10007 @end smallexample
10008 @end table
10009
10010 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10011 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10012 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10013 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10014 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10015 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10016 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10017 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10018 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10019 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10020
10021 @item show print frame-arguments
10022 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10023
10024 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10025 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10026
10027 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10028 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10029 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10030 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10031 This is the default.
10032
10033 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10034 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10035
10036 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10037 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10038 @kindex set print entry-values
10039 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10040 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10041 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10042 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10043 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10044
10045 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10046 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10047 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10048 @code{no} setting.
10049
10050 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10051 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10052 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10053 this information.
10054
10055 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10056
10057 @table @code
10058 @item no
10059 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10060 point.
10061 @smallexample
10062 #0 equal (val=5)
10063 #0 different (val=6)
10064 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10065 #0 born (val=10)
10066 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10067 @end smallexample
10068
10069 @item only
10070 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10071 values are never printed.
10072 @smallexample
10073 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10074 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10075 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10076 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10077 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10078 @end smallexample
10079
10080 @item preferred
10081 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10082 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10083 value for such parameter.
10084 @smallexample
10085 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10086 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10087 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10088 #0 born (val=10)
10089 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10090 @end smallexample
10091
10092 @item if-needed
10093 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10094 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10095 parameter.
10096 @smallexample
10097 #0 equal (val=5)
10098 #0 different (val=6)
10099 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10100 #0 born (val=10)
10101 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10102 @end smallexample
10103
10104 @item both
10105 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10106 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10107 optimizations.
10108 @smallexample
10109 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10110 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10111 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10112 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10113 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10114 @end smallexample
10115
10116 @item compact
10117 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10118 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10119 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10120 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10121 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10122 @smallexample
10123 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10124 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10125 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10126 #0 born (val=10)
10127 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10128 @end smallexample
10129
10130 @item default
10131 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10132 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10133 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10134 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10135 @smallexample
10136 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10137 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10138 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10139 #0 born (val=10)
10140 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10141 @end smallexample
10142 @end table
10143
10144 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10145 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10146
10147 @item show print entry-values
10148 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10149 entry.
10150
10151 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10152 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10153 @cindex repeated array elements
10154 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10155 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10156 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10157 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10158 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10159 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10160 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10161 is 10.
10162
10163 @item show print repeats
10164 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10165 elements.
10166
10167 @item set print null-stop
10168 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10169 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10170 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10171 contain only short strings.
10172 The default is off.
10173
10174 @item show print null-stop
10175 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10176 @sc{null} character.
10177
10178 @item set print pretty on
10179 @cindex print structures in indented form
10180 @cindex indentation in structure display
10181 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10182 per line, like this:
10183
10184 @smallexample
10185 @group
10186 $1 = @{
10187 next = 0x0,
10188 flags = @{
10189 sweet = 1,
10190 sour = 1
10191 @},
10192 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10193 @}
10194 @end group
10195 @end smallexample
10196
10197 @item set print pretty off
10198 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10199
10200 @smallexample
10201 @group
10202 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10203 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10204 @end group
10205 @end smallexample
10206
10207 @noindent
10208 This is the default format.
10209
10210 @item show print pretty
10211 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10212
10213 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10214 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10215 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10216 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10217 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10218 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10219 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10220 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10221
10222 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10223 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10224 international character sets, and is the default.
10225
10226 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10227 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10228
10229 @item set print union on
10230 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10231 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10232 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10233
10234 @item set print union off
10235 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10236 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10237 instead.
10238
10239 @item show print union
10240 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10241 structures and other unions.
10242
10243 For example, given the declarations
10244
10245 @smallexample
10246 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10247 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10248 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10249 Bug_forms;
10250
10251 struct thing @{
10252 Species it;
10253 union @{
10254 Tree_forms tree;
10255 Bug_forms bug;
10256 @} form;
10257 @};
10258
10259 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10260 @end smallexample
10261
10262 @noindent
10263 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10264
10265 @smallexample
10266 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10267 @end smallexample
10268
10269 @noindent
10270 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10271
10272 @smallexample
10273 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10274 @end smallexample
10275
10276 @noindent
10277 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10278 and in Pascal.
10279 @end table
10280
10281 @need 1000
10282 @noindent
10283 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10284
10285 @table @code
10286 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10287 @item set print demangle
10288 @itemx set print demangle on
10289 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10290 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10291 linkage. The default is on.
10292
10293 @item show print demangle
10294 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10295
10296 @item set print asm-demangle
10297 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10298 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10299 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10300 The default is off.
10301
10302 @item show print asm-demangle
10303 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10304 or demangled form.
10305
10306 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10307 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10308 @kindex set demangle-style
10309 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10310 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10311 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10312
10313 @table @code
10314 @item auto
10315 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10316 This is the default.
10317
10318 @item gnu
10319 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10320
10321 @item hp
10322 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10323
10324 @item lucid
10325 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10326
10327 @item arm
10328 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10329 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10330 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10331 require further enhancement to permit that.
10332
10333 @end table
10334 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10335
10336 @item show demangle-style
10337 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10338
10339 @item set print object
10340 @itemx set print object on
10341 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10342 @cindex display derived types
10343 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10344 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10345 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10346 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10347 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10348 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10349 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10350
10351 @item set print object off
10352 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10353 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10354
10355 @item show print object
10356 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10357
10358 @item set print static-members
10359 @itemx set print static-members on
10360 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10361 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10362
10363 @item set print static-members off
10364 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10365
10366 @item show print static-members
10367 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10368
10369 @item set print pascal_static-members
10370 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10371 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10372 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10373 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10374
10375 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10376 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10377
10378 @item show print pascal_static-members
10379 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10380
10381 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10382 @item set print vtbl
10383 @itemx set print vtbl on
10384 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10385 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10386 @cindex VTBL display
10387 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10388 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10389 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10390
10391 @item set print vtbl off
10392 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10393
10394 @item show print vtbl
10395 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10396 @end table
10397
10398 @node Pretty Printing
10399 @section Pretty Printing
10400
10401 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10402 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10403 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10404
10405 @menu
10406 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10407 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10408 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10409 @end menu
10410
10411 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10412 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10413
10414 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10415 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10416 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10417
10418 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10419 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10420 pretty-printers with their names.
10421 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10422 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10423 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10424 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10425
10426 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10427 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10428 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10429 do anything special.
10430
10431 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10432
10433 @itemize @bullet
10434 @item
10435 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10436 all inferiors.
10437
10438 @item
10439 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10440 when debugging that program.
10441 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10442
10443 @item
10444 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10445 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10446 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10447 @end itemize
10448
10449 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10450 pretty-printers are selected,
10451
10452 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10453 for new types.
10454
10455 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10456 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10457
10458 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10459
10460 @smallexample
10461 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10462 $1 = @{
10463 static npos = 4294967295,
10464 _M_dataplus = @{
10465 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10466 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10467 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10468 @},
10469 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10470 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10471 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10472 @}
10473 @}
10474 @end smallexample
10475
10476 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10477
10478 @smallexample
10479 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10480 $2 = "abcd"
10481 @end smallexample
10482
10483 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10484 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10485 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10486
10487 @table @code
10488 @kindex info pretty-printer
10489 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10490 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10491 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10492
10493 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10494 whose pretty-printers to list.
10495 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10496 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10497 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10498 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10499 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10500
10501 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10502 to list.
10503
10504 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10505 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10506 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10507 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10508
10509 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10510 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10511 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10512 @end table
10513
10514 Example:
10515
10516 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10517 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10518 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10519 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10520
10521 @smallexample
10522 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10523 library1.so:
10524 foo
10525 library2.so:
10526 bar
10527 bar1
10528 bar2
10529 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10530 library2.so:
10531 bar
10532 bar1
10533 bar2
10534 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10535 1 printer disabled
10536 2 of 3 printers enabled
10537 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10538 library1.so:
10539 foo [disabled]
10540 library2.so:
10541 bar
10542 bar1
10543 bar2
10544 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10545 1 printer disabled
10546 1 of 3 printers enabled
10547 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10548 library1.so:
10549 foo [disabled]
10550 library2.so:
10551 bar
10552 bar1 [disabled]
10553 bar2
10554 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10555 1 printer disabled
10556 0 of 3 printers enabled
10557 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10558 library1.so:
10559 foo [disabled]
10560 library2.so:
10561 bar [disabled]
10562 bar1 [disabled]
10563 bar2
10564 @end smallexample
10565
10566 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10567 as can each individual subprinter.
10568
10569 @node Value History
10570 @section Value History
10571
10572 @cindex value history
10573 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10574 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10575 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10576 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10577 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10578 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10579 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10580 symbol table.
10581
10582 @cindex @code{$}
10583 @cindex @code{$$}
10584 @cindex history number
10585 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10586 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10587 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10588 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10589 history number.
10590
10591 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10592 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10593 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10594 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10595 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10596 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10597 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10598
10599 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10600 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10601
10602 @smallexample
10603 p *$
10604 @end smallexample
10605
10606 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10607 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10608
10609 @smallexample
10610 p *$.next
10611 @end smallexample
10612
10613 @noindent
10614 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10615 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10616
10617 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10618 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10619
10620 @smallexample
10621 print x
10622 set x=5
10623 @end smallexample
10624
10625 @noindent
10626 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10627 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10628
10629 @table @code
10630 @kindex show values
10631 @item show values
10632 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10633 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10634 values} does not change the history.
10635
10636 @item show values @var{n}
10637 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10638
10639 @item show values +
10640 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10641 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10642 @end table
10643
10644 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10645 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10646
10647 @node Convenience Vars
10648 @section Convenience Variables
10649
10650 @cindex convenience variables
10651 @cindex user-defined variables
10652 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10653 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10654 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10655 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10656 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10657
10658 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10659 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10660 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10661 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10662 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10663
10664 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10665 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10666 For example:
10667
10668 @smallexample
10669 set $foo = *object_ptr
10670 @end smallexample
10671
10672 @noindent
10673 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10674 @code{object_ptr}.
10675
10676 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10677 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10678 value with another assignment at any time.
10679
10680 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10681 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10682 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10683 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10684
10685 @table @code
10686 @kindex show convenience
10687 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10688 @item show convenience
10689 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10690 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10691 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10692
10693 @kindex init-if-undefined
10694 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10695 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10696 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10697 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10698 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10699 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10700 override default values used in a command script.
10701
10702 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10703 any side-effects do not occur.
10704 @end table
10705
10706 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10707 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10708 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10709
10710 @smallexample
10711 set $i = 0
10712 print bar[$i++]->contents
10713 @end smallexample
10714
10715 @noindent
10716 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10717
10718 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10719 values likely to be useful.
10720
10721 @table @code
10722 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10723 @item $_
10724 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10725 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10726 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10727 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10728 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10729 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10730 to the type of @code{$__}.
10731
10732 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10733 @item $__
10734 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10735 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10736 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10737
10738 @item $_exitcode
10739 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10740 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10741 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10742 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10743
10744 @item $_exitsignal
10745 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10746 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10747 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10748 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10749
10750 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10751 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10752 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10753 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10754 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10755
10756 @smallexample
10757 #include <signal.h>
10758
10759 int
10760 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10761 @{
10762 raise (SIGALRM);
10763 return 0;
10764 @}
10765 @end smallexample
10766
10767 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10768 or signalled would be:
10769
10770 @smallexample
10771 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10772 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10773 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10774 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10775 >echo The program has exited\n
10776 >else
10777 >echo The program has signalled\n
10778 >end
10779 >end
10780 (@value{GDBP}) run
10781 Starting program:
10782
10783 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10784 The program no longer exists.
10785 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10786 The program has signalled
10787 @end smallexample
10788
10789 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10790 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10791 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10792 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10793
10794 @smallexample
10795 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10796 The program has exited
10797 @end smallexample
10798
10799 @item $_exception
10800 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10801 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10802
10803 @item $_probe_argc
10804 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10805 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10806
10807 @item $_sdata
10808 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10809 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10810 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10811 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10812 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10813
10814 @item $_siginfo
10815 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10816 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10817 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10818 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10819 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10820
10821 @item $_tlb
10822 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10823 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10824 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10825 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10826 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10827 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10828
10829 @item $_inferior
10830 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
10831 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
10832
10833 @item $_thread
10834 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
10835
10836 @item $_gthread
10837 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
10838
10839 @end table
10840
10841 @node Convenience Funs
10842 @section Convenience Functions
10843
10844 @cindex convenience functions
10845 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10846 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10847 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10848 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10849 @value{GDBN}.
10850
10851 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10852 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10853
10854 @table @code
10855
10856 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10857 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10858 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10859 returns zero.
10860
10861 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10862 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10863 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10864 it is @code{void}:
10865
10866 @smallexample
10867 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10868 $1 = void
10869 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10870 $2 = 1
10871 (@value{GDBP}) run
10872 Starting program: ./a.out
10873 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10874 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10875 $3 = 0
10876 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10877 $4 = 0
10878 @end smallexample
10879
10880 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10881 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10882 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10883 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10884 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10885 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10886 anymore.
10887
10888 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10889 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10890
10891 @smallexample
10892 void
10893 foo (void)
10894 @{
10895 @}
10896 @end smallexample
10897
10898 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10899
10900 @smallexample
10901 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10902 $1 = void
10903 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10904 $2 = 1
10905 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10906 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10907 $3 = void
10908 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10909 $4 = 1
10910 @end smallexample
10911
10912 @end table
10913
10914 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10915 @code{Python} support.
10916
10917 @table @code
10918
10919 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10920 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10921 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10922 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10923 Otherwise it returns zero.
10924
10925 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10926 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10927 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10928 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10929 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10930 regular expression support.
10931
10932 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10933 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10934 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10935 Otherwise it returns zero.
10936
10937 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10938 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10939 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10940
10941 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10942 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10943 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10944 Otherwise it returns zero.
10945
10946 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10947 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10948 The default is 1.
10949
10950 Example:
10951
10952 @smallexample
10953 (gdb) backtrace
10954 #0 bottom_func ()
10955 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10956 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10957 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10958 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10959 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10960 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10961 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10962 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10963 $1 = 1
10964 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10965 $1 = 1
10966 @end smallexample
10967
10968 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10969 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10970 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10971 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10972
10973 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10974 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10975 The default is 1.
10976
10977 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10978 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10979 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10980 Otherwise it returns zero.
10981
10982 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10983 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10984 The default is 1.
10985
10986 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10987 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10988 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10989 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10990
10991 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10992 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10993 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10994 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10995
10996 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10997 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10998 The default is 1.
10999
11000 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11001 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11002 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11003 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11004
11005 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11006 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11007 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11008
11009 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11010 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11011 an enumerated type:
11012
11013 @smallexample
11014 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11015 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11016 @end smallexample
11017
11018 @end table
11019
11020 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11021 convenience functions.
11022
11023 @table @code
11024 @item help function
11025 @kindex help function
11026 @cindex show all convenience functions
11027 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11028 @end table
11029
11030 @node Registers
11031 @section Registers
11032
11033 @cindex registers
11034 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11035 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11036 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11037 your machine.
11038
11039 @table @code
11040 @kindex info registers
11041 @item info registers
11042 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11043 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11044
11045 @kindex info all-registers
11046 @cindex floating point registers
11047 @item info all-registers
11048 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11049 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11050
11051 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11052 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11053 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11054 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11055
11056 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11057 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11058 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11059 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11060 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11061 @end table
11062
11063 @anchor{standard registers}
11064 @cindex stack pointer register
11065 @cindex program counter register
11066 @cindex process status register
11067 @cindex frame pointer register
11068 @cindex standard registers
11069 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11070 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11071 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11072 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11073 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11074 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11075 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11076 you could print the program counter in hex with
11077
11078 @smallexample
11079 p/x $pc
11080 @end smallexample
11081
11082 @noindent
11083 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11084
11085 @smallexample
11086 x/i $pc
11087 @end smallexample
11088
11089 @noindent
11090 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11091 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11092 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11093 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11094 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11095 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11096 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 set $sp += 4
11100 @end smallexample
11101
11102 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11103 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11104 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11105 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11106 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11107 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11108 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11109
11110 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11111 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11112 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11113 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11114 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11115 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11116 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11117
11118 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11119 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11120 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11121 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11122 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11123 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11124 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11125 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11126 prints the data in both formats.
11127
11128 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11129 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11130 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11131 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11132 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11133 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11134 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11135
11136 @smallexample
11137 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11138 $1 = @{
11139 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11140 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11141 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11142 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11143 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11144 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11145 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11146 @}
11147 @end smallexample
11148
11149 @noindent
11150 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11151 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11152 value to a @code{struct} member:
11153
11154 @smallexample
11155 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11156 @end smallexample
11157
11158 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11159 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11160 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11161 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11162 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11163 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11164
11165 @cindex caller-saved registers
11166 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11167 @cindex volatile registers
11168 @cindex <not saved> values
11169 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11170 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11171 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11172 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11173 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11174 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11175 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11176 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11177 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11178 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11179 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11180 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11181 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11182 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11183 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11184 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11185 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11186 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11187 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11188 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11189 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11190 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11191 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11192
11193 @node Floating Point Hardware
11194 @section Floating Point Hardware
11195 @cindex floating point
11196
11197 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11198 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11199
11200 @table @code
11201 @kindex info float
11202 @item info float
11203 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11204 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11205 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11206 the ARM and x86 machines.
11207 @end table
11208
11209 @node Vector Unit
11210 @section Vector Unit
11211 @cindex vector unit
11212
11213 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11214 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11215
11216 @table @code
11217 @kindex info vector
11218 @item info vector
11219 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11220 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11221 @end table
11222
11223 @node OS Information
11224 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11225 @cindex OS information
11226
11227 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11228 you debug your program.
11229
11230 @cindex auxiliary vector
11231 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11232 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11233 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11234 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11235 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11236 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11237 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11238 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11239 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11240 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11241 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11242 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11243
11244 @table @code
11245 @kindex info auxv
11246 @item info auxv
11247 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11248 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11249 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11250 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11251 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11252 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11253 an unrecognized tag.
11254 @end table
11255
11256 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11257 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11258 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11259 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11260 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11261 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11262 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11263
11264 @table @code
11265 @kindex info os
11266 @item info os @var{infotype}
11267
11268 Display OS information of the requested type.
11269
11270 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11271
11272 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11273 @table @code
11274 @kindex info os cpus
11275 @item cpus
11276 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11277 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11278 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11279 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11280 kernel initialization.
11281
11282 @kindex info os files
11283 @item files
11284 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11285 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11286 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11287 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11288
11289 @kindex info os modules
11290 @item modules
11291 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11292 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11293 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11294 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11295 in memory.
11296
11297 @kindex info os msg
11298 @item msg
11299 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11300 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11301 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11302 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11303 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11304 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11305 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11306 the message queue was last changed.
11307
11308 @kindex info os processes
11309 @item processes
11310 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11311 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11312 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11313 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11314 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11315 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11316
11317 @kindex info os procgroups
11318 @item procgroups
11319 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11320 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11321 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11322 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11323 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11324 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11325 and the process group leader is listed first.
11326
11327 @kindex info os semaphores
11328 @item semaphores
11329 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11330 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11331 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11332 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11333 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11334
11335 @kindex info os shm
11336 @item shm
11337 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11338 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11339 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11340 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11341 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11342 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11343 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11344
11345 @kindex info os sockets
11346 @item sockets
11347 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11348 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11349 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11350 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11351 connection.
11352
11353 @kindex info os threads
11354 @item threads
11355 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11356 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11357 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11358 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11359 process is not listed.
11360 @end table
11361
11362 @item info os
11363 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11364 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11365 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11366 types, this command will report an error.
11367 @end table
11368
11369 @node Memory Region Attributes
11370 @section Memory Region Attributes
11371 @cindex memory region attributes
11372
11373 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11374 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11375 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11376 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11377 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11378 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11379 user can override the fetched regions.
11380
11381 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11382 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11383 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11384 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11385 all memory.
11386
11387 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11388 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11389
11390 @table @code
11391 @kindex mem
11392 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11393 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11394 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11395 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11396 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11397 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11398
11399 @item mem auto
11400 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11401 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11402
11403 @kindex delete mem
11404 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11405 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11406 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11407
11408 @kindex disable mem
11409 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11410 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11411 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11412 It may be enabled again later.
11413
11414 @kindex enable mem
11415 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11416 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11417
11418 @kindex info mem
11419 @item info mem
11420 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11421 for each region:
11422
11423 @table @emph
11424 @item Memory Region Number
11425 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11426 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11427 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11428
11429 @item Lo Address
11430 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11431
11432 @item Hi Address
11433 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11434
11435 @item Attributes
11436 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11437 @end table
11438 @end table
11439
11440
11441 @subsection Attributes
11442
11443 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11444 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11445 write accesses to a memory region.
11446
11447 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11448 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11449 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11450
11451 @table @code
11452 @item ro
11453 Memory is read only.
11454 @item wo
11455 Memory is write only.
11456 @item rw
11457 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11458 @end table
11459
11460 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11461 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11462 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11463 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11464 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11465
11466 @table @code
11467 @item 8
11468 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11469 @item 16
11470 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11471 @item 32
11472 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11473 @item 64
11474 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11475 @end table
11476
11477 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11478 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11479 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11480 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11481 @c
11482 @c @table @code
11483 @c @item hwbreak
11484 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11485 @c @item swbreak (default)
11486 @c @end table
11487
11488 @subsubsection Data Cache
11489 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11490 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11491 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11492 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11493 registers.
11494
11495 @table @code
11496 @item cache
11497 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11498 @item nocache
11499 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11500 @end table
11501
11502 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11503 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11504 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11505 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11506 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11507
11508 @table @code
11509 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11510 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11511 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11512 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11513 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11514 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11515 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11516 The default value is @code{on}.
11517 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11518 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11519 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11520 @end table
11521
11522
11523 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11524 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11525 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11526 @c
11527 @c @table @code
11528 @c @item verify
11529 @c @item noverify (default)
11530 @c @end table
11531
11532 @node Dump/Restore Files
11533 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11534 @cindex dump/restore files
11535 @cindex append data to a file
11536 @cindex dump data to a file
11537 @cindex restore data from a file
11538
11539 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11540 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11541 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11542 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11543 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11544 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11545 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11546
11547 @table @code
11548
11549 @kindex dump
11550 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11551 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11552 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11553 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11554
11555 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11556 @table @code
11557 @item binary
11558 Raw binary form.
11559 @item ihex
11560 Intel hex format.
11561 @item srec
11562 Motorola S-record format.
11563 @item tekhex
11564 Tektronix Hex format.
11565 @item verilog
11566 Verilog Hex format.
11567 @end table
11568
11569 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11570 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11571 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11572 form.
11573
11574 @kindex append
11575 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11576 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11577 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11578 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11579 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11580
11581 @kindex restore
11582 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11583 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11584 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11585 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11586 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11587
11588 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11589 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11590 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11591 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11592 from that location.
11593
11594 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11595 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11596 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11597 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11598
11599 @end table
11600
11601 @node Core File Generation
11602 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11603 @cindex dump core from inferior
11604
11605 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11606 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11607 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11608 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11609 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11610 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11611 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11612
11613 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11614 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11615 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11616
11617 @table @code
11618 @kindex gcore
11619 @kindex generate-core-file
11620 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11621 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11622 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11623 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11624 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11625 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11626
11627 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11628 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11629
11630 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11631 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11632 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11633 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11634 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11635
11636 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11637 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11638 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11639 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11640 Enable or disable the use of the file
11641 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11642 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11643 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11644 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11645
11646 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11647 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11648 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11649 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11650 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11651 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11652 about the bits that can be set in the
11653 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11654 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11655
11656 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11657 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11658 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11659 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11660 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11661 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11662 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11663 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11664
11665 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11666 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11667 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11668 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11669 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11670 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11671 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11672
11673 The default value is @code{off}.
11674 @end table
11675
11676 @node Character Sets
11677 @section Character Sets
11678 @cindex character sets
11679 @cindex charset
11680 @cindex translating between character sets
11681 @cindex host character set
11682 @cindex target character set
11683
11684 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11685 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11686 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11687 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11688 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11689 @dfn{target character set}.
11690
11691 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11692 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11693 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11694 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11695 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11696 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11697 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11698 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11699 character and string literals in expressions.
11700
11701 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11702 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11703 target-charset} command, described below.
11704
11705 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11706 support:
11707
11708 @table @code
11709 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11710 @kindex set target-charset
11711 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11712 list of supported target character sets, type
11713 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11714
11715 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11716 @kindex set host-charset
11717 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11718
11719 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11720 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11721 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11722 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11723 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11724
11725 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11726 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11727 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11728
11729 @item set charset @var{charset}
11730 @kindex set charset
11731 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11732 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11733 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11734 for both host and target.
11735
11736 @item show charset
11737 @kindex show charset
11738 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11739
11740 @item show host-charset
11741 @kindex show host-charset
11742 Show the name of the current host character set.
11743
11744 @item show target-charset
11745 @kindex show target-charset
11746 Show the name of the current target character set.
11747
11748 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11749 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11750 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11751 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11752 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11753 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11754
11755 @item show target-wide-charset
11756 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11757 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11758 @end table
11759
11760 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11761 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11762 @file{charset-test.c}:
11763
11764 @smallexample
11765 #include <stdio.h>
11766
11767 char ascii_hello[]
11768 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11769 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11770 char ibm1047_hello[]
11771 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11772 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11773
11774 main ()
11775 @{
11776 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11777 @}
11778 @end smallexample
11779
11780 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11781 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11782 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11783
11784 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11785
11786 @smallexample
11787 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11788 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11789 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11790 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11791 @dots{}
11792 (@value{GDBP})
11793 @end smallexample
11794
11795 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11796 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11797 strings:
11798
11799 @smallexample
11800 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11801 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11802 (@value{GDBP})
11803 @end smallexample
11804
11805 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11806 initial character set:
11807 @smallexample
11808 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11809 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11810 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11811 (@value{GDBP})
11812 @end smallexample
11813
11814 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11815 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11816 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11817 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11818 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11819
11820 @smallexample
11821 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11822 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11823 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11824 $2 = 72 'H'
11825 (@value{GDBP})
11826 @end smallexample
11827
11828 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11829 literals you use in expressions:
11830
11831 @smallexample
11832 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11833 $3 = 43 '+'
11834 (@value{GDBP})
11835 @end smallexample
11836
11837 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11838 character.
11839
11840 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11841 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11842 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11843
11844 @smallexample
11845 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11846 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11847 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11848 $5 = 200 '\310'
11849 (@value{GDBP})
11850 @end smallexample
11851
11852 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11853 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11854
11855 @smallexample
11856 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11857 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11858 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11859 @end smallexample
11860
11861 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11862 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11863 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11864 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11865 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11866
11867 @smallexample
11868 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11869 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11870 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11871 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11872 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11873 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11874 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11875 $7 = 72 '\110'
11876 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11877 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11878 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11879 $9 = 200 'H'
11880 (@value{GDBP})
11881 @end smallexample
11882
11883 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11884 string literals you use in expressions:
11885
11886 @smallexample
11887 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11888 $10 = 78 '+'
11889 (@value{GDBP})
11890 @end smallexample
11891
11892 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11893 character.
11894
11895 @node Caching Target Data
11896 @section Caching Data of Targets
11897 @cindex caching data of targets
11898
11899 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11900 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11901 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11902 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11903 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11904 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11905 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11906 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11907 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11908 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11909 is executing.
11910 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11911 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11912 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11913 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11914 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11915 in the code segment.
11916 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11917 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11918
11919 @table @code
11920 @kindex set remotecache
11921 @item set remotecache on
11922 @itemx set remotecache off
11923 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11924 with old scripts.
11925
11926 @kindex show remotecache
11927 @item show remotecache
11928 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11929
11930 @kindex set stack-cache
11931 @item set stack-cache on
11932 @itemx set stack-cache off
11933 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11934 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11935
11936 @kindex show stack-cache
11937 @item show stack-cache
11938 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11939
11940 @kindex set code-cache
11941 @item set code-cache on
11942 @itemx set code-cache off
11943 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11944 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11945 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11946
11947 @kindex show code-cache
11948 @item show code-cache
11949 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11950 accesses.
11951
11952 @kindex info dcache
11953 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11954 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11955 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11956 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11957 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11958 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11959
11960 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11961 printed in hex.
11962
11963 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11964 @cindex dcache size
11965 @kindex set dcache size
11966 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11967
11968 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11969 @cindex dcache line-size
11970 @kindex set dcache line-size
11971 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11972 Must be a power of 2.
11973
11974 @item show dcache size
11975 @kindex show dcache size
11976 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11977
11978 @item show dcache line-size
11979 @kindex show dcache line-size
11980 Show default size of dcache lines.
11981
11982 @end table
11983
11984 @node Searching Memory
11985 @section Search Memory
11986 @cindex searching memory
11987
11988 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11989 @code{find} command.
11990
11991 @table @code
11992 @kindex find
11993 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11994 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11995 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11996 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11997 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11998 @end table
11999
12000 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12001 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12002
12003 @table @r
12004 @item @var{s}, search query size
12005 The size of each search query value.
12006
12007 @table @code
12008 @item b
12009 bytes
12010 @item h
12011 halfwords (two bytes)
12012 @item w
12013 words (four bytes)
12014 @item g
12015 giant words (eight bytes)
12016 @end table
12017
12018 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12019 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12020 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12021 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12022 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12023
12024 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12025 value's type in the current language.
12026 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12027 pattern as a mixture of types.
12028 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12029 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12030 which is typically four bytes.
12031
12032 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12033 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12034 @end table
12035
12036 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12037 (@code{"}).
12038 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12039 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12040
12041 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12042 number of matches found.
12043
12044 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12045 @samp{$_}.
12046 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12047
12048 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12049
12050 @smallexample
12051 void
12052 hello ()
12053 @{
12054 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12055 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12056 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12057 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12058 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12059 @}
12060 @end smallexample
12061
12062 @noindent
12063 you get during debugging:
12064
12065 @smallexample
12066 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12067 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12068 1 pattern found
12069 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12070 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12071 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12072 2 patterns found.
12073 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12074 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12075 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12076 2 patterns found.
12077 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12078 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12079 1 pattern found
12080 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12081 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12082 1 pattern found
12083 (gdb) print $numfound
12084 $1 = 1
12085 (gdb) print $_
12086 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12087 @end smallexample
12088
12089 @node Value Sizes
12090 @section Value Sizes
12091
12092 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12093 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12094 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12095 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12096 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12097
12098 @table @code
12099 @kindex set max-value-size
12100 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12101 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12102 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12103 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12104 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12105
12106 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12107 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12108
12109 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12110 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12111 currently 16 bytes.
12112
12113 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12114 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12115 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12116 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12117 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12118 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12119 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12120 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12121
12122 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12123
12124 @kindex show max-value-size
12125 @item show max-value-size
12126 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12127 allocate for the contents of a value.
12128 @end table
12129
12130 @node Optimized Code
12131 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12132 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12133 @cindex debugging optimized code
12134
12135 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12136 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12137 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12138 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12139 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12140 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12141 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12142
12143 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12144 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12145 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12146 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12147
12148 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12149 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12150 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12151 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12152 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12153 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12154
12155 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12156 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12157 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12158 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12159 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12160
12161 @menu
12162 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12163 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12164 @end menu
12165
12166 @node Inline Functions
12167 @section Inline Functions
12168 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12169
12170 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12171 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12172 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12173 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12174 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12175 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12176 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12177 @code{info frame} command.
12178
12179 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12180 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12181 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12182 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12183 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12184 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12185 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12186 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12187 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12188 local variables in the caller.
12189
12190 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12191 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12192 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12193 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12194 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12195 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12196 instructions are executed.
12197
12198 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12199 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12200 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12201 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12202
12203 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12204 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12205
12206 @itemize @bullet
12207 @item
12208 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12209 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12210 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12211 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12212 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12213 or inside the inlined function instead.
12214
12215 @item
12216 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12217 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12218 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12219 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12220
12221 @end itemize
12222
12223 @node Tail Call Frames
12224 @section Tail Call Frames
12225 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12226
12227 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12228 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12229 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12230 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12231 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12232
12233 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12234 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12235 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12236 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12237 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12238 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12239 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12240
12241 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12242 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12243 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12244 this information.
12245
12246 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12247 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12248
12249 @smallexample
12250 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12251 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12252 (gdb) info frame
12253 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12254 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12255 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12256 source language c++.
12257 Arglist at unknown address.
12258 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12259 @end smallexample
12260
12261 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12262 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12263 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12264 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12265 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12266 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12267
12268 @table @code
12269 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12270 @item set debug entry-values
12271 @kindex set debug entry-values
12272 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12273 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12274 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12275 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12276 result.
12277
12278 @item show debug entry-values
12279 @kindex show debug entry-values
12280 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12281 values at function entry and tail calls.
12282 @end table
12283
12284 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12285 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12286 reference by variable @code{x}):
12287
12288 @smallexample
12289 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12290 void (*x) (void) = c;
12291 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12292 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12293 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12294
12295 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12296 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12297 a () at t.c:3
12298 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12299 (gdb) bt
12300 #0 a () at t.c:3
12301 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12302 @end smallexample
12303
12304 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12305
12306 @smallexample
12307 int i;
12308 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12309 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12310 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12311 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12312 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12313 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12314 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12315 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12316
12317 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12318 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12319 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12320 (gdb) bt
12321 #0 f () at t.c:2
12322 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12323 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12324 @end smallexample
12325
12326 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12327 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12328
12329 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12330 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12331 @set ARROW @click{}
12332 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12333 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12334 @end ifset
12335 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12336 @set ARROW ->
12337 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12338 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12339 @end ifclear
12340
12341 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12342 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12343 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12344
12345 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12346 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12347 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12348 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12349 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12350 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12351
12352 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12353 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12354 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12355 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12356 omitted.
12357
12358 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12359 entry may fail:
12360
12361 @smallexample
12362 int v;
12363 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12364 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12365 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12366 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12367 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12368 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12369
12370 (gdb) bt
12371 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12372 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12373 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12374 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12375 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12376 @end smallexample
12377
12378 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12379 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12380 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12381 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12382 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12383
12384 @node Macros
12385 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12386
12387 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12388 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12389 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12390 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12391 where it was defined.
12392
12393 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12394 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12395 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12396 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12397
12398 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12399 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12400 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12401 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12402 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12403 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12404 see @ref{List}.
12405
12406 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12407 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12408 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12409
12410 @table @code
12411
12412 @kindex macro expand
12413 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12414 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12415 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12416 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12417 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12418 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12419 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12420 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12421 it can be any string of tokens.
12422
12423 @kindex macro exp1
12424 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12425 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12426 @cindex expand macro once
12427 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12428 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12429 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12430 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12431 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12432 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12433 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12434 can be any string of tokens.
12435
12436 @kindex info macro
12437 @cindex macro definition, showing
12438 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12439 @cindex macros, from debug info
12440 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12441 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12442 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12443 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12444 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12445 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12446
12447 @kindex info macros
12448 @item info macros @var{location}
12449 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12450 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12451 command-line where those definitions were established.
12452
12453 @kindex macro define
12454 @cindex user-defined macros
12455 @cindex defining macros interactively
12456 @cindex macros, user-defined
12457 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12458 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12459 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12460 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12461 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12462 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12463 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12464 @var{arglist}.
12465
12466 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12467 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12468 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12469 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12470 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12471
12472 @kindex macro undef
12473 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12474 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12475 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12476 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12477 in the program being debugged.
12478
12479 @kindex macro list
12480 @item macro list
12481 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12482 @end table
12483
12484 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12485 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12486 show our source files:
12487
12488 @smallexample
12489 $ cat sample.c
12490 #include <stdio.h>
12491 #include "sample.h"
12492
12493 #define M 42
12494 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12495
12496 main ()
12497 @{
12498 #define N 28
12499 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12500 #undef N
12501 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12502 #define N 1729
12503 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12504 @}
12505 $ cat sample.h
12506 #define Q <
12507 $
12508 @end smallexample
12509
12510 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12511 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12512 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12513 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12514 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12515 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12516 information.
12517
12518 @smallexample
12519 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12520 $
12521 @end smallexample
12522
12523 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12524
12525 @smallexample
12526 $ gdb -nw sample
12527 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12528 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12529 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12530 (@value{GDBP})
12531 @end smallexample
12532
12533 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12534 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12535 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12536
12537 @smallexample
12538 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12539 3
12540 4 #define M 42
12541 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12542 6
12543 7 main ()
12544 8 @{
12545 9 #define N 28
12546 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12547 11 #undef N
12548 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12549 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12550 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12551 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12552 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12553 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12554 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12555 #define Q <
12556 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12557 expands to: (42 + 1)
12558 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12559 expands to: once (M + 1)
12560 (@value{GDBP})
12561 @end smallexample
12562
12563 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12564 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12565 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12566 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12567
12568 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12569 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12570
12571 @smallexample
12572 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12573 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12574 (@value{GDBP}) run
12575 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12576
12577 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12578 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12579 (@value{GDBP})
12580 @end smallexample
12581
12582 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12583
12584 @smallexample
12585 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12586 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12587 #define N 28
12588 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12589 expands to: 28 < 42
12590 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12591 $1 = 1
12592 (@value{GDBP})
12593 @end smallexample
12594
12595 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12596 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12597 thereof) in force at each point:
12598
12599 @smallexample
12600 (@value{GDBP}) next
12601 Hello, world!
12602 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12603 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12604 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12605 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12606 (@value{GDBP}) next
12607 We're so creative.
12608 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12609 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12610 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12611 #define N 1729
12612 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12613 expands to: 1729 < 42
12614 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12615 $2 = 0
12616 (@value{GDBP})
12617 @end smallexample
12618
12619 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12620 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12621 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12622 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12623
12624 @smallexample
12625 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12626 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12627 -D__STDC__=1
12628 (@value{GDBP})
12629 @end smallexample
12630
12631
12632 @node Tracepoints
12633 @chapter Tracepoints
12634 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12635 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12636
12637 @cindex tracepoints
12638 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12639 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12640 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12641 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12642 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12643 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12644 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12645
12646 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12647 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12648 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12649 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12650 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12651 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12652 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12653 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12654 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12655 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12656 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12657
12658 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12659 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12660 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12661 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12662 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12663 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12664 Packets}.
12665
12666 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12667 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12668 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12669
12670 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12671
12672 @menu
12673 * Set Tracepoints::
12674 * Analyze Collected Data::
12675 * Tracepoint Variables::
12676 * Trace Files::
12677 @end menu
12678
12679 @node Set Tracepoints
12680 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12681
12682 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12683 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12684 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12685 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12686 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12687 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12688 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12689
12690 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12691 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12692 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12693 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12694 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12695 tracepoint was hit.
12696
12697 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12698 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12699 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12700 either.
12701
12702 @cindex fast tracepoints
12703 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12704 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12705 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12706
12707 @cindex static tracepoints
12708 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12709 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12710 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12711 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12712 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12713 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12714 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12715 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12716 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12717 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12718 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12719 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12720 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12721 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12722 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12723 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12724 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12725 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12726 static tracepoint marker.
12727
12728 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12729 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12730
12731 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12732 conditions and actions.
12733
12734 @menu
12735 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12736 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12737 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12738 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12739 * Trace State Variables::
12740 * Tracepoint Actions::
12741 * Listing Tracepoints::
12742 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12743 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12744 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12745 @end menu
12746
12747 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12748 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12749
12750 @table @code
12751 @cindex set tracepoint
12752 @kindex trace
12753 @item trace @var{location}
12754 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12755 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
12756 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
12757 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
12758 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
12759 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12760 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12761 in tracing}).
12762 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12763 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12764 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12765 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12766 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12767 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12768 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12769 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12770 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12771 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12772 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12773 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12774
12775 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12776
12777 @smallexample
12778 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12779
12780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12781
12782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12783
12784 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12785
12786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12787 @end smallexample
12788
12789 @noindent
12790 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12791
12792 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12793 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12794 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12795 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12796 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12797 information on tracepoint conditions.
12798
12799 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12800 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12801 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12802 @kindex ftrace
12803 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12804 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12805 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12806 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12807 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12808 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12809 message.
12810
12811 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12812 @code{trace}.
12813
12814 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12815 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12816 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12817 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12818 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12819 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12820 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12821 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12822
12823 @example
12824 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12825 @end example
12826
12827 @noindent
12828 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12829 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12830
12831 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12832 @cindex set static tracepoint
12833 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12834 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12835 @kindex strace
12836 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12837 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12838 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12839 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12840 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12841
12842 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12843 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12844 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12845 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12846 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12847 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12848 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12849 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12850 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12851 tracing engine:
12852
12853 @smallexample
12854 main ()
12855 @{
12856 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12857 @}
12858 @end smallexample
12859
12860 @noindent
12861 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12862 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12863
12864 @smallexample
12865 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12866 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12867 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12868 Data: "str %s"
12869 [etc...]
12870 @end smallexample
12871
12872 @noindent
12873 so you may probe the marker above with:
12874
12875 @smallexample
12876 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12877 @end smallexample
12878
12879 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12880 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12881 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12882 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12883 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12884 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12885 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12886 the @samp{Data:} field.
12887
12888 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12889 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12890 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12891
12892 @vindex $tpnum
12893 @cindex last tracepoint number
12894 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12895 @cindex tracepoint number
12896 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12897 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12898
12899 @kindex delete tracepoint
12900 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12901 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12902 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12903 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12904 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12905
12906 Examples:
12907
12908 @smallexample
12909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12910
12911 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12912 @end smallexample
12913
12914 @noindent
12915 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12916 @end table
12917
12918 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12919 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12920
12921 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12922
12923 @table @code
12924 @kindex disable tracepoint
12925 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12926 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12927 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12928 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12929 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12930 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12931 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12932 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12933 next trace experiment.
12934
12935 @kindex enable tracepoint
12936 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12937 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12938 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12939 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12940 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12941 next time a trace experiment is run.
12942 @end table
12943
12944 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12945 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12946
12947 @table @code
12948 @kindex passcount
12949 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12950 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12951 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12952 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12953 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12954 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12955 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12956 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12957 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12958 user.
12959
12960 Examples:
12961
12962 @smallexample
12963 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12964 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12965
12966 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12967 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12968 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12971 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12973 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12974 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12975 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12976 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12977 @end smallexample
12978 @end table
12979
12980 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12981 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12982 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12983 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12984
12985 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12986 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12987 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12988 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12989 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12990 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12991 is true.
12992
12993 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12994 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12995 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12996 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12997 just as with breakpoints.
12998
12999 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13000 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13001 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13002 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13003 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13004 accesses, and so forth.
13005
13006 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13007 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13008 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13009 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13010 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13011 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13012 search through.
13013
13014 @smallexample
13015 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13016 @end smallexample
13017
13018 @node Trace State Variables
13019 @subsection Trace State Variables
13020 @cindex trace state variables
13021
13022 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13023 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13024 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13025 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13026 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13027 integers.
13028
13029 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13030 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13031 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13032 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13033
13034 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13035 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13036 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13037 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13038 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13039 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13040 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13041 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13042 variable with the same name.
13043
13044 @table @code
13045
13046 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13047 @kindex tvariable
13048 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13049 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13050 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13051 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13052 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13053 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13054 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13055 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13056 value. The default initial value is 0.
13057
13058 @item info tvariables
13059 @kindex info tvariables
13060 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13061 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13062 currently running.
13063
13064 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13065 @kindex delete tvariable
13066 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13067 are specified.
13068
13069 @end table
13070
13071 @node Tracepoint Actions
13072 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13073
13074 @table @code
13075 @kindex actions
13076 @cindex tracepoint actions
13077 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13078 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13079 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13080 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13081 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13082 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13083 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13084 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13085 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13086 @code{while-stepping}.
13087
13088 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13089 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13090 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13091
13092 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13093 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13094 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13095
13096 @smallexample
13097 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13098
13099 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13100
13101 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13102 @end smallexample
13103
13104 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13105 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13106 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13107 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13108 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13109 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13110 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13111 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13112
13113 @smallexample
13114 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13115 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13116 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13117 > collect bar,baz
13118 > collect $regs
13119 > while-stepping 12
13120 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13121 > end
13122 end
13123 @end smallexample
13124
13125 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13126 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13127 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13128 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13129 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13130 special arguments are supported:
13131
13132 @table @code
13133 @item $regs
13134 Collect all registers.
13135
13136 @item $args
13137 Collect all function arguments.
13138
13139 @item $locals
13140 Collect all local variables.
13141
13142 @item $_ret
13143 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13144 of a backtrace.
13145
13146 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13147 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13148 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13149 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13150 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13151 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13152
13153 @item $_probe_argc
13154 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13155 tracepoint is located.
13156 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13157
13158 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13159 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13160 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13161 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13162
13163 @item $_sdata
13164 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13165 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13166 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13167 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13168 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13169 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13170 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13171 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13172 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13173
13174 @smallexample
13175 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13176 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13177 @end smallexample
13178
13179 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13180 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13181 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13182 @value{GDBN}.
13183 @end table
13184
13185 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13186 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13187 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13188
13189 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13190 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13191 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13192 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13193 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13194 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13195 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13196 @samp{mystr}.
13197
13198 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13199 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13200
13201 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13202 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13203 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13204 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13205 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13206 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13207 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13208 action were used.
13209
13210 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13211 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13212 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13213 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13214 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13215 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13216
13217 @smallexample
13218 > while-stepping 12
13219 > collect $regs, myglobal
13220 > end
13221 >
13222 @end smallexample
13223
13224 @noindent
13225 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13226 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13227 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13228 @code{stepping}.
13229
13230 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13231 @kindex set default-collect
13232 @cindex default collection action
13233 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13234 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13235 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13236 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13237 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13238 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13239
13240 @item show default-collect
13241 @kindex show default-collect
13242 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13243 tracepoint hit.
13244
13245 @end table
13246
13247 @node Listing Tracepoints
13248 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13249
13250 @table @code
13251 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13252 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13253 @cindex information about tracepoints
13254 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13255 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13256 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13257 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13258 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13259 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13260
13261 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13262 tracing:
13263
13264 @itemize @bullet
13265 @item
13266 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13267
13268 @item
13269 the state about installed on target of each location
13270 @end itemize
13271
13272 @smallexample
13273 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13274 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13275 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13276 while-stepping 20
13277 collect globfoo, $regs
13278 end
13279 collect globfoo2
13280 end
13281 pass count 1200
13282 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13283 collect $eip
13284 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13285 installed on target
13286 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13287 installed on target
13288 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13289 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13290 not installed on target
13291 (@value{GDBP})
13292 @end smallexample
13293
13294 @noindent
13295 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13296 @end table
13297
13298 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13299 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13300
13301 @table @code
13302 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13303 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13304 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13305 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13306 program.
13307
13308 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13309
13310 @table @emph
13311 @item Count
13312 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13313 stable identifier.
13314 @item ID
13315 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13316 @item Enabled or Disabled
13317 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13318 that are not enabled.
13319 @item Address
13320 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13321 @item What
13322 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13323 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13324 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13325 will be left blank.
13326 @end table
13327
13328 @noindent
13329 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13330
13331 @table @emph
13332 @item Data
13333 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13334 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13335 marker call.
13336 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13337 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13338 @end table
13339
13340 @smallexample
13341 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13342 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13343 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13344 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13345 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13346 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13347 Data: str %s
13348 (@value{GDBP})
13349 @end smallexample
13350 @end table
13351
13352 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13353 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13354
13355 @table @code
13356 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13357 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13358 @cindex collected data discarded
13359 @item tstart
13360 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13361 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13362 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13363 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13364 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13365 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13366 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13367 information, and so forth.
13368
13369 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13370 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13371 @item tstop
13372 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13373 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13374 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13375 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13376 needs to be stopped quickly.
13377
13378 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13379 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13380 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13381
13382 @kindex tstatus
13383 @cindex status of trace data collection
13384 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13385 @item tstatus
13386 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13387 collection.
13388 @end table
13389
13390 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13391
13392 @smallexample
13393 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13394 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13395 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13396 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13397 > while-stepping 11
13398 > collect $regs
13399 > end
13400 > end
13401 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13402 [time passes @dots{}]
13403 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13404 @end smallexample
13405
13406 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13407 @cindex disconnected tracing
13408 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13409 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13410 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13411 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13412 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13413 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13414 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13415 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13416
13417 @table @code
13418 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13419 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13420 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13421 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13422 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13423 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13424 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13425 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13426
13427 @item show disconnected-tracing
13428 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13429 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13430
13431 @end table
13432
13433 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13434 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13435 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13436 it will continue after reconnection.
13437
13438 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13439 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13440 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13441 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13442 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13443 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13444 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13445 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13446 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13447 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13448
13449 @cindex circular trace buffer
13450 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13451 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13452 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13453 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13454 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13455 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13456 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13457 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13458 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13459 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13460 the next run.
13461
13462 @table @code
13463 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13464 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13465 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13466 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13467 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13468 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13469 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13470
13471 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13472 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13473 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13474 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13475 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13476 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13477
13478 @end table
13479
13480 @table @code
13481 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13482 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13483 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13484 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13485 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13486 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13487 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13488 likes. This is also the default.
13489
13490 @item show trace-buffer-size
13491 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13492 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13493 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13494 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13495 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13496 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13497 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13498 @end table
13499
13500 @table @code
13501 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13502 @kindex set trace-user
13503
13504 @item show trace-user
13505 @kindex show trace-user
13506
13507 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13508 @kindex set trace-notes
13509 Set the trace run's notes.
13510
13511 @item show trace-notes
13512 @kindex show trace-notes
13513 Show the trace run's notes.
13514
13515 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13516 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13517 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13518 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13519 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13520
13521 @item show trace-stop-notes
13522 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13523 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13524
13525 @end table
13526
13527 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13528 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13529
13530 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13531 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13532 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13533 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13534 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13535 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13536 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13537 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13538 mentioned here.
13539
13540 @itemize @bullet
13541
13542 @item
13543 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13544 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13545 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13546 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13547 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13548 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13549 cannot be collected either.
13550
13551 @item
13552 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13553 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13554 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13555 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13556 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13557 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13558 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13559 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13560 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13561 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13562
13563 @item
13564 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13565 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13566 in a misleading way.
13567
13568 @item
13569 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13570 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13571 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13572 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13573 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13574 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13575 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13576 by @code{ptr}.
13577
13578 @item
13579 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13580 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13581 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13582 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13583 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13584 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13585 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13586 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13587 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13588 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13589 invalid address.
13590
13591 @item
13592 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13593 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13594 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13595 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13596 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13597 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13598 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13599 it to zero.
13600
13601 @end itemize
13602
13603 @node Analyze Collected Data
13604 @section Using the Collected Data
13605
13606 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13607 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13608 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13609 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13610 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13611 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13612 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13613 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13614 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13615 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13616 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13617 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13618 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13619 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13620 the buffer will fail.
13621
13622 @menu
13623 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13624 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13625 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13626 @end menu
13627
13628 @node tfind
13629 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13630
13631 @kindex tfind
13632 @cindex select trace snapshot
13633 @cindex find trace snapshot
13634 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13635 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13636 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13637 snapshot is selected.
13638
13639 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13640
13641 @table @code
13642 @item tfind start
13643 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13644 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13645
13646 @item tfind none
13647 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13648
13649 @item tfind end
13650 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13651
13652 @item tfind
13653 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13654 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13655
13656 @item tfind -
13657 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13658 retracing earlier steps.
13659
13660 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13661 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13662 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13663 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13664 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13665
13666 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13667 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13668 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13669 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13670 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13671
13672 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13673 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13674 addresses (exclusive).
13675
13676 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13677 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13678 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13679
13680 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13681 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13682 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13683 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13684 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13685 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13686 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13687 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13688 @end table
13689
13690 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13691 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13692 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13693 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13694 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13695 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13696 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13697 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13698 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13699 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13700 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13701 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13702 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13703 tracepoint as the current one.
13704
13705 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13706 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13707 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13708 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13709 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13710
13711 @smallexample
13712 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13714 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13715 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13716 > tfind
13717 > end
13718
13719 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13720 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13721 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13722 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13723 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13724 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13725 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13726 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13727 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13728 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13729 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13730 @end smallexample
13731
13732 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13733 the buffer:
13734
13735 @smallexample
13736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13737 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13738 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13739 > tfind line
13740 > end
13741
13742 Frame 0, X = 1
13743 Frame 7, X = 2
13744 Frame 13, X = 255
13745 @end smallexample
13746
13747 @node tdump
13748 @subsection @code{tdump}
13749 @kindex tdump
13750 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13751 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13752
13753 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13754 the current trace snapshot.
13755
13756 @smallexample
13757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13759 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13760 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13761 > end
13762
13763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13764
13765 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13766 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13767 at gdb_test.c:444
13768 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13769
13770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13771 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13772 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13773 d1 0x18 24
13774 d2 0x80 128
13775 d3 0x33 51
13776 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13777 d5 0x22 34
13778 d6 0xe0 224
13779 d7 0x380035 3670069
13780 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13781 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13782 a2 0x100 256
13783 a3 0x322000 3284992
13784 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13785 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13786 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13787 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13788 ps 0x0 0
13789 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13790 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13791 fpstatus 0x0 0
13792 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13793 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13794 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13795 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13796 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13797 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13798 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13799 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13800 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13801
13802 (@value{GDBP})
13803 @end smallexample
13804
13805 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13806 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13807 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13808 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13809
13810 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13811 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13812 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13813 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13814 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13815 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13816 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13817 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13818 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13819 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13820
13821 @node save tracepoints
13822 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13823 @kindex save tracepoints
13824 @kindex save-tracepoints
13825 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13826
13827 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13828 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13829 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13830 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13831 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13832 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13833
13834 @node Tracepoint Variables
13835 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13836 @cindex tracepoint variables
13837 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13838
13839 @table @code
13840 @vindex $trace_frame
13841 @item (int) $trace_frame
13842 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13843 snapshot is selected.
13844
13845 @vindex $tracepoint
13846 @item (int) $tracepoint
13847 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13848
13849 @vindex $trace_line
13850 @item (int) $trace_line
13851 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13852
13853 @vindex $trace_file
13854 @item (char []) $trace_file
13855 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13856
13857 @vindex $trace_func
13858 @item (char []) $trace_func
13859 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13860 @end table
13861
13862 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13863 use @code{output} instead.
13864
13865 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13866 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13867 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13868 which are managed by the target.
13869
13870 @smallexample
13871 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13872
13873 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13874 > output $trace_file
13875 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13876 > tfind
13877 > end
13878 @end smallexample
13879
13880 @node Trace Files
13881 @section Using Trace Files
13882 @cindex trace files
13883
13884 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13885 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13886 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13887 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13888 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13889
13890 @table @code
13891
13892 @kindex tsave
13893 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13894 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13895 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13896 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13897 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13898 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13899 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13900 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13901 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13902 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13903 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13904 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
13905 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13906 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13907 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13908
13909 @kindex target tfile
13910 @kindex tfile
13911 @kindex target ctf
13912 @kindex ctf
13913 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13914 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13915 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13916 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13917 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13918 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13919 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13920 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13921 the host.
13922
13923 @smallexample
13924 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13925 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13926 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13927 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13928 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13929 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13930 i = 0
13931 a = 0
13932 b = 1 '\001'
13933 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13934 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13935 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13936 $1 = 1
13937 @end smallexample
13938
13939 @end table
13940
13941 @node Overlays
13942 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13943 @cindex overlays
13944
13945 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13946 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13947 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13948 use overlays.
13949
13950 @menu
13951 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13952 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13953 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13954 mapped by asking the inferior.
13955 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13956 @end menu
13957
13958 @node How Overlays Work
13959 @section How Overlays Work
13960 @cindex mapped overlays
13961 @cindex unmapped overlays
13962 @cindex load address, overlay's
13963 @cindex mapped address
13964 @cindex overlay area
13965
13966 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13967 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13968 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13969 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13970 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13971
13972 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13973 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13974 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13975 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13976 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13977 largest overlay as well.
13978
13979 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13980 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13981 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13982 there.
13983
13984 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13985 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13986 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13987
13988 @smallexample
13989 @group
13990 Data Instruction Larger
13991 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13992 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13993 | | | | | |
13994 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13995 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13996 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13997 | and heap | | | | | |
13998 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13999 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14000 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14001 | | | | | |
14002 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14003 address | | | | | |
14004 | overlay | <-' | | |
14005 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14006 | | <---. | | load address
14007 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14008 | | | |
14009 +-----------+ | |
14010 +-----------+
14011 | |
14012 +-----------+
14013
14014 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14015 @end group
14016 @end smallexample
14017
14018 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14019 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14020 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14021 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14022 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14023 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14024 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14025 program and the overlay area.
14026
14027 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14028 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14029 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14030 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14031 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14032 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14033 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14034
14035 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14036 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14037 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14038
14039 @itemize @bullet
14040
14041 @item
14042 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14043 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14044 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14045 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14046
14047 @item
14048 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14049 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14050 your program's performance.
14051
14052 @item
14053 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14054 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14055 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14056 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14057 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14058 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14059 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14060
14061 @item
14062 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14063 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14064 instruction and data spaces.
14065
14066 @end itemize
14067
14068 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14069 improved in many ways:
14070
14071 @itemize @bullet
14072
14073 @item
14074 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14075 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14076 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14077 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14078 area in the usual way.
14079
14080 @item
14081 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14082 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14083
14084 @item
14085 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14086 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14087 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14088 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14089 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14090 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14091 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14092
14093 @end itemize
14094
14095
14096 @node Overlay Commands
14097 @section Overlay Commands
14098
14099 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14100 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14101 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14102 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14103 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14104 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14105
14106 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14107 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14108
14109 @table @code
14110 @item overlay off
14111 @kindex overlay
14112 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14113 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14114 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14115 overlay support is disabled.
14116
14117 @item overlay manual
14118 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14119 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14120 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14121 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14122 commands described below.
14123
14124 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14125 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14126 @cindex map an overlay
14127 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14128 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14129 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14130 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14131 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14132 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14133
14134 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14135 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14136 @cindex unmap an overlay
14137 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14138 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14139 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14140 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14141
14142 @item overlay auto
14143 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14144 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14145 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14146 Overlay Debugging}.
14147
14148 @item overlay load-target
14149 @itemx overlay load
14150 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14151 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14152 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14153 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14154 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14155 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14156
14157 @item overlay list-overlays
14158 @itemx overlay list
14159 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14160 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14161 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14162
14163 @end table
14164
14165 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14166 of the function the address falls in:
14167
14168 @smallexample
14169 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14170 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14171 @end smallexample
14172 @noindent
14173 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14174 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14175 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14176 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14177
14178 @smallexample
14179 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14180 No sections are mapped.
14181 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14182 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14183 @end smallexample
14184 @noindent
14185 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14186 name normally:
14187
14188 @smallexample
14189 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14190 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14191 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14192 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14193 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14194 @end smallexample
14195
14196 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14197 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14198 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14199 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14200 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14201
14202 @itemize @bullet
14203 @item
14204 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14205 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14206 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14207 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14208 @item
14209 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14210 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14211 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14212 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14213 breakpoints properly.
14214 @end itemize
14215
14216
14217 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14218 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14219 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14220
14221 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14222 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14223 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14224 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14225 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14226 current state of the overlays.
14227
14228 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14229 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14230
14231 @table @asis
14232
14233 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14234 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14235
14236 @smallexample
14237 struct
14238 @{
14239 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14240 unsigned long vma;
14241
14242 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14243 unsigned long size;
14244
14245 /* The overlay's load address. */
14246 unsigned long lma;
14247
14248 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14249 zero otherwise. */
14250 unsigned long mapped;
14251 @}
14252 @end smallexample
14253
14254 @item @code{_novlys}:
14255 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14256 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14257
14258 @end table
14259
14260 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14261 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14262 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14263 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14264 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14265 currently mapped.
14266
14267 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14268 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14269 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14270 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14271 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14272 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14273 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14274 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14275 are not being executed.
14276
14277 @node Overlay Sample Program
14278 @section Overlay Sample Program
14279 @cindex overlay example program
14280
14281 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14282 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14283 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14284 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14285 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14286 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14287 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14288
14289 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14290 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14291 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14292 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14293
14294 @table @file
14295 @item overlays.c
14296 The main program file.
14297 @item ovlymgr.c
14298 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14299 @item foo.c
14300 @itemx bar.c
14301 @itemx baz.c
14302 @itemx grbx.c
14303 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14304 @item d10v.ld
14305 @itemx m32r.ld
14306 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14307 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14308 @end table
14309
14310 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14311 cross-compiler like this:
14312
14313 @smallexample
14314 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14315 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14316 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14317 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14318 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14319 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14320 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14321 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14322 @end smallexample
14323
14324 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14325 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14326 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14327
14328
14329 @node Languages
14330 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14331 @cindex languages
14332
14333 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14334 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14335 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14336 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14337 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14338 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14339
14340 @cindex working language
14341 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14342 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14343 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14344 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14345 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14346 language}.
14347
14348 @menu
14349 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14350 * Show:: Displaying the language
14351 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14352 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14353 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14354 @end menu
14355
14356 @node Setting
14357 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14358
14359 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14360 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14361 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14362 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14363 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14364 are printed, etc.
14365
14366 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14367 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14368 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14369 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14370 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14371 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14372 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14373 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14374 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14375 Displaying the Language}.
14376
14377 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14378 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14379 another language. In that case, make the
14380 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14381 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14382 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14383
14384 @menu
14385 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14386 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14387 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14388 @end menu
14389
14390 @node Filenames
14391 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14392
14393 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14394 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14395
14396 @table @file
14397 @item .ada
14398 @itemx .ads
14399 @itemx .adb
14400 @itemx .a
14401 Ada source file.
14402
14403 @item .c
14404 C source file
14405
14406 @item .C
14407 @itemx .cc
14408 @itemx .cp
14409 @itemx .cpp
14410 @itemx .cxx
14411 @itemx .c++
14412 C@t{++} source file
14413
14414 @item .d
14415 D source file
14416
14417 @item .m
14418 Objective-C source file
14419
14420 @item .f
14421 @itemx .F
14422 Fortran source file
14423
14424 @item .mod
14425 Modula-2 source file
14426
14427 @item .s
14428 @itemx .S
14429 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14430 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14431 @end table
14432
14433 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14434 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14435
14436 @node Manually
14437 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14438
14439 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14440 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14441 your program.
14442
14443 @kindex set language
14444 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14445 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14446 a language, such as
14447 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14448 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14449
14450 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14451 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14452 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14453 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14454 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14455 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14456 command such as:
14457
14458 @smallexample
14459 print a = b + c
14460 @end smallexample
14461
14462 @noindent
14463 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14464 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14465 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14466 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14467
14468 @node Automatically
14469 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14470
14471 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14472 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14473 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14474 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14475 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14476 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14477 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14478 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14479 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14480
14481 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14482 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14483 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14484 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14485 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14486
14487 @node Show
14488 @section Displaying the Language
14489
14490 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14491 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14492
14493 @table @code
14494 @item show language
14495 @anchor{show language}
14496 @kindex show language
14497 Display the current working language. This is the
14498 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14499 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14500
14501 @item info frame
14502 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14503 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14504 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14505 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14506 information listed here.
14507
14508 @item info source
14509 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14510 Display the source language of this source file.
14511 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14512 information listed here.
14513 @end table
14514
14515 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14516 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14517 with a language explicitly:
14518
14519 @table @code
14520 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14521 @kindex set extension-language
14522 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14523 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14524
14525 @item info extensions
14526 @kindex info extensions
14527 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14528 @end table
14529
14530 @node Checks
14531 @section Type and Range Checking
14532
14533 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14534 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14535 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14536 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14537 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14538 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14539 errors when your program is running.
14540
14541 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14542 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14543 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14544 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14545
14546 @menu
14547 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14548 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14549 @end menu
14550
14551 @cindex type checking
14552 @cindex checks, type
14553 @node Type Checking
14554 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14555
14556 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14557 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14558 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14559 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14560
14561 @smallexample
14562 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14563
14564 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14565 $1 = 2
14566 @exdent but
14567 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14568 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14572 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14573
14574 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14575 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14576 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14577 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14578 expressions like the second example above.
14579
14580 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14581 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14582 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14583 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14584 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14585 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14586
14587 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14588
14589 @kindex set check type
14590 @kindex show check type
14591 @table @code
14592 @item set check type on
14593 @itemx set check type off
14594 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14595 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14596 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14597
14598 @item show check type
14599 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14600 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14601 @end table
14602
14603 @cindex range checking
14604 @cindex checks, range
14605 @node Range Checking
14606 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14607
14608 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14609 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14610 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14611 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14612 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14613
14614 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14615 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14616 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14617 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14618
14619 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14620 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14621 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14622 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14623 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14624 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14625
14626 @smallexample
14627 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14628 @end smallexample
14629
14630 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14631 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14632 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14633
14634 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14635
14636 @kindex set check range
14637 @kindex show check range
14638 @table @code
14639 @item set check range auto
14640 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14641 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14642 each language.
14643
14644 @item set check range on
14645 @itemx set check range off
14646 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14647 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14648 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14649 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14650
14651 @item set check range warn
14652 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14653 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14654 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14655 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14656 systems).
14657
14658 @item show range
14659 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14660 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14661 @end table
14662
14663 @node Supported Languages
14664 @section Supported Languages
14665
14666 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14667 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14668 @c This is false ...
14669 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14670 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14671 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14672 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14673 language.
14674
14675 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14676 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14677 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14678 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14679 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14680 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14681 language reference or tutorial.
14682
14683 @menu
14684 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14685 * D:: D
14686 * Go:: Go
14687 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14688 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14689 * Fortran:: Fortran
14690 * Pascal:: Pascal
14691 * Rust:: Rust
14692 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14693 * Ada:: Ada
14694 @end menu
14695
14696 @node C
14697 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14698
14699 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14700 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14701
14702 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14703 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14704 together.
14705
14706 @cindex C@t{++}
14707 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14708 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14709 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14710 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14711 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14712 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14713 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14714
14715 @menu
14716 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14717 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14718 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14719 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14720 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14721 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14722 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14723 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14724 @end menu
14725
14726 @node C Operators
14727 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14728
14729 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14730
14731 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14732 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14733 often defined on groups of types.
14734
14735 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14736
14737 @itemize @bullet
14738
14739 @item
14740 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14741 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14742
14743 @item
14744 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14745 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14746
14747 @item
14748 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14749
14750 @item
14751 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14752
14753 @end itemize
14754
14755 @noindent
14756 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14757 in order of increasing precedence:
14758
14759 @table @code
14760 @item ,
14761 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14762 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14763 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14764
14765 @item =
14766 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14767 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14768
14769 @item @var{op}=
14770 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14771 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14772 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14773 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14774 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14775
14776 @item ?:
14777 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14778 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14779 should be of an integral type.
14780
14781 @item ||
14782 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14783
14784 @item &&
14785 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14786
14787 @item |
14788 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14789
14790 @item ^
14791 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14792
14793 @item &
14794 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14795
14796 @item ==@r{, }!=
14797 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14798 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14799
14800 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14801 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14802 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14803 and non-zero for true.
14804
14805 @item <<@r{, }>>
14806 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14807
14808 @item @@
14809 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14810
14811 @item +@r{, }-
14812 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14813 pointer types.
14814
14815 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14816 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14817 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14818 integral types.
14819
14820 @item ++@r{, }--
14821 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14822 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14823 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14824 operation takes place.
14825
14826 @item *
14827 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14828 @code{++}.
14829
14830 @item &
14831 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14832
14833 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14834 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14835 to examine the address
14836 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14837 stored.
14838
14839 @item -
14840 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14841 precedence as @code{++}.
14842
14843 @item !
14844 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14845 @code{++}.
14846
14847 @item ~
14848 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14849 @code{++}.
14850
14851
14852 @item .@r{, }->
14853 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14854 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14855 pointer based on the stored type information.
14856 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14857
14858 @item .*@r{, }->*
14859 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14860
14861 @item []
14862 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14863 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14864
14865 @item ()
14866 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14867
14868 @item ::
14869 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14870 and @code{class} types.
14871
14872 @item ::
14873 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14874 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14875 above.
14876 @end table
14877
14878 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14879 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14880 predefined meaning.
14881
14882 @node C Constants
14883 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14884
14885 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14886
14887 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14888 following ways:
14889
14890 @itemize @bullet
14891 @item
14892 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14893 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14894 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14895 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14896 @code{long} value.
14897
14898 @item
14899 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14900 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14901 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14902 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14903 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14904 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14905 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14906 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14907 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14908 constant.
14909
14910 @item
14911 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14912 integral equivalents.
14913
14914 @item
14915 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14916 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14917 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14918 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14919 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14920 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14921 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14922 @samp{\n} for newline.
14923
14924 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14925 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14926 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14927 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14928
14929 @item
14930 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14931 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14932 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14933 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14934 characters.
14935
14936 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14937 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14938 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14939
14940 @item
14941 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14942 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14943
14944 @item
14945 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14946 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14947 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14948 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14949 @end itemize
14950
14951 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14952 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14953
14954 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14955 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14956
14957 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14958 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14959 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14960 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14961 @quotation
14962 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14963 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14964 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14965 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14966 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14967 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14968 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14969 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14970 @end quotation
14971
14972 @enumerate
14973
14974 @cindex member functions
14975 @item
14976 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14977
14978 @smallexample
14979 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14980 @end smallexample
14981
14982 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14983 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14984 @item
14985 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14986 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14987 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14988 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14989 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14990
14991 @cindex call overloaded functions
14992 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14993 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14994 @item
14995 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14996 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14997 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14998 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14999 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15000 default arguments.
15001
15002 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15003 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15004 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15005 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15006 number of function arguments.
15007
15008 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15009 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15010 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15011
15012 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15013 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15014 @smallexample
15015 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15016 @end smallexample
15017
15018 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15019 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15020
15021 @cindex reference declarations
15022 @item
15023 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15024 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15025 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15026
15027 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15028 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15029 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15030 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15031 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15032
15033 @item
15034 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15035 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15036 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15037 necessary, for example in an expression like
15038 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15039 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15040 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15041
15042 @item
15043 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15044 specification.
15045 @end enumerate
15046
15047 @node C Defaults
15048 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15049
15050 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15051
15052 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15053 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15054 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15055 selects the working language.
15056
15057 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15058 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15059 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15060 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15061 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15062 for further details.
15063
15064 @node C Checks
15065 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15066
15067 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15068
15069 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15070 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15071 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15072 constants to pointers.
15073
15074 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15075 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15076 that is not itself an array.
15077
15078 @node Debugging C
15079 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15080
15081 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15082 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15083 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15084 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15085
15086 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15087 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15088 ,Expressions}.
15089
15090 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15091 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15092
15093 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15094
15095 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15096 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15097
15098 @table @code
15099 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15100 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15101 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15102 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15103 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15104 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15105
15106 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15107 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15108 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15109 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15110 classes.
15111 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15112
15113 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15114 @item catch throw
15115 @itemx catch rethrow
15116 @itemx catch catch
15117 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15118 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15119
15120 @cindex inheritance
15121 @item ptype @var{typename}
15122 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15123 @var{typename}.
15124 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15125
15126 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15127 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15128 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15129 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15130 multiple inheritance is in use.
15131
15132 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15133 @item demangle @var{name}
15134 Demangle @var{name}.
15135 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15136
15137 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15138 @item set print demangle
15139 @itemx show print demangle
15140 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15141 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15142 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15143 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15144 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15145
15146 @item set print object
15147 @itemx show print object
15148 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15149 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15150
15151 @item set print vtbl
15152 @itemx show print vtbl
15153 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15154 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15155 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15156 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15157
15158 @kindex set overload-resolution
15159 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15160 @item set overload-resolution on
15161 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15162 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15163 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15164 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15165 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15166 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15167
15168 @item set overload-resolution off
15169 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15170 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15171 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15172 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15173 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15174 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15175 argument types.
15176
15177 @kindex show overload-resolution
15178 @item show overload-resolution
15179 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15180
15181 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15182 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15183 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15184 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15185 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15186 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15187 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15188
15189 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15190
15191 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15192 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15193 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15194 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15195 for more detail.
15196
15197 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15198 function that returns a std::string:
15199
15200 @smallexample
15201 std::string function(int);
15202 @end smallexample
15203
15204 @noindent
15205 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15206 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15207
15208 @smallexample
15209 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15210 @end smallexample
15211
15212 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15213 tag. For example:
15214
15215 @smallexample
15216 (gdb) b function(int)
15217 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15218 (gdb) info breakpoints
15219 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15220 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15221 at main.cc:10
15222 @end smallexample
15223
15224 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15225 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15226 name, like:
15227
15228 @smallexample
15229 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15230 @end smallexample
15231 @end table
15232
15233 @node Decimal Floating Point
15234 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15235 @cindex decimal floating point format
15236
15237 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15238 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15239 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15240 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15241
15242 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15243 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15244 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15245 configured target.
15246
15247 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15248 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15249 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15250
15251 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15252 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15253 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15254
15255 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15256 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15257 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15258
15259 @node D
15260 @subsection D
15261
15262 @cindex D
15263 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15264 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15265 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15266
15267 @node Go
15268 @subsection Go
15269
15270 @cindex Go (programming language)
15271 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15272 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15273
15274 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15275
15276 @table @code
15277 @cindex current Go package
15278 @item The current Go package
15279 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15280 specifying global variables and functions.
15281
15282 For example, given the program:
15283
15284 @example
15285 package main
15286 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15287 func main () @{
15288 // ...
15289 @}
15290 @end example
15291
15292 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15293
15294 @example
15295 (gdb) p myglob
15296 (gdb) p main.myglob
15297 @end example
15298
15299 @cindex builtin Go types
15300 @item Builtin Go types
15301 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15302 as a string.
15303
15304 @cindex builtin Go functions
15305 @item Builtin Go functions
15306 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15307 function and handles it internally.
15308
15309 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15310 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15311 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15312 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15313 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15314 @end table
15315
15316 @node Objective-C
15317 @subsection Objective-C
15318
15319 @cindex Objective-C
15320 This section provides information about some commands and command
15321 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15322 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15323 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15324
15325 @menu
15326 * Method Names in Commands::
15327 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15328 @end menu
15329
15330 @node Method Names in Commands
15331 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15332
15333 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15334 names as line specifications:
15335
15336 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15337 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15338 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15339 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15340 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15341 @itemize
15342 @item @code{clear}
15343 @item @code{break}
15344 @item @code{info line}
15345 @item @code{jump}
15346 @item @code{list}
15347 @end itemize
15348
15349 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15350
15351 @smallexample
15352 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15353 @end smallexample
15354
15355 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15356 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15357 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15358 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15359 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15360 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15361 debugged, enter:
15362
15363 @smallexample
15364 break -[Fruit create]
15365 @end smallexample
15366
15367 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15368 enter:
15369
15370 @smallexample
15371 list +[NSText initialize]
15372 @end smallexample
15373
15374 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15375 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15376 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15377 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15378
15379 @smallexample
15380 break create
15381 @end smallexample
15382
15383 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15384 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15385 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15386 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15387 none apply.
15388
15389 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15390 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15391
15392 @smallexample
15393 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15394 @end smallexample
15395
15396 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15397 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15398 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15399 @kindex print-object
15400 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15401
15402 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15403
15404 @smallexample
15405 print -[@var{object} hash]
15406 @end smallexample
15407
15408 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15409 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15410 @noindent
15411 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15412 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15413 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15414 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15415 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15416 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15417
15418 @node OpenCL C
15419 @subsection OpenCL C
15420
15421 @cindex OpenCL C
15422 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15423
15424 @menu
15425 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15426 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15427 * OpenCL C Operators::
15428 @end menu
15429
15430 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15431 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15432
15433 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15434 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15435 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15436 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15437 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15438
15439 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15440 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15441
15442 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15443 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15444 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15445 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15446
15447 @node OpenCL C Operators
15448 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15449
15450 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15451 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15452 vector data types.
15453
15454 @node Fortran
15455 @subsection Fortran
15456 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15457
15458 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15459 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15460
15461 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15462 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15463 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15464 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15465 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15466 underscore.
15467
15468 @menu
15469 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15470 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15471 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15472 @end menu
15473
15474 @node Fortran Operators
15475 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15476
15477 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15478
15479 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15480 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15481 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15482
15483 @table @code
15484 @item **
15485 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15486 of the second one.
15487
15488 @item :
15489 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15490 represent a section of array.
15491
15492 @item %
15493 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15494 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15495 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15496 union type.
15497 @end table
15498
15499 @node Fortran Defaults
15500 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15501
15502 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15503
15504 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15505 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15506 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15507 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15508
15509 @node Special Fortran Commands
15510 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15511
15512 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15513
15514 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15515 such as displaying common blocks.
15516
15517 @table @code
15518 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15519 @kindex info common
15520 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15521 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15522 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15523 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15524 printed.
15525 @end table
15526
15527 @node Pascal
15528 @subsection Pascal
15529
15530 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15531 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15532 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15533 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15534 syntax.
15535
15536 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15537 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15538 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15539
15540 @node Rust
15541 @subsection Rust
15542
15543 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15544 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15545 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15546 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15547
15548 @itemize @bullet
15549 @item
15550 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15551 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15552 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15553
15554 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15555 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15556 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15557 @samp{B}.
15558
15559 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15560 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15561
15562 @item
15563 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15564 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15565 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15566 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15567 @samp{K::x::y}.
15568
15569 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15570 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15571 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15572 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15573 scope.
15574
15575 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15576 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15577
15578 @item
15579 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15580 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15581
15582 @item
15583 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15584
15585 @item
15586 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15587 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15588 never be destroyed.
15589
15590 @item
15591 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15592 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15593 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15594
15595 @item
15596 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15597 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15598 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15599 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15600 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15601 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15602 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15603 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15604
15605 @item
15606 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15607 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15608 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15609 @itemize @bullet
15610
15611 @item
15612 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15613
15614 @item
15615 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15616
15617 @item
15618 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15619 type names.
15620
15621 @item
15622 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15623
15624 @item
15625 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15626 available in the crate.
15627 @end itemize
15628 @end itemize
15629
15630 @node Modula-2
15631 @subsection Modula-2
15632
15633 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15634
15635 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15636 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15637 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15638 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15639 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15640 table.
15641
15642 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15643 @menu
15644 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15645 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15646 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15647 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15648 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15649 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15650 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15651 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15652 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15653 @end menu
15654
15655 @node M2 Operators
15656 @subsubsection Operators
15657 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15658
15659 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15660 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15661 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15662 following definitions hold:
15663
15664 @itemize @bullet
15665
15666 @item
15667 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15668 their subranges.
15669
15670 @item
15671 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15672
15673 @item
15674 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15675
15676 @item
15677 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15678 @var{type}}.
15679
15680 @item
15681 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15682
15683 @item
15684 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15685
15686 @item
15687 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15688 @end itemize
15689
15690 @noindent
15691 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15692 increasing precedence:
15693
15694 @table @code
15695 @item ,
15696 Function argument or array index separator.
15697
15698 @item :=
15699 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15700 @var{value}.
15701
15702 @item <@r{, }>
15703 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15704 types.
15705
15706 @item <=@r{, }>=
15707 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15708 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15709 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15710
15711 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15712 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15713 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15714 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15715 comment character.
15716
15717 @item IN
15718 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15719 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15720
15721 @item OR
15722 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15723
15724 @item AND@r{, }&
15725 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15726
15727 @item @@
15728 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15729
15730 @item +@r{, }-
15731 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15732 and difference on set types.
15733
15734 @item *
15735 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15736 on set types.
15737
15738 @item /
15739 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15740 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15741
15742 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
15743 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
15744 precedence as @code{*}.
15745
15746 @item -
15747 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
15748
15749 @item ^
15750 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
15751
15752 @item NOT
15753 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
15754 @code{^}.
15755
15756 @item .
15757 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
15758 precedence as @code{^}.
15759
15760 @item []
15761 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
15762
15763 @item ()
15764 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
15765 as @code{^}.
15766
15767 @item ::@r{, }.
15768 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
15769 @end table
15770
15771 @quotation
15772 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
15773 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
15774 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
15775 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
15776 @end quotation
15777
15778
15779 @node Built-In Func/Proc
15780 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
15781 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
15782
15783 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
15784 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
15785
15786 @table @var
15787
15788 @item a
15789 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
15790
15791 @item c
15792 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
15793
15794 @item i
15795 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
15796
15797 @item m
15798 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
15799 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
15800 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
15801
15802 @item n
15803 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
15804
15805 @item r
15806 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
15807
15808 @item t
15809 represents a type.
15810
15811 @item v
15812 represents a variable.
15813
15814 @item x
15815 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
15816 explanation of the function for details.
15817 @end table
15818
15819 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
15820
15821 @table @code
15822 @item ABS(@var{n})
15823 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
15824
15825 @item CAP(@var{c})
15826 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
15827 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
15828
15829 @item CHR(@var{i})
15830 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15831
15832 @item DEC(@var{v})
15833 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15834
15835 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
15836 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15837 new value.
15838
15839 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15840 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
15841 set.
15842
15843 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
15844 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
15845
15846 @item HIGH(@var{a})
15847 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
15848
15849 @item INC(@var{v})
15850 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
15851
15852 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
15853 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
15854 new value.
15855
15856 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
15857 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
15858 there. Returns the new set.
15859
15860 @item MAX(@var{t})
15861 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
15862
15863 @item MIN(@var{t})
15864 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
15865
15866 @item ODD(@var{i})
15867 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
15868
15869 @item ORD(@var{x})
15870 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
15871 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
15872 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
15873 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15874
15875 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15876 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15877 variable or a type.
15878
15879 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15880 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15881
15882 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15883 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15884 variable or a type.
15885
15886 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15887 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15888 @end table
15889
15890 @quotation
15891 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15892 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15893 an error.
15894 @end quotation
15895
15896 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15897 @node M2 Constants
15898 @subsubsection Constants
15899
15900 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15901 ways:
15902
15903 @itemize @bullet
15904
15905 @item
15906 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15907 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15908 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15909 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15910
15911 @item
15912 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15913 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15914 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15915 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15916 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15917 digits.
15918
15919 @item
15920 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15921 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15922 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15923 followed by a @samp{C}.
15924
15925 @item
15926 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15927 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15928 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15929 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15930 sequences.
15931
15932 @item
15933 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15934
15935 @item
15936 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15937 @code{FALSE}.
15938
15939 @item
15940 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15941
15942 @item
15943 Set constants are not yet supported.
15944 @end itemize
15945
15946 @node M2 Types
15947 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15948 @cindex Modula-2 types
15949
15950 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15951 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15952 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15953 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15954 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15955 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15956
15957 The first example contains the following section of code:
15958
15959 @smallexample
15960 VAR
15961 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15962 r: [20..40] ;
15963 @end smallexample
15964
15965 @noindent
15966 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15967 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15968
15969 @smallexample
15970 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15971 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15972 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15973 SET OF CHAR
15974 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15975 21
15976 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15977 [20..40]
15978 @end smallexample
15979
15980 @noindent
15981 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15982
15983 @smallexample
15984 VAR
15985 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15986 @end smallexample
15987
15988 @noindent
15989 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15990
15991 @smallexample
15992 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15993 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15994 @end smallexample
15995
15996 @noindent
15997 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15998 expressions using the debugger.
15999
16000 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16001 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16002
16003 @smallexample
16004 VAR
16005 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16006 @end smallexample
16007
16008 @smallexample
16009 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16010 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16011 @end smallexample
16012
16013 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16014 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16015 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16016 above.
16017
16018 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16019
16020 @smallexample
16021 TYPE
16022 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16023 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16024 VAR
16025 s: t ;
16026 BEGIN
16027 s := blue ;
16028 @end smallexample
16029
16030 @noindent
16031 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16032 and value of a variable.
16033
16034 @smallexample
16035 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16036 $1 = blue
16037 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16038 type = [blue..yellow]
16039 @end smallexample
16040
16041 @noindent
16042 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16043 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16044 their @code{C} counterparts.
16045
16046 @smallexample
16047 VAR
16048 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16049 BEGIN
16050 s[1] := 1 ;
16051 @end smallexample
16052
16053 @smallexample
16054 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16055 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16056 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16057 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16058 @end smallexample
16059
16060 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16061 pointer types as shown in this example:
16062
16063 @smallexample
16064 VAR
16065 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16066 BEGIN
16067 NEW(s) ;
16068 s^[1] := 1 ;
16069 @end smallexample
16070
16071 @noindent
16072 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16073
16074 @smallexample
16075 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16076 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16077 @end smallexample
16078
16079 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16080 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16081 types:
16082
16083 @smallexample
16084 TYPE
16085 foo = RECORD
16086 f1: CARDINAL ;
16087 f2: CHAR ;
16088 f3: myarray ;
16089 END ;
16090
16091 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16092 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16093 VAR
16094 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16095 @end smallexample
16096
16097 @noindent
16098 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16099 below.
16100
16101 @smallexample
16102 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16103 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16104 f1 : CARDINAL;
16105 f2 : CHAR;
16106 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16107 END
16108 @end smallexample
16109
16110 @node M2 Defaults
16111 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16112 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16113
16114 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16115 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16116 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16117 selected the working language.
16118
16119 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16120 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16121 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16122 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16123
16124 @node Deviations
16125 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16126 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16127
16128 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16129 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16130
16131 @itemize @bullet
16132 @item
16133 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16134 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16135 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16136 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16137 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16138 returned a pointer.)
16139
16140 @item
16141 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16142 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16143 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16144 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16145
16146 @item
16147 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16148 argument.
16149
16150 @item
16151 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16152 @end itemize
16153
16154 @node M2 Checks
16155 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16156 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16157
16158 @quotation
16159 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16160 range checking.
16161 @end quotation
16162 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16163
16164 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16165
16166 @itemize @bullet
16167 @item
16168 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16169 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16170
16171 @item
16172 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16173 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16174 @end itemize
16175
16176 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16177 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16178
16179 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16180 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16181
16182 @node M2 Scope
16183 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16184 @cindex scope
16185 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16186 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16187 @ifinfo
16188 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16189 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16190 @end ifinfo
16191 @ifnotinfo
16192 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16193 @end ifnotinfo
16194
16195 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16196 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16197 similar syntax:
16198
16199 @smallexample
16200
16201 @var{module} . @var{id}
16202 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16203 @end smallexample
16204
16205 @noindent
16206 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16207 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16208 identifier within your program, except another module.
16209
16210 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16211 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16212 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16213 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16214
16215 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16216 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16217 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16218 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16219 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16220 @var{module}.
16221
16222 @node GDB/M2
16223 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16224
16225 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16226 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16227 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16228 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16229 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16230 analogue in Modula-2.
16231
16232 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16233 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16234 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16235 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16236 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16237 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16238
16239 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16240 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16241 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16242
16243 @node Ada
16244 @subsection Ada
16245 @cindex Ada
16246
16247 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16248 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16249 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16250 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16251 to be difficult.
16252
16253
16254 @cindex expressions in Ada
16255 @menu
16256 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16257 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16258 in @value{GDBN}.
16259 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16260 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16261 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16262 subprograms.
16263 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16264 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16265 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16266 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16267 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16268 Profile
16269 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16270 @end menu
16271
16272 @node Ada Mode Intro
16273 @subsubsection Introduction
16274 @cindex Ada mode, general
16275
16276 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16277 syntax, with some extensions.
16278 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16279
16280 @itemize @bullet
16281 @item
16282 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16283 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16284 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16285 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16286
16287 @item
16288 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16289 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16290
16291 @item
16292 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16293 @end itemize
16294
16295 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16296 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16297 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16298 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16299 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16300
16301 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16302 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16303 was translated from an Ada source file.
16304
16305 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16306 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16307 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16308 middle (to allow based literals).
16309
16310 @node Omissions from Ada
16311 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16312 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16313
16314 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16315
16316 @itemize @bullet
16317 @item
16318 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16319
16320 @itemize @minus
16321 @item
16322 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16323 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16324
16325 @item
16326 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16327
16328 @item
16329 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16330
16331 @item
16332 @t{'Tag}.
16333
16334 @item
16335 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16336 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16337
16338 @item
16339 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16340 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16341
16342 @item
16343 @t{'Address}.
16344 @end itemize
16345
16346 @item
16347 The names in
16348 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16349 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16350 not currently available.
16351
16352 @item
16353 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16354 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16355 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16356 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16357 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16358 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16359 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16360 indeterminate values.
16361
16362 @item
16363 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16364 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16365 are not implemented.
16366
16367 @item
16368 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16369 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16370 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16371 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16372 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16373
16374 @smallexample
16375 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16376 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16377 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16378 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16379 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16380 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16381 @end smallexample
16382
16383 Changing a
16384 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16385 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16386 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16387 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16388 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16389 declared to have a type such as:
16390
16391 @smallexample
16392 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16393 Id : Integer;
16394 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16395 end record;
16396 @end smallexample
16397
16398 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16399 assignments:
16400
16401 @smallexample
16402 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16403 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16404 @end smallexample
16405
16406 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16407 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16408 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16409 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16410 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16411 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16412 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16413 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16414
16415 @item
16416 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16417
16418 @item
16419 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16420 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16421 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16422 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16423 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16424 the proper resolution.
16425
16426 @item
16427 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16428
16429 @item
16430 Entry calls are not implemented.
16431
16432 @item
16433 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16434 formats are not supported.
16435
16436 @item
16437 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16438
16439 @item
16440 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16441 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16442 context.
16443 Should your program
16444 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16445 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16446 @end itemize
16447
16448 @node Additions to Ada
16449 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16450 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16451
16452 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16453 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16454
16455 @itemize @bullet
16456 @item
16457 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16458 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16459 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16460 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16461 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16462 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16463 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16464 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16465
16466 @item
16467 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16468 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16469 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16470
16471 @item
16472 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16473 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16474
16475 @item
16476 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16477 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16478 @end itemize
16479
16480 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16481 additions specific to Ada:
16482
16483 @itemize @bullet
16484 @item
16485 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16486 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16487
16488 @smallexample
16489 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16490 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16491 @end smallexample
16492
16493 @item
16494 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16495 the value of its right-hand operand.
16496 This allows, for example,
16497 complex conditional breaks:
16498
16499 @smallexample
16500 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16501 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16502 @end smallexample
16503
16504 @item
16505 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16506 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16507 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16508 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16509 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16510 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16511 in strings. For example,
16512 @smallexample
16513 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16514 @end smallexample
16515 @noindent
16516 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16517 after each period.
16518
16519 @item
16520 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16521 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16522 to write
16523
16524 @smallexample
16525 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16526 @end smallexample
16527
16528 @item
16529 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16530 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16531 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16532 of 3 might print as
16533
16534 @smallexample
16535 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16536 @end smallexample
16537
16538 @noindent
16539 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16540 clause.
16541
16542 @item
16543 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16544 multi-character subsequence of
16545 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16546 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16547 in place of @t{a'length}.
16548
16549 @item
16550 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16551 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16552 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16553 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16554 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16555 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16556 For example,
16557 @smallexample
16558 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16559 @end smallexample
16560
16561 @item
16562 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16563 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16564 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16565 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16566 object.
16567
16568 @end itemize
16569
16570 @node Overloading support for Ada
16571 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16572 @cindex overloading, Ada
16573
16574 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16575 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16576 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16577 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16578 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16579 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16580
16581 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16582 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16583 use, for instance:
16584
16585 @smallexample
16586 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16587 Multiple matches for f
16588 [0] cancel
16589 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16590 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16591 >
16592 @end smallexample
16593
16594 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16595 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16596 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16597
16598 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16599 case:
16600
16601 @table @code
16602
16603 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16604 @item set ada print-signatures
16605 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16606 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16607 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16608
16609 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16610 @item show ada print-signatures
16611 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16612 overloads selection menu.
16613 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16614
16615 @end table
16616
16617 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16618 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16619
16620 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16621 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16622 before reaching the main procedure.
16623 As defined in the Ada Reference
16624 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16625 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16626 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16627 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16628
16629 @node Ada Exceptions
16630 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16631
16632 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16633
16634 @table @code
16635 @kindex info exceptions
16636 @item info exceptions
16637 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16638 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16639 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16640 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16641 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16642 @end table
16643
16644 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16645 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16646 argument.
16647
16648 @smallexample
16649 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16650 All defined Ada exceptions:
16651 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16652 program_error: 0x613d20
16653 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16654 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16655 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16656 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16657 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16658 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16659 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16660 @end smallexample
16661
16662 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16663 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16664
16665 @node Ada Tasks
16666 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16667 @cindex Ada, tasking
16668
16669 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16670 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16671
16672 @table @code
16673 @kindex info tasks
16674 @item info tasks
16675 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16676
16677
16678 @smallexample
16679 @iftex
16680 @leftskip=0.5cm
16681 @end iftex
16682 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16683 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16684 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16685 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16686 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16687 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16688
16689 @end smallexample
16690
16691 @noindent
16692 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16693 task currently being inspected.
16694
16695 @table @asis
16696 @item ID
16697 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16698
16699 @item TID
16700 The Ada task ID.
16701
16702 @item P-ID
16703 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16704
16705 @item Pri
16706 The base priority of the task.
16707
16708 @item State
16709 Current state of the task.
16710
16711 @table @code
16712 @item Unactivated
16713 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16714 executing.
16715
16716 @item Runnable
16717 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16718 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16719
16720 @item Terminated
16721 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16722 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16723 terminated themselves.
16724
16725 @item Child Activation Wait
16726 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16727
16728 @item Accept Statement
16729 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16730
16731 @item Waiting on entry call
16732 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16733
16734 @item Async Select Wait
16735 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16736 select statement.
16737
16738 @item Delay Sleep
16739 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16740 alternative open.
16741
16742 @item Child Termination Wait
16743 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
16744 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
16745 waiting on a terminate Phase.
16746
16747 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
16748 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
16749 finish terminating.
16750
16751 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
16752 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
16753 @end table
16754
16755 @item Name
16756 Name of the task in the program.
16757
16758 @end table
16759
16760 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
16761 @item info task @var{taskno}
16762 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
16763 the following example:
16764 @smallexample
16765 @iftex
16766 @leftskip=0.5cm
16767 @end iftex
16768 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16769 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16770 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16771 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
16772 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
16773 Ada Task: 0x807c468
16774 Name: task_1
16775 Thread: 0x807f378
16776 Parent: 1 (main_task)
16777 Base Priority: 15
16778 State: Runnable
16779 @end smallexample
16780
16781 @item task
16782 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
16783 @cindex current Ada task ID
16784 This command prints the ID of the current task.
16785
16786 @smallexample
16787 @iftex
16788 @leftskip=0.5cm
16789 @end iftex
16790 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16791 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16792 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16793 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16794 (@value{GDBP}) task
16795 [Current task is 2]
16796 @end smallexample
16797
16798 @item task @var{taskno}
16799 @cindex Ada task switching
16800 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
16801 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
16802 from the current task to the given task.
16803
16804 @smallexample
16805 @iftex
16806 @leftskip=0.5cm
16807 @end iftex
16808 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16809 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16810 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16811 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
16812 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
16813 [Switching to task 1]
16814 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16815 (@value{GDBP}) bt
16816 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
16817 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
16818 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
16819 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
16820 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
16821 @end smallexample
16822
16823 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
16824 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
16825 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
16826 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
16827 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
16828 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
16829 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
16830 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
16831 in @ref{Specify Location}.
16832
16833 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
16834 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
16835 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
16836 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
16837 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
16838
16839 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
16840 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
16841 program.
16842
16843 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
16844 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
16845 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
16846
16847 For example,
16848
16849 @smallexample
16850 @iftex
16851 @leftskip=0.5cm
16852 @end iftex
16853 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16854 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16855 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16856 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
16857 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16858 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
16859 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
16860 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
16861 (@value{GDBP}) cont
16862 Continuing.
16863 task # 1 running
16864 task # 2 running
16865
16866 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
16867 15 flush;
16868 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16869 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16870 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16871 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
16872 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
16873 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
16874 @end smallexample
16875 @end table
16876
16877 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
16878 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16879 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
16880
16881 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
16882 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
16883 the platform being used.
16884 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
16885 switching is not supported.
16886
16887 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
16888 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
16889 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
16890 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
16891 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
16892 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
16893
16894 @node Ravenscar Profile
16895 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
16896 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
16897
16898 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
16899 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
16900 requirements.
16901
16902 @table @code
16903 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
16904 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
16905 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
16906 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16907 Profile. This is the default.
16908
16909 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
16910 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
16911 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
16912 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
16913 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
16914 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
16915 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16916
16917 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16918 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16919 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16920 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16921
16922 @end table
16923
16924 @node Ada Glitches
16925 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16926 @cindex Ada, problems
16927
16928 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16929 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16930 @value{GDBN},
16931 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16932 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16933
16934 @itemize @bullet
16935 @item
16936 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16937 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16938
16939 @item
16940 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16941 argument lists are treated as positional).
16942
16943 @item
16944 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16945
16946 @item
16947 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16948 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16949 the host machine.
16950
16951 @item
16952 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16953 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16954 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16955 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16956 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16957 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16958 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16959 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16960 you can usually resolve the confusion
16961 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16962 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16963 @end itemize
16964
16965 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16966 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16967 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16968 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16969 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16970 enabled.
16971
16972 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16973 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16974 @table @code
16975
16976 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16977 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16978 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16979 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16980 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16981 This is the default.
16982
16983 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16984 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16985 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16986 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16987 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16988 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16989 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16990
16991 @end table
16992
16993 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16994 @cindex GNAT encoding
16995 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16996 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16997 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16998 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16999 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17000 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17001
17002 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17003 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17004 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17005 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17006 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17007 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17008 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17009 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17010
17011 @table @code
17012
17013 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17014 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17015 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17016 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17017
17018 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17019 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17020 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17021
17022 @end table
17023
17024 @node Unsupported Languages
17025 @section Unsupported Languages
17026
17027 @cindex unsupported languages
17028 @cindex minimal language
17029 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17030 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17031 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17032 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17033 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17034 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17035
17036 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17037 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17038 language.
17039
17040 @node Symbols
17041 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17042
17043 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17044 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17045 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17046 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17047 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17048 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17049 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17050
17051 @cindex symbol names
17052 @cindex names of symbols
17053 @cindex quoting names
17054 @anchor{quoting names}
17055 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17056 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17057 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17058 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17059 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17060 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17061 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17062 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17063
17064 @smallexample
17065 p 'foo.c'::x
17066 @end smallexample
17067
17068 @noindent
17069 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17070
17071 @table @code
17072 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17073 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17074 @kindex set case-sensitive
17075 @item set case-sensitive on
17076 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17077 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17078 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17079 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17080 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17081 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17082 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17083 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17084 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17085 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17086 case-insensitive matches.
17087
17088 @kindex show case-sensitive
17089 @item show case-sensitive
17090 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17091 lookups.
17092
17093 @kindex set print type methods
17094 @item set print type methods
17095 @itemx set print type methods on
17096 @itemx set print type methods off
17097 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17098 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17099 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17100 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17101 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17102 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17103
17104 @kindex show print type methods
17105 @item show print type methods
17106 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17107 classes.
17108
17109 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17110 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17111 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17112 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17113 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17114 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17115 types defined in classes.
17116
17117 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17118 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17119 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17120 printing classes.
17121
17122 @kindex set print type typedefs
17123 @item set print type typedefs
17124 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17125 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17126
17127 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17128 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17129 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17130 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17131 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17132 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17133 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17134 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17135 types.
17136
17137 @kindex show print type typedefs
17138 @item show print type typedefs
17139 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17140 printing classes.
17141
17142 @kindex info address
17143 @cindex address of a symbol
17144 @item info address @var{symbol}
17145 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17146 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17147 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17148 is always stored.
17149
17150 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17151 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17152 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17153
17154 @kindex info symbol
17155 @cindex symbol from address
17156 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17157 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17158 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17159 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17160 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17161
17162 @smallexample
17163 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17164 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17165 @end smallexample
17166
17167 @noindent
17168 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17169 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17170
17171 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17172 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17173
17174 @smallexample
17175 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17176 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17177 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17178 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17179 @end smallexample
17180
17181 @kindex demangle
17182 @cindex demangle
17183 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17184 Demangle @var{name}.
17185 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17186 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17187
17188 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17189 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17190
17191 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17192 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17193
17194 @kindex whatis
17195 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17196 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17197 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17198 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17199
17200 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17201 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17202 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17203
17204 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17205 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17206 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17207 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17208 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17209 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17210 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17211 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17212 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17213
17214 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17215 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17216 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17217 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17218 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17219 unroll it.
17220
17221 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17222 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17223 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17224
17225 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17226 Available flags are:
17227
17228 @table @code
17229 @item r
17230 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17231 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17232 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17233
17234 @item m
17235 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17236
17237 @item M
17238 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17239 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17240
17241 @item t
17242 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17243 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17244 names are substituted when printing other types.
17245
17246 @item T
17247 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17248 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17249
17250 @item o
17251 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17252 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17253
17254 For example, given the following declarations:
17255
17256 @smallexample
17257 struct tuv
17258 @{
17259 int a1;
17260 char *a2;
17261 int a3;
17262 @};
17263
17264 struct xyz
17265 @{
17266 int f1;
17267 char f2;
17268 void *f3;
17269 struct tuv f4;
17270 @};
17271
17272 union qwe
17273 @{
17274 struct tuv fff1;
17275 struct xyz fff2;
17276 @};
17277
17278 struct tyu
17279 @{
17280 int a1 : 1;
17281 int a2 : 3;
17282 int a3 : 23;
17283 char a4 : 2;
17284 int64_t a5;
17285 int a6 : 5;
17286 int64_t a7 : 3;
17287 @};
17288 @end smallexample
17289
17290 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17291
17292 @smallexample
17293 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17294 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17295 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17296 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17297 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17298 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17299
17300 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17301 @}
17302 @end smallexample
17303
17304 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17305 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17306 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17307 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17308 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17309 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17310 its fields.
17311
17312 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17313
17314 @smallexample
17315 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17316 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17317 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17318 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17319 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17320 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17321 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17322
17323 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17324 @} fff1;
17325 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17326 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17327 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17328 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17329 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17330 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17331 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17332 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17333 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17334 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17335
17336 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17337 @} f4;
17338
17339 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17340 @} fff2;
17341
17342 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17343 @}
17344 @end smallexample
17345
17346 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17347 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17348 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17349 of these structures' fields.
17350
17351 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17352 bitfields:
17353
17354 @smallexample
17355 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17356 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17357 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17358 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17359 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17360 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17361 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17362 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17363 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17364 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17365 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17366
17367 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17368 @}
17369 @end smallexample
17370
17371 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17372 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17373 @end table
17374
17375 @kindex ptype
17376 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17377 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17378 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17379 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17380
17381 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17382 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17383 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17384 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17385 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17386 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17387 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17388 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17389
17390 For example, for this variable declaration:
17391
17392 @smallexample
17393 typedef double real_t;
17394 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17395 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17396 complex_t var;
17397 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17398 @end smallexample
17399
17400 @noindent
17401 the two commands give this output:
17402
17403 @smallexample
17404 @group
17405 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17406 type = complex_t
17407 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17408 type = struct complex @{
17409 real_t real;
17410 double imag;
17411 @}
17412 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17413 type = struct complex
17414 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17415 type = struct complex
17416 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17417 type = struct complex @{
17418 real_t real;
17419 double imag;
17420 @}
17421 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17422 type = real_t *
17423 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17424 type = double *
17425 @end group
17426 @end smallexample
17427
17428 @noindent
17429 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17430 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17431
17432 @cindex incomplete type
17433 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17434 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17435 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17436 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17437 given these declarations:
17438
17439 @smallexample
17440 struct foo;
17441 struct foo *fooptr;
17442 @end smallexample
17443
17444 @noindent
17445 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17446
17447 @smallexample
17448 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17449 $1 = <incomplete type>
17450 @end smallexample
17451
17452 @noindent
17453 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17454 completely specified.
17455
17456 @cindex unknown type
17457 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17458 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17459 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17460 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17461 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17462 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17463 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17464 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17465
17466 @smallexample
17467 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17468 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17469 @end smallexample
17470
17471 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17472 of such variables.
17473
17474 @kindex info types
17475 @item info types @var{regexp}
17476 @itemx info types
17477 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17478 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17479 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17480 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17481 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17482 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17483 name is @code{value}.
17484
17485 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17486 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17487 lists all source files where a type is defined.
17488
17489 @kindex info type-printers
17490 @item info type-printers
17491 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17492 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17493 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17494 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17495 type printers.
17496
17497 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17498
17499 @kindex enable type-printer
17500 @kindex disable type-printer
17501 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17502 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17503 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17504
17505 @kindex info scope
17506 @cindex local variables
17507 @item info scope @var{location}
17508 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17509 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17510 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17511 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17512 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17513
17514 @smallexample
17515 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17516 Scope for command_line_handler:
17517 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17518 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17519 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17520 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17521 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17522 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17523 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17524 @end smallexample
17525
17526 @noindent
17527 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17528 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17529 collect}.
17530
17531 @kindex info source
17532 @item info source
17533 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17534 the function containing the current point of execution:
17535 @itemize @bullet
17536 @item
17537 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17538 @item
17539 the directory it was compiled in,
17540 @item
17541 its length, in lines,
17542 @item
17543 which programming language it is written in,
17544 @item
17545 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17546 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17547 @item
17548 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17549 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17550 @item
17551 whether the debugging information includes information about
17552 preprocessor macros.
17553 @end itemize
17554
17555
17556 @kindex info sources
17557 @item info sources
17558 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17559 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17560 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17561
17562 @kindex info functions
17563 @item info functions
17564 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17565
17566 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17567 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
17568 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
17569 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
17570 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17571 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
17572 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17573 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17574
17575 @kindex info variables
17576 @item info variables
17577 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17578 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17579
17580 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17581 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
17582 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
17583 @var{regexp}.
17584
17585 @kindex info classes
17586 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17587 @item info classes
17588 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17589 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17590 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17591 expression.
17592
17593 @kindex info selectors
17594 @item info selectors
17595 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17596 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17597 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17598 expression.
17599
17600 @ignore
17601 This was never implemented.
17602 @kindex info methods
17603 @item info methods
17604 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17605 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17606 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17607 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17608 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17609 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17610 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17611 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17612 @end ignore
17613
17614 @cindex opaque data types
17615 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17616 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17617 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17618 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17619 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17620 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17621 another source file. The default is on.
17622
17623 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17624 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17625
17626 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17627 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17628 is printed as follows:
17629 @smallexample
17630 @{<no data fields>@}
17631 @end smallexample
17632
17633 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17634 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17635 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17636
17637 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17638 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17639 @item set print symbol-loading
17640 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17641 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17642 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17643 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17644 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17645 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17646 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17647 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17648 can be annoying.
17649 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17650 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17651 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17652 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17653
17654 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17655 @item show print symbol-loading
17656 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17657 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17658
17659 @kindex maint print symbols
17660 @cindex symbol dump
17661 @kindex maint print psymbols
17662 @cindex partial symbol dump
17663 @kindex maint print msymbols
17664 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17665 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17666 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17667 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17668 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17669 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17670 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17671 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17672 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17673 that objfile.
17674 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17675 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17676 @code{main}.
17677 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17678 source file.
17679
17680 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17681 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17682 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17683 tables.
17684 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17685 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17686 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17687 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17688 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17689 ``ELF symbols''.
17690
17691 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17692 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17693
17694 @kindex maint info symtabs
17695 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17696 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17697 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17698 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17699 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17700 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17701 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17702
17703 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17704 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17705 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
17706 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
17707 structure in more detail. For example:
17708
17709 @smallexample
17710 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
17711 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17712 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17713 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17714 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
17715 readin no
17716 fullname (null)
17717 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
17718 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
17719 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
17720 dependencies (none)
17721 @}
17722 @}
17723 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17724 (@value{GDBP})
17725 @end smallexample
17726 @noindent
17727 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
17728 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
17729 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
17730 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
17731 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
17732
17733 @smallexample
17734 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
17735 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
17736 line 1574.
17737 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
17738 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
17739 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
17740 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
17741 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
17742 dirname (null)
17743 fullname (null)
17744 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
17745 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
17746 debugformat DWARF 2
17747 @}
17748 @}
17749 (@value{GDBP})
17750 @end smallexample
17751
17752 @kindex maint info line-table
17753 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
17754 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17755 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17756
17757 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
17758 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17759 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
17760
17761 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
17762 @cindex symbol cache size
17763 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
17764 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
17765 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
17766 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
17767 with different sizes.
17768
17769 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
17770 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
17771 Show the size of the symbol cache.
17772
17773 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
17774 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
17775 @item maint print symbol-cache
17776 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
17777 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
17778
17779 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17780 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
17781 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
17782 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
17783 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
17784
17785 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
17786 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
17787 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
17788 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
17789 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
17790 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
17791
17792 @end table
17793
17794 @node Altering
17795 @chapter Altering Execution
17796
17797 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
17798 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
17799 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
17800 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
17801 program.
17802
17803 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
17804 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
17805 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
17806
17807 @menu
17808 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
17809 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
17810 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
17811 * Returning:: Returning from a function
17812 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
17813 * Patching:: Patching your program
17814 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17815 @end menu
17816
17817 @node Assignment
17818 @section Assignment to Variables
17819
17820 @cindex assignment
17821 @cindex setting variables
17822 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
17823 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
17824
17825 @smallexample
17826 print x=4
17827 @end smallexample
17828
17829 @noindent
17830 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
17831 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
17832 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
17833 information on operators in supported languages.
17834
17835 @kindex set variable
17836 @cindex variables, setting
17837 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
17838 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
17839 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
17840 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
17841 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
17842
17843 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
17844 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
17845 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
17846 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
17847 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
17848 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
17849 command @code{set width}:
17850
17851 @smallexample
17852 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
17853 type = double
17854 (@value{GDBP}) p width
17855 $4 = 13
17856 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
17857 Invalid syntax in expression.
17858 @end smallexample
17859
17860 @noindent
17861 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
17862 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
17863
17864 @smallexample
17865 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
17866 @end smallexample
17867
17868 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
17869 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
17870 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
17871 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
17872 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
17873 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
17874
17875 @smallexample
17876 @group
17877 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
17878 type = double
17879 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17880 $1 = 1
17881 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
17882 (@value{GDBP}) p g
17883 $2 = 1
17884 (@value{GDBP}) r
17885 The program being debugged has been started already.
17886 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
17887 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
17888 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
17889 Invalid bfd target.
17890 (@value{GDBP}) show g
17891 The current BFD target is "=4".
17892 @end group
17893 @end smallexample
17894
17895 @noindent
17896 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
17897 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
17898 @code{g}, use
17899
17900 @smallexample
17901 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
17902 @end smallexample
17903
17904 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
17905 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
17906 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
17907 same length or shorter.
17908 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
17909 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
17910
17911 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
17912 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
17913 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
17914 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
17915 and representation in memory), and
17916
17917 @smallexample
17918 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
17919 @end smallexample
17920
17921 @noindent
17922 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
17923
17924 @node Jumping
17925 @section Continuing at a Different Address
17926
17927 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
17928 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
17929 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
17930
17931 @table @code
17932 @kindex jump
17933 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
17934 @item jump @var{location}
17935 @itemx j @var{location}
17936 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
17937 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
17938 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
17939 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
17940 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
17941
17942 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
17943 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
17944 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
17945 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
17946 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
17947 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
17948 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
17949 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
17950 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
17951 @end table
17952
17953 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
17954 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
17955 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
17956 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
17957 example,
17958
17959 @smallexample
17960 set $pc = 0x485
17961 @end smallexample
17962
17963 @noindent
17964 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
17965 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
17966 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
17967
17968 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
17969 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
17970 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
17971 detail.
17972
17973 @c @group
17974 @node Signaling
17975 @section Giving your Program a Signal
17976 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
17977
17978 @table @code
17979 @kindex signal
17980 @item signal @var{signal}
17981 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
17982 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
17983 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
17984 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
17985
17986 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
17987 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
17988 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
17989 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
17990 signal.
17991
17992 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
17993 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
17994 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
17995 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
17996 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
17997 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
17998 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
17999 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18000
18001 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18002 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18003 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18004 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18005 passes the signal directly to your program.
18006
18007 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18008 after executing the command.
18009
18010 @kindex queue-signal
18011 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18012 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18013 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18014 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18015 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18016 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18017 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18018 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18019 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18020
18021 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18022 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18023 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18024 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18025 @code{continue} command.
18026
18027 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18028 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18029 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18030 (@pxref{Signals}).
18031 @end table
18032 @c @end group
18033
18034 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18035 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18036
18037 @node Returning
18038 @section Returning from a Function
18039
18040 @table @code
18041 @cindex returning from a function
18042 @kindex return
18043 @item return
18044 @itemx return @var{expression}
18045 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18046 command. If you give an
18047 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18048 value.
18049 @end table
18050
18051 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18052 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18053 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18054 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18055
18056 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18057 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18058 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18059 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18060 of functions.
18061
18062 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18063 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18064 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18065 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18066 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18067
18068 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18069 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18070 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18071 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18072 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18073 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18074 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18075 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18076 assignment into the right register(s).
18077
18078 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18079 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18080 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18081 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18082 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18083 into a @code{long long int}:
18084
18085 @smallexample
18086 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18087 29 return 31;
18088 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18089 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18090 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18091 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18092 (@value{GDBP})
18093 @end smallexample
18094
18095 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18096 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18097 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18098 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18099 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18100 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18101 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18102 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18103
18104 @smallexample
18105 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18106 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18107 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18108 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18109 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18110 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18111 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18112 (@value{GDBP})
18113 @end smallexample
18114
18115 @node Calling
18116 @section Calling Program Functions
18117
18118 @table @code
18119 @cindex calling functions
18120 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18121 @item print @var{expr}
18122 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18123 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18124 debugged.
18125
18126 @kindex call
18127 @item call @var{expr}
18128 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18129 returned values.
18130
18131 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18132 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18133 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18134 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18135 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18136 value history.
18137 @end table
18138
18139 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18140 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18141 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18142 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18143
18144 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18145 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18146 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18147 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18148 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18149 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18150 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18151 in that case is controlled by the
18152 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18153
18154 @table @code
18155 @item set unwindonsignal
18156 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18157 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18158 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18159 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18160 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18161 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18162 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18163 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18164 received.
18165
18166 @item show unwindonsignal
18167 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18168 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18169 @value{GDBN}.
18170
18171 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18172 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18173 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18174 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18175 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18176 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18177 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18178 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18179 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18180 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18181
18182 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18183 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18184 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18185 @value{GDBN}.
18186
18187 @end table
18188
18189 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18190
18191 @cindex no debug info functions
18192 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18193 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18194 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18195 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18196 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18197 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18198
18199 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18200 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18201 declared return type. For example:
18202
18203 @smallexample
18204 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18205 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18206 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18207 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18208 @end smallexample
18209
18210 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18211 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18212 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18213 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18214
18215 @smallexample
18216 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18217 @end smallexample
18218
18219 @noindent
18220 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18221
18222 @smallexample
18223 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18224 @end smallexample
18225
18226 @noindent
18227 these calls are equivalent:
18228
18229 @smallexample
18230 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18231 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18232 @end smallexample
18233
18234 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18235 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18236 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18237 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18238 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18239 float parameters, and no debug info:
18240
18241 @smallexample
18242 float
18243 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18244 float v1, v2;
18245 @{
18246 return v1 * v2;
18247 @}
18248 @end smallexample
18249
18250 @noindent
18251 you call it like this:
18252
18253 @smallexample
18254 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18255 @end smallexample
18256
18257 @node Patching
18258 @section Patching Programs
18259
18260 @cindex patching binaries
18261 @cindex writing into executables
18262 @cindex writing into corefiles
18263
18264 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18265 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18266 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18267 patching your program's binary.
18268
18269 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18270 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18271 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18272 repairs.
18273
18274 @table @code
18275 @kindex set write
18276 @item set write on
18277 @itemx set write off
18278 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18279 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18280 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18281
18282 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18283 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18284 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18285
18286 @item show write
18287 @kindex show write
18288 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18289 as well as reading.
18290 @end table
18291
18292 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18293 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18294 @cindex injecting code
18295 @cindex writing into executables
18296 @cindex compiling code
18297
18298 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18299 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18300 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18301 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18302
18303 @table @code
18304 @kindex compile code
18305 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18306 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18307 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18308 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18309 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18310 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18311 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18312 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18313 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18314 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18315 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18316 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18317
18318 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18319 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18320 E.g.:
18321
18322 @smallexample
18323 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18324 @end smallexample
18325
18326 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18327 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18328 from actual source code. E.g.:
18329
18330 @smallexample
18331 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18332 @end smallexample
18333
18334 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18335 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18336 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18337 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18338 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18339 editor.
18340
18341 @smallexample
18342 compile code
18343 >printf ("hello\n");
18344 >printf ("world\n");
18345 >end
18346 @end smallexample
18347
18348 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18349 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18350 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18351 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18352 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18353 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18354 inferior symbols otherwise.
18355
18356 @kindex compile file
18357 @item compile file @var{filename}
18358 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18359 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18360
18361 @smallexample
18362 compile file /home/user/example.c
18363 @end smallexample
18364 @end table
18365
18366 @table @code
18367 @item compile print @var{expr}
18368 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18369 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18370 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18371 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18372 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18373 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18374 Formats}.
18375
18376 @item compile print
18377 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18378 @cindex reprint the last value
18379 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18380 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18381 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18382 multiple-line editor.
18383 @end table
18384
18385 @noindent
18386 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18387
18388 @table @code
18389 @anchor{set debug compile}
18390 @item set debug compile
18391 @cindex compile command debugging info
18392 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18393 injecting the code. The default is off.
18394
18395 @item show debug compile
18396 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18397 compiling and injecting the code.
18398 @end table
18399
18400 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18401
18402 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18403 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18404 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18405 injecting process.
18406
18407 @noindent
18408 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18409
18410 @table @asis
18411 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18412 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18413 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18414 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18415
18416 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18417 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18418 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18419 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18420 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18421 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18422 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18423 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18424
18425 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18426 @end table
18427
18428 @noindent
18429 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18430
18431 @table @code
18432 @item set compile-args
18433 @cindex compile command options override
18434 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18435 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18436 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18437 compilation.
18438
18439 @item show compile-args
18440 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18441 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18442 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18443 @end table
18444
18445 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18446
18447 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18448 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18449 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18450
18451 @table @asis
18452 @item C code examples and caveats
18453 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18454 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18455 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18456 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18457 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18458
18459 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18460 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18461 much like any other normal debugging session.
18462
18463 @smallexample
18464 void function1 (void)
18465 @{
18466 int i = 42;
18467 printf ("function 1\n");
18468 @}
18469
18470 void function2 (void)
18471 @{
18472 int j = 12;
18473 function1 ();
18474 @}
18475
18476 int main(void)
18477 @{
18478 int k = 6;
18479 int *p;
18480 function2 ();
18481 return 0;
18482 @}
18483 @end smallexample
18484
18485 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18486 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18487 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18488
18489 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18490 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18491 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18492 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18493 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18494
18495 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18496 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18497 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18498 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18499 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18500 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18501 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18502 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18503 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18504 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18505
18506 @smallexample
18507 compile code k = 3;
18508 @end smallexample
18509
18510 @noindent
18511 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18512 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18513 @code{compile} command changes it.
18514
18515 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18516 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18517 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18518 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18519 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18520
18521 @smallexample
18522 compile code j = 3;
18523 @end smallexample
18524
18525 @noindent
18526 will result in a compilation error message.
18527
18528 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18529 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18530 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18531
18532 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18533 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18534 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18535 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18536
18537 @smallexample
18538 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18539 @end smallexample
18540
18541 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18542 command has completed:
18543
18544 @smallexample
18545 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18546 @end smallexample
18547
18548 @noindent
18549 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18550 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18551 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18552 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18553 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18557 @end smallexample
18558
18559 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18560 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18561 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18562 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18563 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18564 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18565 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18566 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18567
18568 @smallexample
18569 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18570 @end smallexample
18571
18572 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18573 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18574 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18575 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18576 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18577 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18578 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18579
18580 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18581 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18582 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18583 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18584 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18585 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18586
18587 @smallexample
18588 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18589 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18590 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18591 Compilation failed.
18592 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18593 42
18594 @end smallexample
18595
18596 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18597 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18598 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18599 will print to the console.
18600 @end table
18601
18602 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18603
18604 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18605 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18606 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18607 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18608 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18609 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18610 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18611 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18612
18613
18614 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18615 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18616 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18617 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18618 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18619 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18620 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18621
18622 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18623 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18624 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18625 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18626 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18627 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18628 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18629
18630 @table @code
18631 @item set compile-gcc
18632 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18633 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18634 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18635 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18636 default.
18637
18638 @item show compile-gcc
18639 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18640 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18641 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18642 @end table
18643
18644 @node GDB Files
18645 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18646
18647 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18648 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18649 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18650 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18651
18652 @menu
18653 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18654 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18655 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18656 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18657 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18658 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18659 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18660 @end menu
18661
18662 @node Files
18663 @section Commands to Specify Files
18664
18665 @cindex symbol table
18666 @cindex core dump file
18667
18668 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18669 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18670 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18671 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18672
18673 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18674 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18675 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18676 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18677 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18678 new files are useful.
18679
18680 @table @code
18681 @cindex executable file
18682 @kindex file
18683 @item file @var{filename}
18684 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18685 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18686 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18687 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18688 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18689 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18690 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18691 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18692
18693 @cindex unlinked object files
18694 @cindex patching object files
18695 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18696 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18697 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18698 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18699 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18700 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18701 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18702 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18703
18704 @item file
18705 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
18706 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
18707
18708 @kindex exec-file
18709 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18710 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
18711 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
18712 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
18713 discard information on the executable file.
18714
18715 @kindex symbol-file
18716 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
18717 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
18718 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
18719 table and program to run from the same file.
18720
18721 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
18722 program's symbol table.
18723
18724 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
18725 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
18726 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
18727 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
18728 @value{GDBN}.
18729
18730 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
18731 executing it once.
18732
18733 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
18734 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
18735 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
18736 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
18737 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
18738 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
18739 optimized code.
18740
18741 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
18742 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
18743 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
18744 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
18745 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
18746
18747 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
18748 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
18749 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
18750 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
18751 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
18752 Warnings and Messages}.)
18753
18754 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
18755 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
18756 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
18757 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
18758 in stabs format.
18759
18760 @kindex readnow
18761 @cindex reading symbols immediately
18762 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
18763 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18764 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
18765 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
18766 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
18767 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
18768 entire symbol table available.
18769
18770 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
18771 @cindex never read symbols
18772 @cindex symbols, never read
18773 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
18774 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
18775 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
18776 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
18777 @xref{--readnever}.
18778
18779 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
18780 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
18781 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
18782 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
18783 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
18784 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
18785 @c files.
18786
18787 @kindex core-file
18788 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18789 @itemx core
18790 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
18791 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
18792 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
18793 executable file itself for other parts.
18794
18795 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
18796 to be used.
18797
18798 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
18799 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
18800 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
18801 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
18802 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
18803
18804 @kindex add-symbol-file
18805 @cindex dynamic linking
18806 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
18807 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]}
18808 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
18809 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
18810 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
18811 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
18812 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
18813 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
18814 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
18815 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
18816 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
18817 @var{address} as an expression.
18818
18819 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
18820 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
18821 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
18822 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
18823
18824 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
18825
18826 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
18827 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
18828 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
18829 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
18830 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
18831 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
18832 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
18833 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
18834 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
18835
18836 @itemize @bullet
18837 @item
18838 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
18839 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
18840 @item
18841 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
18842 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
18843 @item
18844 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
18845 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18846 @end itemize
18847
18848 @noindent
18849 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
18850 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
18851 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
18852 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
18853 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
18854 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
18855 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
18856 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
18857 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
18858 way.
18859
18860 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18861
18862 @kindex remove-symbol-file
18863 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
18864 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
18865 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
18866 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
18867 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
18868
18869 @smallexample
18870 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
18871 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
18872 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
18873 (y or n) y
18874 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
18875 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
18876 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
18877 (gdb)
18878 @end smallexample
18879
18880
18881 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
18882
18883 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
18884 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
18885 @cindex load symbols from memory
18886 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
18887 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
18888 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
18889 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
18890 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
18891 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
18892 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
18893 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
18894 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
18895
18896 @kindex section
18897 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
18898 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
18899 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
18900 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
18901 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
18902 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
18903 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
18904 their addresses.
18905
18906 @kindex info files
18907 @kindex info target
18908 @item info files
18909 @itemx info target
18910 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
18911 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
18912 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
18913 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
18914 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
18915 current ones.
18916
18917 @kindex maint info sections
18918 @item maint info sections
18919 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
18920 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
18921 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
18922 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
18923 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
18924 may be arbitrarily combined):
18925
18926 @table @code
18927 @item ALLOBJ
18928 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
18929 @item @var{sections}
18930 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
18931 @item @var{section-flags}
18932 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
18933 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
18934 @table @code
18935 @item ALLOC
18936 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
18937 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
18938 @item LOAD
18939 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
18940 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
18941 @item RELOC
18942 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
18943 @item READONLY
18944 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
18945 @item CODE
18946 Section contains executable code only.
18947 @item DATA
18948 Section contains data only (no executable code).
18949 @item ROM
18950 Section will reside in ROM.
18951 @item CONSTRUCTOR
18952 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
18953 @item HAS_CONTENTS
18954 Section is not empty.
18955 @item NEVER_LOAD
18956 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
18957 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
18958 A notification to the linker that the section contains
18959 COFF shared library information.
18960 @item IS_COMMON
18961 Section contains common symbols.
18962 @end table
18963 @end table
18964 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
18965 @cindex read-only sections
18966 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
18967 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
18968 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
18969 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
18970 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
18971 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
18972 enhancement to debugging performance.
18973
18974 The default is off.
18975
18976 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
18977 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
18978 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
18979 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
18980
18981 @item show trust-readonly-sections
18982 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
18983 @end table
18984
18985 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
18986 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
18987 name and remembers it that way.
18988
18989 @cindex shared libraries
18990 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
18991 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
18992 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
18993 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
18994
18995 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
18996 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
18997
18998 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
18999 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19000 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19001 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19002 debugging a core file).
19003
19004 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19005 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19006 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19007
19008 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19009 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19010 particularly large or there are many of them.
19011
19012 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19013 commands:
19014
19015 @table @code
19016 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19017 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19018 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19019 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19020 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19021 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19022 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19023 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19024
19025 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19026 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19027 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19028 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19029 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19030 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19031 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19032 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19033 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19034
19035 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19036 @item show auto-solib-add
19037 Display the current autoloading mode.
19038 @end table
19039
19040 @cindex load shared library
19041 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19042 command:
19043
19044 @table @code
19045 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19046 @kindex info share
19047 @item info share @var{regex}
19048 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19049 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19050 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19051 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19052
19053 @kindex info dll
19054 @item info dll @var{regex}
19055 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19056
19057 @kindex sharedlibrary
19058 @kindex share
19059 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19060 @itemx share @var{regex}
19061 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19062 Unix regular expression.
19063 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19064 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19065 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19066 loaded.
19067
19068 @item nosharedlibrary
19069 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19070 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19071 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19072 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19073 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19074 discarded.
19075 @end table
19076
19077 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19078 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19079 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19080 Catchpoints}).
19081
19082 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19083 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19084 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19085 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19086
19087 @table @code
19088 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19089 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19090 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19091 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19092 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19093 shared library.
19094
19095 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19096 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19097 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19098 library events happen.
19099 @end table
19100
19101 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19102 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19103 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19104 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19105 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19106 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19107 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19108 not.
19109
19110 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19111 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19112 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19113 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19114 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19115
19116 @table @code
19117 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19118 @cindex system root, alternate
19119 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19120 @kindex set sysroot
19121 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19122 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19123 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19124 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19125 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19126 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19127 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19128 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19129 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19130 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19131 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19132 @var{path}.
19133
19134 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19135 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19136 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19137 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19138 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19139 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19140 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19141 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19142 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19143 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19144 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19145 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19146 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19147 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19148
19149 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19150 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19151 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19152 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19153 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19154
19155 @smallexample
19156 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19157 @end smallexample
19158
19159 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19160 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19161 system:
19162
19163 @smallexample
19164 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19165 @end smallexample
19166
19167 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19168 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19169 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19170 colons:
19171
19172 @smallexample
19173 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19174 @end smallexample
19175
19176 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19177 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19178 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19179 @samp{z}):
19180
19181 @smallexample
19182 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19183 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19184 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19185 @end smallexample
19186
19187 @noindent
19188 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19189 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19190 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19191
19192 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19193 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19194
19195 @smallexample
19196 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19197 @end smallexample
19198
19199 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19200 if you don't want or need to.
19201
19202 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19203 sysroot}.
19204
19205 @cindex default system root
19206 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19207 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19208 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19209 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19210 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19211 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19212 location.
19213
19214 @kindex show sysroot
19215 @item show sysroot
19216 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19217
19218 @kindex set solib-search-path
19219 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19220 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19221 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19222 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19223 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19224 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19225 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19226 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19227 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19228 of shared library symbols.
19229
19230 @kindex show solib-search-path
19231 @item show solib-search-path
19232 Display the current shared library search path.
19233
19234 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19235 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19236 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19237 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19238 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19239
19240 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19241 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19242 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19243 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19244 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19245 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19246 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19247 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19248 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19249 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19250 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19251 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19252 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19253 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19254 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19255 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19256 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19257 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19258 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19259 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19260 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19261 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19262
19263 @table @code
19264 @item unix
19265 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19266 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19267 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19268 the forward slash.
19269
19270 @item dos-based
19271 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19272 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19273 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19274 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19275 considered directory separators.
19276
19277 @item auto
19278 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19279 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19280 This is the default.
19281 @end table
19282 @end table
19283
19284 @cindex file name canonicalization
19285 @cindex base name differences
19286 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19287 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19288 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19289 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19290 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19291 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19292 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19293 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19294 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19295 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19296 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19297 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19298 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19299 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19300 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19301
19302 @table @code
19303 @item set basenames-may-differ
19304 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19305 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19306
19307 @item show basenames-may-differ
19308 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19309 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19310 @end table
19311
19312 @node File Caching
19313 @section File Caching
19314 @cindex caching of opened files
19315 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19316
19317 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19318 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19319 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19320 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19321
19322 @table @code
19323 @kindex maint info bfds
19324 @item maint info bfds
19325 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19326 @value{GDBN}.
19327
19328 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19329 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19330 @kindex bfd caching
19331 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19332 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19333 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19334 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19335 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19336 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19337 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19338 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19339 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19340
19341 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19342 @kindex bfd caching
19343 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19344 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19345
19346 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19347 @kindex bfd caching
19348 @item show debug bfd-cache
19349 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19350 @end table
19351
19352 @node Separate Debug Files
19353 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19354 @cindex separate debugging information files
19355 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19356 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19357 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19358 @cindex global debugging information directories
19359 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19360 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19361
19362 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19363 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19364 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19365 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19366 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19367 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19368 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19369
19370 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19371 file:
19372
19373 @itemize @bullet
19374 @item
19375 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19376 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19377 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19378 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19379 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19380 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19381 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19382 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19383
19384 @item
19385 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19386 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19387 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19388 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19389 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19390 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19391 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19392 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19393 below.
19394 @end itemize
19395
19396 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19397 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19398
19399 @itemize @bullet
19400 @item
19401 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19402 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19403 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19404 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19405 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19406
19407 @item
19408 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19409 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19410 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19411 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19412 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19413 hex characters, not 10.)
19414 @end itemize
19415
19416 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19417 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19418 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19419 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19420 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19421 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19422
19423 @itemize @minus
19424 @item
19425 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19426 @item
19427 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19428 @item
19429 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19430 @item
19431 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19432 @end itemize
19433
19434 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19435 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19436 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19437 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19438 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19439
19440 @table @code
19441
19442 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19443 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19444 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19445 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19446 concatenating them by a path separator.
19447
19448 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19449 @item show debug-file-directory
19450 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19451 information files.
19452
19453 @end table
19454
19455 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19456 @cindex debug link sections
19457 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19458 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19459
19460 @itemize
19461 @item
19462 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19463 a zero byte,
19464 @item
19465 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19466 boundary within the section, and
19467 @item
19468 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19469 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19470 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19471 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19472 @end itemize
19473
19474 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19475 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19476 described above.
19477
19478 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19479 @cindex build ID sections
19480 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19481 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19482 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19483 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19484 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19485 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19486 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19487 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19488 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19489
19490 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19491 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19492 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19493 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19494 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19495 in an ordinary executable.
19496
19497 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19498 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19499 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19500 following commands:
19501
19502 @smallexample
19503 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19504 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507 @noindent
19508 These commands remove the debugging
19509 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19510 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19511 two files:
19512
19513 @itemize @bullet
19514 @item
19515 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19516 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19517
19518 @smallexample
19519 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19520 @end smallexample
19521
19522 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19523 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19524 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19525 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19526
19527 @item
19528 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19529 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19530 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19531 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19532 @end itemize
19533
19534 @noindent
19535
19536 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19537 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19538 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19539
19540 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19541 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19542 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19543 @c different ways!
19544 @ifhtml
19545 @display
19546 @html
19547 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19548 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19549 @end html
19550 @end display
19551 @end ifhtml
19552 @ifnothtml
19553 @display
19554 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19555 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19556 @end display
19557 @end ifnothtml
19558
19559 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19560 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19561 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19562 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19563 CRC.
19564
19565 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19566 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19567 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19568 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19569 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19570
19571 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19572 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19573 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19574 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19575 @code{0xffffffff}.
19576
19577 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19578 @smallexample
19579 unsigned long
19580 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19581 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19582 @{
19583 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19584 @{
19585 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19586 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19587 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19588 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19589 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19590 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19591 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19592 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19593 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19594 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19595 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19596 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19597 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19598 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19599 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19600 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19601 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19602 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19603 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19604 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19605 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19606 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19607 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19608 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19609 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19610 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19611 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19612 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19613 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19614 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19615 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19616 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19617 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19618 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19619 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19620 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19621 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19622 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19623 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19624 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19625 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19626 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19627 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19628 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19629 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19630 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19631 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19632 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19633 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19634 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19635 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19636 0x2d02ef8d
19637 @};
19638 unsigned char *end;
19639
19640 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19641 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19642 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19643 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19644 @}
19645 @end smallexample
19646
19647 @noindent
19648 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19649
19650 @node MiniDebugInfo
19651 @section Debugging information in a special section
19652 @cindex separate debug sections
19653 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19654
19655 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19656 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19657 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19658 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19659
19660 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19661 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19662 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19663 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19664 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19665 debugging information might be included in the section.
19666
19667 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19668 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19669 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19670
19671 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19672 standard utilities:
19673
19674 @smallexample
19675 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19676 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19677 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19678 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19679
19680 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19681 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19682 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19683 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19684 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19685 | sort > funcsyms
19686
19687 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19688 # table.
19689 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19690
19691 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19692 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19693
19694 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19695 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19696 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19697 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
19698
19699 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
19700 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
19701
19702 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
19703 # original binary.
19704 xz mini_debuginfo
19705 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
19706 @end smallexample
19707
19708 @node Index Files
19709 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
19710 @cindex index files
19711 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
19712
19713 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
19714 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
19715 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
19716 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
19717 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
19718 startup.
19719
19720 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
19721 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
19722 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
19723
19724 @smallexample
19725 $ gdb-add-index symfile
19726 @end smallexample
19727
19728 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
19729
19730 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
19731 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
19732
19733 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
19734 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
19735 using @command{objcopy}.
19736
19737 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
19738
19739 @table @code
19740 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
19741 @kindex save gdb-index
19742 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
19743 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
19744 default creates it produces a single file
19745 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
19746 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
19747 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
19748 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
19749 given @var{directory}.
19750 @end table
19751
19752 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
19753 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
19754
19755 @smallexample
19756 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
19757 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
19758 @end smallexample
19759
19760 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
19761
19762 @smallexample
19763 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
19764 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
19765 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
19766 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
19767 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
19768 @end smallexample
19769
19770 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
19771 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
19772 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
19773 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
19774 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
19775 The default is @code{off}.
19776 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
19777 @xref{Index Section Format}.
19778
19779 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
19780 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
19781
19782 @smallexample
19783 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19784 @end smallexample
19785
19786 Instead you must do, for example,
19787
19788 @smallexample
19789 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
19790 @end smallexample
19791
19792 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
19793 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
19794 currently work for programs using Ada.
19795
19796 @node Symbol Errors
19797 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
19798
19799 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
19800 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
19801 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
19802 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
19803 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
19804 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
19805 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
19806 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
19807 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
19808 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19809 Messages}).
19810
19811 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
19812
19813 @table @code
19814 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
19815
19816 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
19817 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
19818 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
19819 in its outer scope blocks.
19820
19821 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
19822 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
19823 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
19824 function.
19825
19826 @item block at @var{address} out of order
19827
19828 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
19829 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
19830 do so.
19831
19832 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
19833 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
19834 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
19835 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
19836 Messages}.)
19837
19838 @item bad block start address patched
19839
19840 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
19841 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
19842 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
19843
19844 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
19845 starting on the previous source line.
19846
19847 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
19848
19849 @cindex foo
19850 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
19851 larger than the size of the string table.
19852
19853 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
19854 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
19855 with this name.
19856
19857 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
19858
19859 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
19860 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
19861 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
19862
19863 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
19864 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
19865 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
19866 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
19867 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
19868 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
19869
19870 @item stub type has NULL name
19871
19872 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
19873
19874 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
19875 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
19876 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
19877 it.
19878
19879 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
19880
19881 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
19882
19883 @end table
19884
19885 @node Data Files
19886 @section GDB Data Files
19887
19888 @cindex prefix for data files
19889 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
19890 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
19891
19892 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
19893 is currently using.
19894
19895 @table @code
19896 @kindex set data-directory
19897 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
19898 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
19899 to @var{directory}.
19900
19901 @kindex show data-directory
19902 @item show data-directory
19903 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
19904 @end table
19905
19906 @cindex default data directory
19907 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
19908 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
19909 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
19910 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19911 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
19912 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19913 location.
19914
19915 The data directory may also be specified with the
19916 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
19917 @xref{Mode Options}.
19918
19919 @node Targets
19920 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
19921
19922 @cindex debugging target
19923 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
19924
19925 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
19926 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
19927 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
19928 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
19929 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
19930 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
19931 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
19932 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
19933
19934 @cindex target architecture
19935 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
19936 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
19937 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
19938 command.
19939
19940 @table @code
19941 @kindex set architecture
19942 @kindex show architecture
19943 @item set architecture @var{arch}
19944 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
19945 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
19946 supported architectures.
19947
19948 @item show architecture
19949 Show the current target architecture.
19950
19951 @item set processor
19952 @itemx processor
19953 @kindex set processor
19954 @kindex show processor
19955 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
19956 and @code{show architecture}.
19957 @end table
19958
19959 @menu
19960 * Active Targets:: Active targets
19961 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
19962 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
19963 @end menu
19964
19965 @node Active Targets
19966 @section Active Targets
19967
19968 @cindex stacking targets
19969 @cindex active targets
19970 @cindex multiple targets
19971
19972 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
19973 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
19974 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
19975 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
19976 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
19977 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
19978 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
19979 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
19980 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
19981
19982 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
19983 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
19984 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
19985 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
19986
19987 @node Target Commands
19988 @section Commands for Managing Targets
19989
19990 @table @code
19991 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
19992 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
19993 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
19994 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
19995 protocol of the target machine.
19996
19997 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
19998 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
19999 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20000
20001 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20002 after executing the command.
20003
20004 @kindex help target
20005 @item help target
20006 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20007 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20008 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20009
20010 @item help target @var{name}
20011 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20012 select it.
20013
20014 @kindex set gnutarget
20015 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20016 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20017 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20018 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20019 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20020 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20021
20022 @quotation
20023 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20024 you must know the actual BFD name.
20025 @end quotation
20026
20027 @noindent
20028 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20029
20030 @kindex show gnutarget
20031 @item show gnutarget
20032 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20033 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20034 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20035 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20036 @end table
20037
20038 @cindex common targets
20039 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20040 configuration):
20041
20042 @table @code
20043 @kindex target
20044 @item target exec @var{program}
20045 @cindex executable file target
20046 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20047 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20048
20049 @item target core @var{filename}
20050 @cindex core dump file target
20051 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20052 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20053
20054 @item target remote @var{medium}
20055 @cindex remote target
20056 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20057 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20058 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20059
20060 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20061 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20062
20063 @smallexample
20064 target remote /dev/ttya
20065 @end smallexample
20066
20067 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20068 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20069 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20070 clobbered by the download.
20071
20072 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20073 @cindex built-in simulator target
20074 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20075 In general,
20076 @smallexample
20077 target sim
20078 load
20079 run
20080 @end smallexample
20081 @noindent
20082 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20083 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20084 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20085 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20086 Processors}.
20087
20088 @item target native
20089 @cindex native target
20090 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20091 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20092 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20093 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20094
20095 @end table
20096
20097 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20098 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20099
20100 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20101 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20102 various aspects of this process.
20103
20104 @table @code
20105
20106 @item set hash
20107 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20108 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20109 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20110 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20111 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20112 monitor.
20113
20114 @item show hash
20115 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20116 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20117
20118 @item set debug monitor
20119 @kindex set debug monitor
20120 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20121 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20122 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20123
20124 @item show debug monitor
20125 @kindex show debug monitor
20126 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20127 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20128 @end table
20129
20130 @table @code
20131
20132 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20133 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20134 @anchor{load}
20135 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20136 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20137 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20138 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20139 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20140 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20141
20142 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20143 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20144 target is @dots{}}''
20145
20146 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20147 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20148 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20149 specifies a fixed address.
20150 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20151
20152 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20153 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20154 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20155
20156 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20157 load programs into flash memory.
20158
20159 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20160 @end table
20161
20162 @table @code
20163
20164 @kindex flash-erase
20165 @item flash-erase
20166 @anchor{flash-erase}
20167
20168 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20169
20170 @end table
20171
20172 @node Byte Order
20173 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20174
20175 @cindex choosing target byte order
20176 @cindex target byte order
20177
20178 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20179 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20180 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20181 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20182 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20183 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20184
20185 @table @code
20186 @kindex set endian
20187 @item set endian big
20188 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20189
20190 @item set endian little
20191 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20192
20193 @item set endian auto
20194 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20195 executable.
20196
20197 @item show endian
20198 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20199
20200 @end table
20201
20202 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20203 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20204 target system.
20205
20206
20207 @node Remote Debugging
20208 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20209 @cindex remote debugging
20210
20211 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20212 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20213 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20214 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20215 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20216
20217 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20218 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20219 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20220 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20221 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20222 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20223
20224 Other remote targets may be available in your
20225 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20226
20227 @menu
20228 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20229 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20230 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20231 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20232 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20233 @end menu
20234
20235 @node Connecting
20236 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20237 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20238 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20239 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20240 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20241 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20242 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20243
20244 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20245 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20246 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20247 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20248
20249 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20250
20251 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20252 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20253 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20254 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20255
20256 @table @asis
20257
20258 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20259 @item Result of detach or program exit
20260 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20261 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20262 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20263
20264 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20265 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20266 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20267 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20268
20269 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20270 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20271 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20272 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20273
20274 @item Specifying the program to debug
20275 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20276 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20277 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20278 target.
20279
20280 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20281 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20282 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20283
20284 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20285 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20286 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20287 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20288
20289 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20290 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20291 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20292 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20293 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20294 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20295 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20296 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20297 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20298
20299 @item The @code{run} command
20300 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20301 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20302 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20303 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20304 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20305
20306 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20307 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20308 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20309 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20310 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20311
20312 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20313 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20314 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20315 @code{target remote} mode.
20316
20317 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20318 @item Attaching
20319 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20320 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20321 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20322
20323 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20324 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20325 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20326 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20327 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20328
20329 @end table
20330
20331 @anchor{Host and target files}
20332 @subsection Host and Target Files
20333 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20334 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20335
20336 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20337 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20338 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20339 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20340 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20341
20342 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20343 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20344 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20345 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20346 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20347
20348 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20349 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20350 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20351 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20352 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20353 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20354 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20355 target libraries.
20356
20357 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20358 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20359 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20360 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20361 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20362 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20363 programs.
20364
20365 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20366 @cindex remote connection commands
20367 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20368 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20369 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20370 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20371 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20372 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20373 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20374
20375 @table @code
20376
20377 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20378 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20379 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20380 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20381 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20382
20383 @smallexample
20384 target remote /dev/ttyb
20385 @end smallexample
20386
20387 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20388 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20389 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20390 @code{target} command.
20391
20392 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20393 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20394 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20395 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20396 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20397 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20398 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
20399 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
20400 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
20401 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
20402 target.
20403
20404 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20405 @code{manyfarms}:
20406
20407 @smallexample
20408 target remote manyfarms:2828
20409 @end smallexample
20410
20411 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20412 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20413 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20414 port 1234 on your local machine:
20415
20416 @smallexample
20417 target remote :1234
20418 @end smallexample
20419 @noindent
20420
20421 Note that the colon is still required here.
20422
20423 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20424 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20425 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20426 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20427 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20428
20429 @smallexample
20430 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20431 @end smallexample
20432
20433 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20434 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20435 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20436 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20437
20438 @item target remote | @var{command}
20439 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20440 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20441 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20442 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20443 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20444 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20445 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20446 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20447 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20448
20449 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20450 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20451 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20452
20453 @end table
20454
20455 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20456 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20457 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20458 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20459 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20460 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20461 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20462
20463 @smallexample
20464 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20465 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20466 @end smallexample
20467
20468 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20469 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20470 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20471 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20472
20473 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20474 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20475
20476 @table @code
20477 @kindex detach (remote)
20478 @item detach
20479 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20480 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20481 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20482 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20483 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20484 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20485 still connected to the target.
20486
20487 @kindex disconnect
20488 @item disconnect
20489 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20490 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20491 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20492 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20493 another target.
20494
20495 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20496 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20497 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20498 @kindex monitor
20499 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20500 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20501 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20502 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20503 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20504 and implement.
20505 @end table
20506
20507 @node File Transfer
20508 @section Sending files to a remote system
20509 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20510 @cindex file transfer
20511 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20512
20513 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20514 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20515 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20516 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20517 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20518 the only way to upload or download files.
20519
20520 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20521
20522 @table @code
20523 @kindex remote put
20524 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20525 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20526 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20527
20528 @kindex remote get
20529 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20530 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20531 on the host system.
20532
20533 @kindex remote delete
20534 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20535 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20536
20537 @end table
20538
20539 @node Server
20540 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20541
20542 @kindex gdbserver
20543 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20544 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20545 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20546 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20547 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20548
20549 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20550 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20551 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20552 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20553 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20554 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20555 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20556 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20557 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20558 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20559 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20560 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20561 choice for debugging.
20562
20563 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20564 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20565 protocol.
20566
20567 @quotation
20568 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20569 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20570 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20571 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20572 @code{gdbserver}.
20573 @end quotation
20574
20575 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20576 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20577 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20578 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20579
20580 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20581 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20582 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20583 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20584 system does all the symbol handling.
20585
20586 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20587 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20588 syntax is:
20589
20590 @smallexample
20591 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20592 @end smallexample
20593
20594 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20595 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20596 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20597 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20598 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20599 @file{/dev/com1}:
20600
20601 @smallexample
20602 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20603 @end smallexample
20604
20605 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20606 with it.
20607
20608 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20609
20610 @smallexample
20611 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20612 @end smallexample
20613
20614 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20615 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20616 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20617 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20618 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20619 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20620 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20621 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20622 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20623 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20624 @code{target remote} command.
20625
20626 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20627 with ssh:
20628
20629 @smallexample
20630 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20631 @end smallexample
20632
20633 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20634 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20635 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20636 You could elide it if you want to.
20637
20638 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20639 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20640 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20641 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20642
20643 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20644 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20645 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20646 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20647
20648 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
20649 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
20650
20651 @smallexample
20652 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
20653 @end smallexample
20654
20655 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
20656 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
20657
20658 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
20659 @value{GDBN} attach command
20660 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
20661
20662 @pindex pidof
20663 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
20664 @code{pidof} utility:
20665
20666 @smallexample
20667 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
20668 @end smallexample
20669
20670 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
20671 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
20672 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
20673
20674 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
20675
20676 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
20677 port.
20678
20679 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
20680 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
20681 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
20682 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
20683 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
20684 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
20685 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
20686 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
20687
20688 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
20689 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
20690 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
20691
20692 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
20693 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
20694 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
20695 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
20696 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
20697 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
20698 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
20699 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
20700 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
20701 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
20702 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
20703 instance closes its port after the first connection.
20704
20705 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
20706 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
20707
20708 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
20709 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
20710 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
20711 program. For more information,
20712 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
20713
20714 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20715 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
20716 status information about the debugging process.
20717 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
20718 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
20719 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
20720 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
20721
20722 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
20723 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
20724 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
20725 Possible options are:
20726
20727 @table @code
20728 @item none
20729 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20730 @item all
20731 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20732 @item timestamps
20733 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20734 @end table
20735
20736 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20737 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20738
20739 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
20740 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
20741 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
20742 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
20743 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
20744
20745 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
20746 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
20747 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
20748 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
20749
20750 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
20751 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
20752 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
20753 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
20754
20755 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
20756 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
20757 environment:
20758
20759 @smallexample
20760 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
20761 @end smallexample
20762
20763 @cindex @option{--selftest}
20764 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
20765
20766 @smallexample
20767 $ gdbserver --selftest
20768 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
20769 @end smallexample
20770
20771 These tests are disabled in release.
20772 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
20773
20774 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
20775 @itemize
20776
20777 @item
20778 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
20779
20780 @item
20781 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
20782 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
20783 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
20784 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
20785 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
20786 @code{--with-sysroot}).
20787
20788 @item
20789 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20790 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
20791 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
20792 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
20793 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
20794 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
20795 program is already on the target.
20796
20797 @end itemize
20798
20799 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
20800 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
20801 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
20802
20803 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
20804 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
20805 Here are the available commands.
20806
20807 @table @code
20808 @item monitor help
20809 List the available monitor commands.
20810
20811 @item monitor set debug 0
20812 @itemx monitor set debug 1
20813 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
20814
20815 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
20816 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
20817 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
20818 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
20819
20820 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
20821 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
20822 Possible options are:
20823
20824 @table @code
20825 @item none
20826 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
20827 @item all
20828 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
20829 @item timestamps
20830 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
20831 @end table
20832
20833 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
20834 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
20835
20836 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
20837 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
20838 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20839 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
20840 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
20841 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
20842
20843 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
20844 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
20845
20846 @item monitor exit
20847 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
20848 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
20849 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
20850 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
20851 of a multi-process mode debug session.
20852
20853 @end table
20854
20855 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20856 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
20857
20858 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
20859 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
20860
20861 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
20862 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
20863 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
20864 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
20865 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
20866 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
20867 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
20868 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
20869 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
20870 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
20871 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
20872 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
20873
20874 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
20875
20876 @table @code
20877 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
20878
20879 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
20880 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
20881 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
20882
20883 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
20884
20885 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
20886 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
20887 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
20888 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
20889 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
20890 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
20891
20892 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
20893
20894 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
20895 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
20896 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
20897 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
20898 command for that. For example:
20899
20900 @smallexample
20901 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
20902 @end smallexample
20903
20904 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
20905 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
20906 @end table
20907
20908 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
20909 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
20910 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
20911 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
20912 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
20913 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
20914 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
20915 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
20916 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
20917 @code{gdbserver} like so:
20918
20919 @smallexample
20920 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
20921 @end smallexample
20922
20923 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
20924
20925 @smallexample
20926 $ gdb myprogram
20927 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
20928 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
20929 (@value{GDBP}) b main
20930 (@value{GDBP}) continue
20931 @end smallexample
20932
20933 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
20934 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
20935 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
20936 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
20937 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
20938 tracing.
20939
20940 @node Remote Configuration
20941 @section Remote Configuration
20942
20943 @kindex set remote
20944 @kindex show remote
20945 This section documents the configuration options available when
20946 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
20947 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
20948 system-call-allowed}.
20949
20950 @table @code
20951 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
20952 @cindex address size for remote targets
20953 @cindex bits in remote address
20954 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
20955 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
20956 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
20957 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
20958
20959 @item show remoteaddresssize
20960 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
20961
20962 @item set serial baud @var{n}
20963 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
20964 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
20965 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
20966 remote targets.
20967
20968 @item show serial baud
20969 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
20970
20971 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
20972 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
20973 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
20974
20975 @item show serial parity
20976 Show the current parity of the serial port.
20977
20978 @item set remotebreak
20979 @cindex interrupt remote programs
20980 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
20981 @anchor{set remotebreak}
20982 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
20983 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
20984 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
20985 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
20986 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
20987
20988 @item show remotebreak
20989 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
20990 interrupt the remote program.
20991
20992 @item set remoteflow on
20993 @itemx set remoteflow off
20994 @kindex set remoteflow
20995 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
20996 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
20997
20998 @item show remoteflow
20999 @kindex show remoteflow
21000 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21001
21002 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21003 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21004 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21005 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21006 @code{ascii}.
21007
21008 @item show remotelogbase
21009 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21010 protocol.
21011
21012 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21013 @cindex record serial communications on file
21014 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21015 default is not to record at all.
21016
21017 @item show remotelogfile.
21018 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21019 serial communications.
21020
21021 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21022 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21023 @cindex remote timeout
21024 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21025 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21026
21027 @item show remotetimeout
21028 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21029 responses.
21030
21031 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21032 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21033 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21034 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21035 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21036 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21037 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
21038 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
21039
21040 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21041 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21042 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21043 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21044 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
21045 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
21046 as unlimited.
21047
21048 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21049 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21050 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21051
21052 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21053 @itemx show remote exec-file
21054 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21055 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21056 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21057 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21058 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21059 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21060
21061 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21062 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21063 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21064 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21065 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21066 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21067 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21068 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21069 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21070 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21071
21072 @item show interrupt-sequence
21073 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21074 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21075 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21076 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21077
21078 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21079 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21080 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21081 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21082 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21083 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21084
21085 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21086 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21087 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21088
21089 @kindex set tcp
21090 @kindex show tcp
21091 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21092 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21093 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21094 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21095 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21096 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21097 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21098 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21099 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21100
21101 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21102 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21103
21104 @item show tcp auto-retry
21105 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21106
21107 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21108 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21109 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21110 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21111 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21112 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21113 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21114 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21115 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21116 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21117 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21118
21119 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21120 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21121 @end table
21122
21123 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21124 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21125 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21126 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21127 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21128 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21129 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21130 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21131 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21132
21133 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21134 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21135 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21136 @value{GDBN} developers.
21137
21138 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21139 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21140 are:
21141
21142 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21143 @item Command Name
21144 @tab Remote Packet
21145 @tab Related Features
21146
21147 @item @code{fetch-register}
21148 @tab @code{p}
21149 @tab @code{info registers}
21150
21151 @item @code{set-register}
21152 @tab @code{P}
21153 @tab @code{set}
21154
21155 @item @code{binary-download}
21156 @tab @code{X}
21157 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21158
21159 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21160 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21161 @tab @code{info auxv}
21162
21163 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21164 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21165 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21166
21167 @item @code{attach}
21168 @tab @code{vAttach}
21169 @tab @code{attach}
21170
21171 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21172 @tab @code{vCont}
21173 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21174
21175 @item @code{run}
21176 @tab @code{vRun}
21177 @tab @code{run}
21178
21179 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21180 @tab @code{Z0}
21181 @tab @code{break}
21182
21183 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21184 @tab @code{Z1}
21185 @tab @code{hbreak}
21186
21187 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21188 @tab @code{Z2}
21189 @tab @code{watch}
21190
21191 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21192 @tab @code{Z3}
21193 @tab @code{rwatch}
21194
21195 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21196 @tab @code{Z4}
21197 @tab @code{awatch}
21198
21199 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21200 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21201 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21202
21203 @item @code{target-features}
21204 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21205 @tab @code{set architecture}
21206
21207 @item @code{library-info}
21208 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21209 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21210
21211 @item @code{memory-map}
21212 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21213 @tab @code{info mem}
21214
21215 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21216 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21217 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21218
21219 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21220 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21221 @tab @code{info spu}
21222
21223 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21224 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21225 @tab @code{info spu}
21226
21227 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21228 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21229 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21230
21231 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21232 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21233 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21234
21235 @item @code{threads}
21236 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21237 @tab @code{info threads}
21238
21239 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21240 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21241 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21242
21243 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21244 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21245 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21246
21247 @item @code{search-memory}
21248 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21249 @tab @code{find}
21250
21251 @item @code{supported-packets}
21252 @tab @code{qSupported}
21253 @tab Remote communications parameters
21254
21255 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21256 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21257 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21258
21259 @item @code{pass-signals}
21260 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21261 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21262
21263 @item @code{program-signals}
21264 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21265 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21266
21267 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21268 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21269 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21270
21271 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21272 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21273 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21274
21275 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21276 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21277 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21278
21279 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21280 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21281 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21282
21283 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21284 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21285 @tab @code{remote delete}
21286
21287 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21288 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21289 @tab Host I/O
21290
21291 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21292 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21293 @tab Host I/O
21294
21295 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21296 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21297 @tab Host I/O
21298
21299 @item @code{noack-packet}
21300 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21301 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21302
21303 @item @code{osdata}
21304 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21305 @tab @code{info os}
21306
21307 @item @code{query-attached}
21308 @tab @code{qAttached}
21309 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21310
21311 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21312 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21313 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21314
21315 @item @code{trace-status}
21316 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21317 @tab @code{tstatus}
21318
21319 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21320 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21321 @tab Traceframe info
21322
21323 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21324 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21325 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21326
21327 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21328 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21329 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21330
21331 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21332 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21333 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21334
21335 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21336 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21337 @tab @code{set environment}
21338
21339 @item @code{environment-unset}
21340 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21341 @tab @code{unset environment}
21342
21343 @item @code{environment-reset}
21344 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21345 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21346
21347 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21348 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21349 @tab @code{set cwd}
21350
21351 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21352 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21353 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21354
21355 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21356 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21357 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21358
21359 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21360 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21361 @tab @code{break}
21362
21363 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21364 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21365 @tab @code{hbreak}
21366
21367 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21368 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21369 @tab @code{fork}
21370
21371 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21372 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21373 @tab @code{vfork}
21374
21375 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21376 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21377 @tab @code{exec}
21378
21379 @item @code{thread-events}
21380 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21381 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21382
21383 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21384 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21385 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21386
21387 @end multitable
21388
21389 @node Remote Stub
21390 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21391
21392 @cindex debugging stub, example
21393 @cindex remote stub, example
21394 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21395 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21396 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21397 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21398 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21399 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21400 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21401 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21402
21403 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21404 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21405 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21406 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21407 program, you need:
21408
21409 @enumerate
21410 @item
21411 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21412 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21413 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21414
21415 @item
21416 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21417 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21418
21419 @item
21420 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21421 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21422 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21423 documentation.
21424 @end enumerate
21425
21426 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21427 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21428 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21429
21430 @table @emph
21431 @item On the host,
21432 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21433 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21434 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21435
21436 @item On the target,
21437 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21438 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21439 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21440
21441 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21442 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21443 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21444 @end table
21445
21446 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21447 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21448 @sc{sparc} boards.
21449
21450 @cindex remote serial stub list
21451 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21452
21453 @table @code
21454
21455 @item i386-stub.c
21456 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21457 @cindex Intel
21458 @cindex i386
21459 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21460
21461 @item m68k-stub.c
21462 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21463 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21464 @cindex m680x0
21465 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21466
21467 @item sh-stub.c
21468 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21469 @cindex Renesas
21470 @cindex SH
21471 For Renesas SH architectures.
21472
21473 @item sparc-stub.c
21474 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21475 @cindex Sparc
21476 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21477
21478 @item sparcl-stub.c
21479 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21480 @cindex Fujitsu
21481 @cindex SparcLite
21482 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21483
21484 @end table
21485
21486 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21487 recently added stubs.
21488
21489 @menu
21490 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21491 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21492 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21493 @end menu
21494
21495 @node Stub Contents
21496 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21497
21498 @cindex remote serial stub
21499 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21500 subroutines:
21501
21502 @table @code
21503 @item set_debug_traps
21504 @findex set_debug_traps
21505 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21506 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21507 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21508 program's startup code.
21509
21510 @item handle_exception
21511 @findex handle_exception
21512 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21513 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21514 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21515 run when a trap is triggered.
21516
21517 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21518 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21519 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21520 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21521 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21522 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21523 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21524 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21525 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21526 machine.
21527
21528 @item breakpoint
21529 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21530 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21531 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21532 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21533 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21534 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21535 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21536 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21537 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21538 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21539 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21540
21541 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21542 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21543 start of your debugging session.
21544 @end table
21545
21546 @node Bootstrapping
21547 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21548
21549 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21550 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21551 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21552 debugging target machine.
21553
21554 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21555 serial port.
21556
21557 @table @code
21558 @item int getDebugChar()
21559 @findex getDebugChar
21560 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21561 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21562 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21563
21564 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21565 @findex putDebugChar
21566 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21567 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21568 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21569 @end table
21570
21571 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21572 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21573 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21574 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21575 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21576 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21577 remote system to stop.
21578
21579 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21580 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21581 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21582 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21583
21584 Other routines you need to supply are:
21585
21586 @table @code
21587 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21588 @findex exceptionHandler
21589 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21590 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21591 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21592 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21593 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21594 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21595 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21596 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21597 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21598 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21599 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21600 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21601 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21602
21603 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21604 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21605 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21606 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21607 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21608
21609 @item void flush_i_cache()
21610 @findex flush_i_cache
21611 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21612 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21613 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21614
21615 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21616 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21617 @end table
21618
21619 @noindent
21620 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21621
21622 @table @code
21623 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21624 @findex memset
21625 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21626 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21627 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21628 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21629 @end table
21630
21631 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21632 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21633 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21634 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21635
21636
21637 @node Debug Session
21638 @subsection Putting it All Together
21639
21640 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
21641 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
21642 steps.
21643
21644 @enumerate
21645 @item
21646 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
21647 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
21648 @display
21649 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
21650 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
21651 @end display
21652
21653 @item
21654 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
21655 procedure is called:
21656
21657 @smallexample
21658 set_debug_traps();
21659 breakpoint();
21660 @end smallexample
21661
21662 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
21663 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
21664 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
21665 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
21666 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
21667 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
21668 progress.
21669
21670 @item
21671 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
21672 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
21673
21674 @smallexample
21675 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
21676 @end smallexample
21677
21678 @noindent
21679 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
21680 function in your program, that function is called when
21681 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
21682 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
21683 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
21684
21685 @item
21686 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
21687 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
21688
21689 @item
21690 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
21691 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
21692
21693 @item
21694 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
21695 @c document that. FIXME.
21696 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
21697 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
21698
21699 @item
21700 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
21701 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21702
21703 @end enumerate
21704
21705 @node Configurations
21706 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
21707
21708 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
21709 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
21710 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
21711
21712 There are three major categories of configurations: native
21713 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
21714 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
21715 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
21716 are quite different from each other.
21717
21718 @menu
21719 * Native::
21720 * Embedded OS::
21721 * Embedded Processors::
21722 * Architectures::
21723 @end menu
21724
21725 @node Native
21726 @section Native
21727
21728 This section describes details specific to particular native
21729 configurations.
21730
21731 @menu
21732 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
21733 * Process Information:: Process information
21734 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
21735 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
21736 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
21737 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
21738 @end menu
21739
21740 @node BSD libkvm Interface
21741 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
21742
21743 @cindex libkvm
21744 @cindex kernel memory image
21745 @cindex kernel crash dump
21746
21747 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
21748 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
21749 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
21750 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
21751 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
21752 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
21753 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
21754 @code{kvm} target:
21755
21756 @smallexample
21757 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
21758 @end smallexample
21759
21760 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
21761 argument:
21762
21763 @smallexample
21764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
21765 @end smallexample
21766
21767 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
21768 available:
21769
21770 @table @code
21771 @kindex kvm
21772 @item kvm pcb
21773 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
21774
21775 @item kvm proc
21776 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
21777 modern FreeBSD systems.
21778 @end table
21779
21780 @node Process Information
21781 @subsection Process Information
21782 @cindex /proc
21783 @cindex examine process image
21784 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
21785
21786 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
21787 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
21788 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
21789 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
21790 to report information about the process running your program, or about
21791 any process running on your system.
21792
21793 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
21794 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
21795 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
21796 systems.
21797
21798 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
21799 information.
21800
21801 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
21802 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
21803 information available from a live process. Process information is
21804 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
21805 systems.
21806
21807 @table @code
21808 @kindex info proc
21809 @cindex process ID
21810 @item info proc
21811 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
21812 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
21813 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
21814 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
21815 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
21816 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
21817 executable file's absolute file name.
21818
21819 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
21820 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
21821 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
21822 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
21823 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
21824 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
21825
21826 @item info proc cmdline
21827 @cindex info proc cmdline
21828 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
21829 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21830
21831 @item info proc cwd
21832 @cindex info proc cwd
21833 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
21834 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21835
21836 @item info proc exe
21837 @cindex info proc exe
21838 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
21839 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21840
21841 @item info proc mappings
21842 @cindex memory address space mappings
21843 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program. On
21844 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
21845 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
21846 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
21847 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
21848
21849 @item info proc stat
21850 @itemx info proc status
21851 @cindex process detailed status information
21852 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
21853 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
21854 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
21855 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
21856 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
21857
21858 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
21859 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
21860
21861 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
21862 proc status}.
21863
21864 @item info proc all
21865 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
21866 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
21867
21868 @ignore
21869 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
21870 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
21871 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
21872 @kindex info proc times
21873 @item info proc times
21874 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
21875 its children.
21876
21877 @kindex info proc id
21878 @item info proc id
21879 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
21880 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
21881 @end ignore
21882
21883 @item set procfs-trace
21884 @kindex set procfs-trace
21885 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
21886 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
21887
21888 @item show procfs-trace
21889 @kindex show procfs-trace
21890 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
21891
21892 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
21893 @kindex set procfs-file
21894 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
21895 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
21896 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
21897 standard output.
21898
21899 @item show procfs-file
21900 @kindex show procfs-file
21901 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
21902
21903 @item proc-trace-entry
21904 @itemx proc-trace-exit
21905 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
21906 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
21907 @kindex proc-trace-entry
21908 @kindex proc-trace-exit
21909 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
21910 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
21911 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
21912 from the @code{syscall} interface.
21913
21914 @item info pidlist
21915 @kindex info pidlist
21916 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
21917 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
21918 processes and all the threads within each process.
21919
21920 @item info meminfo
21921 @kindex info meminfo
21922 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
21923 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
21924 @end table
21925
21926 @node DJGPP Native
21927 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
21928 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
21929 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
21930 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
21931
21932 @cindex DPMI
21933 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
21934 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
21935 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
21936 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
21937
21938 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
21939 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
21940 subsection describes those commands.
21941
21942 @table @code
21943 @kindex info dos
21944 @item info dos
21945 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
21946 information about the target system and important OS structures.
21947
21948 @kindex sysinfo
21949 @cindex MS-DOS system info
21950 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
21951 @item info dos sysinfo
21952 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
21953 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
21954 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
21955
21956 @cindex GDT
21957 @cindex LDT
21958 @cindex IDT
21959 @cindex segment descriptor tables
21960 @cindex descriptor tables display
21961 @item info dos gdt
21962 @itemx info dos ldt
21963 @itemx info dos idt
21964 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
21965 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
21966 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
21967 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
21968 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
21969 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
21970 rights.
21971
21972 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
21973 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
21974 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
21975 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
21976 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
21977
21978 @cindex garbled pointers
21979 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
21980 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
21981 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
21982 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
21983 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
21984 debugged program's data segment:
21985
21986 @smallexample
21987 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
21988 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
21989 @end smallexample
21990
21991 @noindent
21992 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
21993 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
21994
21995 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
21996 @item info dos pde
21997 @itemx info dos pte
21998 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
21999 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22000 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22001 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22002 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22003 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22004 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22005 that is currently in use.
22006
22007 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22008 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22009 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22010 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22011 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22012 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22013 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22014
22015 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22016 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22017 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22018 controller.
22019
22020 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22021
22022 @cindex physical address from linear address
22023 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22024 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22025 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22026 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22027 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22028 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22029 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22030
22031 @smallexample
22032 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22033 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22034 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22035 @end smallexample
22036
22037 @noindent
22038 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22039 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22040 attributes of that page.
22041
22042 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22043 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22044 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22045 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22046 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22047 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22048
22049 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22050 transfer buffer:
22051
22052 @smallexample
22053 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22054 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22055 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22056 @end smallexample
22057
22058 @noindent
22059 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22060 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22061 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22062 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22063 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22064
22065 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22066 @end table
22067
22068 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22069 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22070 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22071 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22072
22073 @table @code
22074 @kindex set com1base
22075 @kindex set com1irq
22076 @kindex set com2base
22077 @kindex set com2irq
22078 @kindex set com3base
22079 @kindex set com3irq
22080 @kindex set com4base
22081 @kindex set com4irq
22082 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22083 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22084 port.
22085
22086 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22087 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22088 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22089
22090 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22091 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22092 other 3 COM ports.
22093
22094 @kindex show com1base
22095 @kindex show com1irq
22096 @kindex show com2base
22097 @kindex show com2irq
22098 @kindex show com3base
22099 @kindex show com3irq
22100 @kindex show com4base
22101 @kindex show com4irq
22102 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22103 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22104 lines used by the COM ports.
22105
22106 @item info serial
22107 @kindex info serial
22108 @cindex DOS serial port status
22109 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22110 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22111 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22112 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22113 @end table
22114
22115
22116 @node Cygwin Native
22117 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22118 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22119 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22120 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22121
22122 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22123 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22124
22125 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22126 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22127 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22128 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22129 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22130 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22131 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22132 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22133
22134 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22135 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22136 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22137
22138 @table @code
22139 @kindex info w32
22140 @item info w32
22141 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22142 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22143
22144 @item info w32 selector
22145 This command displays information returned by
22146 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22147 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22148 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22149 Without argument, this command displays information
22150 about the six segment registers.
22151
22152 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22153 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22154 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22155 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22156
22157 @kindex signal-event
22158 @item signal-event @var{id}
22159 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22160 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22161
22162 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22163 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22164 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22165 (for x86_64 versions):
22166
22167 @itemize @minus
22168 @item
22169 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22170 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22171 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22172
22173 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22174 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22175 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22176 to attach.
22177
22178 @item
22179 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22180 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22181 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22182 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22183 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22184 @end itemize
22185
22186 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22187 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22188 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22189 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22190 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22191 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22192 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22193 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22194 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22195 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22196 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22197
22198 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22199 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22200 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22201 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22202
22203 @kindex set new-console
22204 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22205 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22206 be started in a new console on next start.
22207 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22208 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22209
22210 @kindex show new-console
22211 @item show new-console
22212 Displays whether a new console is used
22213 when the debuggee is started.
22214
22215 @kindex set new-group
22216 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22217 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22218 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22219 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22220 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22221
22222 @kindex show new-group
22223 @item show new-group
22224 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22225
22226 @kindex set debugevents
22227 @item set debugevents
22228 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22229 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22230 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22231 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22232 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22233
22234 @kindex set debugexec
22235 @item set debugexec
22236 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22237 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22238
22239 @kindex set debugexceptions
22240 @item set debugexceptions
22241 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22242 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22243
22244 @kindex set debugmemory
22245 @item set debugmemory
22246 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22247 and writes by the debugger.
22248
22249 @kindex set shell
22250 @item set shell
22251 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22252 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22253
22254 @kindex show shell
22255 @item show shell
22256 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22257
22258 @end table
22259
22260 @menu
22261 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22262 @end menu
22263
22264 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22265 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22266 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22267 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22268
22269 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22270 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22271 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22272 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22273 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22274 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22275 ``minimal symbols''.
22276
22277 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22278 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22279 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22280 program run once to completion.
22281
22282 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22283
22284 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22285 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22286 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22287 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22288 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22289 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22290 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22291 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22292 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22293
22294 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22295 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22296 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22297 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22298 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22299 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22300
22301 @smallexample
22302 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22303 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22304
22305 Non-debugging symbols:
22306 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22307 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22308 @end smallexample
22309
22310 @smallexample
22311 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22312 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22313
22314 Non-debugging symbols:
22315 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22316 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22317 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22318 [etc...]
22319 @end smallexample
22320
22321 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22322
22323 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22324 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22325 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22326 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22327 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22328 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22329 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22330
22331 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22332 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22333 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22334 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22335 problem:
22336
22337 @smallexample
22338 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22339 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22340 @end smallexample
22341
22342 @smallexample
22343 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22344 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22345 @end smallexample
22346
22347 And two possible solutions:
22348
22349 @smallexample
22350 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22351 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22352 @end smallexample
22353
22354 @smallexample
22355 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22356 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22357 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22358 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22359 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22360 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22361 @end smallexample
22362
22363 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22364 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22365 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22366 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22367 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22368
22369 @smallexample
22370 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22371 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22372 @end smallexample
22373
22374 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22375 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22376 safe.
22377
22378 @node Hurd Native
22379 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22380 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22381
22382 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22383 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22384
22385 @table @code
22386 @item set signals
22387 @itemx set sigs
22388 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22389 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22390 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22391 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22392 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22393 @code{signals}.
22394
22395 @item show signals
22396 @itemx show sigs
22397 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22398 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22399 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22400
22401 @item set signal-thread
22402 @itemx set sigthread
22403 @kindex set signal-thread
22404 @kindex set sigthread
22405 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22406 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22407 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22408 signal-thread}.
22409
22410 @item show signal-thread
22411 @itemx show sigthread
22412 @kindex show signal-thread
22413 @kindex show sigthread
22414 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22415 delivered a signal.
22416
22417 @item set stopped
22418 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22419 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22420 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22421 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22422
22423 @item show stopped
22424 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22425 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22426 stopped.
22427
22428 @item set exceptions
22429 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22430 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22431 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22432 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22433 trapping on.
22434
22435 @item show exceptions
22436 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22437 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22438
22439 @item set task pause
22440 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22441 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22442 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22443 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22444 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22445 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22446 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22447 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22448 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22449
22450 @item show task pause
22451 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22452 Show the current state of task suspension.
22453
22454 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22455 @cindex task suspend count
22456 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22457 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22458 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22459
22460 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22461 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22462
22463 @item set task exception-port
22464 @itemx set task excp
22465 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22466 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22467 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22468 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22469
22470 @item set noninvasive
22471 @cindex noninvasive task options
22472 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22473 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22474 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22475 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22476
22477 @item info send-rights
22478 @itemx info receive-rights
22479 @itemx info port-rights
22480 @itemx info port-sets
22481 @itemx info dead-names
22482 @itemx info ports
22483 @itemx info psets
22484 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22485 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22486 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22487 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22488 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22489 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22490 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22491 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22492 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22493
22494 @item set thread pause
22495 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22496 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22497 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22498 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22499 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22500 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22501 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22502 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22503 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22504 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22505 only the current thread.
22506
22507 @item show thread pause
22508 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22509 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22510
22511 @item set thread run
22512 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22513
22514 @item show thread run
22515 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22516
22517 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22518 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22519 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22520 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22521 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22522 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22523 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22524
22525 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22526 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22527 detaching.
22528
22529 @item set thread exception-port
22530 @itemx set thread excp
22531 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22532 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22533 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22534
22535 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22536 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22537 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22538 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22539
22540 @item set thread default
22541 @itemx show thread default
22542 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22543 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22544 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22545 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22546 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22547 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22548 the non-default commands.
22549 @end table
22550
22551 @node Darwin
22552 @subsection Darwin
22553 @cindex Darwin
22554
22555 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22556
22557 @table @code
22558 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22559 @kindex set debug darwin
22560 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22561 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22562
22563 @item show debug darwin
22564 @kindex show debug darwin
22565 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22566
22567 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22568 @kindex set debug mach-o
22569 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22570 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22571 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22572 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22573 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22574 usage.
22575
22576 @item show debug mach-o
22577 @kindex show debug mach-o
22578 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22579
22580 @item set mach-exceptions on
22581 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22582 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22583 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22584 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22585 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22586 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22587
22588 @item show mach-exceptions
22589 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22590 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22591 @end table
22592
22593
22594 @node Embedded OS
22595 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22596
22597 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22598 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22599 architectures.
22600
22601 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22602 various real-time operating systems.
22603
22604 @node Embedded Processors
22605 @section Embedded Processors
22606
22607 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22608 configurations.
22609
22610 @cindex send command to simulator
22611 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22612 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22613
22614 @table @code
22615 @item sim @var{command}
22616 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22617 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22618 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22619 acceptable commands.
22620 @end table
22621
22622
22623 @menu
22624 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22625 * ARM:: ARM
22626 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22627 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22628 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22629 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
22630 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22631 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22632 * CRIS:: CRIS
22633 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22634 @end menu
22635
22636 @node ARC
22637 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22638 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22639 @cindex ARC specific commands
22640 @cindex ARC600
22641 @cindex ARC700
22642 @cindex ARC EM
22643 @cindex ARC HS
22644
22645 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
22646
22647 @table @code
22648 @item set debug arc
22649 @kindex set debug arc
22650 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
22651 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
22652
22653 @item show debug arc
22654 @kindex show debug arc
22655 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
22656
22657 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
22658 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
22659 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
22660
22661 @end table
22662
22663 @node ARM
22664 @subsection ARM
22665
22666 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
22667
22668 @table @code
22669 @item set arm disassembler
22670 @kindex set arm
22671 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
22672 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
22673
22674 @item show arm disassembler
22675 @kindex show arm
22676 Show the current disassembly style.
22677
22678 @item set arm apcs32
22679 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
22680 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
22681
22682 @item show arm apcs32
22683 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
22684
22685 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
22686 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
22687 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
22688
22689 @table @code
22690 @item auto
22691 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
22692 @item softfpa
22693 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
22694 processors.
22695 @item fpa
22696 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
22697 @item softvfp
22698 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
22699 @item vfp
22700 VFP co-processor.
22701 @end table
22702
22703 @item show arm fpu
22704 Show the current type of the FPU.
22705
22706 @item set arm abi
22707 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
22708
22709 @item show arm abi
22710 Show the currently used ABI.
22711
22712 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22713 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
22714 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
22715 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
22716 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
22717 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
22718 register).
22719
22720 @item show arm fallback-mode
22721 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
22722
22723 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
22724 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
22725 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
22726 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
22727 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
22728
22729 @item show arm force-mode
22730 Show the current forced instruction mode.
22731
22732 @item set debug arm
22733 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
22734 target support subsystem.
22735
22736 @item show debug arm
22737 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22738 @end table
22739
22740 @table @code
22741 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
22742 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
22743
22744 @table @code
22745 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
22746 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
22747 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
22748 The default value is @code{all}.
22749
22750 @table @code
22751 @item none
22752 @item demon
22753 @item angel
22754 @item redboot
22755 @item all
22756 @end table
22757 @end table
22758 @end table
22759
22760 @node M68K
22761 @subsection M68k
22762
22763 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
22764
22765 @node MicroBlaze
22766 @subsection MicroBlaze
22767 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
22768 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
22769
22770 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
22771 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
22772 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
22773 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
22774 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
22775 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
22776 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
22777 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
22778 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
22779 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
22780 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
22781
22782 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
22783
22784 @table @code
22785 @item target remote :1234
22786 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
22787 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
22788
22789 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
22790 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
22791 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
22792
22793 @item load
22794 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
22795
22796 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
22797 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
22798
22799 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
22800 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
22801 @end table
22802
22803 @node MIPS Embedded
22804 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
22805
22806 @noindent
22807 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
22808
22809 @table @code
22810 @item set mipsfpu double
22811 @itemx set mipsfpu single
22812 @itemx set mipsfpu none
22813 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
22814 @itemx show mipsfpu
22815 @kindex set mipsfpu
22816 @kindex show mipsfpu
22817 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
22818 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
22819 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
22820 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
22821 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
22822 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
22823 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
22824 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
22825 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
22826 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
22827 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
22828 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
22829 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
22830
22831 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
22832 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
22833 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
22834
22835 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
22836 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
22837 @end table
22838
22839 @node OpenRISC 1000
22840 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
22841 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
22842
22843 @noindent
22844 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
22845 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
22846 FPGA's.
22847
22848 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
22849 a target:
22850
22851 @table @code
22852
22853 @kindex target sim
22854 @item target sim
22855
22856 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
22857 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
22858 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
22859 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
22860
22861 Example: @code{target sim}
22862
22863 @item set debug or1k
22864 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
22865 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
22866
22867 @item show debug or1k
22868 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
22869 @end table
22870
22871 @node PowerPC Embedded
22872 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
22873
22874 @cindex DVC register
22875 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
22876 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
22877
22878 @smallexample
22879 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
22880 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
22881 @end smallexample
22882
22883 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
22884 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
22885 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
22886 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
22887 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
22888 or newer.
22889
22890 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
22891 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
22892 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
22893 watching variables of scalar types.
22894
22895 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
22896 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
22897
22898 @smallexample
22899 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
22900 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
22901 @end smallexample
22902
22903 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
22904 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
22905
22906 @cindex ranged breakpoint
22907 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
22908 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
22909 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
22910 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
22911 use the @code{break-range} command.
22912
22913 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
22914
22915 @table @code
22916 @kindex break-range
22917 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
22918 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
22919 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
22920 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
22921 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
22922 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
22923 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
22924 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
22925 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
22926
22927 @kindex set powerpc
22928 @item set powerpc soft-float
22929 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
22930 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
22931 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
22932 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22933
22934 @item set powerpc vector-abi
22935 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
22936 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
22937 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
22938 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
22939 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
22940 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
22941 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
22942
22943 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
22944 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
22945 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
22946 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
22947 address of its first byte.
22948
22949 @end table
22950
22951 @node AVR
22952 @subsection Atmel AVR
22953 @cindex AVR
22954
22955 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
22956 following AVR-specific commands:
22957
22958 @table @code
22959 @item info io_registers
22960 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
22961 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
22962 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
22963 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
22964 @end table
22965
22966 @node CRIS
22967 @subsection CRIS
22968 @cindex CRIS
22969
22970 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
22971 following CRIS-specific commands:
22972
22973 @table @code
22974 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
22975 @cindex CRIS version
22976 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
22977 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
22978 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
22979
22980 @item show cris-version
22981 Show the current CRIS version.
22982
22983 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
22984 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
22985 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
22986 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
22987 @code{R59}.
22988
22989 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
22990 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
22991
22992 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
22993 @cindex CRIS mode
22994 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
22995 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
22996 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
22997
22998 @item show cris-mode
22999 Show the current CRIS mode.
23000 @end table
23001
23002 @node Super-H
23003 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23004 @cindex Super-H
23005
23006 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23007 commands:
23008
23009 @table @code
23010 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23011 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23012 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23013 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23014 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23015 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23016 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23017 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23018 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23019 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23020 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23021 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23022
23023 @item show sh calling-convention
23024 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23025 Show the current calling convention setting.
23026
23027 @end table
23028
23029
23030 @node Architectures
23031 @section Architectures
23032
23033 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23034 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23035
23036 @menu
23037 * AArch64::
23038 * i386::
23039 * Alpha::
23040 * MIPS::
23041 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23042 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23043 * PowerPC::
23044 * Nios II::
23045 * Sparc64::
23046 @end menu
23047
23048 @node AArch64
23049 @subsection AArch64
23050 @cindex AArch64 support
23051
23052 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23053 following special commands:
23054
23055 @table @code
23056 @item set debug aarch64
23057 @kindex set debug aarch64
23058 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23059 messages are to be displayed.
23060
23061 @item show debug aarch64
23062 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23063
23064 @end table
23065
23066 @node i386
23067 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23068
23069 @table @code
23070 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23071 @kindex set struct-convention
23072 @cindex struct return convention
23073 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23074 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23075 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23076 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23077 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23078 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23079 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23080 be returned in a register.
23081
23082 @item show struct-convention
23083 @kindex show struct-convention
23084 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23085 from functions.
23086 @end table
23087
23088
23089 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23090 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23091
23092 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23093 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23094 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23095 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23096 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23097 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23098 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23099
23100 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23101 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23102 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23103 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23104 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23105 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23106
23107 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23108 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23109 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23110
23111 @smallexample
23112 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23113 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23114 @end smallexample
23115
23116 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23117 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23118 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23119 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23120 the pointer.
23121
23122 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23123 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23124 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23125 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23126 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23127
23128 @table @code
23129 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23130 @kindex show mpx bound
23131 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23132
23133 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23134 @kindex set mpx bound
23135 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23136 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23137 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23138 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23139 @end table
23140
23141 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23142 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23143 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23144 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23145
23146 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23147 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23148 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23149 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23150 function.
23151
23152 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23153 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23154 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23155 continuing the execution. For example:
23156
23157 @smallexample
23158 $ break *upper
23159 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23160 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23161 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23162 $ print $bnd0
23163 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23164 @end smallexample
23165
23166 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23167 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23168 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23169
23170 @node Alpha
23171 @subsection Alpha
23172
23173 See the following section.
23174
23175 @node MIPS
23176 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23177
23178 @cindex stack on Alpha
23179 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23180 @cindex Alpha stack
23181 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23182 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23183 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23184 find the beginning of a function.
23185
23186 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23187 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23188 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23189 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23190 commands:
23191
23192 @table @code
23193 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23194 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23195 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23196 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23197 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23198 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23199 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23200 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23201
23202 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23203 Display the current limit.
23204 @end table
23205
23206 @noindent
23207 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23208 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23209
23210 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23211 programs:
23212
23213 @table @code
23214 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23215 @kindex set mips abi
23216 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23217 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23218 values of @var{arg} are:
23219
23220 @table @samp
23221 @item auto
23222 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23223 default).
23224 @item o32
23225 @item o64
23226 @item n32
23227 @item n64
23228 @item eabi32
23229 @item eabi64
23230 @end table
23231
23232 @item show mips abi
23233 @kindex show mips abi
23234 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23235
23236 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23237 @kindex set mips compression
23238 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23239 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23240 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23241 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23242 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23243 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23244 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23245 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23246 provided by the executable.
23247
23248 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23249 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23250 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23251 identified as such.
23252
23253 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23254 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23255 implicitly from an executable.
23256
23257 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23258 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23259 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23260 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23261 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23262
23263 @item show mips compression
23264 @kindex show mips compression
23265 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23266 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23267
23268 @item set mipsfpu
23269 @itemx show mipsfpu
23270 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23271
23272 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23273 @kindex set mips mask-address
23274 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23275 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23276 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23277 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23278 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23279
23280 @item show mips mask-address
23281 @kindex show mips mask-address
23282 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23283 not.
23284
23285 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23286 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23287 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23288 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23289 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23290 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23291
23292 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23293 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23294 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23295
23296 @item set debug mips
23297 @kindex set debug mips
23298 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23299 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23300
23301 @item show debug mips
23302 @kindex show debug mips
23303 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23304 @end table
23305
23306
23307 @node HPPA
23308 @subsection HPPA
23309 @cindex HPPA support
23310
23311 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23312 following special commands:
23313
23314 @table @code
23315 @item set debug hppa
23316 @kindex set debug hppa
23317 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23318 messages are to be displayed.
23319
23320 @item show debug hppa
23321 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23322
23323 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23324 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23325 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23326 given @var{address}.
23327
23328 @end table
23329
23330
23331 @node SPU
23332 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23333 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23334 @cindex SPU
23335
23336 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23337 it provides the following special commands:
23338
23339 @table @code
23340 @item info spu event
23341 @kindex info spu
23342 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23343 and pending event status.
23344
23345 @item info spu signal
23346 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23347 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23348 notification channels.
23349
23350 @item info spu mailbox
23351 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23352 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23353 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23354
23355 @item info spu dma
23356 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23357 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23358 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23359
23360 @item info spu proxydma
23361 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23362 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23363 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23364
23365 @end table
23366
23367 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23368 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23369 special commands:
23370
23371 @table @code
23372 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23373 @kindex set spu
23374 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23375 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23376 function. The default is @code{off}.
23377
23378 @item show spu stop-on-load
23379 @kindex show spu
23380 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23381
23382 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23383 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23384 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23385 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23386 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23387 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23388
23389 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23390 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23391
23392 @end table
23393
23394 @node PowerPC
23395 @subsection PowerPC
23396 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23397
23398 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23399 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23400 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23401 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23402 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23403
23404 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23405 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23406 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23407
23408 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23409 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23410
23411 @node Nios II
23412 @subsection Nios II
23413 @cindex Nios II architecture
23414
23415 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23416 it provides the following special commands:
23417
23418 @table @code
23419
23420 @item set debug nios2
23421 @kindex set debug nios2
23422 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23423 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23424
23425 @item show debug nios2
23426 @kindex show debug nios2
23427 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23428 @end table
23429
23430 @node Sparc64
23431 @subsection Sparc64
23432 @cindex Sparc64 support
23433 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23434 @subsubsection ADI Support
23435
23436 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23437 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23438 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23439 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23440 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23441 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23442 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23443 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23444 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23445 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23446 signal.
23447
23448 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23449 ADI-enabled.
23450
23451 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23452 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23453
23454
23455 @table @code
23456 @kindex adi examine
23457 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23458
23459 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23460 cacheline.
23461
23462 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23463 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23464 block size, to display.
23465
23466 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23467 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23468
23469 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23470
23471 @smallexample
23472 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23473 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23474 @end smallexample
23475
23476 @kindex adi assign
23477 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23478
23479 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23480 to an address.
23481
23482 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23483 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23484 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23485
23486 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23487 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23488
23489 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23490
23491 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23492 variable "shmaddr":
23493
23494 @smallexample
23495 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23496 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23497 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23498 @end smallexample
23499
23500 @end table
23501
23502 @node Controlling GDB
23503 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23504
23505 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23506 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23507 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23508 described here.
23509
23510 @menu
23511 * Prompt:: Prompt
23512 * Editing:: Command editing
23513 * Command History:: Command history
23514 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23515 * Numbers:: Numbers
23516 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23517 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23518 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23519 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23520 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23521 @end menu
23522
23523 @node Prompt
23524 @section Prompt
23525
23526 @cindex prompt
23527
23528 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23529 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23530 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23531 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23532 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23533 which one you are talking to.
23534
23535 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23536 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23537 or a prompt that does not.
23538
23539 @table @code
23540 @kindex set prompt
23541 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23542 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23543
23544 @kindex show prompt
23545 @item show prompt
23546 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23547 @end table
23548
23549 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23550 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23551 are:
23552
23553 @table @code
23554 @kindex set extended-prompt
23555 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23556 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23557 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23558 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23559 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23560 is displayed.
23561
23562 For example:
23563
23564 @smallexample
23565 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23566 @end smallexample
23567
23568 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23569 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23570
23571 @kindex show extended-prompt
23572 @item show extended-prompt
23573 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23574 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23575 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23576 @end table
23577
23578 @node Editing
23579 @section Command Editing
23580 @cindex readline
23581 @cindex command line editing
23582
23583 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23584 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23585 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23586 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23587 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23588 debugging sessions.
23589
23590 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23591 command @code{set}.
23592
23593 @table @code
23594 @kindex set editing
23595 @cindex editing
23596 @item set editing
23597 @itemx set editing on
23598 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23599
23600 @item set editing off
23601 Disable command line editing.
23602
23603 @kindex show editing
23604 @item show editing
23605 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23606 @end table
23607
23608 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23609 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23610 @end ifset
23611 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23612 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23613 @end ifclear
23614 for more details about the Readline
23615 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23616 encouraged to read that chapter.
23617
23618 @node Command History
23619 @section Command History
23620 @cindex command history
23621
23622 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23623 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23624 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23625 history facility.
23626
23627 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23628 package, to provide the history facility.
23629 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23630 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23631 @end ifset
23632 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23633 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23634 @end ifclear
23635 for the detailed description of the History library.
23636
23637 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23638 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23639 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
23640 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
23641 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
23642 pressed on a line by itself.
23643
23644 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
23645 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
23646 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
23647 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
23648
23649 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
23650 history.
23651
23652 @table @code
23653 @cindex history substitution
23654 @cindex history file
23655 @kindex set history filename
23656 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
23657 @item set history filename @var{fname}
23658 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
23659 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
23660 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
23661 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
23662 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
23663 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
23664 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
23665 is not set.
23666
23667 @cindex save command history
23668 @kindex set history save
23669 @item set history save
23670 @itemx set history save on
23671 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
23672 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
23673
23674 @item set history save off
23675 Stop recording command history in a file.
23676
23677 @cindex history size
23678 @kindex set history size
23679 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
23680 @item set history size @var{size}
23681 @itemx set history size unlimited
23682 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
23683 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
23684 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
23685 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
23686 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
23687 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
23688
23689 @cindex remove duplicate history
23690 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
23691 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
23692 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
23693 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
23694 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
23695 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
23696 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
23697 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
23698 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
23699
23700 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
23701 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
23702
23703 @end table
23704
23705 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
23706 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23707 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
23708 @end ifset
23709 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23710 @xref{Event Designators},
23711 @end ifclear
23712 for more details.
23713
23714 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
23715 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
23716 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
23717 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
23718 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
23719 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
23720 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
23721 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
23722
23723 The commands to control history expansion are:
23724
23725 @table @code
23726 @item set history expansion on
23727 @itemx set history expansion
23728 @kindex set history expansion
23729 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
23730
23731 @item set history expansion off
23732 Disable history expansion.
23733
23734 @c @group
23735 @kindex show history
23736 @item show history
23737 @itemx show history filename
23738 @itemx show history save
23739 @itemx show history size
23740 @itemx show history expansion
23741 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
23742 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
23743 @c @end group
23744 @end table
23745
23746 @table @code
23747 @kindex show commands
23748 @cindex show last commands
23749 @cindex display command history
23750 @item show commands
23751 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
23752
23753 @item show commands @var{n}
23754 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
23755
23756 @item show commands +
23757 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
23758 @end table
23759
23760 @node Screen Size
23761 @section Screen Size
23762 @cindex size of screen
23763 @cindex screen size
23764 @cindex pagination
23765 @cindex page size
23766 @cindex pauses in output
23767
23768 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
23769 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
23770 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
23771 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
23772 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
23773 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
23774 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
23775 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
23776
23777 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
23778 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
23779 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
23780 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
23781 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
23782 width} commands:
23783
23784 @table @code
23785 @kindex set height
23786 @kindex set width
23787 @kindex show width
23788 @kindex show height
23789 @item set height @var{lpp}
23790 @itemx set height unlimited
23791 @itemx show height
23792 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
23793 @itemx set width unlimited
23794 @itemx show width
23795 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
23796 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
23797 commands display the current settings.
23798
23799 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
23800 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
23801 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
23802 buffer.
23803
23804 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
23805 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
23806
23807 @item set pagination on
23808 @itemx set pagination off
23809 @kindex set pagination
23810 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
23811 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
23812 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
23813 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
23814
23815 @item show pagination
23816 @kindex show pagination
23817 Show the current pagination mode.
23818 @end table
23819
23820 @node Numbers
23821 @section Numbers
23822 @cindex number representation
23823 @cindex entering numbers
23824
23825 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
23826 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
23827 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
23828 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
23829 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
23830 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
23831 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
23832 both input and output with the commands described below.
23833
23834 @table @code
23835 @kindex set input-radix
23836 @item set input-radix @var{base}
23837 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
23838 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23839 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
23840 example, any of
23841
23842 @smallexample
23843 set input-radix 012
23844 set input-radix 10.
23845 set input-radix 0xa
23846 @end smallexample
23847
23848 @noindent
23849 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
23850 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
23851 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
23852 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
23853 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
23854 change the radix.
23855
23856 @kindex set output-radix
23857 @item set output-radix @var{base}
23858 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
23859 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
23860 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
23861
23862 @kindex show input-radix
23863 @item show input-radix
23864 Display the current default base for numeric input.
23865
23866 @kindex show output-radix
23867 @item show output-radix
23868 Display the current default base for numeric display.
23869
23870 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
23871 @itemx show radix
23872 @kindex set radix
23873 @kindex show radix
23874 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
23875 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
23876 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
23877 default value of 10.
23878
23879 @end table
23880
23881 @node ABI
23882 @section Configuring the Current ABI
23883
23884 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
23885 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
23886 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
23887 current ABI.
23888
23889 @cindex OS ABI
23890 @kindex set osabi
23891 @kindex show osabi
23892 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
23893
23894 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
23895 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
23896 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
23897 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
23898 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
23899 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
23900 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
23901 platform provides.
23902
23903 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
23904 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
23905 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
23906 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
23907
23908 @table @code
23909 @item show osabi
23910 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
23911
23912 @item set osabi
23913 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
23914
23915 @item set osabi @var{abi}
23916 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
23917 @end table
23918
23919 @cindex float promotion
23920
23921 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
23922 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
23923 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
23924 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
23925 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
23926 @code{double} and then passed.
23927
23928 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
23929 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
23930 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
23931
23932 @table @code
23933 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
23934 @item set coerce-float-to-double
23935 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
23936 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
23937 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
23938
23939 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
23940 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
23941 functions.
23942
23943 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
23944 @item show coerce-float-to-double
23945 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
23946 @end table
23947
23948 @kindex set cp-abi
23949 @kindex show cp-abi
23950 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
23951 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
23952 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
23953 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
23954 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
23955 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
23956 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
23957 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
23958 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
23959 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
23960 ``auto''.
23961
23962 @table @code
23963 @item show cp-abi
23964 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
23965
23966 @item set cp-abi
23967 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
23968
23969 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
23970 @itemx set cp-abi auto
23971 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
23972 @end table
23973
23974 @node Auto-loading
23975 @section Automatically loading associated files
23976 @cindex auto-loading
23977
23978 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
23979 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
23980 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
23981 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
23982 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
23983 sources).
23984
23985 @menu
23986 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23987 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
23988
23989 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
23990 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
23991 @end menu
23992
23993 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
23994 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
23995 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
23996
23997 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
23998 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
23999 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24000
24001 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24002 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24003
24004 @table @code
24005 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24006 @kindex set auto-load off
24007 @item set auto-load off
24008 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24009 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24010 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24011 @smallexample
24012 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24013 @end smallexample
24014
24015 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24016 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24017 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24018 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24019 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24020 @code{set auto-load no}.
24021
24022 @anchor{show auto-load}
24023 @kindex show auto-load
24024 @item show auto-load
24025 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24026 or disabled.
24027
24028 @smallexample
24029 (gdb) show auto-load
24030 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24031 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24032 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24033 is on.
24034 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24035 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24036 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24037 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24038 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24039 @end smallexample
24040
24041 @anchor{info auto-load}
24042 @kindex info auto-load
24043 @item info auto-load
24044 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24045 not.
24046
24047 @smallexample
24048 (gdb) info auto-load
24049 gdb-scripts:
24050 Loaded Script
24051 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24052 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24053 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24054 loaded.
24055 python-scripts:
24056 Loaded Script
24057 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24058 @end smallexample
24059 @end table
24060
24061 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24062
24063 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24064 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24065 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24066 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24067 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24068 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24069 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24070 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24071 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24072 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24073 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24074 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24075 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24076 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24077 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24078 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24079 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24080 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24081 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24082 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24083 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24084 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24085 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24086 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24087 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24088 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24089 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24090 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24091 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24092 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24093 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24094 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24095 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24096 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24097 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24098 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24099 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24100 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24101 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24102 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24103 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24104 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24105 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24106 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24107 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24108 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24109 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24110 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24111 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24112 @end multitable
24113
24114 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24115 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24116 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24117
24118 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24119 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24120 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24121
24122 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24123 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24124
24125 @table @code
24126 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24127 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24128 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24129 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24130 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24131
24132 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24133 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24134 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24135 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24136 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24137
24138 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24139 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24140 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24141 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24142 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24143 @end table
24144
24145 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24146 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24147 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24148
24149 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24150
24151 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24152 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24153
24154 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24155 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24156 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24157 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24158 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24159 library.
24160
24161 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24162 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24163
24164 @table @code
24165 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24166 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24167 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24168 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24169
24170 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24171 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24172 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24173 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24174 enabled or disabled.
24175
24176 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24177 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24178 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24179 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24180 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24181 @end table
24182
24183 @node Auto-loading safe path
24184 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24185 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24186
24187 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24188 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24189 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24190 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24191 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24192
24193 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24194 get loaded:
24195
24196 @smallexample
24197 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24198 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24199 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24200 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24201 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24202 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24203 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24204 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24205 @end smallexample
24206
24207 @noindent
24208 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24209 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24210
24211 @smallexample
24212 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24213 @end smallexample
24214
24215 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24216
24217 @table @code
24218 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24219 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24220 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24221 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24222 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24223 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24224 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24225 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24226 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24227 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24228
24229 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24230 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24231 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24232
24233 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24234 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24235 @item show auto-load safe-path
24236 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24237 scripts.
24238
24239 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24240 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24241 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24242 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24243 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24244 by the host platform path separator in use.
24245 @end table
24246
24247 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24248 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24249 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24250 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24251 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24252
24253 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24254 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24255 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24256 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24257 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24258 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24259 init file in the current directory
24260 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24261
24262 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24263 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24264
24265 @table @asis
24266 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24267 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24268 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24269 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24270
24271 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24272 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24273 @value{GDBN} session.
24274
24275 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24276 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24277 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24278 from trusted sources.
24279
24280 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24281 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24282 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24283 trusted sources.
24284 @end table
24285
24286 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24287 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24288
24289 @table @asis
24290 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24291 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24292
24293 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24294 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24295 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24296 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24297 @end table
24298
24299 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24300 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24301 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24302 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24303 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24304 recommended to be entered.
24305
24306 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24307 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24308 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24309
24310 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24311 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24312 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24313 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24314 be printed.
24315
24316 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24317 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24318 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24319
24320 @smallexample
24321 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24322 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24323 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24324 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24325 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24326 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24327 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24328 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24329 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24330 @end smallexample
24331
24332 @table @code
24333 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24334 @kindex set debug auto-load
24335 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24336 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24337
24338 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24339 @kindex show debug auto-load
24340 @item show debug auto-load
24341 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24342 on or off.
24343 @end table
24344
24345 @node Messages/Warnings
24346 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24347
24348 @cindex verbose operation
24349 @cindex optional warnings
24350 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24351 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24352 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24353 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24354
24355 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24356 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24357 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24358
24359 @table @code
24360 @kindex set verbose
24361 @item set verbose on
24362 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24363
24364 @item set verbose off
24365 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24366
24367 @kindex show verbose
24368 @item show verbose
24369 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24370 @end table
24371
24372 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24373 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24374 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24375 Symbol Files}).
24376
24377 @table @code
24378
24379 @kindex set complaints
24380 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24381 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24382 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24383 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24384 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24385
24386 @kindex show complaints
24387 @item show complaints
24388 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24389
24390 @end table
24391
24392 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24393 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24394 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24395 you try to run a program which is already running:
24396
24397 @smallexample
24398 (@value{GDBP}) run
24399 The program being debugged has been started already.
24400 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24401 @end smallexample
24402
24403 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24404 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24405
24406 @table @code
24407
24408 @kindex set confirm
24409 @cindex flinching
24410 @cindex confirmation
24411 @cindex stupid questions
24412 @item set confirm off
24413 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24414 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24415 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24416
24417 @item set confirm on
24418 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24419
24420 @kindex show confirm
24421 @item show confirm
24422 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24423
24424 @end table
24425
24426 @cindex command tracing
24427 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24428 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24429 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24430 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24431
24432 @table @code
24433 @kindex set trace-commands
24434 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24435 @item set trace-commands on
24436 Enable command tracing.
24437 @item set trace-commands off
24438 Disable command tracing.
24439 @item show trace-commands
24440 Display the current state of command tracing.
24441 @end table
24442
24443 @node Debugging Output
24444 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24445 @cindex optional debugging messages
24446
24447 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24448 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24449 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24450 section documents those commands.
24451
24452 @table @code
24453 @kindex set exec-done-display
24454 @item set exec-done-display
24455 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24456 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24457 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24458 @kindex show exec-done-display
24459 @item show exec-done-display
24460 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24461 notification.
24462 @kindex set debug
24463 @cindex ARM AArch64
24464 @item set debug aarch64
24465 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24466 The default is off.
24467 @kindex show debug
24468 @item show debug aarch64
24469 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24470 ARM AArch64.
24471 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24472 @cindex architecture debugging info
24473 @item set debug arch
24474 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24475 @item show debug arch
24476 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24477 @item set debug aix-solib
24478 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24479 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24480 support module. The default is off.
24481 @item show debug aix-thread
24482 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24483 @item set debug aix-thread
24484 @cindex AIX threads
24485 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24486 module.
24487 @item show debug aix-thread
24488 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24489 @item set debug check-physname
24490 @cindex physname
24491 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24492 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24493 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24494 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24495 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24496 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24497 @item show debug check-physname
24498 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24499 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24500 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24501 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24502 exported symbols. The default is off.
24503 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24504 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24505 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24506 @item set debug dwarf-die
24507 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24508 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24509 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24510 A value of zero turns off the display.
24511 @item show debug dwarf-die
24512 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24513 @item set debug dwarf-line
24514 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24515 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24516 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24517 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24518 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24519 @item show debug dwarf-line
24520 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24521 @item set debug dwarf-read
24522 @cindex DWARF Reading
24523 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24524 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24525 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24526 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24527 @item show debug dwarf-read
24528 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24529 @item set debug displaced
24530 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24531 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24532 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24533 @item show debug displaced
24534 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24535 related to displaced stepping.
24536 @item set debug event
24537 @cindex event debugging info
24538 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24539 default is off.
24540 @item show debug event
24541 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24542 info.
24543 @item set debug expression
24544 @cindex expression debugging info
24545 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24546 expression parsing. The default is off.
24547 @item show debug expression
24548 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24549 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24550 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24551 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24552 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24553 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24554 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24555 @item set debug fbsd-nat
24556 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
24557 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
24558 @item show debug fbsd-nat
24559 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
24560 @item set debug frame
24561 @cindex frame debugging info
24562 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24563 default is off.
24564 @item show debug frame
24565 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24566 info.
24567 @item set debug gnu-nat
24568 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24569 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24570 @item show debug gnu-nat
24571 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24572 @item set debug infrun
24573 @cindex inferior debugging info
24574 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24575 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24576 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24577 @item show debug infrun
24578 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24579 @item set debug jit
24580 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24581 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24582 @item show debug jit
24583 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24584 @item set debug lin-lwp
24585 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24586 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24587 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24588 @item show debug lin-lwp
24589 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24590 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24591 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24592 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24593 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24594 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24595 @item set debug mach-o
24596 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24597 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24598 processing. The default is off.
24599 @item show debug mach-o
24600 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24601 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24602 @item set debug notification
24603 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24604 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24605 The default is off.
24606 @item show debug notification
24607 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24608 @item set debug observer
24609 @cindex observer debugging info
24610 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24611 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24612 @item show debug observer
24613 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24614 @item set debug overload
24615 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24616 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24617 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24618 is off.
24619 @item show debug overload
24620 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24621 debugging info.
24622 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24623 @cindex debug expression parser
24624 @item set debug parser
24625 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24626 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24627 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24628 details. The default is off.
24629 @item show debug parser
24630 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24631 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24632 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24633 @cindex debug remote protocol
24634 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24635 @cindex display remote packets
24636 @item set debug remote
24637 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
24638 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
24639 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
24640 @item show debug remote
24641 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
24642
24643 @item set debug separate-debug-file
24644 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
24645 @item show debug separate-debug-file
24646 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
24647
24648 @item set debug serial
24649 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
24650 default is off.
24651 @item show debug serial
24652 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
24653 info.
24654 @item set debug solib-frv
24655 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
24656 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
24657 @item show debug solib-frv
24658 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
24659 messages.
24660 @item set debug symbol-lookup
24661 @cindex symbol lookup
24662 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
24663 The default is 0 (off).
24664 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24665 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24666 @item show debug symbol-lookup
24667 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
24668 @item set debug symfile
24669 @cindex symbol file functions
24670 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
24671 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
24672 @item show debug symfile
24673 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
24674 @item set debug symtab-create
24675 @cindex symbol table creation
24676 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
24677 The default is 0 (off).
24678 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24679 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24680 @item show debug symtab-create
24681 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
24682 @item set debug target
24683 @cindex target debugging info
24684 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
24685 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
24686 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
24687 value of large memory transfers.
24688 @item show debug target
24689 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
24690 info.
24691 @item set debug timestamp
24692 @cindex timestampping debugging info
24693 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
24694 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
24695 message.
24696 @item show debug timestamp
24697 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
24698 debugging info.
24699 @item set debug varobj
24700 @cindex variable object debugging info
24701 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
24702 info. The default is off.
24703 @item show debug varobj
24704 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
24705 debugging info.
24706 @item set debug xml
24707 @cindex XML parser debugging
24708 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
24709 @item show debug xml
24710 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
24711 @end table
24712
24713 @node Other Misc Settings
24714 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
24715 @cindex miscellaneous settings
24716
24717 @table @code
24718 @kindex set interactive-mode
24719 @item set interactive-mode
24720 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
24721 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
24722 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
24723 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
24724 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
24725 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
24726 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
24727 is, non-interactively otherwise.
24728
24729 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
24730 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
24731 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
24732 inside a cygwin window.
24733
24734 @kindex show interactive-mode
24735 @item show interactive-mode
24736 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
24737 @end table
24738
24739 @node Extending GDB
24740 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
24741 @cindex extending GDB
24742
24743 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
24744 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
24745 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
24746 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
24747 being debugged.
24748
24749 @menu
24750 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
24751 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
24752 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
24753 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
24754 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
24755 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
24756 @end menu
24757
24758 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
24759 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
24760 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
24761 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
24762 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24763 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
24764
24765 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
24766 setting:
24767
24768 @table @code
24769 @kindex set script-extension
24770 @kindex show script-extension
24771 @item set script-extension off
24772 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
24773
24774 @item set script-extension soft
24775 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24776 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
24777 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
24778 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
24779
24780 @item set script-extension strict
24781 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
24782 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
24783 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
24784
24785 @item show script-extension
24786 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
24787
24788 @end table
24789
24790 @node Sequences
24791 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
24792
24793 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
24794 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
24795 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
24796 files.
24797
24798 @menu
24799 * Define:: How to define your own commands
24800 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
24801 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
24802 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
24803 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
24804 @end menu
24805
24806 @node Define
24807 @subsection User-defined Commands
24808
24809 @cindex user-defined command
24810 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
24811 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
24812 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
24813 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
24814 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
24815 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
24816
24817 @smallexample
24818 define adder
24819 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24820 end
24821 @end smallexample
24822
24823 @noindent
24824 To execute the command use:
24825
24826 @smallexample
24827 adder 1 2 3
24828 @end smallexample
24829
24830 @noindent
24831 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
24832 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
24833 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
24834 functions calls.
24835
24836 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
24837 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
24838 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
24839 been passed.
24840
24841 @smallexample
24842 define adder
24843 if $argc == 2
24844 print $arg0 + $arg1
24845 end
24846 if $argc == 3
24847 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
24848 end
24849 end
24850 @end smallexample
24851
24852 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
24853 to process a variable number of arguments:
24854
24855 @smallexample
24856 define adder
24857 set $i = 0
24858 set $sum = 0
24859 while $i < $argc
24860 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
24861 set $i = $i + 1
24862 end
24863 print $sum
24864 end
24865 @end smallexample
24866
24867 @table @code
24868
24869 @kindex define
24870 @item define @var{commandname}
24871 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
24872 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
24873 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
24874 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
24875 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
24876 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
24877
24878 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
24879 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
24880 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
24881
24882 @kindex document
24883 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
24884 @item document @var{commandname}
24885 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
24886 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
24887 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
24888 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
24889 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
24890 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
24891
24892 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
24893 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
24894 does not change the documentation.
24895
24896 @kindex dont-repeat
24897 @cindex don't repeat command
24898 @item dont-repeat
24899 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
24900 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
24901 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
24902
24903 @kindex help user-defined
24904 @item help user-defined
24905 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
24906 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
24907 included (if any).
24908
24909 @kindex show user
24910 @item show user
24911 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
24912 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
24913 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
24914 definitions for all user-defined commands.
24915 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
24916
24917 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
24918 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
24919 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
24920 @item show max-user-call-depth
24921 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
24922 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
24923 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
24924 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
24925 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
24926 @end table
24927
24928 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
24929 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
24930
24931 When user-defined commands are executed, the
24932 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
24933 stops execution of the user-defined command.
24934
24935 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
24936 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
24937 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
24938 messages when used in a user-defined command.
24939
24940 @node Hooks
24941 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
24942 @cindex command hooks
24943 @cindex hooks, for commands
24944 @cindex hooks, pre-command
24945
24946 @kindex hook
24947 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
24948 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
24949 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
24950 before that command.
24951
24952 @cindex hooks, post-command
24953 @kindex hookpost
24954 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
24955 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
24956 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
24957 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
24958 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
24959
24960 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
24961 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
24962
24963 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
24964 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
24965
24966 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
24967 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
24968 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
24969 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
24970 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
24971
24972 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
24973 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
24974 you could define:
24975
24976 @smallexample
24977 define hook-stop
24978 handle SIGALRM nopass
24979 end
24980
24981 define hook-run
24982 handle SIGALRM pass
24983 end
24984
24985 define hook-continue
24986 handle SIGALRM pass
24987 end
24988 @end smallexample
24989
24990 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
24991 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
24992 you could define:
24993
24994 @smallexample
24995 define hook-echo
24996 echo <<<---
24997 end
24998
24999 define hookpost-echo
25000 echo --->>>\n
25001 end
25002
25003 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25004 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25005 (@value{GDBP})
25006
25007 @end smallexample
25008
25009 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25010 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25011 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25012 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25013 @c or not?
25014 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25015 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25016 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25017
25018 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25019 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25020 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25021
25022 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25023 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25024
25025 @node Command Files
25026 @subsection Command Files
25027
25028 @cindex command files
25029 @cindex scripting commands
25030 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25031 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25032 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25033 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25034 terminal.
25035
25036 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25037 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25038 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25039 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25040 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25041
25042 @table @code
25043 @kindex source
25044 @cindex execute commands from a file
25045 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25046 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25047 @end table
25048
25049 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25050 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25051 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25052 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25053 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25054
25055 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25056 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25057 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25058 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25059 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25060 is not relevant to scripts.
25061
25062 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25063 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25064 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25065 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25066 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25067 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25068 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25069 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25070 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25071 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25072 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25073 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25074 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25075 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25076
25077 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25078 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25079 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25080
25081 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25082 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25083 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25084 when called from command files.
25085
25086 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25087 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25088 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25089 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25090 the next command.
25091
25092 @smallexample
25093 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25094 @end smallexample
25095
25096 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25097 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25098 would be directed to @file{log}.
25099
25100 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25101 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25102 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25103 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25104 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25105 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25106 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25107 conditionally, etc.
25108
25109 @table @code
25110 @kindex if
25111 @kindex else
25112 @item if
25113 @itemx else
25114 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25115 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25116 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25117 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25118 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25119 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25120 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25121
25122 @kindex while
25123 @item while
25124 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25125 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25126 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25127 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25128 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25129 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25130
25131 @kindex loop_break
25132 @item loop_break
25133 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25134 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25135 line.
25136
25137 @kindex loop_continue
25138 @item loop_continue
25139 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25140 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25141 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25142 the controlling expression.
25143
25144 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25145 @item end
25146 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25147 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25148 @end table
25149
25150
25151 @node Output
25152 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25153
25154 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25155 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25156 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25157 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25158 want.
25159
25160 @table @code
25161 @kindex echo
25162 @item echo @var{text}
25163 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25164 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25165 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25166 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25167 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25168 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25169 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25170 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25171 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25172 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25173 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25174
25175 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25176 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25177
25178 @smallexample
25179 echo This is some text\n\
25180 which is continued\n\
25181 onto several lines.\n
25182 @end smallexample
25183
25184 produces the same output as
25185
25186 @smallexample
25187 echo This is some text\n
25188 echo which is continued\n
25189 echo onto several lines.\n
25190 @end smallexample
25191
25192 @kindex output
25193 @item output @var{expression}
25194 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25195 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25196 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25197 on expressions.
25198
25199 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25200 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25201 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25202 Formats}, for more information.
25203
25204 @kindex printf
25205 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25206 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25207 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25208 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25209 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25210 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25211 executing the code below:
25212
25213 @smallexample
25214 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25215 @end smallexample
25216
25217 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25218 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25219 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25220 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25221 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25222 printed.
25223
25224 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25225
25226 @smallexample
25227 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25228 @end smallexample
25229
25230 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25231 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25232 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25233
25234 @itemize @bullet
25235 @item
25236 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25237
25238 @item
25239 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25240 width.
25241
25242 @item
25243 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25244 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25245
25246 @item
25247 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25248 supported.
25249
25250 @item
25251 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25252
25253 @item
25254 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25255 @end itemize
25256
25257 @noindent
25258 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25259 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25260 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25261 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25262
25263 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25264 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25265 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25266 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25267 supported.
25268
25269 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25270 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25271 together with a floating point specifier.
25272 letters:
25273
25274 @itemize @bullet
25275 @item
25276 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25277
25278 @item
25279 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25280
25281 @item
25282 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25283 @end itemize
25284
25285 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25286 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25287 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25288
25289 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25290 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25291
25292 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25293 @smallexample
25294 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25295 @end smallexample
25296
25297 @anchor{eval}
25298 @kindex eval
25299 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25300 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25301 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25302
25303 @end table
25304
25305 @node Auto-loading sequences
25306 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25307 @cindex native script auto-loading
25308
25309 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25310 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25311 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25312 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25313
25314 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25315 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25316
25317 @table @code
25318 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25319 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25320 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25321 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25322
25323 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25324 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25325 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25326 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25327 disabled.
25328
25329 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25330 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25331 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25332 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25333 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25334 auto-loaded.
25335 @end table
25336
25337 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25338 matching names are printed.
25339
25340 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25341 @include python.texi
25342
25343 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25344 @include guile.texi
25345
25346 @node Auto-loading extensions
25347 @section Auto-loading extensions
25348 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25349
25350 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25351 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25352 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25353 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25354 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25355
25356 @menu
25357 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25358 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25359 * Which flavor to choose?::
25360 @end menu
25361
25362 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25363 debugging commands and features.
25364
25365 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25366 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25367 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25368 for more information.
25369 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25370 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25371
25372 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25373 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25374
25375 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25376 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25377 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25378 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25379 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25380
25381 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25382 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25383 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25384 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25385
25386 @table @code
25387 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25388 GDB's own command language
25389 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25390 Python
25391 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25392 Guile
25393 @end table
25394
25395 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25396 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25397 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25398 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25399 script in the specified extension language.
25400
25401 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25402 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25403
25404 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25405 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25406
25407 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25408 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25409 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25410 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25411 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25412 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25413
25414 @table @code
25415 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25416 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25417 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25418 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25419 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25420 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25421
25422 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25423 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25424
25425 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25426 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25427 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25428 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25429
25430 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25431 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25432 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25433 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25434 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25435 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25436 platform.
25437
25438 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25439 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25440 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25441
25442 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25443 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25444 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25445 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25446
25447 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25448 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25449 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25450 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25451 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25452 @end table
25453
25454 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25455 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25456 @var{objfile} is opened.
25457 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25458 is evaluated more than once.
25459
25460 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25461 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25462 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25463
25464 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25465 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25466 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25467 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25468 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25469 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25470 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25471
25472 The following entries are supported:
25473
25474 @table @code
25475 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25476 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25477 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25478 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25479 @end table
25480
25481 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25482
25483 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25484 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25485 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25486 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25487 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25488
25489 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25490 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25491
25492 @example
25493 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25494 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25495 asm("\
25496 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25497 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25498 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25499 .popsection \n\
25500 ");
25501 @end example
25502
25503 @noindent
25504 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25505 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25506
25507 @example
25508 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25509 @end example
25510
25511 The script name may include directories if desired.
25512
25513 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25514 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25515
25516 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25517 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25518 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25519 will remove duplicates.
25520
25521 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25522
25523 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25524 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25525 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25526 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25527 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25528 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25529 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25530 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25531 on its name.
25532
25533 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25534 testsuite.
25535
25536 @example
25537 #include "symcat.h"
25538 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25539 asm(
25540 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25541 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25542 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25543 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25544 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25545 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25546 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25547 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25548 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25549 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25550 ".byte 0\n"
25551 ".popsection\n"
25552 );
25553 @end example
25554
25555 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25556 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25557 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25558 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25559
25560 @node Which flavor to choose?
25561 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25562
25563 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25564 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25565
25566 @noindent
25567 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25568
25569 @itemize @bullet
25570 @item
25571 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25572
25573 @item
25574 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25575
25576 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25577 in the source search path.
25578 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25579 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25580
25581 @item
25582 Doesn't require source code additions.
25583 @end itemize
25584
25585 @noindent
25586 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25587
25588 @itemize @bullet
25589 @item
25590 Works with static linking.
25591
25592 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25593 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25594 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25595 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25596 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25597
25598 @item
25599 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25600
25601 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25602 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25603
25604 @item
25605 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25606
25607 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25608 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25609 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25610 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25611 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25612 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25613 @end itemize
25614
25615 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25616 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25617
25618 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25619 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25620 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25621
25622 @subsection Python comes first
25623
25624 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25625 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25626 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25627 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25628 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25629 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25630 pretty-printed form of a value).
25631 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25632 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25633 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25634
25635 @node Aliases
25636 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25637 @cindex aliases for commands
25638
25639 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
25640 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
25641 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
25642 that involves less typing.
25643
25644 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
25645 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
25646 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
25647
25648 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
25649 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
25650 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
25651
25652 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
25653
25654 @table @code
25655
25656 @kindex alias
25657 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
25658
25659 @end table
25660
25661 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
25662 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
25663 underscores.
25664
25665 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
25666 that is being aliased.
25667
25668 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
25669 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
25670 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
25671
25672 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
25673 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
25674
25675 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
25676 of a command so that there is less to type.
25677 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
25678 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
25679 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
25680 The following will accomplish this.
25681
25682 @smallexample
25683 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
25684 @end smallexample
25685
25686 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
25687 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
25688 for it with the @samp{document} command.
25689 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
25690
25691 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
25692 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
25693 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
25694 of a command.
25695
25696 @smallexample
25697 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
25698 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
25699 (gdb) set p elms 20
25700 (gdb) show p elms
25701 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
25702 @end smallexample
25703
25704 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
25705 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
25706 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
25707
25708 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
25709 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
25710
25711 @smallexample
25712 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
25713 @end smallexample
25714
25715 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
25716 alias for a more complex command.
25717 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
25718
25719 @smallexample
25720 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
25721 (gdb) spe 20
25722 @end smallexample
25723
25724 @node Interpreters
25725 @chapter Command Interpreters
25726 @cindex command interpreters
25727
25728 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
25729 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
25730 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
25731
25732 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
25733 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
25734 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
25735 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
25736
25737 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
25738 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
25739 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
25740 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
25741
25742 @table @code
25743 @item console
25744 @cindex console interpreter
25745 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
25746 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
25747 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
25748
25749 @item mi
25750 @cindex mi interpreter
25751 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
25752 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
25753 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
25754 Interface}.
25755
25756 @item mi2
25757 @cindex mi2 interpreter
25758 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
25759
25760 @item mi1
25761 @cindex mi1 interpreter
25762 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
25763
25764 @end table
25765
25766 @cindex invoke another interpreter
25767
25768 @kindex interpreter-exec
25769 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
25770 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
25771 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
25772
25773 @smallexample
25774 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
25775 @end smallexample
25776
25777 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
25778 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
25779
25780 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
25781 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
25782 permanently.
25783
25784 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
25785
25786 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
25787 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
25788 device (usually a tty).
25789
25790 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
25791 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
25792 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
25793 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
25794 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
25795 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
25796 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
25797 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
25798 the separate MI interpreter.
25799
25800 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
25801 @code{new-ui} command:
25802
25803 @kindex new-ui
25804 @cindex new user interface
25805 @smallexample
25806 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
25807 @end smallexample
25808
25809 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
25810 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
25811 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
25812 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
25813 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
25814 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
25815
25816 @smallexample
25817 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
25818 @end smallexample
25819
25820 @noindent
25821 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
25822
25823 @node TUI
25824 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
25825 @cindex TUI
25826 @cindex Text User Interface
25827
25828 @menu
25829 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
25830 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
25831 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
25832 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
25833 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
25834 @end menu
25835
25836 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
25837 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
25838 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
25839 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
25840 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
25841 is available.
25842
25843 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
25844 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
25845 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
25846 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
25847 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
25848 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
25849
25850 @node TUI Overview
25851 @section TUI Overview
25852
25853 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
25854
25855 @table @emph
25856 @item command
25857 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
25858 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
25859 managed using readline.
25860
25861 @item source
25862 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
25863 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
25864
25865 @item assembly
25866 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
25867
25868 @item register
25869 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
25870 when their values change.
25871 @end table
25872
25873 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
25874 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
25875 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
25876 indicates the breakpoint type:
25877
25878 @table @code
25879 @item B
25880 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25881
25882 @item b
25883 Breakpoint which was never hit.
25884
25885 @item H
25886 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
25887
25888 @item h
25889 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
25890 @end table
25891
25892 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
25893
25894 @table @code
25895 @item +
25896 Breakpoint is enabled.
25897
25898 @item -
25899 Breakpoint is disabled.
25900 @end table
25901
25902 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
25903 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
25904 changes.
25905
25906 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
25907 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
25908 layouts:
25909
25910 @itemize @bullet
25911 @item
25912 source only,
25913
25914 @item
25915 assembly only,
25916
25917 @item
25918 source and assembly,
25919
25920 @item
25921 source and registers, or
25922
25923 @item
25924 assembly and registers.
25925 @end itemize
25926
25927 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
25928
25929 @table @emph
25930 @item target
25931 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
25932 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
25933
25934 @item process
25935 Gives the current process or thread number.
25936 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
25937
25938 @item function
25939 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
25940 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
25941 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
25942 the string @code{??} is displayed.
25943
25944 @item line
25945 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
25946 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
25947
25948 @item pc
25949 Indicates the current program counter address.
25950 @end table
25951
25952 @node TUI Keys
25953 @section TUI Key Bindings
25954 @cindex TUI key bindings
25955
25956 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
25957 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25958 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
25959 @end ifset
25960 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25961 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
25962 @end ifclear
25963 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
25964 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
25965
25966 @table @kbd
25967 @kindex C-x C-a
25968 @item C-x C-a
25969 @kindex C-x a
25970 @itemx C-x a
25971 @kindex C-x A
25972 @itemx C-x A
25973 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
25974 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
25975 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
25976 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
25977 The screen is then refreshed.
25978
25979 @kindex C-x 1
25980 @item C-x 1
25981 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
25982 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
25983 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
25984
25985 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
25986
25987 @kindex C-x 2
25988 @item C-x 2
25989 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
25990 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
25991 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
25992 previous layout and the new one.
25993
25994 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
25995
25996 @kindex C-x o
25997 @item C-x o
25998 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
25999 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26000 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26001
26002 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26003
26004 @kindex C-x s
26005 @item C-x s
26006 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26007 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26008 @end table
26009
26010 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26011
26012 @table @asis
26013 @kindex PgUp
26014 @item @key{PgUp}
26015 Scroll the active window one page up.
26016
26017 @kindex PgDn
26018 @item @key{PgDn}
26019 Scroll the active window one page down.
26020
26021 @kindex Up
26022 @item @key{Up}
26023 Scroll the active window one line up.
26024
26025 @kindex Down
26026 @item @key{Down}
26027 Scroll the active window one line down.
26028
26029 @kindex Left
26030 @item @key{Left}
26031 Scroll the active window one column left.
26032
26033 @kindex Right
26034 @item @key{Right}
26035 Scroll the active window one column right.
26036
26037 @kindex C-L
26038 @item @kbd{C-L}
26039 Refresh the screen.
26040 @end table
26041
26042 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26043 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26044 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26045 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26046 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26047
26048 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26049 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26050 @cindex TUI single key mode
26051
26052 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26053 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26054 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26055
26056 @table @kbd
26057 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26058 @item c
26059 continue
26060
26061 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26062 @item d
26063 down
26064
26065 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26066 @item f
26067 finish
26068
26069 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26070 @item n
26071 next
26072
26073 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26074 @item o
26075 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26076
26077 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26078 @item q
26079 exit the SingleKey mode.
26080
26081 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26082 @item r
26083 run
26084
26085 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26086 @item s
26087 step
26088
26089 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26090 @item i
26091 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26092
26093 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26094 @item u
26095 up
26096
26097 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26098 @item v
26099 info locals
26100
26101 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26102 @item w
26103 where
26104 @end table
26105
26106 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26107 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26108 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26109 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26110 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26111 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26112
26113
26114 @node TUI Commands
26115 @section TUI-specific Commands
26116 @cindex TUI commands
26117
26118 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26119 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26120 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26121 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26122
26123 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26124 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26125 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26126 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26127 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26128
26129 @table @code
26130 @item tui enable
26131 @kindex tui enable
26132 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26133 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26134 otherwise a default layout is used.
26135
26136 @item tui disable
26137 @kindex tui disable
26138 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26139
26140 @item info win
26141 @kindex info win
26142 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26143
26144 @item layout @var{name}
26145 @kindex layout
26146 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26147 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26148 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26149
26150 @table @code
26151 @item next
26152 Display the next layout.
26153
26154 @item prev
26155 Display the previous layout.
26156
26157 @item src
26158 Display the source and command windows.
26159
26160 @item asm
26161 Display the assembly and command windows.
26162
26163 @item split
26164 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26165
26166 @item regs
26167 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26168 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26169 register, assembler, and command windows.
26170 @end table
26171
26172 @item focus @var{name}
26173 @kindex focus
26174 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26175 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26176
26177 @table @code
26178 @item next
26179 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26180
26181 @item prev
26182 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26183
26184 @item src
26185 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26186
26187 @item asm
26188 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26189
26190 @item regs
26191 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26192
26193 @item cmd
26194 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26195 @end table
26196
26197 @item refresh
26198 @kindex refresh
26199 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26200
26201 @item tui reg @var{group}
26202 @kindex tui reg
26203 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26204 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26205 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26206 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26207 following groups are available on most targets:
26208 @table @code
26209 @item next
26210 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26211 through all of the available register groups.
26212
26213 @item prev
26214 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26215 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26216 @var{next}.
26217
26218 @item general
26219 Display the general registers.
26220 @item float
26221 Display the floating point registers.
26222 @item system
26223 Display the system registers.
26224 @item vector
26225 Display the vector registers.
26226 @item all
26227 Display all registers.
26228 @end table
26229
26230 @item update
26231 @kindex update
26232 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26233
26234 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26235 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26236 @kindex winheight
26237 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26238 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26239 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26240 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26241 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26242
26243 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26244 @kindex tabset
26245 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26246 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26247 assembly windows.
26248 @end table
26249
26250 @node TUI Configuration
26251 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26252 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26253
26254 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26255
26256 @table @code
26257 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26258 @kindex set tui border-kind
26259 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26260 The possible values are the following:
26261 @table @code
26262 @item space
26263 Use a space character to draw the border.
26264
26265 @item ascii
26266 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26267
26268 @item acs
26269 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26270 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26271 @end table
26272
26273 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26274 @kindex set tui border-mode
26275 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26276 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26277 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26278 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26279 @table @code
26280 @item normal
26281 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26282
26283 @item standout
26284 Use standout mode.
26285
26286 @item reverse
26287 Use reverse video mode.
26288
26289 @item half
26290 Use half bright mode.
26291
26292 @item half-standout
26293 Use half bright and standout mode.
26294
26295 @item bold
26296 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26297
26298 @item bold-standout
26299 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26300 @end table
26301 @end table
26302
26303 @node Emacs
26304 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26305
26306 @cindex Emacs
26307 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26308 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26309 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26310 @value{GDBN}.
26311
26312 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26313 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26314 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26315 created Emacs buffer.
26316 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26317
26318 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26319 things:
26320
26321 @itemize @bullet
26322 @item
26323 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26324 the GUD buffer.
26325
26326 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26327 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26328
26329 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26330 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26331 in this way.
26332
26333 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26334 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26335 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26336 stop.
26337
26338 @item
26339 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26340
26341 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26342 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26343 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26344 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26345 and the source.
26346
26347 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26348 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26349 @end itemize
26350
26351 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26352 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26353 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26354 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26355
26356 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26357 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26358 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26359 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26360 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26361 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26362 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26363 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26364 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26365
26366 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26367 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26368 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26369 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26370
26371 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26372 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26373 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26374 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26375 one you want.
26376
26377 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26378 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26379
26380 @table @kbd
26381 @item C-h m
26382 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26383
26384 @item C-c C-s
26385 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26386 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26387
26388 @item C-c C-n
26389 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26390 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26391 to show the current file and location.
26392
26393 @item C-c C-i
26394 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26395 display window accordingly.
26396
26397 @item C-c C-f
26398 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26399 @code{finish} command.
26400
26401 @item C-c C-r
26402 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26403 command.
26404
26405 @item C-c <
26406 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26407 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26408 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26409
26410 @item C-c >
26411 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26412 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26413 @end table
26414
26415 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26416 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26417
26418 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26419 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26420 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26421 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26422 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26423 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26424 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26425
26426 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26427 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26428 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26429 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26430 frame.
26431
26432 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26433 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26434 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26435 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26436 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26437 to correspond properly with the code.
26438
26439 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26440 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26441 Emacs Manual}).
26442
26443 @node GDB/MI
26444 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26445
26446 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26447
26448 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26449 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26450 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26451 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26452 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26453 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26454
26455 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26456 in the form of a reference manual.
26457
26458 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26459 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26460 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26461
26462 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26463
26464 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26465 This chapter uses the following notation:
26466
26467 @itemize @bullet
26468 @item
26469 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26470
26471 @item
26472 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26473 it may or may not be given.
26474
26475 @item
26476 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26477 may repeat zero or more times.
26478
26479 @item
26480 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26481 may repeat one or more times.
26482
26483 @item
26484 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26485 @end itemize
26486
26487 @ignore
26488 @heading Dependencies
26489 @end ignore
26490
26491 @menu
26492 * GDB/MI General Design::
26493 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26494 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26495 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26496 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26497 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26498 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26499 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26500 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26501 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26502 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26503 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26504 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26505 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26506 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26507 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26508 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26509 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26510 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26511 @ignore
26512 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26513 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26514 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26515 @end ignore
26516 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26517 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26518 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26519 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26520 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26521 @end menu
26522
26523 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26524 @node GDB/MI General Design
26525 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26526 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26527
26528 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26529 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26530 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26531 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26532 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26533 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26534 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26535 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26536 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26537 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26538
26539 The important examples of notifications are:
26540 @itemize @bullet
26541
26542 @item
26543 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26544 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26545 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26546 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26547 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26548 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26549 command itself was successfully executed.
26550
26551 @item
26552 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26553 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26554 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26555 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26556 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26557 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26558
26559 @item
26560 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26561 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26562 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26563 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26564 orthogonal frontend design.
26565
26566 @end itemize
26567
26568 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26569 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26570 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26571 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26572 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26573 the user interface.
26574
26575
26576 @menu
26577 * Context management::
26578 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26579 * Thread groups::
26580 @end menu
26581
26582 @node Context management
26583 @subsection Context management
26584
26585 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26586
26587 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26588 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26589 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26590 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26591 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26592 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26593 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26594 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26595 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26596
26597 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26598 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26599 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26600 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26601 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26602 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26603 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26604 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26605 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26606 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26607 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26608
26609 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26610 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26611 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26612 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26613 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26614 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26615 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26616 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26617 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26618 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26619
26620 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26621 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26622 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26623 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26624 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26625 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26626 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26627 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26628 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26629 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26630 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26631 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26632 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26633 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26634 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26635 @samp{--frame} options.
26636
26637 @subsubsection Language
26638
26639 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
26640 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
26641 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
26642 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
26643 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
26644 For instance:
26645
26646 @smallexample
26647 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
26648 ^done,value="4"
26649 (gdb)
26650 @end smallexample
26651
26652 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
26653 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
26654 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
26655
26656 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
26657 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
26658
26659 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
26660 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
26661 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
26662 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
26663 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
26664 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
26665 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
26666 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
26667 @code{-list-target-features} command.
26668
26669 @table @code
26670 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
26671 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
26672 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
26673
26674 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
26675 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
26676 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
26677
26678 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
26679 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
26680 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
26681 MI commands even while the target is running.
26682
26683 @item -gdb-show mi-async
26684 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
26685 @end table
26686
26687 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
26688 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
26689 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
26690 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
26691 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
26692 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
26693
26694 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
26695 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
26696 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
26697 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
26698 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
26699 are running.
26700
26701 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
26702 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
26703 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
26704 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
26705 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
26706 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
26707 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
26708 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
26709 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
26710 @samp{--thread} option).
26711
26712 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
26713 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
26714 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
26715 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
26716
26717 @node Thread groups
26718 @subsection Thread groups
26719 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
26720 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
26721 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
26722 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
26723 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
26724
26725 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
26726 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
26727 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
26728 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
26729 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
26730 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
26731 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
26732 into processes.
26733
26734 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
26735 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
26736 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
26737 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
26738 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
26739 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
26740 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
26741 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
26742 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
26743 the members of specific thread group.
26744
26745 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
26746 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
26747 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
26748 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
26749 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
26750 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
26751 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
26752 after attaching to that thread group.
26753
26754 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
26755 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
26756 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
26757 such thread groups.
26758
26759 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26760 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
26761 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
26762
26763 @menu
26764 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
26765 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
26766 @end menu
26767
26768 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
26769 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
26770
26771 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
26772 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
26773 @table @code
26774 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
26775 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
26776
26777 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
26778 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
26779 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
26780
26781 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
26782 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
26783 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
26784
26785 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26786 "any sequence of digits"
26787
26788 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
26789 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
26790
26791 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
26792 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
26793
26794 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
26795 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
26796
26797 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
26798 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
26799 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
26800
26801 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
26802 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
26803
26804 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26805 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26806 @end table
26807
26808 @noindent
26809 Notes:
26810
26811 @itemize @bullet
26812 @item
26813 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
26814 output is described below.
26815
26816 @item
26817 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
26818 finishes.
26819
26820 @item
26821 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
26822 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
26823 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
26824 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
26825 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
26826 @end itemize
26827
26828 Pragmatics:
26829
26830 @itemize @bullet
26831 @item
26832 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
26833
26834 @item
26835 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
26836 @end itemize
26837
26838 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
26839 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
26840
26841 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
26842 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
26843 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
26844 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
26845 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
26846 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
26847
26848 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
26849 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
26850 @var{token}.
26851
26852 @table @code
26853 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
26854 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
26855
26856 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
26857 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
26858
26859 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
26860 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
26861
26862 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
26863 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
26864
26865 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
26866 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
26867
26868 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
26869 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
26870
26871 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
26872 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
26873
26874 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
26875 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
26876
26877 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
26878 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
26879
26880 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
26881 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
26882 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
26883
26884 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
26885 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
26886
26887 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
26888 @code{ @var{string} }
26889
26890 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
26891 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
26892
26893 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
26894 @code{@var{c-string}}
26895
26896 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
26897 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
26898
26899 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
26900 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
26901 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
26902
26903 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
26904 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
26905
26906 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
26907 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
26908
26909 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
26910 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
26911
26912 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
26913 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
26914
26915 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
26916 @code{CR | CR-LF}
26917
26918 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
26919 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
26920 @end table
26921
26922 @noindent
26923 Notes:
26924
26925 @itemize @bullet
26926 @item
26927 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
26928
26929 @item
26930 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
26931 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
26932 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
26933 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
26934 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
26935 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
26936 prior command.
26937
26938 @item
26939 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26940 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
26941 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
26942 prefixed by @samp{+}.
26943
26944 @item
26945 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26946 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
26947 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
26948 @samp{*}.
26949
26950 @item
26951 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26952 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
26953 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
26954 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
26955
26956 @item
26957 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26958 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
26959 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
26960 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
26961
26962 @item
26963 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26964 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
26965 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
26966
26967 @item
26968 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26969 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
26970 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
26971 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
26972
26973 @item
26974 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
26975 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
26976 @var{values}.
26977
26978
26979 @end itemize
26980
26981 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
26982 details about the various output records.
26983
26984 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26985 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
26986 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
26987
26988 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
26989 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
26990
26991 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
26992 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
26993 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
26994 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
26995 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
26996 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
26997
26998 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
26999 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27000 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27001
27002 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27003 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27004 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27005 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27006
27007 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27008 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27009
27010 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27011 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27012 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27013 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27014 might change.
27015
27016 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27017 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27018 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27019 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27020
27021 @itemize @bullet
27022 @item
27023 New MI commands may be added.
27024
27025 @item
27026 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27027
27028 @item
27029 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27030 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27031
27032 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27033 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27034
27035 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27036 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27037 @end itemize
27038
27039 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27040 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27041 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27042 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27043 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27044
27045 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27046 @c version?
27047
27048 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27049 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27050 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27051 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27052 @cindex mailing lists
27053
27054 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27055 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27056 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27057
27058 @menu
27059 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27060 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27061 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27062 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27063 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27064 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27065 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27066 @end menu
27067
27068 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27069 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27070
27071 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27072 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27073 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27074 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27075
27076 @table @code
27077 @findex ^done
27078 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27079 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27080 values.
27081
27082 @item "^running"
27083 @findex ^running
27084 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27085 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27086 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27087 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27088 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27089 which threads are resumed.
27090
27091 @item "^connected"
27092 @findex ^connected
27093 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27094
27095 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27096 @findex ^error
27097 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27098 the corresponding error message.
27099
27100 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27101 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27102 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27103
27104 @table @samp
27105 @item "undefined-command"
27106 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27107 @end table
27108
27109 @item "^exit"
27110 @findex ^exit
27111 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27112
27113 @end table
27114
27115 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27116 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27117
27118 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27119 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27120 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27121 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27122 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27123
27124 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27125 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27126 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27127 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27128 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27129
27130 @table @code
27131 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27132 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27133 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27134
27135 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27136 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27137 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27138 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27139
27140 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27141 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27142 internals.
27143 @end table
27144
27145 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27146 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27147
27148 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27149 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27150 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27151 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27152 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27153 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27154
27155 The following is the list of possible async records:
27156
27157 @table @code
27158
27159 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27160 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27161 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27162 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27163 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27164 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27165 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27166 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27167 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27168 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27169 it run freely.
27170
27171 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27172 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27173 following values:
27174
27175 @table @code
27176 @item breakpoint-hit
27177 A breakpoint was reached.
27178 @item watchpoint-trigger
27179 A watchpoint was triggered.
27180 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27181 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27182 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27183 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27184 @item function-finished
27185 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27186 @item location-reached
27187 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27188 @item watchpoint-scope
27189 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27190 @item end-stepping-range
27191 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27192 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27193 @item exited-signalled
27194 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27195 @item exited
27196 The inferior exited.
27197 @item exited-normally
27198 The inferior exited normally.
27199 @item signal-received
27200 A signal was received by the inferior.
27201 @item solib-event
27202 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27203 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27204 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27205 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27206 @item fork
27207 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27208 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27209 @item vfork
27210 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27211 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27212 @item syscall-entry
27213 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27214 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27215 @item syscall-return
27216 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27217 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27218 @item exec
27219 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27220 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27221 @end table
27222
27223 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27224 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27225 Depending on whether all-stop
27226 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27227 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27228 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27229 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27230 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27231 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27232 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27233 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27234 if such information is not available.
27235
27236 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27237 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27238 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27239 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27240 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27241 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27242 cannot be used in any way.
27243
27244 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27245 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27246 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27247 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27248 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27249 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27250
27251 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27252 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27253 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27254 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27255 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27256 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27257
27258 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27259 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27260 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27261 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27262 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27263
27264 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27265 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27266 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27267 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27268 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27269 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27270 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27271 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27272 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27273
27274 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27275 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27276
27277 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27278 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27279 that thread.
27280
27281 @item =library-loaded,...
27282 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27283 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27284 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27285 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27286 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27287 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27288 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27289 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27290 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27291 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27292 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27293 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27294 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27295 to this library.
27296
27297 @item =library-unloaded,...
27298 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27299 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27300 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27301 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27302 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27303 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27304 thread groups.
27305
27306 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27307 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27308 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27309 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27310 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27311
27312 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27313 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27314 initial value @var{initial}.
27315
27316 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27317 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27318 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27319 trace state variables are deleted.
27320
27321 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27322 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27323 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27324 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27325 value of trace state variable is known.
27326
27327 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27328 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27329 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27330 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27331 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27332 user.
27333
27334 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27335 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27336 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27337
27338 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27339 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27340
27341 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27342 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27343 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27344 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27345 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27346
27347 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27348 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27349 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27350 for existing method and format values.
27351
27352 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27353 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27354 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27355 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27356 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27357 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27358
27359 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27360 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27361 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27362 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27363 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27364 executable code.
27365 @end table
27366
27367 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27368 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27369
27370 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27371 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27372 following fields:
27373
27374 @table @code
27375 @item number
27376 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27377 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27378 @samp{1.2}.
27379
27380 @item type
27381 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27382 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27383
27384 @item catch-type
27385 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27386 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27387
27388 @item disp
27389 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27390 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27391 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27392
27393 @item enabled
27394 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27395 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27396 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27397
27398 @item addr
27399 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27400 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27401 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27402 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27403 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27404
27405 @item func
27406 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27407 If not known, this field is not present.
27408
27409 @item filename
27410 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27411 If not known, this field is not present.
27412
27413 @item fullname
27414 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27415 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27416
27417 @item line
27418 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27419 If not known, this field is not present.
27420
27421 @item at
27422 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27423 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27424 by a symbol name.
27425
27426 @item pending
27427 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27428 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27429
27430 @item evaluated-by
27431 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27432 @samp{target}.
27433
27434 @item thread
27435 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27436 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27437
27438 @item task
27439 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27440 field will hold the task identifier.
27441
27442 @item cond
27443 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27444
27445 @item ignore
27446 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27447
27448 @item enable
27449 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27450
27451 @item traceframe-usage
27452 FIXME.
27453
27454 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27455 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27456
27457 @item mask
27458 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27459
27460 @item pass
27461 A tracepoint's pass count.
27462
27463 @item original-location
27464 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27465 This field is optional.
27466
27467 @item times
27468 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27469
27470 @item installed
27471 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27472 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27473 is not.
27474
27475 @item what
27476 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27477
27478 @end table
27479
27480 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27481 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27482
27483 @smallexample
27484 -> -break-insert main
27485 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27486 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27487 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27488 times="0"@}
27489 <- (gdb)
27490 @end smallexample
27491
27492 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27493 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27494
27495 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27496 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27497 fields:
27498
27499 @table @code
27500 @item level
27501 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27502 zero. This field is always present.
27503
27504 @item func
27505 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27506 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27507
27508 @item addr
27509 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27510
27511 @item file
27512 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27513 address. This field may be absent.
27514
27515 @item line
27516 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27517 may be absent.
27518
27519 @item from
27520 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27521 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27522
27523 @end table
27524
27525 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27526 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27527
27528 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27529 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27530 stated otherwise.
27531
27532 @table @code
27533 @item id
27534 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27535
27536 @item target-id
27537 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27538
27539 @item details
27540 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27541 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27542 frontend. This field is optional.
27543
27544 @item name
27545 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27546 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27547 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27548 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27549 field is omitted.
27550
27551 @item state
27552 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27553 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27554
27555 @item frame
27556 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27557 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27558 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27559
27560 @item core
27561 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27562 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27563 @end table
27564
27565 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27566 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27567
27568 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27569 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27570 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27571 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
27572 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
27573 the @code{exception-message} field.
27574
27575 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27576 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27577 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27578 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27579
27580 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27581 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27582 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27583 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27584
27585 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27586 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27587
27588 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27589
27590 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27591 information of the breakpoint.
27592
27593 @smallexample
27594 -> -break-insert main
27595 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27596 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27597 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27598 times="0"@}
27599 <- (gdb)
27600 @end smallexample
27601
27602 @subheading Program Execution
27603
27604 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27605 reason that execution stopped.
27606
27607 @smallexample
27608 -> -exec-run
27609 <- ^running
27610 <- (gdb)
27611 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27612 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27613 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27614 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27615 <- (gdb)
27616 -> -exec-continue
27617 <- ^running
27618 <- (gdb)
27619 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27620 <- (gdb)
27621 @end smallexample
27622
27623 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27624
27625 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27626
27627 @smallexample
27628 -> (gdb)
27629 <- -gdb-exit
27630 <- ^exit
27631 @end smallexample
27632
27633 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27634 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27635 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27636 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27637 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
27638 fails to exit in reasonable time.
27639
27640 @subheading A Bad Command
27641
27642 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
27643
27644 @smallexample
27645 -> -rubbish
27646 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
27647 <- (gdb)
27648 @end smallexample
27649
27650
27651 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27652 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
27653 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
27654
27655 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
27656 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
27657
27658 @subheading Motivation
27659
27660 The motivation for this collection of commands.
27661
27662 @subheading Introduction
27663
27664 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
27665
27666 @subheading Commands
27667
27668 For each command in the block, the following is described:
27669
27670 @subsubheading Synopsis
27671
27672 @smallexample
27673 -command @var{args}@dots{}
27674 @end smallexample
27675
27676 @subsubheading Result
27677
27678 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27679
27680 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
27681
27682 @subsubheading Example
27683
27684 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
27685 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
27686
27687
27688 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27689 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
27690 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
27691
27692 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
27693 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
27694 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27695 breakpoints.
27696
27697 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
27698 @findex -break-after
27699
27700 @subsubheading Synopsis
27701
27702 @smallexample
27703 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
27704 @end smallexample
27705
27706 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
27707 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
27708 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
27709 @samp{-break-list} command below.
27710
27711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27712
27713 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
27714
27715 @subsubheading Example
27716
27717 @smallexample
27718 (gdb)
27719 -break-insert main
27720 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27721 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27722 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27723 times="0"@}
27724 (gdb)
27725 -break-after 1 3
27726 ~
27727 ^done
27728 (gdb)
27729 -break-list
27730 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27731 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27732 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27733 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27734 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27735 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27736 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27737 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27738 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27739 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27740 (gdb)
27741 @end smallexample
27742
27743 @ignore
27744 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
27745 @findex -break-catch
27746 @end ignore
27747
27748 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
27749 @findex -break-commands
27750
27751 @subsubheading Synopsis
27752
27753 @smallexample
27754 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
27755 @end smallexample
27756
27757 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
27758 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
27759 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
27760 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
27761 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
27762 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
27763
27764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27765
27766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
27767
27768 @subsubheading Example
27769
27770 @smallexample
27771 (gdb)
27772 -break-insert main
27773 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27774 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
27775 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
27776 times="0"@}
27777 (gdb)
27778 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
27779 ^done
27780 (gdb)
27781 @end smallexample
27782
27783 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
27784 @findex -break-condition
27785
27786 @subsubheading Synopsis
27787
27788 @smallexample
27789 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
27790 @end smallexample
27791
27792 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
27793 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
27794 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
27795 command below).
27796
27797 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27798
27799 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
27800
27801 @subsubheading Example
27802
27803 @smallexample
27804 (gdb)
27805 -break-condition 1 1
27806 ^done
27807 (gdb)
27808 -break-list
27809 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27810 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27811 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27812 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27813 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27814 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27815 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27816 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27817 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27818 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
27819 (gdb)
27820 @end smallexample
27821
27822 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
27823 @findex -break-delete
27824
27825 @subsubheading Synopsis
27826
27827 @smallexample
27828 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27829 @end smallexample
27830
27831 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
27832 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
27833
27834 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27835
27836 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
27837
27838 @subsubheading Example
27839
27840 @smallexample
27841 (gdb)
27842 -break-delete 1
27843 ^done
27844 (gdb)
27845 -break-list
27846 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
27847 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27848 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27849 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27850 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27851 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27852 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27853 body=[]@}
27854 (gdb)
27855 @end smallexample
27856
27857 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
27858 @findex -break-disable
27859
27860 @subsubheading Synopsis
27861
27862 @smallexample
27863 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27864 @end smallexample
27865
27866 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
27867 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
27868
27869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27870
27871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
27872
27873 @subsubheading Example
27874
27875 @smallexample
27876 (gdb)
27877 -break-disable 2
27878 ^done
27879 (gdb)
27880 -break-list
27881 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27882 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27883 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27884 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27885 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27886 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27887 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27888 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27889 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27890 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27891 (gdb)
27892 @end smallexample
27893
27894 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
27895 @findex -break-enable
27896
27897 @subsubheading Synopsis
27898
27899 @smallexample
27900 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
27901 @end smallexample
27902
27903 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
27904
27905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27906
27907 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
27908
27909 @subsubheading Example
27910
27911 @smallexample
27912 (gdb)
27913 -break-enable 2
27914 ^done
27915 (gdb)
27916 -break-list
27917 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27918 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27919 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27920 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27921 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27922 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27923 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27924 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27925 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
27926 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27927 (gdb)
27928 @end smallexample
27929
27930 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
27931 @findex -break-info
27932
27933 @subsubheading Synopsis
27934
27935 @smallexample
27936 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
27937 @end smallexample
27938
27939 @c REDUNDANT???
27940 Get information about a single breakpoint.
27941
27942 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
27943 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
27944 table.
27945
27946 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27947
27948 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
27949
27950 @subsubheading Example
27951 N.A.
27952
27953 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
27954 @findex -break-insert
27955 @anchor{-break-insert}
27956
27957 @subsubheading Synopsis
27958
27959 @smallexample
27960 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
27961 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
27962 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
27963 @end smallexample
27964
27965 @noindent
27966 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
27967
27968 @table @var
27969 @item linespec location
27970 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
27971
27972 @item explicit location
27973 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
27974 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
27975 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
27976
27977 @table @samp
27978 @item --source @var{filename}
27979 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
27980 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
27981
27982 @item --function @var{function}
27983 The name of a function or method.
27984
27985 @item --label @var{label}
27986 The name of a label.
27987
27988 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
27989 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
27990 @end table
27991
27992 @item address location
27993 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
27994 @end table
27995
27996 @noindent
27997 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
27998
27999 @table @samp
28000 @item -t
28001 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28002 @item -h
28003 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28004 @item -f
28005 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28006 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28007 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28008 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28009 cannot be parsed.
28010 @item -d
28011 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28012 @item -a
28013 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28014 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28015 @item -c @var{condition}
28016 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28017 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28018 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28019 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28020 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28021 @var{thread-id}.
28022 @end table
28023
28024 @subsubheading Result
28025
28026 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28027 resulting breakpoint.
28028
28029 Note: this format is open to change.
28030 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28031
28032 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28033
28034 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28035 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28036
28037 @subsubheading Example
28038
28039 @smallexample
28040 (gdb)
28041 -break-insert main
28042 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28043 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28044 times="0"@}
28045 (gdb)
28046 -break-insert -t foo
28047 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28048 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28049 times="0"@}
28050 (gdb)
28051 -break-list
28052 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28053 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28054 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28055 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28056 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28057 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28058 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28059 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28060 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28061 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28062 times="0"@},
28063 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28064 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28065 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28066 times="0"@}]@}
28067 (gdb)
28068 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28069 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28070 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28071 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28072 @c times="0"@}
28073 @c (gdb)
28074 @end smallexample
28075
28076 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28077 @findex -dprintf-insert
28078
28079 @subsubheading Synopsis
28080
28081 @smallexample
28082 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28083 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28084 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28085 [ @var{argument} ]
28086 @end smallexample
28087
28088 @noindent
28089 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28090 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28091
28092 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28093
28094 @table @samp
28095 @item -t
28096 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28097 @item -f
28098 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28099 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28100 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28101 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28102 cannot be parsed.
28103 @item -d
28104 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28105 @item -c @var{condition}
28106 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28107 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28108 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28109 to @var{ignore-count}.
28110 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28111 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28112 @var{thread-id}.
28113 @end table
28114
28115 @subsubheading Result
28116
28117 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28118 resulting breakpoint.
28119
28120 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28121
28122 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28123
28124 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28125
28126 @subsubheading Example
28127
28128 @smallexample
28129 (gdb)
28130 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28131 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28132 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28133 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28134 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28135 original-location="foo"@}
28136 (gdb)
28137 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28138 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28139 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28140 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28141 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28142 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28143 (gdb)
28144 @end smallexample
28145
28146 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28147 @findex -break-list
28148
28149 @subsubheading Synopsis
28150
28151 @smallexample
28152 -break-list
28153 @end smallexample
28154
28155 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28156
28157 @table @samp
28158 @item Number
28159 number of the breakpoint
28160 @item Type
28161 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28162 @item Disposition
28163 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28164 or @samp{nokeep}
28165 @item Enabled
28166 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28167 @item Address
28168 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28169 @item What
28170 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28171 name, line number
28172 @item Thread-groups
28173 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28174 @item Times
28175 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28176 @end table
28177
28178 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28179 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28180
28181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28182
28183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28184
28185 @subsubheading Example
28186
28187 @smallexample
28188 (gdb)
28189 -break-list
28190 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28191 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28192 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28193 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28194 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28195 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28196 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28197 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28198 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28199 times="0"@},
28200 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28201 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28202 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28203 (gdb)
28204 @end smallexample
28205
28206 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28207
28208 @smallexample
28209 (gdb)
28210 -break-list
28211 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28212 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28213 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28214 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28215 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28216 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28217 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28218 body=[]@}
28219 (gdb)
28220 @end smallexample
28221
28222 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28223 @findex -break-passcount
28224
28225 @subsubheading Synopsis
28226
28227 @smallexample
28228 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28229 @end smallexample
28230
28231 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28232 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28233 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28234 command @samp{passcount}.
28235
28236 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28237 @findex -break-watch
28238
28239 @subsubheading Synopsis
28240
28241 @smallexample
28242 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28243 @end smallexample
28244
28245 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28246 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28247 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28248 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28249 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28250 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28251 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28252 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28253
28254 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28255 breakpoints inserted.
28256
28257 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28258
28259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28260 @samp{rwatch}.
28261
28262 @subsubheading Example
28263
28264 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28265
28266 @smallexample
28267 (gdb)
28268 -break-watch x
28269 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28270 (gdb)
28271 -exec-continue
28272 ^running
28273 (gdb)
28274 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28275 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28276 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28277 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
28278 (gdb)
28279 @end smallexample
28280
28281 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28282 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28283 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28284
28285 @smallexample
28286 (gdb)
28287 -break-watch C
28288 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28289 (gdb)
28290 -exec-continue
28291 ^running
28292 (gdb)
28293 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28294 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28295 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28296 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28297 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28298 (gdb)
28299 -exec-continue
28300 ^running
28301 (gdb)
28302 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28303 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28304 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28305 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28306 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28307 (gdb)
28308 @end smallexample
28309
28310 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28311 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28312 deleted.
28313
28314 @smallexample
28315 (gdb)
28316 -break-watch C
28317 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28318 (gdb)
28319 -break-list
28320 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28321 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28322 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28323 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28324 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28325 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28326 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28327 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28328 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28329 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28330 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28331 times="1"@},
28332 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28333 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28334 (gdb)
28335 -exec-continue
28336 ^running
28337 (gdb)
28338 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28339 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28340 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28341 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28342 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28343 (gdb)
28344 -break-list
28345 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28346 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28347 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28348 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28349 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28350 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28351 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28352 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28353 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28354 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28355 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28356 times="1"@},
28357 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28358 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28359 (gdb)
28360 -exec-continue
28361 ^running
28362 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28363 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28364 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28365 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28366 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28367 (gdb)
28368 -break-list
28369 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28370 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28371 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28372 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28373 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28374 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28375 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28376 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28377 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28378 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28379 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28380 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28381 (gdb)
28382 @end smallexample
28383
28384
28385 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28386 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28387 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28388
28389 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28390 catchpoints.
28391
28392 @menu
28393 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28394 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28395 @end menu
28396
28397 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28398 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28399
28400 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28401 @findex -catch-load
28402
28403 @subsubheading Synopsis
28404
28405 @smallexample
28406 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28407 @end smallexample
28408
28409 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28410 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28411 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28412 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28413 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28414
28415
28416 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28417
28418 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28419
28420 @subsubheading Example
28421
28422 @smallexample
28423 -catch-load -t foo.so
28424 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28425 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28426 (gdb)
28427 @end smallexample
28428
28429
28430 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28431 @findex -catch-unload
28432
28433 @subsubheading Synopsis
28434
28435 @smallexample
28436 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28437 @end smallexample
28438
28439 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28440 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28441 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28442 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28443 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28444
28445 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28446
28447 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28448
28449 @subsubheading Example
28450
28451 @smallexample
28452 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28453 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28454 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28455 (gdb)
28456 @end smallexample
28457
28458 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28459 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28460
28461 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28462 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28463
28464 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28465 @findex -catch-assert
28466
28467 @subsubheading Synopsis
28468
28469 @smallexample
28470 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28471 @end smallexample
28472
28473 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28474
28475 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28476
28477 @table @samp
28478 @item -c @var{condition}
28479 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28480 @item -d
28481 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28482 @item -t
28483 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28484 @end table
28485
28486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28487
28488 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28489
28490 @subsubheading Example
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 -catch-assert
28494 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28495 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28496 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28497 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28498 (gdb)
28499 @end smallexample
28500
28501 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28502 @findex -catch-exception
28503
28504 @subsubheading Synopsis
28505
28506 @smallexample
28507 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28508 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28509 @end smallexample
28510
28511 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28512 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28513 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28514 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28515 catchpoints.
28516
28517 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28518
28519 @table @samp
28520 @item -c @var{condition}
28521 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28522 @item -d
28523 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28524 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28525 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28526 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28527 @item -t
28528 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28529 @item -u
28530 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28531 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28532 @end table
28533
28534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28535
28536 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28537 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28538
28539 @subsubheading Example
28540
28541 @smallexample
28542 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28543 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28544 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28545 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28546 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28547 (gdb)
28548 @end smallexample
28549
28550 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
28551 @findex -catch-handlers
28552
28553 @subsubheading Synopsis
28554
28555 @smallexample
28556 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28557 [ -t ]
28558 @end smallexample
28559
28560 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
28561 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28562 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28563 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28564 catchpoints.
28565
28566 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28567
28568 @table @samp
28569 @item -c @var{condition}
28570 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28571 @item -d
28572 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28573 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28574 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
28575 @item -t
28576 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28577 @end table
28578
28579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28580
28581 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
28582
28583 @subsubheading Example
28584
28585 @smallexample
28586 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
28587 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28588 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
28589 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
28590 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
28591 (gdb)
28592 @end smallexample
28593
28594 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28595 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28596 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28597
28598 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28599 @findex -exec-arguments
28600
28601
28602 @subsubheading Synopsis
28603
28604 @smallexample
28605 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28606 @end smallexample
28607
28608 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28609 @samp{-exec-run}.
28610
28611 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28612
28613 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28614
28615 @subsubheading Example
28616
28617 @smallexample
28618 (gdb)
28619 -exec-arguments -v word
28620 ^done
28621 (gdb)
28622 @end smallexample
28623
28624
28625 @ignore
28626 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28627 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28628
28629 @subsubheading Synopsis
28630
28631 @smallexample
28632 -exec-show-arguments
28633 @end smallexample
28634
28635 Print the arguments of the program.
28636
28637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28638
28639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
28640
28641 @subsubheading Example
28642 N.A.
28643 @end ignore
28644
28645
28646 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
28647 @findex -environment-cd
28648
28649 @subsubheading Synopsis
28650
28651 @smallexample
28652 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
28653 @end smallexample
28654
28655 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
28656
28657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28658
28659 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
28660
28661 @subsubheading Example
28662
28663 @smallexample
28664 (gdb)
28665 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28666 ^done
28667 (gdb)
28668 @end smallexample
28669
28670
28671 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
28672 @findex -environment-directory
28673
28674 @subsubheading Synopsis
28675
28676 @smallexample
28677 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28678 @end smallexample
28679
28680 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
28681 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
28682 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
28683 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28684 occurs as normal.
28685 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28686 multiple directories in a single command
28687 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28688 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28689 If blanks are needed as
28690 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28691 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28692 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28693 character must not be used
28694 in any directory name.
28695 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
28696
28697 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28698
28699 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
28700
28701 @subsubheading Example
28702
28703 @smallexample
28704 (gdb)
28705 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
28706 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28707 (gdb)
28708 -environment-directory ""
28709 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
28710 (gdb)
28711 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
28712 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
28713 (gdb)
28714 -environment-directory -r
28715 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
28716 (gdb)
28717 @end smallexample
28718
28719
28720 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
28721 @findex -environment-path
28722
28723 @subsubheading Synopsis
28724
28725 @smallexample
28726 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
28727 @end smallexample
28728
28729 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
28730 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
28731 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
28732 supplied in addition to the
28733 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
28734 occurs as normal.
28735 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
28736 multiple directories in a single command
28737 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
28738 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
28739 If blanks are needed as
28740 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
28741 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
28742 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
28743 character must not be used
28744 in any directory name.
28745 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
28746
28747
28748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28749
28750 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
28751
28752 @subsubheading Example
28753
28754 @smallexample
28755 (gdb)
28756 -environment-path
28757 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
28758 (gdb)
28759 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
28760 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
28761 (gdb)
28762 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
28763 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
28764 (gdb)
28765 @end smallexample
28766
28767
28768 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
28769 @findex -environment-pwd
28770
28771 @subsubheading Synopsis
28772
28773 @smallexample
28774 -environment-pwd
28775 @end smallexample
28776
28777 Show the current working directory.
28778
28779 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28780
28781 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
28782
28783 @subsubheading Example
28784
28785 @smallexample
28786 (gdb)
28787 -environment-pwd
28788 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
28789 (gdb)
28790 @end smallexample
28791
28792 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28793 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
28794 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
28795
28796
28797 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
28798 @findex -thread-info
28799
28800 @subsubheading Synopsis
28801
28802 @smallexample
28803 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
28804 @end smallexample
28805
28806 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
28807 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
28808 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
28809 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
28810 current thread.
28811
28812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28813
28814 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
28815 about all threads.
28816
28817 @subsubheading Result
28818
28819 The result contains the following attributes:
28820
28821 @table @samp
28822 @item threads
28823 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
28824 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
28825
28826 @item current-thread-id
28827 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
28828 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
28829 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
28830 the command.
28831
28832 @end table
28833
28834 @subsubheading Example
28835
28836 @smallexample
28837 -thread-info
28838 ^done,threads=[
28839 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
28840 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
28841 args=[]@},state="running"@},
28842 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
28843 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
28844 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
28845 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
28846 state="running"@}],
28847 current-thread-id="1"
28848 (gdb)
28849 @end smallexample
28850
28851 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
28852 @findex -thread-list-ids
28853
28854 @subsubheading Synopsis
28855
28856 @smallexample
28857 -thread-list-ids
28858 @end smallexample
28859
28860 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
28861 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
28862 threads.
28863
28864 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
28865 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
28866
28867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28868
28869 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
28870
28871 @subsubheading Example
28872
28873 @smallexample
28874 (gdb)
28875 -thread-list-ids
28876 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28877 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
28878 (gdb)
28879 @end smallexample
28880
28881
28882 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
28883 @findex -thread-select
28884
28885 @subsubheading Synopsis
28886
28887 @smallexample
28888 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
28889 @end smallexample
28890
28891 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
28892 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
28893 topmost frame for that thread.
28894
28895 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
28896 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
28897
28898 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28899
28900 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
28901
28902 @subsubheading Example
28903
28904 @smallexample
28905 (gdb)
28906 -exec-next
28907 ^running
28908 (gdb)
28909 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
28910 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
28911 (gdb)
28912 -thread-list-ids
28913 ^done,
28914 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
28915 number-of-threads="3"
28916 (gdb)
28917 -thread-select 3
28918 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
28919 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
28920 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
28921 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
28922 (gdb)
28923 @end smallexample
28924
28925 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28926 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
28927 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
28928
28929 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
28930 @findex -ada-task-info
28931
28932 @subsubheading Synopsis
28933
28934 @smallexample
28935 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
28936 @end smallexample
28937
28938 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
28939 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
28940
28941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28942
28943 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
28944 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
28945
28946 @subsubheading Result
28947
28948 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
28949 defined for each Ada task:
28950
28951 @table @samp
28952 @item current
28953 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
28954
28955 @item id
28956 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
28957
28958 @item task-id
28959 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
28960
28961 @item thread-id
28962 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
28963 task.
28964
28965 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
28966 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
28967 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
28968
28969 @item parent-id
28970 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
28971 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
28972
28973 @item priority
28974 The base priority of the task.
28975
28976 @item state
28977 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
28978 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
28979
28980 @item name
28981 The name of the task.
28982
28983 @end table
28984
28985 @subsubheading Example
28986
28987 @smallexample
28988 -ada-task-info
28989 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
28990 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
28991 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
28992 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
28993 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
28994 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
28995 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
28996 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
28997 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
28998 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
28999 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29000 (gdb)
29001 @end smallexample
29002
29003 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29004 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29005 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29006
29007 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29008 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29009 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29010 other cases.
29011
29012 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29013 @findex -exec-continue
29014
29015 @subsubheading Synopsis
29016
29017 @smallexample
29018 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29019 @end smallexample
29020
29021 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29022 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29023 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29024 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29025 @itemize @bullet
29026 @item
29027 breakpoints or watchpoints
29028 @item
29029 signals or exceptions
29030 @item
29031 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29032 @item
29033 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29034 @end itemize
29035 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29036 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29037 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29038 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29039 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29040 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29041
29042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29043
29044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29045
29046 @subsubheading Example
29047
29048 @smallexample
29049 -exec-continue
29050 ^running
29051 (gdb)
29052 @@Hello world
29053 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29054 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29055 line="13"@}
29056 (gdb)
29057 @end smallexample
29058
29059
29060 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29061 @findex -exec-finish
29062
29063 @subsubheading Synopsis
29064
29065 @smallexample
29066 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29067 @end smallexample
29068
29069 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29070 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29071 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29072 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29073 function was called.
29074
29075 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29076
29077 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29078
29079 @subsubheading Example
29080
29081 Function returning @code{void}.
29082
29083 @smallexample
29084 -exec-finish
29085 ^running
29086 (gdb)
29087 @@hello from foo
29088 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29089 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
29090 (gdb)
29091 @end smallexample
29092
29093 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29094 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29095 value itself.
29096
29097 @smallexample
29098 -exec-finish
29099 ^running
29100 (gdb)
29101 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29102 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29103 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29104 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29105 (gdb)
29106 @end smallexample
29107
29108
29109 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29110 @findex -exec-interrupt
29111
29112 @subsubheading Synopsis
29113
29114 @smallexample
29115 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29116 @end smallexample
29117
29118 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29119 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29120 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29121 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29122 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29123
29124 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29125 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29126 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29127 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29128
29129 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29130 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29131 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29132 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29133
29134 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29135
29136 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29137
29138 @subsubheading Example
29139
29140 @smallexample
29141 (gdb)
29142 111-exec-continue
29143 111^running
29144
29145 (gdb)
29146 222-exec-interrupt
29147 222^done
29148 (gdb)
29149 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29150 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29151 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
29152 (gdb)
29153
29154 (gdb)
29155 -exec-interrupt
29156 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29157 (gdb)
29158 @end smallexample
29159
29160 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29161 @findex -exec-jump
29162
29163 @subsubheading Synopsis
29164
29165 @smallexample
29166 -exec-jump @var{location}
29167 @end smallexample
29168
29169 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29170 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29171 different forms of @var{location}.
29172
29173 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29174
29175 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29176
29177 @subsubheading Example
29178
29179 @smallexample
29180 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29181 *running,thread-id="all"
29182 ^running
29183 @end smallexample
29184
29185
29186 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29187 @findex -exec-next
29188
29189 @subsubheading Synopsis
29190
29191 @smallexample
29192 -exec-next [--reverse]
29193 @end smallexample
29194
29195 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29196 of the next source line is reached.
29197
29198 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29199 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29200 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29201 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29202 source line where the function was called.
29203
29204
29205 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29206
29207 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29208
29209 @subsubheading Example
29210
29211 @smallexample
29212 -exec-next
29213 ^running
29214 (gdb)
29215 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29216 (gdb)
29217 @end smallexample
29218
29219
29220 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29221 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29222
29223 @subsubheading Synopsis
29224
29225 @smallexample
29226 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29227 @end smallexample
29228
29229 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29230 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29231 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29232 printed as well.
29233
29234 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29235 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29236 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29237 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29238 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29239
29240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29241
29242 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29243
29244 @subsubheading Example
29245
29246 @smallexample
29247 (gdb)
29248 -exec-next-instruction
29249 ^running
29250
29251 (gdb)
29252 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29253 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29254 (gdb)
29255 @end smallexample
29256
29257
29258 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29259 @findex -exec-return
29260
29261 @subsubheading Synopsis
29262
29263 @smallexample
29264 -exec-return
29265 @end smallexample
29266
29267 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29268 Displays the new current frame.
29269
29270 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29271
29272 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29273
29274 @subsubheading Example
29275
29276 @smallexample
29277 (gdb)
29278 200-break-insert callee4
29279 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29280 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29281 (gdb)
29282 000-exec-run
29283 000^running
29284 (gdb)
29285 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29286 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29288 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29289 (gdb)
29290 205-break-delete
29291 205^done
29292 (gdb)
29293 111-exec-return
29294 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29295 args=[@{name="strarg",
29296 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29297 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29298 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
29299 (gdb)
29300 @end smallexample
29301
29302
29303 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29304 @findex -exec-run
29305
29306 @subsubheading Synopsis
29307
29308 @smallexample
29309 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29310 @end smallexample
29311
29312 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29313 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29314 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29315 the program has exited exceptionally.
29316
29317 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29318 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29319 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29320 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29321 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29322
29323 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29324 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29325 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29326 (@pxref{Starting}).
29327
29328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29329
29330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29331
29332 @subsubheading Examples
29333
29334 @smallexample
29335 (gdb)
29336 -break-insert main
29337 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29338 (gdb)
29339 -exec-run
29340 ^running
29341 (gdb)
29342 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29343 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29344 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29345 (gdb)
29346 @end smallexample
29347
29348 @noindent
29349 Program exited normally:
29350
29351 @smallexample
29352 (gdb)
29353 -exec-run
29354 ^running
29355 (gdb)
29356 x = 55
29357 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29358 (gdb)
29359 @end smallexample
29360
29361 @noindent
29362 Program exited exceptionally:
29363
29364 @smallexample
29365 (gdb)
29366 -exec-run
29367 ^running
29368 (gdb)
29369 x = 55
29370 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29371 (gdb)
29372 @end smallexample
29373
29374 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29375 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29376
29377 @smallexample
29378 (gdb)
29379 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29380 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29381 @end smallexample
29382
29383
29384 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29385
29386
29387 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29388 @findex -exec-step
29389
29390 @subsubheading Synopsis
29391
29392 @smallexample
29393 -exec-step [--reverse]
29394 @end smallexample
29395
29396 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29397 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29398 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29399 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29400 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29401 previously executed source line.
29402
29403 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29404
29405 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29406
29407 @subsubheading Example
29408
29409 Stepping into a function:
29410
29411 @smallexample
29412 -exec-step
29413 ^running
29414 (gdb)
29415 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29416 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29417 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29418 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
29419 (gdb)
29420 @end smallexample
29421
29422 Regular stepping:
29423
29424 @smallexample
29425 -exec-step
29426 ^running
29427 (gdb)
29428 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29429 (gdb)
29430 @end smallexample
29431
29432
29433 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29434 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29435
29436 @subsubheading Synopsis
29437
29438 @smallexample
29439 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29440 @end smallexample
29441
29442 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29443 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29444 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29445 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29446 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29447 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29448 as well.
29449
29450 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29451
29452 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29453
29454 @subsubheading Example
29455
29456 @smallexample
29457 (gdb)
29458 -exec-step-instruction
29459 ^running
29460
29461 (gdb)
29462 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29463 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29464 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29465 (gdb)
29466 -exec-step-instruction
29467 ^running
29468
29469 (gdb)
29470 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29471 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29472 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29473 (gdb)
29474 @end smallexample
29475
29476
29477 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29478 @findex -exec-until
29479
29480 @subsubheading Synopsis
29481
29482 @smallexample
29483 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29484 @end smallexample
29485
29486 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29487 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29488 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29489 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29490
29491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29492
29493 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29494
29495 @subsubheading Example
29496
29497 @smallexample
29498 (gdb)
29499 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29500 ^running
29501 (gdb)
29502 x = 55
29503 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29504 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29505 (gdb)
29506 @end smallexample
29507
29508 @ignore
29509 @subheading -file-clear
29510 Is this going away????
29511 @end ignore
29512
29513 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29514 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29515 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29516
29517 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29518 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29519
29520 @smallexample
29521 -enable-frame-filters
29522 @end smallexample
29523
29524 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29525 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29526 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29527 request that this functionality be enabled.
29528
29529 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29530
29531 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29532 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29533
29534 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29535 @findex -stack-info-frame
29536
29537 @subsubheading Synopsis
29538
29539 @smallexample
29540 -stack-info-frame
29541 @end smallexample
29542
29543 Get info on the selected frame.
29544
29545 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29546
29547 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29548 (without arguments).
29549
29550 @subsubheading Example
29551
29552 @smallexample
29553 (gdb)
29554 -stack-info-frame
29555 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29556 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29557 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29558 (gdb)
29559 @end smallexample
29560
29561 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29562 @findex -stack-info-depth
29563
29564 @subsubheading Synopsis
29565
29566 @smallexample
29567 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29568 @end smallexample
29569
29570 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29571 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29572
29573 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29574
29575 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29576
29577 @subsubheading Example
29578
29579 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29580
29581 @smallexample
29582 (gdb)
29583 -stack-info-depth
29584 ^done,depth="12"
29585 (gdb)
29586 -stack-info-depth 4
29587 ^done,depth="4"
29588 (gdb)
29589 -stack-info-depth 12
29590 ^done,depth="12"
29591 (gdb)
29592 -stack-info-depth 11
29593 ^done,depth="11"
29594 (gdb)
29595 -stack-info-depth 13
29596 ^done,depth="12"
29597 (gdb)
29598 @end smallexample
29599
29600 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29601 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29602 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29603
29604 @subsubheading Synopsis
29605
29606 @smallexample
29607 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29608 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29609 @end smallexample
29610
29611 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29612 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29613 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29614 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29615 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29616 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29617 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29618 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29619
29620 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29621 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29622 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29623 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29624 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29625 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29626
29627 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29628 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29629 are still displayed, however.
29630
29631 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29632 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29633
29634 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29635
29636 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29637 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
29638 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
29639
29640 @subsubheading Example
29641
29642 @smallexample
29643 (gdb)
29644 -stack-list-frames
29645 ^done,
29646 stack=[
29647 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
29648 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29649 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
29650 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29651 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29652 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
29653 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
29654 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29655 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
29656 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
29657 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29658 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
29659 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
29660 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29661 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
29662 (gdb)
29663 -stack-list-arguments 0
29664 ^done,
29665 stack-args=[
29666 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29667 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
29668 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
29669 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
29670 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29671 (gdb)
29672 -stack-list-arguments 1
29673 ^done,
29674 stack-args=[
29675 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
29676 frame=@{level="1",
29677 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29678 frame=@{level="2",args=[
29679 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29680 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
29681 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
29682 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29683 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
29684 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
29685 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
29686 (gdb)
29687 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
29688 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
29689 (gdb)
29690 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
29691 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
29692 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
29693 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
29694 (gdb)
29695 @end smallexample
29696
29697 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
29698
29699
29700 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
29701 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
29702 @findex -stack-list-frames
29703
29704 @subsubheading Synopsis
29705
29706 @smallexample
29707 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29708 @end smallexample
29709
29710 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
29711 following info:
29712
29713 @table @samp
29714 @item @var{level}
29715 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
29716 @item @var{addr}
29717 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
29718 @item @var{func}
29719 Function name.
29720 @item @var{file}
29721 File name of the source file where the function lives.
29722 @item @var{fullname}
29723 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
29724 @item @var{line}
29725 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
29726 @item @var{from}
29727 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
29728 if the frame's function is not known.
29729 @end table
29730
29731 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
29732 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
29733 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
29734 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
29735 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
29736 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
29737 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
29738 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29739 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29740
29741 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29742
29743 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
29744
29745 @subsubheading Example
29746
29747 Full stack backtrace:
29748
29749 @smallexample
29750 (gdb)
29751 -stack-list-frames
29752 ^done,stack=
29753 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
29754 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
29755 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29756 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29757 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29758 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29759 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29760 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29761 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29762 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29763 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29764 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29765 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29766 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29767 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29768 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29769 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29770 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29771 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29772 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29773 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29774 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29775 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
29776 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
29777 (gdb)
29778 @end smallexample
29779
29780 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
29781
29782 @smallexample
29783 (gdb)
29784 -stack-list-frames 3 5
29785 ^done,stack=
29786 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29787 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29788 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29789 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29790 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29791 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29792 (gdb)
29793 @end smallexample
29794
29795 Show a single frame:
29796
29797 @smallexample
29798 (gdb)
29799 -stack-list-frames 3 3
29800 ^done,stack=
29801 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
29802 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
29803 (gdb)
29804 @end smallexample
29805
29806
29807 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
29808 @findex -stack-list-locals
29809 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
29810
29811 @subsubheading Synopsis
29812
29813 @smallexample
29814 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29815 @end smallexample
29816
29817 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
29818 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29819 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29820 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29821 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29822 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
29823 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
29824 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
29825 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
29826 Python frame filters will not be executed.
29827
29828 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29829 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
29830 variables are still displayed, however.
29831
29832 This command is deprecated in favor of the
29833 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29834
29835 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29836
29837 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
29838
29839 @subsubheading Example
29840
29841 @smallexample
29842 (gdb)
29843 -stack-list-locals 0
29844 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
29845 (gdb)
29846 -stack-list-locals --all-values
29847 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
29848 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
29849 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
29850 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
29851 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
29852 (gdb)
29853 @end smallexample
29854
29855 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
29856 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
29857 @findex -stack-list-variables
29858
29859 @subsubheading Synopsis
29860
29861 @smallexample
29862 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29863 @end smallexample
29864
29865 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
29866 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29867 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29868 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29869 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29870 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29871 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29872
29873 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
29874 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
29875 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
29876
29877 @subsubheading Example
29878
29879 @smallexample
29880 (gdb)
29881 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
29882 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
29883 (gdb)
29884 @end smallexample
29885
29886
29887 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
29888 @findex -stack-select-frame
29889
29890 @subsubheading Synopsis
29891
29892 @smallexample
29893 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
29894 @end smallexample
29895
29896 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
29897 the stack.
29898
29899 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
29900 option to every command.
29901
29902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29903
29904 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
29905 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
29906
29907 @subsubheading Example
29908
29909 @smallexample
29910 (gdb)
29911 -stack-select-frame 2
29912 ^done
29913 (gdb)
29914 @end smallexample
29915
29916 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29917 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
29918 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
29919
29920 @ignore
29921
29922 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29923
29924 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
29925 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
29926 used by @code{Insight}.
29927
29928 The two main reasons for that are:
29929
29930 @enumerate 1
29931 @item
29932 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
29933
29934 @item
29935 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
29936 now).
29937 @end enumerate
29938
29939 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
29940 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
29941 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
29942 hints about their use.
29943
29944 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
29945 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
29946 least, the following operations:
29947
29948 @itemize @bullet
29949 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
29950 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
29951 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
29952 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
29953 @end itemize
29954
29955 @end ignore
29956
29957 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
29958
29959 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
29960
29961 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
29962 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
29963 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
29964 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
29965 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
29966 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
29967 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
29968 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
29969 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
29970 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
29971 object, or to change display format.
29972
29973 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
29974 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
29975 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
29976 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
29977 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
29978 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
29979 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
29980 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
29981 child will be created.
29982
29983 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
29984 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
29985 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
29986 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
29987 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
29988
29989 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
29990 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
29991 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
29992 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
29993 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
29994 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
29995 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
29996 variables that frontend has created.
29997
29998 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
29999 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30000 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30001 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30002 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30003 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30004 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30005 implicitly updated.
30006
30007 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30008 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30009 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30010 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30011 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30012 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30013 frame. Consider this example:
30014
30015 @smallexample
30016 void do_work(...)
30017 @{
30018 struct work_state state;
30019
30020 if (...)
30021 do_work(...);
30022 @}
30023 @end smallexample
30024
30025 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30026 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30027 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30028 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30029 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30030
30031 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30032 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30033 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30034 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30035 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30036 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30037
30038 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30039 access this functionality:
30040
30041 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30042 @item @strong{Operation}
30043 @tab @strong{Description}
30044
30045 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30046 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30047 @item @code{-var-create}
30048 @tab create a variable object
30049 @item @code{-var-delete}
30050 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30051 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30052 @tab set the display format of this variable
30053 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30054 @tab show the display format of this variable
30055 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30056 @tab tells how many children this object has
30057 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30058 @tab return a list of the object's children
30059 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30060 @tab show the type of this variable object
30061 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30062 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30063 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30064 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30065 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30066 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30067 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30068 @tab get the value of this variable
30069 @item @code{-var-assign}
30070 @tab set the value of this variable
30071 @item @code{-var-update}
30072 @tab update the variable and its children
30073 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30074 @tab set frozeness attribute
30075 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30076 @tab set range of children to display on update
30077 @end multitable
30078
30079 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30080 how it can be used.
30081
30082 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30083
30084 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30085 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30086
30087 @smallexample
30088 -enable-pretty-printing
30089 @end smallexample
30090
30091 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30092 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30093 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30094 request that this functionality be enabled.
30095
30096 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30097
30098 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30099 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30100
30101 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30102 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30103
30104 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30105 @findex -var-create
30106
30107 @subsubheading Synopsis
30108
30109 @smallexample
30110 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30111 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30112 @end smallexample
30113
30114 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30115 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30116 register.
30117
30118 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30119 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30120 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30121 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30122 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30123
30124 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30125 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30126 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30127 object must be created.
30128
30129 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30130 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30131
30132 @itemize @bullet
30133 @item
30134 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30135
30136 @item
30137 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30138
30139 @item
30140 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30141 @end itemize
30142
30143 @cindex dynamic varobj
30144 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30145 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30146 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30147 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30148 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30149 compatibility for existing clients.
30150
30151 @subsubheading Result
30152
30153 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30154 are:
30155
30156 @table @samp
30157 @item name
30158 The name of the varobj.
30159
30160 @item numchild
30161 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30162 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30163 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30164
30165 @item value
30166 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30167 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30168 will not be interesting.
30169
30170 @item type
30171 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30172 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30173 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30174 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30175 @emph{declared} one.
30176
30177 @item thread-id
30178 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30179 thread's global identifier.
30180
30181 @item has_more
30182 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30183 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30184
30185 @item dynamic
30186 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30187 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30188 then this attribute will not be present.
30189
30190 @item displayhint
30191 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30192 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30193 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30194 @end table
30195
30196 Typical output will look like this:
30197
30198 @smallexample
30199 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30200 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30201 @end smallexample
30202
30203
30204 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30205 @findex -var-delete
30206
30207 @subsubheading Synopsis
30208
30209 @smallexample
30210 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30211 @end smallexample
30212
30213 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30214 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30215
30216 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30217
30218
30219 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30220 @findex -var-set-format
30221
30222 @subsubheading Synopsis
30223
30224 @smallexample
30225 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30226 @end smallexample
30227
30228 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30229 @var{format-spec}.
30230
30231 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30232 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30233
30234 @smallexample
30235 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30236 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30240 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30241 for pointers, etc.).
30242
30243 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30244 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30245 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30246 zero-hexadecimal format.
30247
30248 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30249 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30250
30251 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30252 @findex -var-show-format
30253
30254 @subsubheading Synopsis
30255
30256 @smallexample
30257 -var-show-format @var{name}
30258 @end smallexample
30259
30260 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30261
30262 @smallexample
30263 @var{format} @expansion{}
30264 @var{format-spec}
30265 @end smallexample
30266
30267
30268 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30269 @findex -var-info-num-children
30270
30271 @subsubheading Synopsis
30272
30273 @smallexample
30274 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30275 @end smallexample
30276
30277 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30278
30279 @smallexample
30280 numchild=@var{n}
30281 @end smallexample
30282
30283 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30284 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30285 be available.
30286
30287
30288 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30289 @findex -var-list-children
30290
30291 @subsubheading Synopsis
30292
30293 @smallexample
30294 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30295 @end smallexample
30296 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30297
30298 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30299 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30300 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30301 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30302 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30303 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30304 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30305 and unions.
30306
30307 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30308 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30309 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30310 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30311 reported.
30312
30313 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30314 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30315 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30316 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30317 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30318 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30319 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30320 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30321 the visible items.
30322
30323 For each child the following results are returned:
30324
30325 @table @var
30326
30327 @item name
30328 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30329
30330 @item exp
30331 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30332 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30333
30334 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30335 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30336
30337 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30338 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30339 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30340 type and value are not present.
30341
30342 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30343 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30344 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30345
30346 @item numchild
30347 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30348 0.
30349
30350 @item type
30351 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30352 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30353 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30354 @emph{declared} one.
30355
30356 @item value
30357 If values were requested, this is the value.
30358
30359 @item thread-id
30360 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30361 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30362
30363 @item frozen
30364 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30365
30366 @item displayhint
30367 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30368 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30369 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30370
30371 @item dynamic
30372 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30373 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30374 then this attribute will not be present.
30375
30376 @end table
30377
30378 The result may have its own attributes:
30379
30380 @table @samp
30381 @item displayhint
30382 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30383 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30384 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30385
30386 @item has_more
30387 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30388 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30389 @end table
30390
30391 @subsubheading Example
30392
30393 @smallexample
30394 (gdb)
30395 -var-list-children n
30396 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30397 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30398 (gdb)
30399 -var-list-children --all-values n
30400 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30401 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30402 @end smallexample
30403
30404
30405 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30406 @findex -var-info-type
30407
30408 @subsubheading Synopsis
30409
30410 @smallexample
30411 -var-info-type @var{name}
30412 @end smallexample
30413
30414 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30415 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30416 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30417
30418 @smallexample
30419 type=@var{typename}
30420 @end smallexample
30421
30422
30423 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30424 @findex -var-info-expression
30425
30426 @subsubheading Synopsis
30427
30428 @smallexample
30429 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30430 @end smallexample
30431
30432 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30433 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30434 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30435
30436 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30437 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30438
30439 @smallexample
30440 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30441 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30442 @end smallexample
30443
30444 @noindent
30445 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30446 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30447
30448 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30449 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30450 is of limited use.
30451
30452 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30453 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30454
30455 @subsubheading Synopsis
30456
30457 @smallexample
30458 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30459 @end smallexample
30460
30461 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30462 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30463 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30464 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30465 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30466 watchpoint from a variable object.
30467
30468 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30469 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30470
30471 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30472 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30473 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30474 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30475 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30476 @smallexample
30477 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30478 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30479 @end smallexample
30480
30481 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30482 @findex -var-show-attributes
30483
30484 @subsubheading Synopsis
30485
30486 @smallexample
30487 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30488 @end smallexample
30489
30490 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30491
30492 @smallexample
30493 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30494 @end smallexample
30495
30496 @noindent
30497 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30498
30499 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30500 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30501
30502 @subsubheading Synopsis
30503
30504 @smallexample
30505 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30506 @end smallexample
30507
30508 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30509 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30510 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30511 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30512 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30513 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30514 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30515
30516 @smallexample
30517 value=@var{value}
30518 @end smallexample
30519
30520 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30521 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30522
30523 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30524 @findex -var-assign
30525
30526 @subsubheading Synopsis
30527
30528 @smallexample
30529 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30530 @end smallexample
30531
30532 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30533 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30534 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30535 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30536
30537 @subsubheading Example
30538
30539 @smallexample
30540 (gdb)
30541 -var-assign var1 3
30542 ^done,value="3"
30543 (gdb)
30544 -var-update *
30545 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30546 (gdb)
30547 @end smallexample
30548
30549 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30550 @findex -var-update
30551
30552 @subsubheading Synopsis
30553
30554 @smallexample
30555 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30556 @end smallexample
30557
30558 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30559 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30560 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30561 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30562 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30563 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30564 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30565 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30566 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30567 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30568 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30569 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30570 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30571
30572 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30573 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30574 diagnostic.
30575
30576 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30577 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30578
30579 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30580 @samp{changelist}.
30581
30582 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30583
30584 @table @samp
30585 @item name
30586 The name of the varobj.
30587
30588 @item value
30589 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30590 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30591
30592 @item in_scope
30593 @anchor{-var-update}
30594 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30595
30596 @table @code
30597 @item "true"
30598 The variable object's current value is valid.
30599
30600 @item "false"
30601 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30602 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30603 scope.
30604
30605 @item "invalid"
30606 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30607 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30608 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30609 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30610 objects.
30611 @end table
30612
30613 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30614 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30615
30616 @item type_changed
30617 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30618 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30619 be @samp{false}.
30620
30621 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30622 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30623 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30624 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30625 unset.
30626
30627 @item new_type
30628 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30629 hold the new type.
30630
30631 @item new_num_children
30632 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30633 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30634
30635 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30636 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30637 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
30638 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
30639 children which may be available.
30640
30641 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
30642 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
30643 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
30644 only happen at the end of the update range).
30645
30646 @item displayhint
30647 The display hint, if any.
30648
30649 @item has_more
30650 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
30651 available outside the varobj's update range.
30652
30653 @item dynamic
30654 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30655 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30656 then this attribute will not be present.
30657
30658 @item new_children
30659 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
30660 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
30661 be listed in this attribute.
30662 @end table
30663
30664 @subsubheading Example
30665
30666 @smallexample
30667 (gdb)
30668 -var-assign var1 3
30669 ^done,value="3"
30670 (gdb)
30671 -var-update --all-values var1
30672 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
30673 type_changed="false"@}]
30674 (gdb)
30675 @end smallexample
30676
30677 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
30678 @findex -var-set-frozen
30679 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
30680
30681 @subsubheading Synopsis
30682
30683 @smallexample
30684 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
30685 @end smallexample
30686
30687 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
30688 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
30689 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
30690 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
30691 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
30692 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
30693 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
30694 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
30695 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
30696 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
30697 @code{-var-update} does.
30698
30699 @subsubheading Example
30700
30701 @smallexample
30702 (gdb)
30703 -var-set-frozen V 1
30704 ^done
30705 (gdb)
30706 @end smallexample
30707
30708 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
30709 @findex -var-set-update-range
30710 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
30711
30712 @subsubheading Synopsis
30713
30714 @smallexample
30715 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
30716 @end smallexample
30717
30718 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
30719 @code{-var-update}.
30720
30721 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
30722 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
30723 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
30724 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
30725
30726 @subsubheading Example
30727
30728 @smallexample
30729 (gdb)
30730 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
30731 ^done
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
30735 @findex -var-set-visualizer
30736 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
30737
30738 @subsubheading Synopsis
30739
30740 @smallexample
30741 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
30742 @end smallexample
30743
30744 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
30745
30746 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
30747 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
30748
30749 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
30750 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
30751 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
30752 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
30753 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
30754 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
30755 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
30756
30757 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
30758 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
30759 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
30760 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
30761
30762 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
30763 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
30764 can be used to check this.
30765
30766 @subsubheading Example
30767
30768 Resetting the visualizer:
30769
30770 @smallexample
30771 (gdb)
30772 -var-set-visualizer V None
30773 ^done
30774 @end smallexample
30775
30776 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
30777
30778 @smallexample
30779 (gdb)
30780 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
30781 ^done
30782 @end smallexample
30783
30784 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
30785 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
30786
30787 @smallexample
30788 (gdb)
30789 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
30790 ^done
30791 @end smallexample
30792
30793 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30794 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
30795 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
30796
30797 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
30798 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
30799 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
30800 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
30801
30802 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
30803 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
30804
30805 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
30806 @c @subheading -data-assign
30807 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
30808 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
30809 @c set variable
30810 @c @subsubheading Example
30811 @c N.A.
30812
30813 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
30814 @findex -data-disassemble
30815
30816 @subsubheading Synopsis
30817
30818 @smallexample
30819 -data-disassemble
30820 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
30821 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
30822 -- @var{mode}
30823 @end smallexample
30824
30825 @noindent
30826 Where:
30827
30828 @table @samp
30829 @item @var{start-addr}
30830 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
30831 @item @var{end-addr}
30832 is the end address
30833 @item @var{filename}
30834 is the name of the file to disassemble
30835 @item @var{linenum}
30836 is the line number to disassemble around
30837 @item @var{lines}
30838 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
30839 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
30840 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
30841 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
30842 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
30843 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
30844 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
30845 are displayed.
30846 @item @var{mode}
30847 is one of:
30848 @itemize @bullet
30849 @item 0 disassembly only
30850 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
30851 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
30852 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
30853 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
30854 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
30855 @end itemize
30856
30857 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
30858 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
30859 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
30860 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
30861 @end table
30862
30863 @subsubheading Result
30864
30865 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
30866 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
30867 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
30868
30869 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
30870 following fields:
30871
30872 @table @code
30873 @item address
30874 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
30875
30876 @item func-name
30877 The name of the function this instruction is within.
30878
30879 @item offset
30880 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
30881
30882 @item inst
30883 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
30884
30885 @item opcodes
30886 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
30887 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
30888
30889 @end table
30890
30891 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
30892 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
30893
30894 @table @code
30895 @item line
30896 The line number within @samp{file}.
30897
30898 @item file
30899 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
30900 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
30901 used.
30902
30903 @item fullname
30904 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
30905 using the source file search path
30906 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
30907 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
30908
30909 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
30910 present in the debug information.
30911
30912 @item line_asm_insn
30913 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
30914 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
30915 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
30916 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
30917 @samp{opcodes}.
30918
30919 @end table
30920
30921 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
30922 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
30923 adjust its format.
30924
30925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30926
30927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
30928
30929 @subsubheading Example
30930
30931 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
30932
30933 @smallexample
30934 (gdb)
30935 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
30936 ^done,
30937 asm_insns=[
30938 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30939 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30940 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30941 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30942 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
30943 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
30944 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
30945 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30946 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
30947 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
30948 (gdb)
30949 @end smallexample
30950
30951 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
30952 @code{main}.
30953
30954 @smallexample
30955 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
30956 ^done,asm_insns=[
30957 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30958 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30959 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30960 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30961 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30962 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
30963 [@dots{}]
30964 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
30965 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
30966 (gdb)
30967 @end smallexample
30968
30969 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
30970
30971 @smallexample
30972 (gdb)
30973 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
30974 ^done,asm_insns=[
30975 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
30976 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
30977 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
30978 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
30979 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
30980 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
30981 (gdb)
30982 @end smallexample
30983
30984 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
30985
30986 @smallexample
30987 (gdb)
30988 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
30989 ^done,asm_insns=[
30990 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
30991 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30992 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30993 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
30994 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
30995 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
30996 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30997 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30998 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
30999 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31000 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31001 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31002 (gdb)
31003 @end smallexample
31004
31005
31006 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31007 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31008
31009 @subsubheading Synopsis
31010
31011 @smallexample
31012 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31013 @end smallexample
31014
31015 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31016 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31017 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31018
31019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31020
31021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31022 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31023 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31024
31025 @subsubheading Example
31026
31027 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31028 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31029 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31030 output.
31031
31032 @smallexample
31033 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31034 211^done,value="1"
31035 (gdb)
31036 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31037 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31038 (gdb)
31039 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31040 411^done,value="4"
31041 (gdb)
31042 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31043 511^done,value="4"
31044 (gdb)
31045 @end smallexample
31046
31047
31048 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31049 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31050
31051 @subsubheading Synopsis
31052
31053 @smallexample
31054 -data-list-changed-registers
31055 @end smallexample
31056
31057 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31058
31059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31060
31061 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31062 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31063
31064 @subsubheading Example
31065
31066 On a PPC MBX board:
31067
31068 @smallexample
31069 (gdb)
31070 -exec-continue
31071 ^running
31072
31073 (gdb)
31074 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31075 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31076 line="5"@}
31077 (gdb)
31078 -data-list-changed-registers
31079 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31080 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31081 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31082 (gdb)
31083 @end smallexample
31084
31085
31086 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31087 @findex -data-list-register-names
31088
31089 @subsubheading Synopsis
31090
31091 @smallexample
31092 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31093 @end smallexample
31094
31095 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31096 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31097 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31098 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31099 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31100 include empty register names.
31101
31102 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31103
31104 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31105 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31106 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31107
31108 @subsubheading Example
31109
31110 For the PPC MBX board:
31111 @smallexample
31112 (gdb)
31113 -data-list-register-names
31114 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31115 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31116 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31117 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31118 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31119 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31120 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31121 (gdb)
31122 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31123 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31124 (gdb)
31125 @end smallexample
31126
31127 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31128 @findex -data-list-register-values
31129
31130 @subsubheading Synopsis
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 -data-list-register-values
31134 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31135 @end smallexample
31136
31137 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31138 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31139 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31140 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31141 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31142 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31143
31144 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31145
31146 @table @code
31147 @item x
31148 Hexadecimal
31149 @item o
31150 Octal
31151 @item t
31152 Binary
31153 @item d
31154 Decimal
31155 @item r
31156 Raw
31157 @item N
31158 Natural
31159 @end table
31160
31161 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31162
31163 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31164 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31165
31166 @subsubheading Example
31167
31168 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31169 don't appear in the actual output):
31170
31171 @smallexample
31172 (gdb)
31173 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31174 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31175 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31176 (gdb)
31177 -data-list-register-values x
31178 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31179 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31180 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31181 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31182 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31183 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31184 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31185 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31186 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31187 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31188 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31189 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31190 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31191 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31192 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31193 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31194 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31195 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31196 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31197 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31198 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31199 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31200 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31201 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31202 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31203 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31204 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31205 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31206 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31207 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31208 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31209 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31210 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31211 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31212 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31213 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31214 (gdb)
31215 @end smallexample
31216
31217
31218 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31219 @findex -data-read-memory
31220
31221 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31222
31223 @subsubheading Synopsis
31224
31225 @smallexample
31226 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31227 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31228 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31229 @end smallexample
31230
31231 @noindent
31232 where:
31233
31234 @table @samp
31235 @item @var{address}
31236 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31237 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31238 quoted using the C convention.
31239
31240 @item @var{word-format}
31241 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31242 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31243 ,Output Formats}).
31244
31245 @item @var{word-size}
31246 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31247
31248 @item @var{nr-rows}
31249 The number of rows in the output table.
31250
31251 @item @var{nr-cols}
31252 The number of columns in the output table.
31253
31254 @item @var{aschar}
31255 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31256 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31257 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31258 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31259
31260 @item @var{byte-offset}
31261 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31262 @end table
31263
31264 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31265 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31266 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31267 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31268 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31269 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31270 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31271 @samp{addr}.
31272
31273 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31274 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31275 @samp{prev-page}.
31276
31277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31278
31279 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31280 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31281
31282 @subsubheading Example
31283
31284 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31285 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31286 word. Display each word in hex.
31287
31288 @smallexample
31289 (gdb)
31290 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31291 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31292 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31293 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31294 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31295 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31296 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31297 (gdb)
31298 @end smallexample
31299
31300 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31301 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31302
31303 @smallexample
31304 (gdb)
31305 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31306 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31307 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31308 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31309 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31310 (gdb)
31311 @end smallexample
31312
31313 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31314 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31315 used as the non-printable character.
31316
31317 @smallexample
31318 (gdb)
31319 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31320 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31321 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31322 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31323 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31324 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31325 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31326 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31327 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31328 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31329 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31330 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31331 (gdb)
31332 @end smallexample
31333
31334 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31335 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31336
31337 @subsubheading Synopsis
31338
31339 @smallexample
31340 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31341 @var{address} @var{count}
31342 @end smallexample
31343
31344 @noindent
31345 where:
31346
31347 @table @samp
31348 @item @var{address}
31349 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31350 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31351 quoted using the C convention.
31352
31353 @item @var{count}
31354 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31355 literal.
31356
31357 @item @var{offset}
31358 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31359 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31360 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31361 arithmetics itself.
31362
31363 @end table
31364
31365 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31366 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31367 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31368 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31369 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31370 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31371
31372 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31373 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31374 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31375 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31376 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31377 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31378 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31379 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31380
31381 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31382 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31383 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31384 and has the following fields:
31385
31386 @table @code
31387 @item begin
31388 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31389
31390 @item end
31391 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31392
31393 @item offset
31394 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31395 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31396
31397 @item contents
31398 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31399
31400 @end table
31401
31402
31403
31404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31405
31406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31407
31408 @subsubheading Example
31409
31410 @smallexample
31411 (gdb)
31412 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31413 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31414 end="0xbffff15e",
31415 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31416 (gdb)
31417 @end smallexample
31418
31419
31420 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31421 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31422
31423 @subsubheading Synopsis
31424
31425 @smallexample
31426 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31427 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31428 @end smallexample
31429
31430 @noindent
31431 where:
31432
31433 @table @samp
31434 @item @var{address}
31435 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31436 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31437 be quoted using the C convention.
31438
31439 @item @var{contents}
31440 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31441 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31442
31443 @item @var{count}
31444 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31445 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31446 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31447 @var{count} memory units.
31448
31449 @end table
31450
31451 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31452
31453 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31454
31455 @subsubheading Example
31456
31457 @smallexample
31458 (gdb)
31459 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31460 ^done
31461 (gdb)
31462 @end smallexample
31463
31464 @smallexample
31465 (gdb)
31466 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31467 ^done
31468 (gdb)
31469 @end smallexample
31470
31471 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31472 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31473 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31474
31475 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31476 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31477
31478 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31479 @findex -trace-find
31480
31481 @subsubheading Synopsis
31482
31483 @smallexample
31484 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31485 @end smallexample
31486
31487 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31488 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31489 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31490
31491 @table @samp
31492
31493 @item none
31494 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31495
31496 @item frame-number
31497 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31498 that index.
31499
31500 @item tracepoint-number
31501 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31502 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31503
31504 @item pc
31505 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31506 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31507 address.
31508
31509 @item pc-inside-range
31510 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31511 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31512 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31513
31514 @item pc-outside-range
31515 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31516 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31517 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31518
31519 @item line
31520 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31521 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31522 the specified location.
31523
31524 @end table
31525
31526 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31527 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31528
31529 @table @samp
31530 @item found
31531 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31532 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31533
31534 @item traceframe
31535 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31536 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31537
31538 @item tracepoint
31539 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31540 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31541
31542 @item frame
31543 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31544 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31545 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31546
31547 @end table
31548
31549 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31550
31551 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31552
31553 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31554 @findex -trace-define-variable
31555
31556 @subsubheading Synopsis
31557
31558 @smallexample
31559 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31560 @end smallexample
31561
31562 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31563 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31564 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31565 with the @samp{$} character.
31566
31567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31568
31569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31570
31571 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31572 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31573
31574 @subsubheading Synopsis
31575
31576 @smallexample
31577 -trace-frame-collected
31578 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31579 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31580 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31581 [--memory-contents]
31582 @end smallexample
31583
31584 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31585 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31586 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31587 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31588 See the output description table below for more details.
31589
31590 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31591 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31592 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31593 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31594 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31595
31596 For instance, if the actions were
31597 @smallexample
31598 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31599 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31600 @end smallexample
31601
31602 @noindent
31603 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31604 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31605 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31606 objects would be computed expressions.
31607
31608 An example output would be:
31609
31610 @smallexample
31611 (gdb)
31612 -trace-frame-collected
31613 ^done,
31614 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31615 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31616 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31617 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31618 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31619 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31620 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31621 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31622 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31623 ...
31624 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31625 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31626 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31627 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31628 (gdb)
31629 @end smallexample
31630
31631 Where:
31632
31633 @table @code
31634 @item explicit-variables
31635 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31636 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31637 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
31638 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
31639 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
31640 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
31641 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
31642 arrays, structures and unions.
31643
31644 @item computed-expressions
31645 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
31646 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
31647 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
31648 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
31649
31650 @item registers
31651 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
31652 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
31653 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
31654 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
31655 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
31656
31657 @item tvars
31658 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
31659 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
31660 current value are returned.
31661
31662 @item memory
31663 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
31664 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
31665 collected memory range and has the following fields:
31666
31667 @table @code
31668 @item address
31669 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
31670
31671 @item length
31672 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
31673
31674 @item contents
31675 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
31676 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
31677
31678 @end table
31679
31680 @end table
31681
31682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31683
31684 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31685
31686 @subsubheading Example
31687
31688 @subheading -trace-list-variables
31689 @findex -trace-list-variables
31690
31691 @subsubheading Synopsis
31692
31693 @smallexample
31694 -trace-list-variables
31695 @end smallexample
31696
31697 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
31698 table has the following fields:
31699
31700 @table @samp
31701 @item name
31702 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
31703
31704 @item initial
31705 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
31706 field is always present.
31707
31708 @item current
31709 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
31710 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
31711 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
31712 presently running.
31713
31714 @end table
31715
31716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31717
31718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
31719
31720 @subsubheading Example
31721
31722 @smallexample
31723 (gdb)
31724 -trace-list-variables
31725 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
31726 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31727 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
31728 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
31729 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
31730 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
31731 (gdb)
31732 @end smallexample
31733
31734 @subheading -trace-save
31735 @findex -trace-save
31736
31737 @subsubheading Synopsis
31738
31739 @smallexample
31740 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
31741 @end smallexample
31742
31743 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
31744 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
31745 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
31746 to perform the save.
31747
31748 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
31749 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
31750 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
31751
31752 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31753
31754 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
31755
31756
31757 @subheading -trace-start
31758 @findex -trace-start
31759
31760 @subsubheading Synopsis
31761
31762 @smallexample
31763 -trace-start
31764 @end smallexample
31765
31766 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
31767 have any fields.
31768
31769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31770
31771 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
31772
31773 @subheading -trace-status
31774 @findex -trace-status
31775
31776 @subsubheading Synopsis
31777
31778 @smallexample
31779 -trace-status
31780 @end smallexample
31781
31782 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
31783 the following fields:
31784
31785 @table @samp
31786
31787 @item supported
31788 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
31789 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
31790 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
31791 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
31792 started. This field is always present.
31793
31794 @item running
31795 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
31796 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
31797 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31798
31799 @item stop-reason
31800 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
31801 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
31802 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
31803 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
31804 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
31805 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
31806 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
31807 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
31808 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
31809
31810 @item stopping-tracepoint
31811 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
31812 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
31813 @samp{passcount}.
31814
31815 @item frames
31816 @itemx frames-created
31817 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
31818 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
31819 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
31820 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
31821
31822 @item buffer-size
31823 @itemx buffer-free
31824 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
31825 remaining space. These fields are optional.
31826
31827 @item circular
31828 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
31829 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
31830 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
31831 and may fill up.
31832
31833 @item disconnected
31834 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
31835 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
31836 that the trace run will stop.
31837
31838 @item trace-file
31839 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
31840 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
31841
31842 @end table
31843
31844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31845
31846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
31847
31848 @subheading -trace-stop
31849 @findex -trace-stop
31850
31851 @subsubheading Synopsis
31852
31853 @smallexample
31854 -trace-stop
31855 @end smallexample
31856
31857 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
31858 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
31859 @samp{running} fields are not output.
31860
31861 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31862
31863 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
31864
31865
31866 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31867 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
31868 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
31869
31870
31871 @ignore
31872 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
31873 @findex -symbol-info-address
31874
31875 @subsubheading Synopsis
31876
31877 @smallexample
31878 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
31879 @end smallexample
31880
31881 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
31882
31883 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31884
31885 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
31886
31887 @subsubheading Example
31888 N.A.
31889
31890
31891 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
31892 @findex -symbol-info-file
31893
31894 @subsubheading Synopsis
31895
31896 @smallexample
31897 -symbol-info-file
31898 @end smallexample
31899
31900 Show the file for the symbol.
31901
31902 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31903
31904 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
31905 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
31906
31907 @subsubheading Example
31908 N.A.
31909
31910
31911 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
31912 @findex -symbol-info-function
31913
31914 @subsubheading Synopsis
31915
31916 @smallexample
31917 -symbol-info-function
31918 @end smallexample
31919
31920 Show which function the symbol lives in.
31921
31922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31923
31924 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
31925
31926 @subsubheading Example
31927 N.A.
31928
31929
31930 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
31931 @findex -symbol-info-line
31932
31933 @subsubheading Synopsis
31934
31935 @smallexample
31936 -symbol-info-line
31937 @end smallexample
31938
31939 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
31940
31941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31942
31943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
31944 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
31945
31946 @subsubheading Example
31947 N.A.
31948
31949
31950 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
31951 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
31952
31953 @subsubheading Synopsis
31954
31955 @smallexample
31956 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
31957 @end smallexample
31958
31959 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
31960
31961 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31962
31963 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
31964
31965 @subsubheading Example
31966 N.A.
31967
31968
31969 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
31970 @findex -symbol-list-functions
31971
31972 @subsubheading Synopsis
31973
31974 @smallexample
31975 -symbol-list-functions
31976 @end smallexample
31977
31978 List the functions in the executable.
31979
31980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31981
31982 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
31983 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
31984
31985 @subsubheading Example
31986 N.A.
31987 @end ignore
31988
31989
31990 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
31991 @findex -symbol-list-lines
31992
31993 @subsubheading Synopsis
31994
31995 @smallexample
31996 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
31997 @end smallexample
31998
31999 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32000 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32001 ascending PC order.
32002
32003 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32004
32005 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32006
32007 @subsubheading Example
32008 @smallexample
32009 (gdb)
32010 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32011 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32012 (gdb)
32013 @end smallexample
32014
32015
32016 @ignore
32017 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32018 @findex -symbol-list-types
32019
32020 @subsubheading Synopsis
32021
32022 @smallexample
32023 -symbol-list-types
32024 @end smallexample
32025
32026 List all the type names.
32027
32028 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32029
32030 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32031 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32032
32033 @subsubheading Example
32034 N.A.
32035
32036
32037 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32038 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32039
32040 @subsubheading Synopsis
32041
32042 @smallexample
32043 -symbol-list-variables
32044 @end smallexample
32045
32046 List all the global and static variable names.
32047
32048 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32049
32050 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32051
32052 @subsubheading Example
32053 N.A.
32054
32055
32056 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32057 @findex -symbol-locate
32058
32059 @subsubheading Synopsis
32060
32061 @smallexample
32062 -symbol-locate
32063 @end smallexample
32064
32065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32066
32067 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32068
32069 @subsubheading Example
32070 N.A.
32071
32072
32073 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32074 @findex -symbol-type
32075
32076 @subsubheading Synopsis
32077
32078 @smallexample
32079 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32080 @end smallexample
32081
32082 Show type of @var{variable}.
32083
32084 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32085
32086 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32087 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32088
32089 @subsubheading Example
32090 N.A.
32091 @end ignore
32092
32093
32094 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32095 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32096 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32097
32098 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32099 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32100
32101 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32102 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32103
32104 @subsubheading Synopsis
32105
32106 @smallexample
32107 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32108 @end smallexample
32109
32110 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32111 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32112 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32113 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32114 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32115 notification.
32116
32117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32118
32119 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32120
32121 @subsubheading Example
32122
32123 @smallexample
32124 (gdb)
32125 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32126 ^done
32127 (gdb)
32128 @end smallexample
32129
32130
32131 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32132 @findex -file-exec-file
32133
32134 @subsubheading Synopsis
32135
32136 @smallexample
32137 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32138 @end smallexample
32139
32140 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32141 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32142 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32143 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32144 notification.
32145
32146 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32147
32148 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32149
32150 @subsubheading Example
32151
32152 @smallexample
32153 (gdb)
32154 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32155 ^done
32156 (gdb)
32157 @end smallexample
32158
32159
32160 @ignore
32161 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32162 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32163
32164 @subsubheading Synopsis
32165
32166 @smallexample
32167 -file-list-exec-sections
32168 @end smallexample
32169
32170 List the sections of the current executable file.
32171
32172 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32173
32174 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32175 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32176 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32177
32178 @subsubheading Example
32179 N.A.
32180 @end ignore
32181
32182
32183 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32184 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32185
32186 @subsubheading Synopsis
32187
32188 @smallexample
32189 -file-list-exec-source-file
32190 @end smallexample
32191
32192 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32193 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32194 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32195 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32196
32197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32198
32199 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32200
32201 @subsubheading Example
32202
32203 @smallexample
32204 (gdb)
32205 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32206 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32207 (gdb)
32208 @end smallexample
32209
32210
32211 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32212 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32213
32214 @subsubheading Synopsis
32215
32216 @smallexample
32217 -file-list-exec-source-files
32218 @end smallexample
32219
32220 List the source files for the current executable.
32221
32222 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32223 name) of a source file.
32224
32225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32226
32227 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32228 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32229
32230 @subsubheading Example
32231 @smallexample
32232 (gdb)
32233 -file-list-exec-source-files
32234 ^done,files=[
32235 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32236 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32237 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32238 (gdb)
32239 @end smallexample
32240
32241 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32242 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32243
32244 @subsubheading Synopsis
32245
32246 @smallexample
32247 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32248 @end smallexample
32249
32250 List the shared libraries in the program.
32251 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32252 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32253
32254 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32255
32256 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32257 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32258 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32259 library. Each range has the following fields:
32260
32261 @table @samp
32262 @item from
32263 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32264 @item to
32265 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32266 @end table
32267
32268 @subsubheading Example
32269 @smallexample
32270 (gdb)
32271 -file-list-exec-source-files
32272 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32273 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32274 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32275 (gdb)
32276 @end smallexample
32277
32278
32279 @ignore
32280 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32281 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32282
32283 @subsubheading Synopsis
32284
32285 @smallexample
32286 -file-list-symbol-files
32287 @end smallexample
32288
32289 List symbol files.
32290
32291 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32292
32293 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32294
32295 @subsubheading Example
32296 N.A.
32297 @end ignore
32298
32299
32300 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32301 @findex -file-symbol-file
32302
32303 @subsubheading Synopsis
32304
32305 @smallexample
32306 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32307 @end smallexample
32308
32309 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32310 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32311 produced, except for a completion notification.
32312
32313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32314
32315 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32316
32317 @subsubheading Example
32318
32319 @smallexample
32320 (gdb)
32321 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32322 ^done
32323 (gdb)
32324 @end smallexample
32325
32326 @ignore
32327 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32328 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32329 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32330
32331 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32332
32333 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32334
32335 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32336
32337 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32338
32339 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32340
32341 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32342
32343 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32344
32345 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32346
32347 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32348 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32349 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32350
32351 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32352
32353 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32354
32355 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32356
32357 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32358 @end ignore
32359
32360
32361 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32362 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32363 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32364
32365
32366 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32367 @findex -target-attach
32368
32369 @subsubheading Synopsis
32370
32371 @smallexample
32372 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32373 @end smallexample
32374
32375 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32376 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32377 group, the id previously returned by
32378 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32379
32380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32381
32382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32383
32384 @subsubheading Example
32385 @smallexample
32386 (gdb)
32387 -target-attach 34
32388 =thread-created,id="1"
32389 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32390 ^done
32391 (gdb)
32392 @end smallexample
32393
32394 @ignore
32395 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32396 @findex -target-compare-sections
32397
32398 @subsubheading Synopsis
32399
32400 @smallexample
32401 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32402 @end smallexample
32403
32404 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32405 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32406
32407 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32408
32409 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32410
32411 @subsubheading Example
32412 N.A.
32413 @end ignore
32414
32415
32416 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32417 @findex -target-detach
32418
32419 @subsubheading Synopsis
32420
32421 @smallexample
32422 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32423 @end smallexample
32424
32425 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32426 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32427 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32428
32429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32430
32431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32432
32433 @subsubheading Example
32434
32435 @smallexample
32436 (gdb)
32437 -target-detach
32438 ^done
32439 (gdb)
32440 @end smallexample
32441
32442
32443 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32444 @findex -target-disconnect
32445
32446 @subsubheading Synopsis
32447
32448 @smallexample
32449 -target-disconnect
32450 @end smallexample
32451
32452 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32453 generally not resumed.
32454
32455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32456
32457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32458
32459 @subsubheading Example
32460
32461 @smallexample
32462 (gdb)
32463 -target-disconnect
32464 ^done
32465 (gdb)
32466 @end smallexample
32467
32468
32469 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32470 @findex -target-download
32471
32472 @subsubheading Synopsis
32473
32474 @smallexample
32475 -target-download
32476 @end smallexample
32477
32478 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32479 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32480
32481 @table @samp
32482 @item section
32483 The name of the section.
32484 @item section-sent
32485 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32486 @item section-size
32487 The size of the section.
32488 @item total-sent
32489 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32490 @item total-size
32491 The size of the overall executable to download.
32492 @end table
32493
32494 @noindent
32495 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32496 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32497
32498 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32499 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32500
32501 @table @samp
32502 @item section
32503 The name of the section.
32504 @item section-size
32505 The size of the section.
32506 @item total-size
32507 The size of the overall executable to download.
32508 @end table
32509
32510 @noindent
32511 At the end, a summary is printed.
32512
32513 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32514
32515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32516
32517 @subsubheading Example
32518
32519 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32520 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32521
32522 @smallexample
32523 (gdb)
32524 -target-download
32525 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32526 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32527 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32528 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32529 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32530 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32531 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32532 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32533 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32534 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32535 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32536 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32537 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32538 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32539 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32540 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32541 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32542 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32543 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32544 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32545 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32546 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32547 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32548 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32549 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32550 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32551 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32552 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32553 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32554 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32555 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32556 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32557 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32558 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32559 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32560 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32561 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32562 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32563 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32564 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32565 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32566 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32567 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32568 write-rate="429"
32569 (gdb)
32570 @end smallexample
32571
32572
32573 @ignore
32574 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32575 @findex -target-exec-status
32576
32577 @subsubheading Synopsis
32578
32579 @smallexample
32580 -target-exec-status
32581 @end smallexample
32582
32583 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32584 not, for instance).
32585
32586 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32587
32588 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32589
32590 @subsubheading Example
32591 N.A.
32592
32593
32594 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32595 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32596
32597 @subsubheading Synopsis
32598
32599 @smallexample
32600 -target-list-available-targets
32601 @end smallexample
32602
32603 List the possible targets to connect to.
32604
32605 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32606
32607 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32608
32609 @subsubheading Example
32610 N.A.
32611
32612
32613 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32614 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32615
32616 @subsubheading Synopsis
32617
32618 @smallexample
32619 -target-list-current-targets
32620 @end smallexample
32621
32622 Describe the current target.
32623
32624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32625
32626 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32627 other things).
32628
32629 @subsubheading Example
32630 N.A.
32631
32632
32633 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32634 @findex -target-list-parameters
32635
32636 @subsubheading Synopsis
32637
32638 @smallexample
32639 -target-list-parameters
32640 @end smallexample
32641
32642 @c ????
32643 @end ignore
32644
32645 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32646
32647 No equivalent.
32648
32649 @subsubheading Example
32650 N.A.
32651
32652 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
32653 @findex -target-flash-erase
32654
32655 @subsubheading Synopsis
32656
32657 @smallexample
32658 -target-flash-erase
32659 @end smallexample
32660
32661 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
32662
32663 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
32664
32665 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
32666 addresses and memory region sizes.
32667
32668 @smallexample
32669 (gdb)
32670 -target-flash-erase
32671 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
32672 (gdb)
32673 @end smallexample
32674
32675 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
32676 @findex -target-select
32677
32678 @subsubheading Synopsis
32679
32680 @smallexample
32681 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
32682 @end smallexample
32683
32684 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
32685
32686 @table @samp
32687 @item @var{type}
32688 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
32689 @item @var{parameters}
32690 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
32691 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
32692 @end table
32693
32694 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
32695 which the target program is, in the following form:
32696
32697 @smallexample
32698 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
32699 args=[@var{arg list}]
32700 @end smallexample
32701
32702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32703
32704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
32705
32706 @subsubheading Example
32707
32708 @smallexample
32709 (gdb)
32710 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
32711 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
32712 (gdb)
32713 @end smallexample
32714
32715 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32716 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
32717 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
32718
32719
32720 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
32721 @findex -target-file-put
32722
32723 @subsubheading Synopsis
32724
32725 @smallexample
32726 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
32727 @end smallexample
32728
32729 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
32730 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
32731
32732 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32733
32734 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
32735
32736 @subsubheading Example
32737
32738 @smallexample
32739 (gdb)
32740 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
32741 ^done
32742 (gdb)
32743 @end smallexample
32744
32745
32746 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
32747 @findex -target-file-get
32748
32749 @subsubheading Synopsis
32750
32751 @smallexample
32752 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
32753 @end smallexample
32754
32755 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
32756 on the host system.
32757
32758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32759
32760 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
32761
32762 @subsubheading Example
32763
32764 @smallexample
32765 (gdb)
32766 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
32767 ^done
32768 (gdb)
32769 @end smallexample
32770
32771
32772 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
32773 @findex -target-file-delete
32774
32775 @subsubheading Synopsis
32776
32777 @smallexample
32778 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
32779 @end smallexample
32780
32781 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
32782
32783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32784
32785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
32786
32787 @subsubheading Example
32788
32789 @smallexample
32790 (gdb)
32791 -target-file-delete remotefile
32792 ^done
32793 (gdb)
32794 @end smallexample
32795
32796
32797 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32798 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
32799 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
32800
32801 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
32802 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
32803
32804 @subsubheading Synopsis
32805
32806 @smallexample
32807 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
32808 @end smallexample
32809
32810 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
32811 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
32812 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32813
32814 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32815
32816 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
32817
32818 @subsubheading Result
32819
32820 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
32821 defined for each exception:
32822
32823 @table @samp
32824 @item name
32825 The name of the exception.
32826
32827 @item address
32828 The address of the exception.
32829
32830 @end table
32831
32832 @subsubheading Example
32833
32834 @smallexample
32835 -info-ada-exceptions aint
32836 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
32837 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32838 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
32839 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
32840 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
32841 @end smallexample
32842
32843 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
32844
32845 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
32846 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
32847 Catchpoint Commands}.
32848
32849
32850 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32851 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
32852 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
32853
32854 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
32855 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
32856 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
32857 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
32858
32859 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
32860 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
32861 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
32862
32863 @subsubheading Synopsis
32864
32865 @smallexample
32866 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
32867 @end smallexample
32868
32869 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
32870
32871 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
32872 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
32873 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
32874 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
32875 dash.
32876
32877 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32878
32879 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32880
32881 @subsubheading Result
32882
32883 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
32884
32885 @table @samp
32886 @item exists
32887 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
32888 @code{"false"} otherwise.
32889
32890 @end table
32891
32892 @subsubheading Example
32893
32894 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
32895
32896 @smallexample
32897 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
32898 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
32899 @end smallexample
32900
32901 @noindent
32902 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
32903 to the debugger:
32904
32905 @smallexample
32906 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
32907 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
32908 @end smallexample
32909
32910 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
32911 @findex -list-features
32912 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
32913
32914 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
32915 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
32916 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
32917 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
32918 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
32919 startup.
32920
32921 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
32922 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
32923 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
32924 is given below.
32925
32926 Example output:
32927
32928 @smallexample
32929 (gdb) -list-features
32930 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
32931 @end smallexample
32932
32933 The current list of features is:
32934
32935 @ftable @samp
32936 @item frozen-varobjs
32937 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
32938 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
32939 of @code{-varobj-create}.
32940 @item pending-breakpoints
32941 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
32942 command.
32943 @item python
32944 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
32945 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
32946 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
32947 @item thread-info
32948 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
32949 @item data-read-memory-bytes
32950 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
32951 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
32952 @item breakpoint-notifications
32953 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
32954 CLI will be announced via async records.
32955 @item ada-task-info
32956 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
32957 @item language-option
32958 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
32959 option (@pxref{Context management}).
32960 @item info-gdb-mi-command
32961 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
32962 @item undefined-command-error-code
32963 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
32964 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
32965 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
32966 @item exec-run-start-option
32967 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
32968 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
32969 @end ftable
32970
32971 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
32972 @findex -list-target-features
32973
32974 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
32975 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
32976 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
32977 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
32978 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
32979 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
32980 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
32981 Example output:
32982
32983 @smallexample
32984 (gdb) -list-target-features
32985 ^done,result=["async"]
32986 @end smallexample
32987
32988 The current list of features is:
32989
32990 @table @samp
32991 @item async
32992 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
32993 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
32994 while the target is running.
32995
32996 @item reverse
32997 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
32998 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
32999
33000 @end table
33001
33002 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33003 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33004 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33005
33006 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33007
33008 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33009 @findex -gdb-exit
33010
33011 @subsubheading Synopsis
33012
33013 @smallexample
33014 -gdb-exit
33015 @end smallexample
33016
33017 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33018
33019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33020
33021 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33022
33023 @subsubheading Example
33024
33025 @smallexample
33026 (gdb)
33027 -gdb-exit
33028 ^exit
33029 @end smallexample
33030
33031
33032 @ignore
33033 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33034 @findex -exec-abort
33035
33036 @subsubheading Synopsis
33037
33038 @smallexample
33039 -exec-abort
33040 @end smallexample
33041
33042 Kill the inferior running program.
33043
33044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33045
33046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33047
33048 @subsubheading Example
33049 N.A.
33050 @end ignore
33051
33052
33053 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33054 @findex -gdb-set
33055
33056 @subsubheading Synopsis
33057
33058 @smallexample
33059 -gdb-set
33060 @end smallexample
33061
33062 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33063 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33064
33065 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33066
33067 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33068
33069 @subsubheading Example
33070
33071 @smallexample
33072 (gdb)
33073 -gdb-set $foo=3
33074 ^done
33075 (gdb)
33076 @end smallexample
33077
33078
33079 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33080 @findex -gdb-show
33081
33082 @subsubheading Synopsis
33083
33084 @smallexample
33085 -gdb-show
33086 @end smallexample
33087
33088 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33089
33090 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33091
33092 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33093
33094 @subsubheading Example
33095
33096 @smallexample
33097 (gdb)
33098 -gdb-show annotate
33099 ^done,value="0"
33100 (gdb)
33101 @end smallexample
33102
33103 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33104
33105
33106 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33107 @findex -gdb-version
33108
33109 @subsubheading Synopsis
33110
33111 @smallexample
33112 -gdb-version
33113 @end smallexample
33114
33115 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33116
33117 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33118
33119 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33120 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33121
33122 @subsubheading Example
33123
33124 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33125 @c box in TeX.
33126 @smallexample
33127 (gdb)
33128 -gdb-version
33129 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33130 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33131 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33132 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33133 ~ certain conditions.
33134 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33135 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33136 ~ details.
33137 ~This GDB was configured as
33138 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33139 ^done
33140 (gdb)
33141 @end smallexample
33142
33143 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33144 @findex -list-thread-groups
33145
33146 @subheading Synopsis
33147
33148 @smallexample
33149 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33150 @end smallexample
33151
33152 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33153 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33154 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33155 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33156 top-level thread groups.
33157
33158 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33159 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33160 available on the target.
33161
33162 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33163 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33164 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33165 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33166 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33167 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33168 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33169 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33170
33171 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33172 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33173 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33174 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33175 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33176 @samp{threads} field.
33177
33178 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33179 the following caveats:
33180
33181 @itemize @bullet
33182 @item
33183 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33184 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33185 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33186
33187 @item
33188 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33189 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33190 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33191 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33192 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33193 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33194
33195 @end itemize
33196
33197 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33198 have the following fields:
33199
33200 @table @code
33201 @item id
33202 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33203 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33204 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33205
33206 @item type
33207 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33208 valid type.
33209
33210 @item pid
33211 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33212 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33213
33214 @item exit-code
33215 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33216 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33217 only if the process is not running.
33218
33219 @item num_children
33220 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33221 absent for an available thread group.
33222
33223 @item threads
33224 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33225 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33226 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33227
33228 @item cores
33229 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33230 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33231 such information is not available.
33232
33233 @item executable
33234 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33235 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33236 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33237
33238 @end table
33239
33240 @subheading Example
33241
33242 @smallexample
33243 @value{GDBP}
33244 -list-thread-groups
33245 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33246 -list-thread-groups 17
33247 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33248 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33249 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33250 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33251 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
33252 -list-thread-groups --available
33253 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33254 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33255 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33256 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33257 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33258 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33259 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33260 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33261 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33262 @end smallexample
33263
33264 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33265 @findex -info-os
33266
33267 @subsubheading Synopsis
33268
33269 @smallexample
33270 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33271 @end smallexample
33272
33273 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33274 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33275 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33276 of data of that type.
33277
33278 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33279 system.
33280
33281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33282
33283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33284
33285 @subsubheading Example
33286
33287 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33288 like this:
33289
33290 @smallexample
33291 @value{GDBP}
33292 -info-os
33293 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33294 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33295 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33296 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33297 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33298 col2="CPUs"@},
33299 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33300 col2="File descriptors"@},
33301 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33302 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33303 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33304 col2="Message queues"@},
33305 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33306 col2="Processes"@},
33307 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33308 col2="Process groups"@},
33309 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33310 col2="Semaphores"@},
33311 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33312 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33313 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33314 col2="Sockets"@},
33315 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33316 col2="Threads"@}]
33317 @value{GDBP}
33318 -info-os processes
33319 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33320 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33321 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33322 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33323 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33324 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33325 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33326 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33327 ...
33328 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33329 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33330 (gdb)
33331 @end smallexample
33332
33333 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33334 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33335 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33336 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33337 @code{info os} omits it.)
33338
33339 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33340 @findex -add-inferior
33341
33342 @subheading Synopsis
33343
33344 @smallexample
33345 -add-inferior
33346 @end smallexample
33347
33348 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33349 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33350 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33351 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33352 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33353 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33354
33355 @subheading Example
33356
33357 @smallexample
33358 @value{GDBP}
33359 -add-inferior
33360 ^done,inferior="i3"
33361 @end smallexample
33362
33363 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33364 @findex -interpreter-exec
33365
33366 @subheading Synopsis
33367
33368 @smallexample
33369 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33370 @end smallexample
33371 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33372
33373 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33374
33375 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33376
33377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33378
33379 @subheading Example
33380
33381 @smallexample
33382 (gdb)
33383 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33384 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33385 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33386 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33387 ^done
33388 (gdb)
33389 @end smallexample
33390
33391 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33392 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33393
33394 @subheading Synopsis
33395
33396 @smallexample
33397 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33398 @end smallexample
33399
33400 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33401
33402 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33403
33404 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33405
33406 @subheading Example
33407
33408 @smallexample
33409 (gdb)
33410 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33411 ^done
33412 (gdb)
33413 @end smallexample
33414
33415 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33416 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33417
33418 @subheading Synopsis
33419
33420 @smallexample
33421 -inferior-tty-show
33422 @end smallexample
33423
33424 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33425
33426 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33427
33428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33429
33430 @subheading Example
33431
33432 @smallexample
33433 (gdb)
33434 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33435 ^done
33436 (gdb)
33437 -inferior-tty-show
33438 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33439 (gdb)
33440 @end smallexample
33441
33442 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33443 @findex -enable-timings
33444
33445 @subheading Synopsis
33446
33447 @smallexample
33448 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33449 @end smallexample
33450
33451 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33452 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33453 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33454 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33455
33456 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33457
33458 No equivalent.
33459
33460 @subheading Example
33461
33462 @smallexample
33463 (gdb)
33464 -enable-timings
33465 ^done
33466 (gdb)
33467 -break-insert main
33468 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33469 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33470 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33471 times="0"@},
33472 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33473 (gdb)
33474 -enable-timings no
33475 ^done
33476 (gdb)
33477 -exec-run
33478 ^running
33479 (gdb)
33480 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33481 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33482 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33483 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33484 (gdb)
33485 @end smallexample
33486
33487 @node Annotations
33488 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33489
33490 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33491 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33492 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33493 relatively high level.
33494
33495 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33496 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33497
33498 @ignore
33499 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33500 @end ignore
33501
33502 @menu
33503 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33504 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33505 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33506 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33507 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33508 * Annotations for Running::
33509 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33510 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33511 @end menu
33512
33513 @node Annotations Overview
33514 @section What is an Annotation?
33515 @cindex annotations
33516
33517 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33518 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33519 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33520 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33521 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33522 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33523 cannot contain newline characters.
33524
33525 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33526 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33527 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33528 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33529 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33530 means those three characters as output.
33531
33532 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33533 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33534 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33535 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33536 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33537 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33538 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33539 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33540 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33541
33542 @table @code
33543 @kindex set annotate
33544 @item set annotate @var{level}
33545 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33546 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33547
33548 @item show annotate
33549 @kindex show annotate
33550 Show the current annotation level.
33551 @end table
33552
33553 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33554
33555 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33556
33557 @smallexample
33558 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33559 GNU gdb 6.0
33560 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33561 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33562 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33563 under certain conditions.
33564 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33565 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33566 for details.
33567 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33568
33569 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33570 (@value{GDBP})
33571 ^Z^Zprompt
33572 @kbd{quit}
33573
33574 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33575 $
33576 @end smallexample
33577
33578 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33579 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33580 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33581 output from @value{GDBN}.
33582
33583 @node Server Prefix
33584 @section The Server Prefix
33585 @cindex server prefix
33586
33587 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33588 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33589 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33590 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33591 a transparent manner.
33592
33593 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33594 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33595 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33596 @code{print} command.
33597
33598 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33599 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33600
33601 @node Prompting
33602 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33603
33604 @cindex annotations for prompts
33605 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33606 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33607 over, etc.
33608
33609 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33610 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33611 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33612 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33613 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33614 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33615 features the following annotations:
33616
33617 @smallexample
33618 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33619 ^Z^Zprompt
33620 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33621 @end smallexample
33622
33623 The input types are
33624
33625 @table @code
33626 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33627 @findex prompt annotation
33628 @findex post-prompt annotation
33629 @item prompt
33630 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33631
33632 @findex pre-commands annotation
33633 @findex commands annotation
33634 @findex post-commands annotation
33635 @item commands
33636 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33637 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
33638
33639 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
33640 @findex overload-choice annotation
33641 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
33642 @item overload-choice
33643 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
33644
33645 @findex pre-query annotation
33646 @findex query annotation
33647 @findex post-query annotation
33648 @item query
33649 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
33650
33651 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
33652 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
33653 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
33654 @item prompt-for-continue
33655 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
33656 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
33657 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
33658 presence of annotations.
33659 @end table
33660
33661 @node Errors
33662 @section Errors
33663 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
33664
33665 @findex quit annotation
33666 @smallexample
33667 ^Z^Zquit
33668 @end smallexample
33669
33670 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
33671
33672 @findex error annotation
33673 @smallexample
33674 ^Z^Zerror
33675 @end smallexample
33676
33677 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
33678
33679 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
33680 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
33681 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
33682 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
33683 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
33684 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
33685 to the top level.
33686
33687 @findex error-begin annotation
33688 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
33689
33690 @smallexample
33691 ^Z^Zerror-begin
33692 @end smallexample
33693
33694 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
33695 message.
33696
33697 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
33698 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
33699 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
33700
33701 @node Invalidation
33702 @section Invalidation Notices
33703
33704 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
33705 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
33706 changed.
33707
33708 @table @code
33709 @findex frames-invalid annotation
33710 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
33711
33712 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
33713 have changed.
33714
33715 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
33716 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
33717
33718 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
33719 deleted a breakpoint.
33720 @end table
33721
33722 @node Annotations for Running
33723 @section Running the Program
33724 @cindex annotations for running programs
33725
33726 @findex starting annotation
33727 @findex stopping annotation
33728 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
33729 @code{step} or @code{continue},
33730
33731 @smallexample
33732 ^Z^Zstarting
33733 @end smallexample
33734
33735 is output. When the program stops,
33736
33737 @smallexample
33738 ^Z^Zstopped
33739 @end smallexample
33740
33741 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
33742 annotations describe how the program stopped.
33743
33744 @table @code
33745 @findex exited annotation
33746 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
33747 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
33748 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
33749
33750 @findex signalled annotation
33751 @findex signal-name annotation
33752 @findex signal-name-end annotation
33753 @findex signal-string annotation
33754 @findex signal-string-end annotation
33755 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
33756 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
33757 annotation continues:
33758
33759 @smallexample
33760 @var{intro-text}
33761 ^Z^Zsignal-name
33762 @var{name}
33763 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
33764 @var{middle-text}
33765 ^Z^Zsignal-string
33766 @var{string}
33767 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
33768 @var{end-text}
33769 @end smallexample
33770
33771 @noindent
33772 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
33773 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
33774 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
33775 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
33776 user's benefit and have no particular format.
33777
33778 @findex signal annotation
33779 @item ^Z^Zsignal
33780 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
33781 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
33782 terminated with it.
33783
33784 @findex breakpoint annotation
33785 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
33786 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
33787
33788 @findex watchpoint annotation
33789 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
33790 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
33791 @end table
33792
33793 @node Source Annotations
33794 @section Displaying Source
33795 @cindex annotations for source display
33796
33797 @findex source annotation
33798 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
33799
33800 @smallexample
33801 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
33802 @end smallexample
33803
33804 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
33805 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
33806 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
33807 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
33808 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
33809 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
33810 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
33811 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
33812 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
33813 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
33814 depend on the language).
33815
33816 @node JIT Interface
33817 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
33818 @cindex just-in-time compilation
33819 @cindex JIT compilation interface
33820
33821 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
33822 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
33823 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
33824 performance while maintaining platform independence.
33825
33826 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
33827 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
33828 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
33829 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
33830 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
33831 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
33832
33833 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
33834 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
33835 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
33836 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
33837 LLVM JIT.
33838
33839 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
33840 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
33841 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
33842 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
33843 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
33844 out about additional code.
33845
33846 @menu
33847 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
33848 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
33849 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
33850 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
33851 @end menu
33852
33853 @node Declarations
33854 @section JIT Declarations
33855
33856 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
33857 implement the interface:
33858
33859 @smallexample
33860 typedef enum
33861 @{
33862 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
33863 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
33864 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
33865 @} jit_actions_t;
33866
33867 struct jit_code_entry
33868 @{
33869 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
33870 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
33871 const char *symfile_addr;
33872 uint64_t symfile_size;
33873 @};
33874
33875 struct jit_descriptor
33876 @{
33877 uint32_t version;
33878 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
33879 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
33880 uint32_t action_flag;
33881 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
33882 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
33883 @};
33884
33885 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
33886 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
33887
33888 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
33889 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
33890 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
33891 @end smallexample
33892
33893 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
33894 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
33895 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
33896
33897 @node Registering Code
33898 @section Registering Code
33899
33900 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
33901
33902 @itemize @bullet
33903 @item
33904 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
33905 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
33906
33907 @item
33908 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
33909 file.
33910
33911 @item
33912 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
33913
33914 @item
33915 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
33916
33917 @item
33918 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
33919 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33920 @end itemize
33921
33922 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
33923 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
33924 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
33925 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
33926
33927 @node Unregistering Code
33928 @section Unregistering Code
33929
33930 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
33931
33932 @itemize @bullet
33933 @item
33934 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
33935
33936 @item
33937 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
33938
33939 @item
33940 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
33941 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
33942 @end itemize
33943
33944 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
33945 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
33946
33947 @node Custom Debug Info
33948 @section Custom Debug Info
33949 @cindex custom JIT debug info
33950 @cindex JIT debug info reader
33951
33952 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
33953 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
33954 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
33955 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
33956 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
33957 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
33958 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
33959 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
33960 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
33961
33962 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
33963 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
33964 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
33965 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
33966 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
33967 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
33968 compiler.
33969
33970 @menu
33971 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
33972 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
33973 @end menu
33974
33975 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33976 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
33977 @kindex jit-reader-load
33978 @kindex jit-reader-unload
33979
33980 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
33981 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
33982
33983 @table @code
33984 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
33985 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
33986 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
33987 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
33988 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
33989 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
33990 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
33991
33992 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
33993 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
33994 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
33995 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
33996 @code{jit-reader-load}.
33997
33998 @item jit-reader-unload
33999 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34000
34001 @end table
34002
34003 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34004 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34005 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34006
34007 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34008 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34009
34010 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34011 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34012 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34013 the system include directory.
34014
34015 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34016 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34017 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34018
34019 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34020 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34021
34022 @findex gdb_init_reader
34023 @smallexample
34024 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34025 @end smallexample
34026
34027 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34028
34029 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34030 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34031 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34032 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34033 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34034 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34035
34036 @smallexample
34037 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34038 @{
34039 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34040 int reader_version;
34041
34042 /* For use by the reader. */
34043 void *priv_data;
34044
34045 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34046 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34047 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34048 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34049 @};
34050 @end smallexample
34051
34052 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34053 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34054
34055 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34056 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34057 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34058 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34059 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34060 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34061 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34062 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34063 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34064 target's address space.
34065
34066 @node In-Process Agent
34067 @chapter In-Process Agent
34068 @cindex debugging agent
34069 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34070 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34071 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34072 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34073 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34074 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34075 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34076 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34077 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34078 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34079 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34080 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34081 behavior without interrupting it.
34082
34083 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34084 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34085 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34086 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34087 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34088 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34089 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34090 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34091 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34092
34093 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34094 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34095 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34096 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34097
34098 @anchor{Control Agent}
34099 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34100 debugging with the following commands:
34101
34102 @table @code
34103 @kindex set agent on
34104 @item set agent on
34105 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34106 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34107 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34108 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34109 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34110 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34111
34112 @kindex set agent off
34113 @item set agent off
34114 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34115 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34116
34117 @kindex show agent
34118 @item show agent
34119 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34120 the in-process agent.
34121 @end table
34122
34123 @menu
34124 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34125 @end menu
34126
34127 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34128 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34129 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34130
34131 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34132 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34133 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34134 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34135 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34136 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34137 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34138 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34139 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34140
34141 @menu
34142 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34143 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34144 @end menu
34145
34146 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34147 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34148 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34149
34150 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34151 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34152
34153 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34154 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34155 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34156 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34157
34158 @enumerate
34159 @item
34160 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34161 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34162 @item
34163 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34164 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34165 the other one.
34166 @end enumerate
34167
34168 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34169
34170 @enumerate
34171 @item
34172 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34173 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34174 @anchor{agent expression object}
34175 @item
34176 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34177 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34178 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34179 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34180 @item
34181 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34182 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34183
34184 @end enumerate
34185
34186 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34187 object:
34188
34189 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34190 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34191 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34192 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34193 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34194 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34195 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34196 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34197 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34198 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34199 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34200 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34201 memory address for collecting.
34202 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34203 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34204 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34205 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34206 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34207 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34208 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34209 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34210 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34211 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34212 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34213 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34214 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34215 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34216 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34217 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34218 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34219 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34220 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34221 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34222 @ref{agent expression object}
34223 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34224 @ref{agent expression object}
34225 @item actions @tab variable
34226 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34227 @end multitable
34228
34229 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34230 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34231 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34232
34233 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34234 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34235
34236 @table @samp
34237
34238 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34239 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34240 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34241 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34242 in IPA finally.
34243
34244 Replies:
34245 @table @samp
34246 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34247 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34248 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34249 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34250 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34251 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34252 @item E @var{NN}
34253 for an error
34254
34255 @end table
34256
34257 @item close
34258 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34259 is about to kill inferiors.
34260
34261 @item qTfSTM
34262 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34263 @item qTsSTM
34264 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34265 @item qTSTMat
34266 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34267 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34268 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34269
34270 Replies:
34271 @table @samp
34272 @item E @var{NN}
34273 for an error
34274 @end table
34275 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34276 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34277 @end table
34278
34279 @node GDB Bugs
34280 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34281 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34282 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34283
34284 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34285
34286 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34287 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34288 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34289 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34290
34291 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34292 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34293
34294 @menu
34295 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34296 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34297 @end menu
34298
34299 @node Bug Criteria
34300 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34301 @cindex bug criteria
34302
34303 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34304
34305 @itemize @bullet
34306 @cindex fatal signal
34307 @cindex debugger crash
34308 @cindex crash of debugger
34309 @item
34310 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34311 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34312
34313 @cindex error on valid input
34314 @item
34315 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34316 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34317 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34318
34319 @cindex invalid input
34320 @item
34321 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34322 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34323 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34324 for traditional practice''.
34325
34326 @item
34327 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34328 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34329 @end itemize
34330
34331 @node Bug Reporting
34332 @section How to Report Bugs
34333 @cindex bug reports
34334 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34335
34336 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34337 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34338 contact that organization first.
34339
34340 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34341 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34342 distribution.
34343 @c should add a web page ref...
34344
34345 @ifset BUGURL
34346 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34347 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34348 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34349 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34350 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34351 be used.
34352
34353 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34354 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34355 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34356 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34357
34358 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34359 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34360 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34361 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34362 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34363 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34364 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34365 bug reports to the mailing list.
34366 @end ifset
34367 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34368 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34369 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34370 @end ifclear
34371 @end ifset
34372
34373 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34374 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34375 fact or leave it out, state it!
34376
34377 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34378 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34379 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34380 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34381 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34382 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34383 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34384 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34385 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34386
34387 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34388 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34389 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34390 self-contained.
34391
34392 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34393 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34394 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34395 bugs properly.
34396
34397 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34398
34399 @itemize @bullet
34400 @item
34401 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34402 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34403 version}.
34404
34405 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34406 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34407
34408 @item
34409 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34410 version number.
34411
34412 @item
34413 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34414 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34415 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34416 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34417
34418 @item
34419 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34420 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34421
34422 @item
34423 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34424 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34425 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34426 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34427 those compilers.
34428
34429 @item
34430 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34431 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34432 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34433 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34434
34435 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34436 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34437
34438 @item
34439 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34440 reproduce the bug.
34441
34442 @item
34443 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34444 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34445
34446 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34447 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34448 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34449 a chance to make a mistake.
34450
34451 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34452 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34453 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34454 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34455 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34456 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34457 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34458 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34459
34460 @pindex script
34461 @cindex recording a session script
34462 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34463 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34464 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34465 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34466
34467 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34468 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34469
34470 @item
34471 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34472 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34473 it by context, not by line number.
34474
34475 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34476 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34477
34478 @end itemize
34479
34480 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34481
34482 @itemize @bullet
34483 @item
34484 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34485
34486 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34487 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34488 changes will not affect it.
34489
34490 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34491 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34492 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34493 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34494
34495 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34496 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34497 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34498 less time, and so on.
34499
34500 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34501 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34502
34503 @item
34504 A patch for the bug.
34505
34506 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34507 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34508 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34509 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34510
34511 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34512 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34513 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34514 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34515
34516 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34517 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34518 help us to understand.
34519
34520 @item
34521 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34522
34523 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34524 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34525 @end itemize
34526
34527 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34528 @c and consists of the two following files:
34529 @c rluser.texi
34530 @c hsuser.texi
34531 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34532 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34533 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34534 @include rluser.texi
34535 @include hsuser.texi
34536 @end ifclear
34537
34538 @node In Memoriam
34539 @appendix In Memoriam
34540
34541 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34542 contributors:
34543
34544 @table @code
34545 @item Fred Fish
34546 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34547 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34548 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34549
34550 @item Michael Snyder
34551 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34552 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34553 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34554 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34555 @end table
34556
34557 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34558 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34559
34560 @node Formatting Documentation
34561 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34562
34563 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34564 @cindex reference card
34565 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34566 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34567 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34568 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34569 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34570 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34571
34572 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34573 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34574
34575 @smallexample
34576 make refcard.dvi
34577 @end smallexample
34578
34579 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34580 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34581 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34582 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34583 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34584
34585 @cindex documentation
34586
34587 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34588 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34589 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34590 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34591 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34592 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34593
34594 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34595 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34596 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34597 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34598 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34599 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34600 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34601 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34602
34603 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34604 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34605 @code{makeinfo}.
34606
34607 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34608 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34609 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34610
34611 @smallexample
34612 cd gdb
34613 make gdb.info
34614 @end smallexample
34615
34616 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34617 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34618 Texinfo definitions file.
34619
34620 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34621 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34622 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34623 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34624 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34625 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34626 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34627
34628 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34629 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34630 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34631 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34632 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34633 directory.
34634
34635 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34636 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34637 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
34638 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
34639
34640 @smallexample
34641 make gdb.dvi
34642 @end smallexample
34643
34644 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
34645
34646 @node Installing GDB
34647 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
34648 @cindex installation
34649
34650 @menu
34651 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
34652 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
34653 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
34654 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
34655 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
34656 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
34657 @end menu
34658
34659 @node Requirements
34660 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
34661 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
34662
34663 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
34664 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
34665
34666 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
34667 @table @asis
34668 @item ISO C90 compiler
34669 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
34670 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
34671
34672 @end table
34673
34674 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
34675 @table @asis
34676 @item Expat
34677 @anchor{Expat}
34678 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
34679 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
34680 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
34681 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
34682 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
34683 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
34684
34685 Expat is used for:
34686
34687 @itemize @bullet
34688 @item
34689 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
34690 @item
34691 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
34692 @item
34693 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
34694 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
34695 @item
34696 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
34697 @item
34698 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
34699 @item
34700 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
34701 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
34702 @end itemize
34703
34704 @item MPFR
34705 @anchor{MPFR}
34706 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
34707 library. This library may be included with your operating system
34708 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34709 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
34710 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
34711 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
34712 option to specify its location.
34713
34714 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
34715 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
34716 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
34717 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
34718
34719 @item zlib
34720 @cindex compressed debug sections
34721 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
34722 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
34723 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
34724 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
34725 information in such binaries.
34726
34727 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
34728 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
34729 @url{http://zlib.net}.
34730
34731 @item iconv
34732 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
34733 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
34734 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
34735 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
34736
34737 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
34738 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
34739 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
34740 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
34741
34742 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
34743 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
34744 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
34745
34746 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
34747 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
34748 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
34749 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
34750 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
34751 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
34752 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
34753 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
34754 @end table
34755
34756 @node Running Configure
34757 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
34758 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
34759 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
34760 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
34761 build the @code{gdb} program.
34762 @iftex
34763 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
34764 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
34765 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
34766 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
34767 @end iftex
34768
34769 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
34770 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
34771 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
34772
34773 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
34774 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
34775
34776 @table @code
34777 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
34778 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
34779
34780 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
34781 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
34782
34783 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
34784 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
34785
34786 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
34787 @sc{gnu} include files
34788
34789 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
34790 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
34791
34792 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
34793 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
34794
34795 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
34796 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
34797
34798 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
34799 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
34800
34801 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
34802 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
34803 @end table
34804
34805 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
34806 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
34807 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
34808
34809 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
34810 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
34811 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
34812 argument.
34813
34814 For example:
34815
34816 @smallexample
34817 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34818 ./configure @var{host}
34819 make
34820 @end smallexample
34821
34822 @noindent
34823 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
34824 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
34825 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
34826 correct value by examining your system.)
34827
34828 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
34829 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
34830 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
34831 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
34832
34833 @need 750
34834 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
34835 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
34836 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
34837
34838 @smallexample
34839 sh configure @var{host}
34840 @end smallexample
34841
34842 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
34843 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
34844 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
34845 @file{configure}
34846 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
34847 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
34848
34849 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
34850 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
34851 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
34852 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
34853 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
34854 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
34855 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
34856 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
34857 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34858
34859 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
34860 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
34861 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
34862 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
34863 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
34864
34865 @node Separate Objdir
34866 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
34867
34868 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
34869 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
34870 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
34871 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
34872 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
34873 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
34874 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
34875 program specified there.
34876
34877 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
34878 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
34879 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
34880 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
34881 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
34882 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
34883
34884 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
34885 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
34886
34887 @smallexample
34888 @group
34889 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
34890 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
34891 cd ../gdb-sun4
34892 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
34893 make
34894 @end group
34895 @end smallexample
34896
34897 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
34898 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
34899 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
34900 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
34901 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
34902 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
34903
34904 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
34905 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
34906 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
34907 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
34908 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
34909
34910 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
34911 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
34912 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
34913 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
34914 You specify a cross-debugging target by
34915 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
34916
34917 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
34918 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
34919 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
34920
34921 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
34922 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
34923 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
34924 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
34925 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
34926
34927 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
34928 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
34929 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
34930 with each other.
34931
34932 @node Config Names
34933 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
34934
34935 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
34936 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
34937 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
34938 of information in the following pattern:
34939
34940 @smallexample
34941 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
34942 @end smallexample
34943
34944 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
34945 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
34946 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
34947
34948 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
34949 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
34950 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
34951 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
34952 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
34953 abbreviations---for example:
34954
34955 @smallexample
34956 % sh config.sub i386-linux
34957 i386-pc-linux-gnu
34958 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
34959 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
34960 % sh config.sub hp9k700
34961 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
34962 % sh config.sub sun4
34963 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
34964 % sh config.sub sun3
34965 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
34966 % sh config.sub i986v
34967 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
34968 @end smallexample
34969
34970 @noindent
34971 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
34972 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
34973
34974 @node Configure Options
34975 @section @file{configure} Options
34976
34977 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
34978 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
34979 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
34980 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
34981
34982 @smallexample
34983 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
34984 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34985 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
34986 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
34987 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
34988 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
34989 @var{host}
34990 @end smallexample
34991
34992 @noindent
34993 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
34994 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
34995 @samp{--}.
34996
34997 @table @code
34998 @item --help
34999 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35000
35001 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35002 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35003 @file{@var{dir}}.
35004
35005 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35006 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35007 @file{@var{dir}}.
35008
35009 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35010 @need 2000
35011 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35012 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
35013 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
35014 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35015 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35016 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35017 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35018 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35019 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35020 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35021 @var{dirname}.
35022
35023 @item --norecursion
35024 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
35025 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
35026
35027 @item --target=@var{target}
35028 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35029 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35030 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35031
35032 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
35033
35034 @item @var{host} @dots{}
35035 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
35036
35037 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
35038 @end table
35039
35040 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
35041 needed for special purposes only.
35042
35043 @node System-wide configuration
35044 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35045 @cindex system-wide init file
35046
35047 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35048 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35049 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35050
35051 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35052
35053 @table @code
35054 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35055 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35056 @var{file}.
35057 @end table
35058
35059 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35060 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35061
35062 @itemize @bullet
35063 @item
35064 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35065 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35066 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35067 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35068 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35069 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35070
35071 @item
35072 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35073 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35074 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35075 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35076 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35077 @end itemize
35078
35079 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35080 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35081 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35082 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35083 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35084 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35085 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35086 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35087 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35088 reread.
35089
35090 @menu
35091 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35092 @end menu
35093
35094 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35095 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35096 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35097
35098 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35099 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35100 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35101 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35102 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35103 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35104
35105 The following scripts are currently available:
35106 @itemize @bullet
35107
35108 @item @file{elinos.py}
35109 @pindex elinos.py
35110 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35111 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35112 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35113 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35114 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35115 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35116
35117 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35118 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35119 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35120 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35121 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35122 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35123
35124 @end itemize
35125
35126 @node Maintenance Commands
35127 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35128 @cindex maintenance commands
35129 @cindex internal commands
35130
35131 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35132 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35133 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35134 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35135 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35136
35137 @table @code
35138 @kindex maint agent
35139 @kindex maint agent-eval
35140 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35141 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35142 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35143 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35144 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35145 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35146 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35147 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35148 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35149 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35150 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35151 addition and return the sum.
35152 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35153 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35154
35155 @kindex maint agent-printf
35156 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35157 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35158 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35159 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35160 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35161
35162 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35163 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35164 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35165 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35166 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35167 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35168 is shown:
35169
35170 @table @code
35171 @item breakpoint
35172 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35173
35174 @item watchpoint
35175 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35176
35177 @item longjmp
35178 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35179 @code{longjmp} calls.
35180
35181 @item longjmp resume
35182 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35183
35184 @item until
35185 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35186
35187 @item finish
35188 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35189
35190 @item shlib events
35191 Shared library events.
35192
35193 @end table
35194
35195 @kindex maint info btrace
35196 @item maint info btrace
35197 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35198
35199 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35200 @item maint btrace packet-history
35201 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35202 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35203 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35204 recording format.
35205
35206 @table @code
35207 @item bts
35208 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35209 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35210
35211 @table @asis
35212 @item Block number
35213 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35214 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35215 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35216 @end table
35217
35218 @item pt
35219 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35220 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35221 information is printed:
35222
35223 @table @asis
35224 @item Packet number
35225 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35226 @item Trace offset
35227 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35228 @item Packet opcode and payload
35229 @end table
35230 @end table
35231
35232 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35233 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35234 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35235 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35236 needed.
35237
35238 @kindex maint btrace clear
35239 @item maint btrace clear
35240 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
35241 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
35242
35243 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
35244 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
35245 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
35246 buffer.
35247
35248 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35249 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35250 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35251 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35252 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
35253 packet history.
35254
35255 @kindex set displaced-stepping
35256 @kindex show displaced-stepping
35257 @cindex displaced stepping support
35258 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
35259 @item set displaced-stepping
35260 @itemx show displaced-stepping
35261 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
35262 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
35263 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
35264 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
35265 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
35266
35267 @table @code
35268 @item set displaced-stepping on
35269 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
35270 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
35271
35272 @item set displaced-stepping off
35273 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
35274 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
35275
35276 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
35277 @item set displaced-stepping auto
35278 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
35279 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
35280 architecture supports displaced stepping.
35281 @end table
35282
35283 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
35284 @item maint check-psymtabs
35285 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
35286 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
35287
35288 @kindex maint check-symtabs
35289 @item maint check-symtabs
35290 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
35291
35292 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35293 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
35294 Expand symbol tables.
35295 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
35296 names matching @var{regexp}.
35297
35298 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
35299 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35300 @cindex demangler crashes
35301 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
35302 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35303 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
35304 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
35305 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
35306 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
35307 option to terminate the current session.
35308
35309 @kindex maint cplus first_component
35310 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
35311 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
35312
35313 @kindex maint cplus namespace
35314 @item maint cplus namespace
35315 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
35316
35317 @kindex maint deprecate
35318 @kindex maint undeprecate
35319 @cindex deprecated commands
35320 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
35321 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
35322 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
35323 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
35324 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
35325 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
35326 the replacement as part of the warning.
35327
35328 @kindex maint dump-me
35329 @item maint dump-me
35330 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
35331 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
35332 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
35333 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
35334
35335 @kindex maint internal-error
35336 @kindex maint internal-warning
35337 @kindex maint demangler-warning
35338 @cindex demangler crashes
35339 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35340 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35341 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35342
35343 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
35344 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
35345 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
35346 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
35347 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
35348 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
35349 @value{GDBN} session.
35350
35351 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
35352 used as the text of the error or warning message.
35353
35354 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
35355
35356 @smallexample
35357 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
35358 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
35359 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
35360 debugging may prove unreliable.
35361 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35362 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35363 (@value{GDBP})
35364 @end smallexample
35365
35366 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35367 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35368 @cindex demangler crashes
35369
35370 @kindex maint set internal-error
35371 @kindex maint show internal-error
35372 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35373 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35374 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35375 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35376 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35377 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35378 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35379 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35380 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35381 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35382 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35383 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35384 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35385 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35386 described in the table below.
35387
35388 @table @samp
35389 @item quit
35390 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35391 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35392
35393 @item corefile
35394 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35395 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35396 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35397 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35398 disabled.
35399 @end table
35400
35401 @kindex maint packet
35402 @item maint packet @var{text}
35403 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35404 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35405 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35406 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35407 checksum.
35408
35409 @kindex maint print architecture
35410 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35411 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35412 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35413
35414 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35415 @item maint print c-tdesc
35416 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35417 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35418 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35419 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35420 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35421 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35422 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35423 modify XML target descriptions.
35424
35425 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35426 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35427 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35428 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35429
35430 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35431 @item maint print dummy-frames
35432 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35433
35434 @smallexample
35435 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35436 @dots{}
35437 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35438 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35439 58 return (a + b);
35440 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35441 @dots{}
35442 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35443 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35444 (@value{GDBP})
35445 @end smallexample
35446
35447 Takes an optional file parameter.
35448
35449 @kindex maint print registers
35450 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35451 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35452 @kindex maint print register-groups
35453 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35454 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35455 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35456 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35457 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35458 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35459 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35460
35461 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35462 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35463 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35464 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35465 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35466 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35467 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35468 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35469
35470 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35471 write the information.
35472
35473 @kindex maint print reggroups
35474 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35475 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35476 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35477 information.
35478
35479 The register groups info looks like this:
35480
35481 @smallexample
35482 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35483 Group Type
35484 general user
35485 float user
35486 all user
35487 vector user
35488 system user
35489 save internal
35490 restore internal
35491 @end smallexample
35492
35493 @kindex flushregs
35494 @item flushregs
35495 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35496
35497 @kindex maint print objfiles
35498 @cindex info for known object files
35499 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35500 Print a dump of all known object files.
35501 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35502 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35503 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35504
35505 @kindex maint print user-registers
35506 @cindex user registers
35507 @item maint print user-registers
35508 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35509 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35510 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35511 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35512 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35513 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35514 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35515
35516 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35517 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35518 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35519 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35520 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35521 matching @var{regexp}.
35522 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35523 and the full path if known.
35524 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35525
35526 @kindex maint print statistics
35527 @cindex bcache statistics
35528 @item maint print statistics
35529 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35530 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35531 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35532 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35533 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35534 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35535 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35536 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35537 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35538 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35539 lengths.
35540
35541 @kindex maint print target-stack
35542 @cindex target stack description
35543 @item maint print target-stack
35544 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35545 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35546 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35547 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35548 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35549 address.
35550
35551 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35552 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35553
35554 @kindex maint print type
35555 @cindex type chain of a data type
35556 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35557 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35558 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35559 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35560 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35561 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35562
35563 @kindex maint selftest
35564 @cindex self tests
35565 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35566 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35567 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35568 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35569 name will by ran.
35570
35571 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35572 @cindex self tests
35573 @item maint info selftests
35574 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35575
35576 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35577 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35578 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35579 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35580 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35581 information.
35582
35583 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35584 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35585 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35586 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35587 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35588 always see the disassembly form.
35589
35590 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35591
35592 @smallexample
35593 (gdb) info addr argc
35594 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35595 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35596 @end smallexample
35597
35598 For more information on these expressions, see
35599 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35600
35601 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35602 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35603 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35604 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35605 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35606
35607 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35608 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35609 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35610 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35611 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35612 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35613 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35614 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35615 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35616
35617 @kindex maint set profile
35618 @kindex maint show profile
35619 @cindex profiling GDB
35620 @item maint set profile
35621 @itemx maint show profile
35622 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
35623
35624 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
35625 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
35626 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
35627 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
35628 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
35629 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
35630 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
35631
35632 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
35633 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
35634
35635 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
35636 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
35637 @cindex hardware debug registers
35638 @item maint set show-debug-regs
35639 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
35640 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
35641 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
35642 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
35643 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
35644 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
35645
35646 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
35647 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
35648 @item maint set show-all-tib
35649 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
35650 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
35651 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
35652 command.
35653
35654 @kindex maint set target-async
35655 @kindex maint show target-async
35656 @item maint set target-async
35657 @itemx maint show target-async
35658 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
35659 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
35660 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
35661 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
35662
35663 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
35664 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
35665 @item maint set target-non-stop
35666 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
35667
35668 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
35669 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
35670 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
35671 if supported by the target.
35672
35673 @table @code
35674 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
35675 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
35676 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
35677
35678 @item maint set target-non-stop on
35679 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
35680 does not indicate support.
35681
35682 @item maint set target-non-stop off
35683 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
35684 target supports it.
35685 @end table
35686
35687 @kindex maint set per-command
35688 @kindex maint show per-command
35689 @item maint set per-command
35690 @itemx maint show per-command
35691 @cindex resources used by commands
35692
35693 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
35694 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
35695
35696 @table @code
35697 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
35698 @itemx maint show per-command space
35699 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
35700 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
35701 took, following the command's own output.
35702 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35703 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35704
35705 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
35706 @itemx maint show per-command time
35707 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
35708 for each command.
35709 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
35710 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
35711 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
35712 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
35713 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
35714 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
35715 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
35716 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
35717 spent by the program been debugged.
35718 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
35719 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
35720
35721 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
35722 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
35723 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
35724 for each command.
35725 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
35726
35727 @enumerate a
35728 @item
35729 number of symbol tables
35730 @item
35731 number of primary symbol tables
35732 @item
35733 number of blocks in the blockvector
35734 @end enumerate
35735 @end table
35736
35737 @kindex maint space
35738 @cindex memory used by commands
35739 @item maint space @var{value}
35740 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
35741 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35742
35743 @kindex maint time
35744 @cindex time of command execution
35745 @item maint time @var{value}
35746 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
35747 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
35748
35749 @kindex maint translate-address
35750 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
35751 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
35752 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
35753 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
35754 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
35755 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
35756 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
35757
35758 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
35759 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
35760 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
35761
35762 @end table
35763
35764 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
35765 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
35766
35767 @table @code
35768 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
35769 @kindex set watchdog
35770 @cindex watchdog timer
35771 @cindex timeout for commands
35772 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
35773 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
35774 reports and error and the command is aborted.
35775
35776 @item show watchdog
35777 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
35778 @end table
35779
35780 @node Remote Protocol
35781 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
35782
35783 @menu
35784 * Overview::
35785 * Packets::
35786 * Stop Reply Packets::
35787 * General Query Packets::
35788 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
35789 * Tracepoint Packets::
35790 * Host I/O Packets::
35791 * Interrupts::
35792 * Notification Packets::
35793 * Remote Non-Stop::
35794 * Packet Acknowledgment::
35795 * Examples::
35796 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
35797 * Library List Format::
35798 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
35799 * Memory Map Format::
35800 * Thread List Format::
35801 * Traceframe Info Format::
35802 * Branch Trace Format::
35803 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
35804 @end menu
35805
35806 @node Overview
35807 @section Overview
35808
35809 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
35810 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
35811 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
35812 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
35813
35814 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
35815 transmitted and received data, respectively.
35816
35817 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
35818 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
35819 @cindex remote serial protocol
35820 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
35821 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
35822 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
35823 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
35824 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
35825
35826 @smallexample
35827 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35828 @end smallexample
35829 @noindent
35830
35831 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
35832 @noindent
35833 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
35834 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
35835 eight bit unsigned checksum).
35836
35837 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
35838 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
35839
35840 @smallexample
35841 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35842 @end smallexample
35843
35844 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
35845 @noindent
35846 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
35847 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
35848 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
35849
35850 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
35851 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
35852 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
35853 retransmission):
35854
35855 @smallexample
35856 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
35857 <- @code{+}
35858 @end smallexample
35859 @noindent
35860
35861 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
35862 once a connection is established.
35863 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
35864
35865 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
35866 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
35867 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
35868 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
35869 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
35870 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
35871 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
35872
35873 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
35874 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
35875 exceptions).
35876
35877 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
35878 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
35879 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
35880 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
35881
35882 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
35883 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
35884 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
35885
35886 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
35887 @anchor{Binary Data}
35888 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
35889 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
35890 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
35891 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
35892 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
35893 binary data.
35894
35895 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
35896 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
35897 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
35898 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
35899 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
35900 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
35901 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
35902 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
35903 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
35904 (described next).
35905
35906 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
35907 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
35908 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
35909 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
35910 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
35911 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
35912 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
35913 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
35914 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
35915 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
35916 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
35917 3}} more times.
35918
35919 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
35920 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
35921 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
35922 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
35923 @samp{0*"00}.
35924
35925 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
35926 error number. That number is not well defined.
35927
35928 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
35929 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
35930 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
35931 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
35932 on that response.
35933
35934 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
35935 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
35936 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
35937 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
35938 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
35939 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
35940
35941 @node Packets
35942 @section Packets
35943
35944 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
35945 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
35946 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
35947 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
35948
35949 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
35950 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
35951 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
35952 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
35953 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
35954 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
35955 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
35956 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
35957 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
35958 @var{baz}.
35959
35960 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
35961 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
35962 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
35963 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
35964 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
35965 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
35966 pick any thread.
35967
35968 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
35969 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
35970 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
35971 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
35972 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
35973 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
35974 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
35975 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
35976 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
35977 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
35978 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
35979 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
35980 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
35981
35982 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
35983 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
35984 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
35985 more information.
35986
35987 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
35988 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
35989
35990 Here are the packet descriptions.
35991
35992 @table @samp
35993
35994 @item !
35995 @cindex @samp{!} packet
35996 @anchor{extended mode}
35997 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
35998 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
35999 debugged.
36000
36001 Reply:
36002 @table @samp
36003 @item OK
36004 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36005 @end table
36006
36007 @item ?
36008 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36009 @anchor{? packet}
36010 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36011 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36012 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36013
36014 Reply:
36015 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36016
36017 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36018 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36019 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36020 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36021 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36022
36023 Reply:
36024 @table @samp
36025 @item OK
36026 The arguments were set.
36027 @item E @var{NN}
36028 An error occurred.
36029 @end table
36030
36031 @item b @var{baud}
36032 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36033 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36034 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36035
36036 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36037 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36038 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36039
36040 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36041 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36042 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36043 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36044 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36045
36046 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36047 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36048 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36049 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36050
36051 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36052 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36053
36054 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36055 @anchor{bc}
36056 @item bc
36057 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36058 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36059
36060 Reply:
36061 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36062
36063 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36064 @anchor{bs}
36065 @item bs
36066 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36067 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36068
36069 Reply:
36070 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36071
36072 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36073 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36074 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36075 is omitted, resume at current address.
36076
36077 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36078 packet}.
36079
36080 Reply:
36081 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36082
36083 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36084 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36085 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36086 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36087
36088 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36089 packet}.
36090
36091 Reply:
36092 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36093
36094 @item d
36095 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36096 Toggle debug flag.
36097
36098 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36099 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36100
36101 @item D
36102 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36103 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36104 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36105 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36106 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36107
36108 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36109 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36110 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36111 big-endian hex string.
36112
36113 Reply:
36114 @table @samp
36115 @item OK
36116 for success
36117 @item E @var{NN}
36118 for an error
36119 @end table
36120
36121 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36122 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36123 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36124 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36125 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36126
36127 @item g
36128 @anchor{read registers packet}
36129 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36130 Read general registers.
36131
36132 Reply:
36133 @table @samp
36134 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36135 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36136 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36137 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36138 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36139 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36140
36141 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36142 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36143 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36144 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36145 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36146 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36147 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36148 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36149
36150 @smallexample
36151 -> @code{g}
36152 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36153 @end smallexample
36154
36155 @item E @var{NN}
36156 for an error.
36157 @end table
36158
36159 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36160 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36161 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36162 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36163
36164 Reply:
36165 @table @samp
36166 @item OK
36167 for success
36168 @item E @var{NN}
36169 for an error
36170 @end table
36171
36172 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36173 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36174 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36175 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36176 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36177 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36178 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36179 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36180 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36181
36182 Reply:
36183 @table @samp
36184 @item OK
36185 for success
36186 @item E @var{NN}
36187 for an error
36188 @end table
36189
36190 @c FIXME: JTC:
36191 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
36192 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
36193 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
36194 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
36195 @c described. For example:
36196 @c
36197 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36198 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
36199 @c otherwise returns current registers.
36200 @c
36201 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36202 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
36203 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
36204
36205 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
36206 @anchor{cycle step packet}
36207 @cindex @samp{i} packet
36208 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
36209 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
36210 step starting at that address.
36211
36212 @item I
36213 @cindex @samp{I} packet
36214 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
36215 step packet}.
36216
36217 @item k
36218 @cindex @samp{k} packet
36219 Kill request.
36220
36221 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
36222
36223 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
36224 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
36225
36226 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
36227
36228 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
36229 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
36230 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
36231
36232 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
36233 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
36234 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
36235
36236 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
36237 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
36238 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
36239 (@pxref{? packet}).
36240
36241 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
36242 @cindex @samp{m} packet
36243 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36244 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
36245 any particular boundary.
36246
36247 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
36248 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
36249 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
36250 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
36251 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
36252 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
36253 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
36254 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
36255
36256 Reply:
36257 @table @samp
36258 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36259 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36260 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
36261 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
36262 @item E @var{NN}
36263 @var{NN} is errno
36264 @end table
36265
36266 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36267 @cindex @samp{M} packet
36268 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36269 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
36270 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36271
36272 Reply:
36273 @table @samp
36274 @item OK
36275 for success
36276 @item E @var{NN}
36277 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
36278 written).
36279 @end table
36280
36281 @item p @var{n}
36282 @cindex @samp{p} packet
36283 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
36284 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
36285 register value is encoded.
36286
36287 Reply:
36288 @table @samp
36289 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36290 the register's value
36291 @item E @var{NN}
36292 for an error
36293 @item @w{}
36294 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
36295 @end table
36296
36297 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
36298 @anchor{write register packet}
36299 @cindex @samp{P} packet
36300 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
36301 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
36302 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
36303
36304 Reply:
36305 @table @samp
36306 @item OK
36307 for success
36308 @item E @var{NN}
36309 for an error
36310 @end table
36311
36312 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36313 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36314 @cindex @samp{q} packet
36315 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
36316 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
36317 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
36318
36319 @item r
36320 @cindex @samp{r} packet
36321 Reset the entire system.
36322
36323 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
36324
36325 @item R @var{XX}
36326 @cindex @samp{R} packet
36327 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
36328 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36329
36330 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
36331
36332 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36333 @cindex @samp{s} packet
36334 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
36335 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
36336
36337 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36338 packet}.
36339
36340 Reply:
36341 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36342
36343 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36344 @anchor{step with signal packet}
36345 @cindex @samp{S} packet
36346 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
36347 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
36348
36349 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36350 packet}.
36351
36352 Reply:
36353 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36354
36355 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
36356 @cindex @samp{t} packet
36357 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
36358 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
36359 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
36360
36361 @item T @var{thread-id}
36362 @cindex @samp{T} packet
36363 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36364
36365 Reply:
36366 @table @samp
36367 @item OK
36368 thread is still alive
36369 @item E @var{NN}
36370 thread is dead
36371 @end table
36372
36373 @item v
36374 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36375 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36376
36377 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36378 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36379 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36380 The process ID is a
36381 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36382 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36383 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36384
36385 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36386 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36387 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36388 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36389 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36390 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36391 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36392 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36393
36394 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36395
36396 Reply:
36397 @table @samp
36398 @item E @var{nn}
36399 for an error
36400 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36401 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36402 @item OK
36403 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36404 @end table
36405
36406 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36407 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36408 @anchor{vCont packet}
36409 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36410
36411 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36412 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36413 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36414 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36415 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36416 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36417 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36418 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36419 error.
36420
36421 Currently supported actions are:
36422
36423 @table @samp
36424 @item c
36425 Continue.
36426 @item C @var{sig}
36427 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36428 @item s
36429 Step.
36430 @item S @var{sig}
36431 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36432 @item t
36433 Stop.
36434 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36435 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36436 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36437 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36438 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36439 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36440
36441 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36442 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36443 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36444 jumps to @var{start}).
36445
36446 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36447 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36448 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36449
36450 @end table
36451
36452 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36453 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36454 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36455
36456 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36457 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36458 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36459 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36460 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36461 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36462 as an implementation detail.
36463
36464 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36465 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36466 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36467 stopped.
36468
36469 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36470 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36471 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36472
36473 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36474 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36475
36476 Reply:
36477 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36478
36479 @item vCont?
36480 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36481 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36482
36483 Reply:
36484 @table @samp
36485 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36486 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36487 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36488 @item @w{}
36489 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36490 @end table
36491
36492 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36493 @item vCtrlC
36494 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36495 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36496 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36497 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36498 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36499 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36500 variant.
36501
36502 Reply:
36503 @table @samp
36504 @item E @var{nn}
36505 for an error
36506 @item OK
36507 for success
36508 @end table
36509
36510 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36511 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36512 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36513 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36514
36515 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36516 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36517 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36518 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36519 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36520 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36521 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36522 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36523 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36524 packet is received.
36525
36526 Reply:
36527 @table @samp
36528 @item OK
36529 for success
36530 @item E @var{NN}
36531 for an error
36532 @end table
36533
36534 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36535 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36536 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36537 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36538 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36539 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36540 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36541 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36542 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36543 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36544 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36545 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36546
36547
36548 Reply:
36549 @table @samp
36550 @item OK
36551 for success
36552 @item E.memtype
36553 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36554 @item E @var{NN}
36555 for an error
36556 @end table
36557
36558 @item vFlashDone
36559 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36560 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36561 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36562 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36563 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36564 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36565 request is completed.
36566
36567 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36568 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36569 @anchor{vKill packet}
36570 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36571 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36572 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36573 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36574
36575 Reply:
36576 @table @samp
36577 @item E @var{nn}
36578 for an error
36579 @item OK
36580 for success
36581 @end table
36582
36583 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36584 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36585 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36586 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36587 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36588
36589 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36590 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36591 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36592 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
36593 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
36594 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
36595
36596 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
36597 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
36598 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
36599 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
36600 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
36601 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
36602 state.
36603
36604 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
36605
36606 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36607
36608 Reply:
36609 @table @samp
36610 @item E @var{nn}
36611 for an error
36612 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36613 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36614 @end table
36615
36616 @item vStopped
36617 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
36618 @xref{Notification Packets}.
36619
36620 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36621 @anchor{X packet}
36622 @cindex @samp{X} packet
36623 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
36624 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
36625 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
36626 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
36627
36628 Reply:
36629 @table @samp
36630 @item OK
36631 for success
36632 @item E @var{NN}
36633 for an error
36634 @end table
36635
36636 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36637 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
36638 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
36639 @cindex @samp{z} packet
36640 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
36641 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
36642 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
36643
36644 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
36645 separately.
36646
36647 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
36648 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
36649 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
36650 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
36651 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
36652 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
36653
36654 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36655 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36656 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
36657 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
36658 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
36659 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
36660
36661 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
36662 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
36663 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
36664 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
36665 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
36666 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
36667 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
36668 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
36669 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
36670 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
36671 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
36672 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
36673 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36674
36675 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
36676 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
36677
36678 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
36679 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
36680
36681 @table @samp
36682
36683 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36684 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36685 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
36686
36687 @end table
36688
36689 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
36690 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
36691 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
36692 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
36693 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
36694 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
36695 separators. Each expression has the following form:
36696
36697 @table @samp
36698
36699 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36700 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
36701 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
36702
36703 @end table
36704
36705 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
36706 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
36707 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
36708 target, is not defined.}
36709
36710 Reply:
36711 @table @samp
36712 @item OK
36713 success
36714 @item @w{}
36715 not supported
36716 @item E @var{NN}
36717 for an error
36718 @end table
36719
36720 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36721 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
36722 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
36723 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
36724 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
36725 address @var{addr}.
36726
36727 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
36728 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
36729 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
36730 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
36731
36732 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
36733 movement.}
36734
36735 Reply:
36736 @table @samp
36737 @item OK
36738 success
36739 @item @w{}
36740 not supported
36741 @item E @var{NN}
36742 for an error
36743 @end table
36744
36745 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36746 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36747 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
36748 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
36749 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36750 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36751
36752 Reply:
36753 @table @samp
36754 @item OK
36755 success
36756 @item @w{}
36757 not supported
36758 @item E @var{NN}
36759 for an error
36760 @end table
36761
36762 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36763 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36764 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
36765 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
36766 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36767 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36768
36769 Reply:
36770 @table @samp
36771 @item OK
36772 success
36773 @item @w{}
36774 not supported
36775 @item E @var{NN}
36776 for an error
36777 @end table
36778
36779 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36780 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
36781 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
36782 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
36783 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
36784 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
36785
36786 Reply:
36787 @table @samp
36788 @item OK
36789 success
36790 @item @w{}
36791 not supported
36792 @item E @var{NN}
36793 for an error
36794 @end table
36795
36796 @end table
36797
36798 @node Stop Reply Packets
36799 @section Stop Reply Packets
36800 @cindex stop reply packets
36801
36802 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
36803 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
36804 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
36805 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
36806 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
36807 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
36808 @value{GDBN} source code.
36809
36810 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
36811 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
36812 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36813
36814 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
36815 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
36816 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
36817 components.
36818
36819 @table @samp
36820
36821 @item S @var{AA}
36822 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36823 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
36824 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
36825
36826 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
36827 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
36828 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
36829 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
36830 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
36831 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
36832 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
36833 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
36834
36835 @itemize @bullet
36836 @item
36837 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
36838 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
36839 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
36840 two-digit hex number.
36841
36842 @item
36843 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
36844 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36845
36846 @item
36847 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
36848 the core on which the stop event was detected.
36849
36850 @item
36851 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
36852 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
36853 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
36854 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
36855
36856 @item
36857 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
36858 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
36859 future.
36860 @end itemize
36861
36862 The currently defined stop reasons are:
36863
36864 @table @samp
36865 @item watch
36866 @itemx rwatch
36867 @itemx awatch
36868 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
36869 hex.
36870
36871 @item syscall_entry
36872 @itemx syscall_return
36873 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
36874 syscall number, in hex.
36875
36876 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
36877 @item library
36878 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
36879 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
36880 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
36881
36882 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
36883 @item replaylog
36884 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
36885 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
36886 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
36887 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
36888 for more information.
36889
36890 @item swbreak
36891 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
36892 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
36893 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
36894 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
36895 part must be left empty.
36896
36897 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
36898 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
36899 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
36900 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
36901 address.
36902
36903 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36904 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36905 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36906 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36907 indicating support.
36908
36909 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
36910
36911 @item hwbreak
36912 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
36913 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
36914
36915 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
36916 apply.
36917
36918 @cindex fork events, remote reply
36919 @item fork
36920 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
36921 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36922 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36923 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36924 fork events.
36925
36926 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36927 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36928 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36929 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36930 indicating support.
36931
36932 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
36933 @item vfork
36934 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
36935 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
36936 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
36937 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
36938 vfork events.
36939
36940 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36941 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36942 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36943 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36944 indicating support.
36945
36946 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
36947 @item vforkdone
36948 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
36949 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
36950 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
36951 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
36952 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
36953
36954 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36955 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36956 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36957 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36958 indicating support.
36959
36960 @cindex exec events, remote reply
36961 @item exec
36962 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
36963 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
36964 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
36965
36966 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
36967 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
36968 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
36969 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
36970 indicating support.
36971
36972 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
36973 @anchor{thread create event}
36974 @item create
36975 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
36976 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
36977 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
36978 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
36979 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
36980 @var{r} part is ignored.
36981
36982 @end table
36983
36984 @item W @var{AA}
36985 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36986 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
36987 applicable to certain targets.
36988
36989 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
36990 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
36991 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
36992 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
36993 hex strings.
36994
36995 @item X @var{AA}
36996 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
36997 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
36998
36999 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37000 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37001 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37002 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37003 hex strings.
37004
37005 @anchor{thread exit event}
37006 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37007 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37008
37009 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37010 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37011 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37012 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37013
37014 @item N
37015 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37016 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37017 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37018 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37019 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37020 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37021 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37022 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37023 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37024 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37025 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37026 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37027 support.
37028
37029 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37030 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37031 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37032 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37033 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37034
37035 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37036 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37037 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37038 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37039 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37040 system calls.
37041
37042 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37043 this very system call.
37044
37045 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37046 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37047 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37048 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37049 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37050 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37051
37052 @end table
37053
37054 @node General Query Packets
37055 @section General Query Packets
37056 @cindex remote query requests
37057
37058 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37059 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37060 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37061 sending information to and from the stub.
37062
37063 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37064 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37065 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37066 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37067 conventions:
37068
37069 @itemize @bullet
37070 @item
37071 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37072 @item
37073 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37074 letter.
37075 @item
37076 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37077 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37078 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37079 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37080 @end itemize
37081
37082 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37083 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37084 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37085 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37086 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37087 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37088 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37089 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37090 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37091 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37092 packet.}.
37093
37094 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37095 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37096 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37097 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37098 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37099
37100 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37101
37102 @table @samp
37103
37104 @item QAgent:1
37105 @itemx QAgent:0
37106 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37107 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37108
37109 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37110 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37111 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37112 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37113 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37114 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37115 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37116 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37117 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37118 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37119 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37120
37121 @item qC
37122 @cindex current thread, remote request
37123 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37124 Return the current thread ID.
37125
37126 Reply:
37127 @table @samp
37128 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37129 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37130 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37131 @item @r{(anything else)}
37132 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37133 @end table
37134
37135 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37136 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37137 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37138 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37139 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37140 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37141 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37142 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37143
37144 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37145 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37146 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37147 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37148 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37149 detect trailing zeros.
37150
37151 Reply:
37152 @table @samp
37153 @item E @var{NN}
37154 An error (such as memory fault)
37155 @item C @var{crc32}
37156 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37157 @end table
37158
37159 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37160 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37161 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37162 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37163 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37164 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37165 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37166 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37167 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37168 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37169 randomization.
37170
37171 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37172
37173 Reply:
37174 @table @samp
37175 @item OK
37176 The request succeeded.
37177
37178 @item E @var{nn}
37179 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37180
37181 @item @w{}
37182 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37183 by the stub.
37184 @end table
37185
37186 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37187 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37188 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37189 address space randomization.
37190
37191 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
37192 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
37193 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
37194 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
37195 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
37196 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
37197 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
37198 inferior using a shell or not.
37199
37200 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
37201 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
37202 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
37203 values are considered an error.
37204
37205 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37206 mode}).
37207
37208 Reply:
37209 @table @samp
37210 @item OK
37211 The request succeeded.
37212
37213 @item E @var{nn}
37214 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37215 @end table
37216
37217 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37218 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37219 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37220 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
37221
37222 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
37223 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
37224
37225 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
37226 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37227 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
37228 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
37229 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
37230 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
37231 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
37232 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
37233 environment}).
37234
37235 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37236 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
37237 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
37238 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
37239 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
37240 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
37241 not be present.
37242
37243 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37244 mode}).
37245
37246 Reply:
37247 @table @samp
37248 @item OK
37249 The request succeeded.
37250 @end table
37251
37252 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37253 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37254 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37255 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37256 inferior.
37257
37258 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
37259 @pxref{set environment}.
37260
37261 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
37262 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
37263 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
37264 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
37265 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
37266 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
37267 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
37268 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
37269
37270 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37271 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
37272
37273 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37274 mode}).
37275
37276 Reply:
37277 @table @samp
37278 @item OK
37279 The request succeeded.
37280 @end table
37281
37282 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37283 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37284 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37285 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37286 inferior.
37287
37288 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
37289 @pxref{unset environment}.
37290
37291 @item QEnvironmentReset
37292 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
37293 @cindex reset environment, remote request
37294 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
37295 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
37296 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
37297 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
37298 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
37299 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
37300 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37301 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
37302 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
37303
37304 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37305 mode}).
37306
37307 Reply:
37308 @table @samp
37309 @item OK
37310 The request succeeded.
37311 @end table
37312
37313 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37314 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37315 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37316 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37317 inferior.
37318
37319 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
37320 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
37321 @cindex set working directory, remote request
37322 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
37323 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
37324 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
37325
37326 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
37327 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
37328 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
37329 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
37330 directory to its original, empty value.
37331
37332 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37333 mode}).
37334
37335 Reply:
37336 @table @samp
37337 @item OK
37338 The request succeeded.
37339 @end table
37340
37341 @item qfThreadInfo
37342 @itemx qsThreadInfo
37343 @cindex list active threads, remote request
37344 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
37345 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
37346 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
37347 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
37348 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
37349 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
37350 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
37351 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
37352
37353 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
37354
37355 Reply:
37356 @table @samp
37357 @item m @var{thread-id}
37358 A single thread ID
37359 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
37360 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
37361 @item l
37362 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37363 @end table
37364
37365 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37366 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37367 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37368 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37369 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37370 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37371 fields.
37372
37373 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37374 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37375 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37376 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37377 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37378
37379 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37380 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37381 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37382 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37383 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37384
37385 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37386 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37387
37388 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37389 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37390 information associated with the variable.)
37391
37392 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37393 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37394 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37395 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37396 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37397 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37398
37399 Reply:
37400 @table @samp
37401 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37402 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37403 local storage requested.
37404
37405 @item E @var{nn}
37406 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37407
37408 @item @w{}
37409 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37410 @end table
37411
37412 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37413 @cindex get thread information block address
37414 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37415 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37416
37417 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37418
37419 Reply:
37420 @table @samp
37421 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37422 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37423 thread information block.
37424
37425 @item E @var{nn}
37426 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37427 address could not be retrieved.
37428
37429 @item @w{}
37430 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37431 @end table
37432
37433 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37434 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37435 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37436 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37437 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37438 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37439 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37440
37441 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37442
37443 Reply:
37444 @table @samp
37445 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37446 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37447 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37448 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37449 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37450 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37451 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37452 @end table
37453
37454 @item qOffsets
37455 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37456 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37457 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37458 image.
37459
37460 Reply:
37461 @table @samp
37462 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37463 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37464 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37465 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37466 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37467 segments by the supplied offsets.
37468
37469 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37470 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37471 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37472
37473 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37474 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37475 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37476 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37477 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37478 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37479 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37480 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37481 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37482 @end table
37483
37484 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37485 @cindex thread information, remote request
37486 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37487 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37488 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37489 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37490
37491 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37492 (see below).
37493
37494 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37495
37496 @item QNonStop:1
37497 @itemx QNonStop:0
37498 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37499 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37500 @anchor{QNonStop}
37501 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37502 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37503
37504 Reply:
37505 @table @samp
37506 @item OK
37507 The request succeeded.
37508
37509 @item E @var{nn}
37510 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37511
37512 @item @w{}
37513 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37514 the stub.
37515 @end table
37516
37517 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37518 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37519 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37520 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37521
37522 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37523 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37524 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37525 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37526 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37527 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37528 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37529
37530 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37531 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37532 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37533
37534 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37535 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37536 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37537 report the requested syscalls.
37538
37539 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37540 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37541
37542 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37543 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37544 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37545 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37546
37547 Reply:
37548 @table @samp
37549 @item OK
37550 The request succeeded.
37551
37552 @item E @var{nn}
37553 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37554
37555 @item @w{}
37556 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37557 the stub.
37558 @end table
37559
37560 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37561 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37562 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37563 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37564
37565 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37566 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37567 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37568 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37569 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37570 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37571 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37572 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37573 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37574 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37575 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37576 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37577 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37578
37579 Reply:
37580 @table @samp
37581 @item OK
37582 The request succeeded.
37583
37584 @item E @var{nn}
37585 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37586
37587 @item @w{}
37588 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37589 the stub.
37590 @end table
37591
37592 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
37593 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
37594 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37595 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37596
37597 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37598 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
37599 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
37600 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
37601 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
37602 Others should be silently discarded.
37603
37604 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
37605 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
37606 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
37607 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
37608 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
37609 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
37610 signals.
37611
37612 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
37613 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
37614
37615 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37616 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37617 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
37618 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
37619 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37620
37621 Reply:
37622 @table @samp
37623 @item OK
37624 The request succeeded.
37625
37626 @item E @var{nn}
37627 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37628
37629 @item @w{}
37630 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
37631 by the stub.
37632 @end table
37633
37634 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
37635 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
37636 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37637 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37638
37639 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
37640 @item QThreadEvents:1
37641 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
37642 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
37643 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
37644
37645 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
37646 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
37647 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
37648 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
37649 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
37650 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
37651 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
37652 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
37653 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
37654 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37655
37656 Reply:
37657 @table @samp
37658 @item OK
37659 The request succeeded.
37660
37661 @item E @var{nn}
37662 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37663
37664 @item @w{}
37665 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
37666 the stub.
37667 @end table
37668
37669 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
37670 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
37671
37672 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
37673 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
37674 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
37675 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
37676 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
37677 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
37678 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
37679 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
37680 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
37681
37682 Reply:
37683 @table @samp
37684 @item OK
37685 A command response with no output.
37686 @item @var{OUTPUT}
37687 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
37688 @item E @var{NN}
37689 Indicate a badly formed request.
37690 @item @w{}
37691 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
37692 @end table
37693
37694 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
37695 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
37696 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
37697 packets.)
37698
37699 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
37700 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
37701 @ifnotinfo
37702 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
37703 @end ifnotinfo
37704 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
37705 @anchor{qSearch memory}
37706 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
37707 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
37708 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
37709
37710 Reply:
37711 @table @samp
37712 @item 0
37713 The pattern was not found.
37714 @item 1,address
37715 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
37716 @item E @var{NN}
37717 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
37718 @item @w{}
37719 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
37720 @end table
37721
37722 @item QStartNoAckMode
37723 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
37724 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
37725 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
37726 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
37727
37728 Reply:
37729 @table @samp
37730 @item OK
37731 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
37732 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
37733 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
37734 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
37735 @item @w{}
37736 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
37737 @end table
37738
37739 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
37740 @cindex supported packets, remote query
37741 @cindex features of the remote protocol
37742 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
37743 @anchor{qSupported}
37744 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
37745 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
37746 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
37747 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
37748 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
37749 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
37750 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
37751 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
37752 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
37753 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
37754 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
37755 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
37756 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
37757 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
37758
37759 Reply:
37760 @table @samp
37761 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
37762 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
37763 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
37764 possible forms).
37765 @item @w{}
37766 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
37767 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
37768 @end table
37769
37770 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
37771 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
37772 are:
37773
37774 @table @samp
37775 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
37776 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
37777 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
37778 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
37779 @item @var{name}+
37780 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
37781 need an associated value.
37782 @item @var{name}-
37783 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
37784 @item @var{name}?
37785 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
37786 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
37787 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
37788 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
37789 @end table
37790
37791 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
37792 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
37793 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
37794 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
37795 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
37796
37797 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
37798 are defined:
37799
37800 @table @samp
37801 @item multiprocess
37802 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
37803 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37804 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37805 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37806 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
37807
37808 @item xmlRegisters
37809 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
37810 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
37811 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
37812 description.
37813
37814 @item qRelocInsn
37815 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
37816 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37817 instruction reply packet}).
37818
37819 @item swbreak
37820 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
37821 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37822
37823 @item hwbreak
37824 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
37825 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
37826
37827 @item fork-events
37828 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
37829 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37830 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37831 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37832
37833 @item vfork-events
37834 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
37835 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37836 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37837 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37838
37839 @item exec-events
37840 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
37841 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
37842 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
37843 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
37844
37845 @item vContSupported
37846 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
37847 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
37848 @end table
37849
37850 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
37851 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
37852 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
37853 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
37854 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
37855 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
37856 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
37857 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
37858 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
37859 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
37860 all the features it supports.
37861
37862 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
37863 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
37864
37865 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
37866 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
37867 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
37868 form response.
37869
37870 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
37871 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
37872 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
37873 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
37874
37875 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
37876 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
37877 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
37878 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
37879 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
37880
37881 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
37882
37883 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
37884 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
37885 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
37886 @item Feature Name
37887 @tab Value Required
37888 @tab Default
37889 @tab Probe Allowed
37890
37891 @item @samp{PacketSize}
37892 @tab Yes
37893 @tab @samp{-}
37894 @tab No
37895
37896 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
37897 @tab No
37898 @tab @samp{-}
37899 @tab Yes
37900
37901 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
37902 @tab No
37903 @tab @samp{-}
37904 @tab Yes
37905
37906 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
37907 @tab No
37908 @tab @samp{-}
37909 @tab Yes
37910
37911 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
37912 @tab No
37913 @tab @samp{-}
37914 @tab Yes
37915
37916 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
37917 @tab No
37918 @tab @samp{-}
37919 @tab Yes
37920
37921 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
37922 @tab No
37923 @tab @samp{-}
37924 @tab Yes
37925
37926 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
37927 @tab No
37928 @tab @samp{-}
37929 @tab Yes
37930
37931 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
37932 @tab No
37933 @tab @samp{-}
37934 @tab No
37935
37936 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
37937 @tab No
37938 @tab @samp{-}
37939 @tab Yes
37940
37941 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
37942 @tab No
37943 @tab @samp{-}
37944 @tab Yes
37945
37946 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
37947 @tab No
37948 @tab @samp{-}
37949 @tab Yes
37950
37951 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
37952 @tab No
37953 @tab @samp{-}
37954 @tab Yes
37955
37956 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
37957 @tab No
37958 @tab @samp{-}
37959 @tab Yes
37960
37961 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
37962 @tab No
37963 @tab @samp{-}
37964 @tab Yes
37965
37966 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
37967 @tab No
37968 @tab @samp{-}
37969 @tab Yes
37970
37971 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
37972 @tab No
37973 @tab @samp{-}
37974 @tab Yes
37975
37976 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
37977 @tab No
37978 @tab @samp{-}
37979 @tab Yes
37980
37981 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
37982 @tab No
37983 @tab @samp{-}
37984 @tab Yes
37985
37986 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
37987 @tab Yes
37988 @tab @samp{-}
37989 @tab Yes
37990
37991 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
37992 @tab Yes
37993 @tab @samp{-}
37994 @tab Yes
37995
37996 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
37997 @tab Yes
37998 @tab @samp{-}
37999 @tab Yes
38000
38001 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38002 @tab Yes
38003 @tab @samp{-}
38004 @tab Yes
38005
38006 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38007 @tab Yes
38008 @tab @samp{-}
38009 @tab Yes
38010
38011 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38012 @tab No
38013 @tab @samp{-}
38014 @tab Yes
38015
38016 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38017 @tab No
38018 @tab @samp{-}
38019 @tab Yes
38020
38021 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38022 @tab No
38023 @tab @samp{-}
38024 @tab Yes
38025
38026 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38027 @tab No
38028 @tab @samp{-}
38029 @tab Yes
38030
38031 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38032 @tab No
38033 @tab @samp{-}
38034 @tab No
38035
38036 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38037 @tab No
38038 @tab @samp{-}
38039 @tab No
38040
38041 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38042 @tab No
38043 @tab @samp{-}
38044 @tab No
38045
38046 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38047 @tab No
38048 @tab @samp{-}
38049 @tab No
38050
38051 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38052 @tab No
38053 @tab @samp{-}
38054 @tab No
38055
38056 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38057 @tab No
38058 @tab @samp{-}
38059 @tab No
38060
38061 @item @samp{QAgent}
38062 @tab No
38063 @tab @samp{-}
38064 @tab No
38065
38066 @item @samp{QAllow}
38067 @tab No
38068 @tab @samp{-}
38069 @tab No
38070
38071 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38072 @tab No
38073 @tab @samp{-}
38074 @tab No
38075
38076 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38077 @tab No
38078 @tab @samp{-}
38079 @tab No
38080
38081 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38082 @tab No
38083 @tab @samp{-}
38084 @tab No
38085
38086 @item @samp{tracenz}
38087 @tab No
38088 @tab @samp{-}
38089 @tab No
38090
38091 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38092 @tab No
38093 @tab @samp{-}
38094 @tab No
38095
38096 @item @samp{swbreak}
38097 @tab No
38098 @tab @samp{-}
38099 @tab No
38100
38101 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38102 @tab No
38103 @tab @samp{-}
38104 @tab No
38105
38106 @item @samp{fork-events}
38107 @tab No
38108 @tab @samp{-}
38109 @tab No
38110
38111 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38112 @tab No
38113 @tab @samp{-}
38114 @tab No
38115
38116 @item @samp{exec-events}
38117 @tab No
38118 @tab @samp{-}
38119 @tab No
38120
38121 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38122 @tab No
38123 @tab @samp{-}
38124 @tab No
38125
38126 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38127 @tab No
38128 @tab @samp{-}
38129 @tab No
38130
38131 @end multitable
38132
38133 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38134
38135 @table @samp
38136 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38137 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38138 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38139 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38140 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38141 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38142 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38143 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38144 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38145 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38146
38147 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38148 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38149 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38150
38151 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38152 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38153 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38154
38155 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38156 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38157 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38158
38159 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38160 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38161 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38162
38163 @item qXfer:features:read
38164 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38165 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38166
38167 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38168 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38169 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38170
38171 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38172 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38173 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38174
38175 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38176 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38177 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38178 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38179
38180 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38181 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38182 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38183
38184 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38185 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38186 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38187
38188 @item qXfer:spu:read
38189 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38190 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38191
38192 @item qXfer:spu:write
38193 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38194 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38195
38196 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38197 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38198 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38199
38200 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38201 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38202 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38203
38204 @item qXfer:threads:read
38205 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38206 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38207
38208 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38209 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38210 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38211
38212 @item qXfer:uib:read
38213 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38214 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38215
38216 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38217 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38218 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38219
38220 @item QNonStop
38221 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38222 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38223
38224 @item QCatchSyscalls
38225 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38226 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
38227
38228 @item QPassSignals
38229 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38230 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38231
38232 @item QStartNoAckMode
38233 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38234 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38235
38236 @item multiprocess
38237 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38238 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38239 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38240 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38241 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38242 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38243 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38244 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38245 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38246 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38247 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38248
38249 @item qXfer:osdata:read
38250 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
38251 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
38252
38253 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
38254 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
38255 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
38256 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
38257
38258 @item ConditionalTracepoints
38259 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
38260 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
38261
38262 @item ReverseContinue
38263 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
38264 (@pxref{bc}).
38265
38266 @item ReverseStep
38267 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
38268 (@pxref{bs}).
38269
38270 @item TracepointSource
38271 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
38272 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
38273
38274 @item QAgent
38275 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
38276
38277 @item QAllow
38278 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
38279
38280 @item QDisableRandomization
38281 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
38282
38283 @item StaticTracepoint
38284 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
38285 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
38286
38287 @item InstallInTrace
38288 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
38289 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
38290
38291 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
38292 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38293 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38294 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38295
38296 @item QTBuffer:size
38297 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38298 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38299
38300 @item tracenz
38301 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38302 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38303 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38304
38305 @item BreakpointCommands
38306 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38307 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38308 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38309
38310 @item Qbtrace:off
38311 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38312
38313 @item Qbtrace:bts
38314 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38315
38316 @item Qbtrace:pt
38317 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
38318
38319 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
38320 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
38321
38322 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
38323 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
38324
38325 @item swbreak
38326 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
38327 breakpoints.
38328
38329 @item hwbreak
38330 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
38331 breakpoints.
38332
38333 @item fork-events
38334 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
38335
38336 @item vfork-events
38337 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
38338 and vforkdone events.
38339
38340 @item exec-events
38341 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
38342
38343 @item vContSupported
38344 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
38345 @samp{vCont?} packet.
38346
38347 @item QThreadEvents
38348 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
38349
38350 @item no-resumed
38351 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
38352
38353 @end table
38354
38355 @item qSymbol::
38356 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38357 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38358 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38359 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38360
38361 Reply:
38362 @table @samp
38363 @item OK
38364 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38365 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38366 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38367 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38368 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38369 below.
38370 @end table
38371
38372 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38373 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38374
38375 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38376 target has previously requested.
38377
38378 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38379 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38380 will be empty.
38381
38382 Reply:
38383 @table @samp
38384 @item OK
38385 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38386 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38387 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38388 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38389 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38390 @end table
38391
38392 @item qTBuffer
38393 @itemx QTBuffer
38394 @itemx QTDisconnected
38395 @itemx QTDP
38396 @itemx QTDPsrc
38397 @itemx QTDV
38398 @itemx qTfP
38399 @itemx qTfV
38400 @itemx QTFrame
38401 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38402
38403 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38404
38405 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38406 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38407 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38408 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38409 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38410 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38411 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38412 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38413 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38414 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38415 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38416
38417 Reply:
38418 @table @samp
38419 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38420 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38421 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38422 the thread's attributes.
38423 @end table
38424
38425 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38426 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38427 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38428 packets.)
38429
38430 @item QTNotes
38431 @itemx qTP
38432 @itemx QTSave
38433 @itemx qTsP
38434 @itemx qTsV
38435 @itemx QTStart
38436 @itemx QTStop
38437 @itemx QTEnable
38438 @itemx QTDisable
38439 @itemx QTinit
38440 @itemx QTro
38441 @itemx qTStatus
38442 @itemx qTV
38443 @itemx qTfSTM
38444 @itemx qTsSTM
38445 @itemx qTSTMat
38446 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38447
38448 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38449 @cindex read special object, remote request
38450 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38451 @anchor{qXfer read}
38452 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38453 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38454 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38455 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38456 additional details about what data to access.
38457
38458 Reply:
38459 @table @samp
38460 @item m @var{data}
38461 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38462 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38463 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38464 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38465 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38466 request.
38467
38468 @item l @var{data}
38469 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38470 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38471 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38472
38473 @item l
38474 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38475 There is no more data to be read.
38476
38477 @item E00
38478 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38479
38480 @item E @var{nn}
38481 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38482 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38483
38484 @item @w{}
38485 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38486 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38487 @end table
38488
38489 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38490 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38491 formats, listed above.
38492
38493 @table @samp
38494 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38495 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38496 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38497 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38498
38499 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38500 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38501
38502 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38503 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38504
38505 Return a description of the current branch trace.
38506 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38507 packet may have one of the following values:
38508
38509 @table @code
38510 @item all
38511 Returns all available branch trace.
38512
38513 @item new
38514 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38515 the last read request.
38516
38517 @item delta
38518 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38519 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38520 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38521 used to stitch traces together.
38522
38523 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38524 @end table
38525
38526 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38527 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38528
38529 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38530 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38531
38532 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38533 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38534
38535 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38536 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38537
38538 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38539 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38540 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38541 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38542 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38543 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38544 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38545
38546 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38547 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38548
38549 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38550 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38551 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38552 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38553 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38554
38555 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38556 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38557
38558 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38559 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38560 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38561 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38562 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38563
38564 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38565 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38566 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38567
38568 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38569 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38570
38571 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38572 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38573 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38574 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38575 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38576 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38577 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38578 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38579
38580 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38581 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38582
38583 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38584 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38585
38586 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38587 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38588 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38589 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38590
38591 @table @code
38592 @item start=@var{address}
38593 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38594 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
38595 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
38596 chosen as the starting point.
38597
38598 @item prev=@var{address}
38599 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
38600 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
38601 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
38602 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
38603 exists prior to the starting point.
38604
38605 @end table
38606
38607 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
38608 ignored.
38609
38610 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38611 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
38612 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
38613 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38614 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38615
38616 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38617 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38618
38619 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38620 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
38621
38622 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
38623 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
38624 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
38625 Action Lists}.
38626
38627 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38628 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38629 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38630
38631 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38632 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
38633 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
38634 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38635 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38636
38637 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38638 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38639 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38640
38641 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38642 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
38643 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38644 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
38645 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38646 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38647 in that context to be accessed.
38648
38649 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38650 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38651 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38652
38653 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38654 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
38655 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
38656 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38657 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38658
38659 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38660 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38661
38662 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38663 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
38664
38665 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
38666 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
38667 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38668
38669 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38670 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38671
38672 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38673 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
38674
38675 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
38676 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
38677
38678 This packet is not probed by default.
38679
38680 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38681 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
38682 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
38683 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
38684 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
38685
38686 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38687 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38688
38689 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38690 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
38691 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
38692 @xref{Operating System Information}.
38693
38694 @end table
38695
38696 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38697 @cindex write data into object, remote request
38698 @anchor{qXfer write}
38699 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
38700 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
38701 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
38702 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
38703 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
38704 to access.
38705
38706 Reply:
38707 @table @samp
38708 @item @var{nn}
38709 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
38710 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
38711
38712 @item E00
38713 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38714
38715 @item E @var{nn}
38716 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
38717 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38718
38719 @item @w{}
38720 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
38721 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
38722 @end table
38723
38724 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38725 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38726 formats, listed above.
38727
38728 @table @samp
38729 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38730 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
38731 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
38732 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
38733 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
38734
38735 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38736 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38737 (@pxref{qSupported}).
38738
38739 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
38740 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
38741 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
38742 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
38743 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
38744 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
38745 in that context to be accessed.
38746
38747 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38748 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38749 @end table
38750
38751 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
38752 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
38753 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
38754 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
38755 must respond with an empty packet.
38756
38757 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
38758 @cindex query attached, remote request
38759 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
38760 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
38761 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
38762 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
38763 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
38764 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
38765 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
38766
38767 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
38768 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
38769 the @code{quit} command.
38770
38771 Reply:
38772 @table @samp
38773 @item 1
38774 The remote server attached to an existing process.
38775 @item 0
38776 The remote server created a new process.
38777 @item E @var{NN}
38778 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38779 @end table
38780
38781 @item Qbtrace:bts
38782 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
38783
38784 Reply:
38785 @table @samp
38786 @item OK
38787 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38788 @item E.errtext
38789 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38790 @end table
38791
38792 @item Qbtrace:pt
38793 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
38794
38795 Reply:
38796 @table @samp
38797 @item OK
38798 Branch tracing has been enabled.
38799 @item E.errtext
38800 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38801 @end table
38802
38803 @item Qbtrace:off
38804 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
38805
38806 Reply:
38807 @table @samp
38808 @item OK
38809 Branch tracing has been disabled.
38810 @item E.errtext
38811 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38812 @end table
38813
38814 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
38815 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38816 btrace recording method in bts format.
38817
38818 Reply:
38819 @table @samp
38820 @item OK
38821 The ring buffer size has been set.
38822 @item E.errtext
38823 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38824 @end table
38825
38826 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
38827 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
38828 btrace recording method in pt format.
38829
38830 Reply:
38831 @table @samp
38832 @item OK
38833 The ring buffer size has been set.
38834 @item E.errtext
38835 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
38836 @end table
38837
38838 @end table
38839
38840 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38841 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
38842
38843 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
38844 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
38845 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
38846
38847 @menu
38848 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
38849 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
38850 @end menu
38851
38852 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
38853 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
38854
38855 @menu
38856 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
38857 @end menu
38858
38859 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
38860 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
38861 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
38862
38863 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38864
38865 @table @r
38866
38867 @item 2
38868 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
38869
38870 @item 3
38871 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
38872
38873 @item 4
38874 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
38875
38876 @end table
38877
38878 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
38879 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
38880
38881 @menu
38882 * MIPS Register packet Format::
38883 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
38884 @end menu
38885
38886 @node MIPS Register packet Format
38887 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
38888 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
38889
38890 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
38891 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
38892 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
38893 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
38894 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
38895 most-significant -- least-significant.
38896
38897 @table @r
38898
38899 @item MIPS32
38900 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
38901 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
38902 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
38903
38904 @item MIPS64
38905 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
38906 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
38907 as @code{MIPS32}.
38908
38909 @end table
38910
38911 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
38912 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
38913 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
38914
38915 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
38916
38917 @table @r
38918
38919 @item 2
38920 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
38921
38922 @item 3
38923 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38924
38925 @item 4
38926 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
38927
38928 @item 5
38929 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
38930
38931 @end table
38932
38933 @node Tracepoint Packets
38934 @section Tracepoint Packets
38935 @cindex tracepoint packets
38936 @cindex packets, tracepoint
38937
38938 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
38939 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
38940
38941 @table @samp
38942
38943 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
38944 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
38945 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
38946 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
38947 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
38948 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
38949 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
38950 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
38951 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
38952 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
38953 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
38954 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
38955 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
38956 actions.
38957
38958 Replies:
38959 @table @samp
38960 @item OK
38961 The packet was understood and carried out.
38962 @item qRelocInsn
38963 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
38964 @item @w{}
38965 The packet was not recognized.
38966 @end table
38967
38968 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
38969 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
38970 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
38971 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
38972 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
38973 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
38974 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
38975
38976 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
38977 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
38978 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
38979 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
38980 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
38981 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
38982 tracepoint actions.
38983
38984 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
38985 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
38986 following forms:
38987
38988 @table @samp
38989
38990 @item R @var{mask}
38991 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
38992 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
38993 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
38994 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
38995 not fit in a 32-bit word.
38996
38997 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
38998 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
38999 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39000 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39001 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39002 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39003 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39004
39005 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39006 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39007 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39008 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39009 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39010 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39011 packet).
39012
39013 @end table
39014
39015 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39016 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39017 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39018 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39019 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39020 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39021 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39022 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39023
39024 Replies:
39025 @table @samp
39026 @item OK
39027 The packet was understood and carried out.
39028 @item qRelocInsn
39029 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39030 @item @w{}
39031 The packet was not recognized.
39032 @end table
39033
39034 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39035 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39036 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39037 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39038 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39039 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39040 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39041 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39042
39043 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39044 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39045 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39046 fit in a single packet.
39047 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39048 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39049
39050 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39051 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39052 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39053 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39054
39055 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39056 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39057 query packets.
39058
39059 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39060 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39061 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39062 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39063 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39064 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39065 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39066 be found.
39067
39068 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39069 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39070 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39071 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39072 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39073 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39074 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39075 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39076 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39077 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39078 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39079 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39080 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39081 variable.
39082
39083 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39084 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39085 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39086 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39087 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39088
39089 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39090 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39091 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39092 one of the following forms:
39093
39094 @table @samp
39095 @item F @var{f}
39096 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39097 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39098 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39099
39100 @item T @var{t}
39101 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39102 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39103
39104 @end table
39105
39106 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39107 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39108 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39109 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39110
39111 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39112 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39113 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39114 is a hexadecimal number.
39115
39116 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39117 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39118 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39119 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39120 numbers.
39121
39122 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39123 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39124 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39125
39126 @item qTMinFTPILen
39127 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39128 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39129 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39130 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39131 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39132 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39133 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39134 arrange for that.
39135
39136 Replies:
39137
39138 @table @samp
39139 @item 0
39140 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39141 @item @var{length}
39142 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39143 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39144 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39145 regardless of size.
39146 @item E
39147 An error has occurred.
39148 @item @w{}
39149 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39150 @end table
39151
39152 @item QTStart
39153 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39154 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39155 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39156 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39157 instruction reply packet}).
39158
39159 @item QTStop
39160 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39161 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39162
39163 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39164 @anchor{QTEnable}
39165 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39166 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39167 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39168 of data from it will resume.
39169
39170 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39171 @anchor{QTDisable}
39172 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39173 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39174 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39175 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39176
39177 @item QTinit
39178 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39179 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39180
39181 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39182 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39183 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39184 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39185 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39186
39187 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39188 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39189 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39190 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39191
39192 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39193 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39194 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39195 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39196 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39197 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39198
39199 @item qTStatus
39200 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39201 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39202
39203 The reply has the form:
39204
39205 @table @samp
39206
39207 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39208 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39209 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39210 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39211
39212 @end table
39213
39214 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39215 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39216
39217 @table @samp
39218
39219 @item tnotrun:0
39220 No trace has been run yet.
39221
39222 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39223 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39224 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39225 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39226 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39227
39228 @item tfull:0
39229 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39230
39231 @item tdisconnected:0
39232 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39233
39234 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39235 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39236
39237 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39238 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39239 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39240 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
39241 is hex encoded.
39242
39243 @item tunknown:0
39244 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39245
39246 @end table
39247
39248 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
39249 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
39250 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
39251 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
39252 trace.
39253
39254 @table @samp
39255
39256 @item tframes:@var{n}
39257 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
39258
39259 @item tcreated:@var{n}
39260 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
39261 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
39262
39263 @item tsize:@var{n}
39264 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
39265
39266 @item tfree:@var{n}
39267 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
39268
39269 @item circular:@var{n}
39270 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
39271 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
39272 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
39273 and may fill up.
39274
39275 @item disconn:@var{n}
39276 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
39277 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
39278 that the trace run will stop.
39279
39280 @end table
39281
39282 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
39283 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
39284 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
39285 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
39286 address @var{addr}.
39287
39288 Replies:
39289 @table @samp
39290 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
39291 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
39292 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39293 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39294 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39295
39296 @end table
39297
39298 @item qTV:@var{var}
39299 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39300 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39301 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39302
39303 Replies:
39304 @table @samp
39305 @item V@var{value}
39306 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39307 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39308 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39309 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39310 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39311 program is running.
39312
39313 @item U
39314 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39315 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39316 was not collected.
39317 @end table
39318
39319 @item qTfP
39320 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39321 @itemx qTsP
39322 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39323 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39324 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39325 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39326 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39327 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39328
39329 @item qTfV
39330 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39331 @itemx qTsV
39332 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39333 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39334 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39335 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39336 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39337 trace state variables.
39338
39339 @item qTfSTM
39340 @itemx qTsSTM
39341 @anchor{qTfSTM}
39342 @anchor{qTsSTM}
39343 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39344 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39345 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39346 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39347 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39348 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39349
39350 Reply:
39351 @table @samp
39352 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39353 A single marker
39354 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39355 a comma-separated list of markers
39356 @item l
39357 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39358 @item E @var{nn}
39359 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39360 @item @w{}
39361 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39362 stub.
39363 @end table
39364
39365 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39366 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39367
39368 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39369 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39370 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39371 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39372 @dfn{last}).
39373
39374 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39375 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39376 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39377 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39378 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39379 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39380 tracepoint markers.
39381
39382 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39383 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39384 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39385 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39386 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39387 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39388
39389 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39390 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39391 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39392 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39393 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39394 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39395 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39396 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39397 available.
39398
39399 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39400 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39401 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39402
39403 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39404 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39405 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39406 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39407 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39408 use whatever size it prefers.
39409
39410 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39411 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39412 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39413 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39414 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39415
39416 @end table
39417
39418 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39419 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39420 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39421 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39422 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39423 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39424 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39425 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39426 it had executed in the original location.
39427
39428 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39429 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39430 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39431 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39432 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39433 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39434 format of the request is:
39435
39436 @table @samp
39437 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39438
39439 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39440 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39441 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39442 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39443 memory starting at @var{to}.
39444 @end table
39445
39446 Replies:
39447 @table @samp
39448 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39449 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39450 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39451 @item E @var{NN}
39452 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39453 relocating the instruction.
39454 @end table
39455
39456 @node Host I/O Packets
39457 @section Host I/O Packets
39458 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39459 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39460
39461 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39462 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39463 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39464 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39465 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39466 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39467 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39468 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39469 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39470 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39471
39472 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39473 its arguments. They have this format:
39474
39475 @table @samp
39476
39477 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39478 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39479 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39480 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39481 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39482 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39483 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39484 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39485 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39486
39487 @end table
39488
39489 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39490
39491 @table @samp
39492
39493 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39494 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39495 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39496 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39497 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39498 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39499 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39500 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39501 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39502 @var{attachment}.
39503
39504 @item @w{}
39505 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39506
39507 @end table
39508
39509 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39510
39511 @table @samp
39512 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39513 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39514 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39515 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39516 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39517 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39518 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39519
39520 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39521 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39522 -1 if an error occurs.
39523
39524 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39525 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39526 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39527 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39528 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39529 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39530 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39531 @var{count} was zero.
39532
39533 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39534 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39535 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39536 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39537 some characters were escaped.
39538
39539 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39540 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39541 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39542 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39543 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39544 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39545 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39546 error occurred.
39547
39548 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39549 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39550 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39551 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39552 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39553 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39554
39555 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39556 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39557 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39558
39559 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39560 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39561 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39562
39563 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39564 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39565 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39566 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39567 some characters were escaped.
39568
39569 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39570 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39571 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39572 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39573 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39574 inferior(s).
39575
39576 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39577 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39578 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39579 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39580 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39581 operation.
39582
39583 @end table
39584
39585 @node Interrupts
39586 @section Interrupts
39587 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39588 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39589
39590 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39591 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39592 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
39593 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
39594
39595 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
39596 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
39597 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
39598 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
39599 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
39600
39601 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
39602 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
39603 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
39604 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
39605 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
39606 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
39607 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
39608 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
39609
39610 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
39611 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
39612 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
39613
39614 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
39615 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
39616 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
39617 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
39618 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
39619 @code{0x03}.
39620
39621 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
39622 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
39623 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
39624 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
39625 currently-executing threads and processes.
39626 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
39627 running program, it should send one of the stop
39628 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
39629 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
39630 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
39631 Interrupts received while the
39632 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
39633 it is resumed next time.
39634
39635 @node Notification Packets
39636 @section Notification Packets
39637 @cindex notification packets
39638 @cindex packets, notification
39639
39640 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
39641 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
39642 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
39643 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
39644 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
39645 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
39646 is not a problem.
39647
39648 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
39649 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
39650 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
39651 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
39652 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
39653 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
39654 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
39655
39656 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
39657 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
39658
39659 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
39660 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
39661 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
39662 not they understand it.
39663
39664 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
39665 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
39666 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
39667 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
39668 recipients.
39669
39670 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
39671 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
39672 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
39673 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
39674 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
39675
39676 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
39677 @table @samp
39678 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
39679 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
39680 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
39681 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
39682 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
39683 @item @var{ack}
39684 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
39685 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
39686 @end table
39687
39688 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
39689 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
39690
39691 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
39692 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
39693 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
39694 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
39695 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
39696 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
39697 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
39698 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
39699 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
39700 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
39701
39702 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
39703 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
39704 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
39705 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
39706 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
39707 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
39708
39709 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
39710 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
39711 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
39712 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
39713 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
39714
39715 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
39716 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
39717 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
39718 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
39719 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
39720 normally.
39721
39722 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
39723 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
39724 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
39725 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
39726 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
39727 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
39728 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
39729 the process shall be repeated.
39730
39731 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
39732 following example:
39733 @smallexample
39734 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
39735 @code{...}
39736 -> @code{vStopped}
39737 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
39738 -> @code{vStopped}
39739 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
39740 -> @code{vStopped}
39741 <- @code{OK}
39742 @end smallexample
39743
39744 The following notifications are defined:
39745 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
39746
39747 @item Notification
39748 @tab Ack
39749 @tab Event
39750 @tab Description
39751
39752 @item Stop
39753 @tab vStopped
39754 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
39755 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
39756 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
39757 @value{GDBN}.
39758 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
39759
39760 @end multitable
39761
39762 @node Remote Non-Stop
39763 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
39764
39765 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
39766 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
39767 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
39768 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39769
39770 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
39771 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
39772 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
39773 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
39774 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
39775 probe the target state after a mode change.
39776
39777 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
39778 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
39779 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
39780 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
39781 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
39782 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
39783 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
39784 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
39785 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
39786 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
39787 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
39788
39789 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
39790 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
39791 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
39792 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
39793 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
39794 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
39795 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
39796 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
39797 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
39798 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
39799 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
39800 @samp{OK}.
39801
39802 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
39803 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
39804 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
39805 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
39806 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
39807 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
39808 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
39809 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
39810 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
39811 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
39812 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
39813 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
39814 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
39815
39816 @node Packet Acknowledgment
39817 @section Packet Acknowledgment
39818
39819 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39820 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
39821 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
39822 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
39823 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
39824 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
39825 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
39826
39827 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
39828 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
39829 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
39830 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
39831 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
39832
39833 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
39834 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
39835 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
39836 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
39837
39838 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
39839 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
39840 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
39841 @pxref{qSupported}.
39842 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
39843 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
39844 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
39845 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
39846 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
39847 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
39848 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
39849
39850 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
39851 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
39852 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
39853 connection.
39854 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
39855 new connection is established,
39856 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
39857 for the current connection, once disabled.
39858
39859 @node Examples
39860 @section Examples
39861
39862 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
39863 does not get any direct output:
39864
39865 @smallexample
39866 -> @code{R00}
39867 <- @code{+}
39868 @emph{target restarts}
39869 -> @code{?}
39870 <- @code{+}
39871 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39872 -> @code{+}
39873 @end smallexample
39874
39875 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
39876
39877 @smallexample
39878 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
39879 <- @code{+}
39880 -> @code{s}
39881 <- @code{+}
39882 @emph{time passes}
39883 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
39884 -> @code{+}
39885 -> @code{g}
39886 <- @code{+}
39887 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
39888 -> @code{+}
39889 @end smallexample
39890
39891 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39892 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
39893 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
39894
39895 @menu
39896 * File-I/O Overview::
39897 * Protocol Basics::
39898 * The F Request Packet::
39899 * The F Reply Packet::
39900 * The Ctrl-C Message::
39901 * Console I/O::
39902 * List of Supported Calls::
39903 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
39904 * Constants::
39905 * File-I/O Examples::
39906 @end menu
39907
39908 @node File-I/O Overview
39909 @subsection File-I/O Overview
39910 @cindex file-i/o overview
39911
39912 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
39913 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
39914 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
39915 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
39916 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
39917 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
39918
39919 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
39920 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
39921 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
39922 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
39923 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
39924
39925 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
39926 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39927 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
39928 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
39929 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
39930 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
39931 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
39932
39933 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
39934 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
39935 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
39936 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
39937 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
39938
39939 @smallexample
39940 (@value{GDBP}) continue
39941 <- target requests 'system call X'
39942 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
39943 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
39944 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
39945 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
39946 @end smallexample
39947
39948 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
39949 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
39950 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
39951 system are not supported by this protocol.
39952
39953 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
39954
39955 @node Protocol Basics
39956 @subsection Protocol Basics
39957 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
39958
39959 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
39960 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
39961 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
39962 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
39963 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
39964 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
39965 to call the appropriate host system call:
39966
39967 @itemize @bullet
39968 @item
39969 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
39970
39971 @item
39972 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
39973 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
39974 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
39975 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
39976
39977 @end itemize
39978
39979 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
39980
39981 @itemize @bullet
39982 @item
39983 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
39984 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
39985 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
39986 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
39987 packet.
39988
39989 @item
39990 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
39991 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
39992
39993 @item
39994 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
39995
39996 @item
39997 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
39998
39999 @item
40000 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40001 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40002 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40003 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40004 packet.
40005
40006 @end itemize
40007
40008 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40009 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40010
40011 @itemize @bullet
40012 @item
40013 Return value.
40014
40015 @item
40016 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40017
40018 @item
40019 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40020
40021 @end itemize
40022
40023 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40024 the latest continue or step action.
40025
40026 @node The F Request Packet
40027 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40028 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40029 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40030
40031 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40032
40033 @table @samp
40034 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40035
40036 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40037 This is just the name of the function.
40038
40039 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40040 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40041 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40042 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40043 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40044 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40045 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40046
40047 @end table
40048
40049
40050
40051 @node The F Reply Packet
40052 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40053 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40054 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40055
40056 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40057
40058 @table @samp
40059
40060 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40061
40062 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40063
40064 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40065 representation.
40066 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40067
40068 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40069 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40070 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40071
40072 @smallexample
40073 F0,0,C
40074 @end smallexample
40075
40076 @noindent
40077 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40078
40079 @smallexample
40080 F-1,4,C
40081 @end smallexample
40082
40083 @noindent
40084 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40085
40086 @end table
40087
40088
40089 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40090 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40091 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40092
40093 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40094 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40095 the target should behave as if it had
40096 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40097 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40098 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40099 packet.
40100
40101 It's important for the target to know in which
40102 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40103
40104 @itemize @bullet
40105 @item
40106 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40107
40108 @item
40109 The system call on the host has been finished.
40110
40111 @end itemize
40112
40113 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40114 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40115 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40116 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40117 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40118 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40119
40120 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40121 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40122 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40123 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40124 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40125 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40126 or the full action has been completed.
40127
40128 @node Console I/O
40129 @subsection Console I/O
40130 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40131
40132 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40133 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40134 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40135 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40136 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40137 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40138 conditions is met:
40139
40140 @itemize @bullet
40141 @item
40142 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40143 @code{read}
40144 system call is treated as finished.
40145
40146 @item
40147 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40148 newline.
40149
40150 @item
40151 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40152 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40153
40154 @end itemize
40155
40156 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40157 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40158 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40159 is stopped at the user's request.
40160
40161
40162 @node List of Supported Calls
40163 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40164 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40165
40166 @menu
40167 * open::
40168 * close::
40169 * read::
40170 * write::
40171 * lseek::
40172 * rename::
40173 * unlink::
40174 * stat/fstat::
40175 * gettimeofday::
40176 * isatty::
40177 * system::
40178 @end menu
40179
40180 @node open
40181 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40182 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40183
40184 @table @asis
40185 @item Synopsis:
40186 @smallexample
40187 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40188 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40189 @end smallexample
40190
40191 @item Request:
40192 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40193
40194 @noindent
40195 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40196
40197 @table @code
40198 @item O_CREAT
40199 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40200 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40201 are concerned.
40202
40203 @item O_EXCL
40204 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40205 an error and open() fails.
40206
40207 @item O_TRUNC
40208 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40209 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40210 truncated to zero length.
40211
40212 @item O_APPEND
40213 The file is opened in append mode.
40214
40215 @item O_RDONLY
40216 The file is opened for reading only.
40217
40218 @item O_WRONLY
40219 The file is opened for writing only.
40220
40221 @item O_RDWR
40222 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40223 @end table
40224
40225 @noindent
40226 Other bits are silently ignored.
40227
40228
40229 @noindent
40230 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40231
40232 @table @code
40233 @item S_IRUSR
40234 User has read permission.
40235
40236 @item S_IWUSR
40237 User has write permission.
40238
40239 @item S_IRGRP
40240 Group has read permission.
40241
40242 @item S_IWGRP
40243 Group has write permission.
40244
40245 @item S_IROTH
40246 Others have read permission.
40247
40248 @item S_IWOTH
40249 Others have write permission.
40250 @end table
40251
40252 @noindent
40253 Other bits are silently ignored.
40254
40255
40256 @item Return value:
40257 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
40258 occurred.
40259
40260 @item Errors:
40261
40262 @table @code
40263 @item EEXIST
40264 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
40265
40266 @item EISDIR
40267 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
40268
40269 @item EACCES
40270 The requested access is not allowed.
40271
40272 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40273 @var{pathname} was too long.
40274
40275 @item ENOENT
40276 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40277
40278 @item ENODEV
40279 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
40280
40281 @item EROFS
40282 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
40283 write access was requested.
40284
40285 @item EFAULT
40286 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
40287
40288 @item ENOSPC
40289 No space on device to create the file.
40290
40291 @item EMFILE
40292 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40293
40294 @item ENFILE
40295 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40296 has been reached.
40297
40298 @item EINTR
40299 The call was interrupted by the user.
40300 @end table
40301
40302 @end table
40303
40304 @node close
40305 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40306 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40307
40308 @table @asis
40309 @item Synopsis:
40310 @smallexample
40311 int close(int fd);
40312 @end smallexample
40313
40314 @item Request:
40315 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40316
40317 @item Return value:
40318 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40319
40320 @item Errors:
40321
40322 @table @code
40323 @item EBADF
40324 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40325
40326 @item EINTR
40327 The call was interrupted by the user.
40328 @end table
40329
40330 @end table
40331
40332 @node read
40333 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40334 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40335
40336 @table @asis
40337 @item Synopsis:
40338 @smallexample
40339 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40340 @end smallexample
40341
40342 @item Request:
40343 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40344
40345 @item Return value:
40346 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40347 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40348 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40349
40350 @item Errors:
40351
40352 @table @code
40353 @item EBADF
40354 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40355 reading.
40356
40357 @item EFAULT
40358 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40359
40360 @item EINTR
40361 The call was interrupted by the user.
40362 @end table
40363
40364 @end table
40365
40366 @node write
40367 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40368 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40369
40370 @table @asis
40371 @item Synopsis:
40372 @smallexample
40373 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40374 @end smallexample
40375
40376 @item Request:
40377 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40378
40379 @item Return value:
40380 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40381 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40382 is returned.
40383
40384 @item Errors:
40385
40386 @table @code
40387 @item EBADF
40388 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40389 writing.
40390
40391 @item EFAULT
40392 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40393
40394 @item EFBIG
40395 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40396 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40397
40398 @item ENOSPC
40399 No space on device to write the data.
40400
40401 @item EINTR
40402 The call was interrupted by the user.
40403 @end table
40404
40405 @end table
40406
40407 @node lseek
40408 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40409 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40410
40411 @table @asis
40412 @item Synopsis:
40413 @smallexample
40414 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40415 @end smallexample
40416
40417 @item Request:
40418 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40419
40420 @var{flag} is one of:
40421
40422 @table @code
40423 @item SEEK_SET
40424 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40425
40426 @item SEEK_CUR
40427 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40428 bytes.
40429
40430 @item SEEK_END
40431 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40432 bytes.
40433 @end table
40434
40435 @item Return value:
40436 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40437 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40438 value of -1 is returned.
40439
40440 @item Errors:
40441
40442 @table @code
40443 @item EBADF
40444 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40445
40446 @item ESPIPE
40447 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40448
40449 @item EINVAL
40450 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40451
40452 @item EINTR
40453 The call was interrupted by the user.
40454 @end table
40455
40456 @end table
40457
40458 @node rename
40459 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40460 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40461
40462 @table @asis
40463 @item Synopsis:
40464 @smallexample
40465 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40466 @end smallexample
40467
40468 @item Request:
40469 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40470
40471 @item Return value:
40472 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40473
40474 @item Errors:
40475
40476 @table @code
40477 @item EISDIR
40478 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40479 directory.
40480
40481 @item EEXIST
40482 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40483
40484 @item EBUSY
40485 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40486 process.
40487
40488 @item EINVAL
40489 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40490 of itself.
40491
40492 @item ENOTDIR
40493 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40494 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40495 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40496
40497 @item EFAULT
40498 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40499
40500 @item EACCES
40501 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40502
40503 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40504
40505 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40506
40507 @item ENOENT
40508 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40509
40510 @item EROFS
40511 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40512
40513 @item ENOSPC
40514 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40515 directory entry.
40516
40517 @item EINTR
40518 The call was interrupted by the user.
40519 @end table
40520
40521 @end table
40522
40523 @node unlink
40524 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40525 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40526
40527 @table @asis
40528 @item Synopsis:
40529 @smallexample
40530 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40531 @end smallexample
40532
40533 @item Request:
40534 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40535
40536 @item Return value:
40537 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40538
40539 @item Errors:
40540
40541 @table @code
40542 @item EACCES
40543 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40544
40545 @item EPERM
40546 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40547
40548 @item EBUSY
40549 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40550 being used by another process.
40551
40552 @item EFAULT
40553 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40554
40555 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40556 @var{pathname} was too long.
40557
40558 @item ENOENT
40559 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40560
40561 @item ENOTDIR
40562 A component of the path is not a directory.
40563
40564 @item EROFS
40565 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40566
40567 @item EINTR
40568 The call was interrupted by the user.
40569 @end table
40570
40571 @end table
40572
40573 @node stat/fstat
40574 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40575 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40576 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40577
40578 @table @asis
40579 @item Synopsis:
40580 @smallexample
40581 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40582 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40583 @end smallexample
40584
40585 @item Request:
40586 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40587 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40588
40589 @item Return value:
40590 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40591
40592 @item Errors:
40593
40594 @table @code
40595 @item EBADF
40596 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
40597
40598 @item ENOENT
40599 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
40600 path is an empty string.
40601
40602 @item ENOTDIR
40603 A component of the path is not a directory.
40604
40605 @item EFAULT
40606 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40607
40608 @item EACCES
40609 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40610
40611 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40612 @var{pathname} was too long.
40613
40614 @item EINTR
40615 The call was interrupted by the user.
40616 @end table
40617
40618 @end table
40619
40620 @node gettimeofday
40621 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
40622 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
40623
40624 @table @asis
40625 @item Synopsis:
40626 @smallexample
40627 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
40628 @end smallexample
40629
40630 @item Request:
40631 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
40632
40633 @item Return value:
40634 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
40635
40636 @item Errors:
40637
40638 @table @code
40639 @item EINVAL
40640 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
40641
40642 @item EFAULT
40643 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40644 @end table
40645
40646 @end table
40647
40648 @node isatty
40649 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
40650 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
40651
40652 @table @asis
40653 @item Synopsis:
40654 @smallexample
40655 int isatty(int fd);
40656 @end smallexample
40657
40658 @item Request:
40659 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
40660
40661 @item Return value:
40662 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
40663
40664 @item Errors:
40665
40666 @table @code
40667 @item EINTR
40668 The call was interrupted by the user.
40669 @end table
40670
40671 @end table
40672
40673 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
40674 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
40675 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
40676 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
40677 needed.
40678
40679
40680 @node system
40681 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
40682 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
40683
40684 @table @asis
40685 @item Synopsis:
40686 @smallexample
40687 int system(const char *command);
40688 @end smallexample
40689
40690 @item Request:
40691 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
40692
40693 @item Return value:
40694 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
40695 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
40696 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
40697 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
40698 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
40699 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
40700 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
40701
40702 @item Errors:
40703
40704 @table @code
40705 @item EINTR
40706 The call was interrupted by the user.
40707 @end table
40708
40709 @end table
40710
40711 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
40712 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
40713 the host is simplified before it's returned
40714 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
40715 is discarded, and the return value consists
40716 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
40717
40718 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
40719 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
40720 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
40721
40722 @table @code
40723 @item set remote system-call-allowed
40724 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
40725 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
40726 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
40727
40728 @item show remote system-call-allowed
40729 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
40730 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
40731 protocol.
40732 @end table
40733
40734 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40735 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
40736 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40737
40738 @menu
40739 * Integral Datatypes::
40740 * Pointer Values::
40741 * Memory Transfer::
40742 * struct stat::
40743 * struct timeval::
40744 @end menu
40745
40746 @node Integral Datatypes
40747 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
40748 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
40749
40750 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
40751 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
40752 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
40753
40754 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
40755 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
40756
40757 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
40758
40759 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
40760 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
40761
40762 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
40763
40764 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
40765 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
40766 byte order.
40767
40768 @node Pointer Values
40769 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
40770 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
40771
40772 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
40773 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
40774 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
40775 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
40776
40777 @smallexample
40778 @code{1aaf/12}
40779 @end smallexample
40780
40781 @noindent
40782 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
40783 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
40784 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
40785 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
40786
40787 @smallexample
40788 @code{123456/d}
40789 @end smallexample
40790
40791 @node Memory Transfer
40792 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
40793 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
40794
40795 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
40796 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
40797 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
40798 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
40799 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
40800 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
40801 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
40802
40803
40804 @node struct stat
40805 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
40806 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
40807
40808 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
40809 is defined as follows:
40810
40811 @smallexample
40812 struct stat @{
40813 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
40814 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
40815 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
40816 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
40817 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
40818 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
40819 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
40820 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
40821 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
40822 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
40823 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
40824 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
40825 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
40826 @};
40827 @end smallexample
40828
40829 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40830 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40831 structure is of size 64 bytes.
40832
40833 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
40834 range of values.
40835
40836 @table @code
40837
40838 @item st_dev
40839 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
40840
40841 @item st_ino
40842 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40843
40844 @item st_mode
40845 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
40846 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
40847
40848 @item st_uid
40849 @itemx st_gid
40850 @itemx st_rdev
40851 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
40852
40853 @item st_atime
40854 @itemx st_mtime
40855 @itemx st_ctime
40856 These values have a host and file system dependent
40857 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
40858 support exact timing values.
40859 @end table
40860
40861 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
40862 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
40863 continuing.
40864
40865 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
40866 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
40867 get truncated on the target.
40868
40869 @node struct timeval
40870 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
40871 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
40872
40873 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
40874 is defined as follows:
40875
40876 @smallexample
40877 struct timeval @{
40878 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
40879 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
40880 @};
40881 @end smallexample
40882
40883 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
40884 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
40885 structure is of size 8 bytes.
40886
40887 @node Constants
40888 @subsection Constants
40889 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
40890
40891 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
40892 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
40893 values before and after the call as needed.
40894
40895 @menu
40896 * Open Flags::
40897 * mode_t Values::
40898 * Errno Values::
40899 * Lseek Flags::
40900 * Limits::
40901 @end menu
40902
40903 @node Open Flags
40904 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
40905 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
40906
40907 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
40908
40909 @smallexample
40910 O_RDONLY 0x0
40911 O_WRONLY 0x1
40912 O_RDWR 0x2
40913 O_APPEND 0x8
40914 O_CREAT 0x200
40915 O_TRUNC 0x400
40916 O_EXCL 0x800
40917 @end smallexample
40918
40919 @node mode_t Values
40920 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
40921 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
40922
40923 All values are given in octal representation.
40924
40925 @smallexample
40926 S_IFREG 0100000
40927 S_IFDIR 040000
40928 S_IRUSR 0400
40929 S_IWUSR 0200
40930 S_IXUSR 0100
40931 S_IRGRP 040
40932 S_IWGRP 020
40933 S_IXGRP 010
40934 S_IROTH 04
40935 S_IWOTH 02
40936 S_IXOTH 01
40937 @end smallexample
40938
40939 @node Errno Values
40940 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
40941 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
40942
40943 All values are given in decimal representation.
40944
40945 @smallexample
40946 EPERM 1
40947 ENOENT 2
40948 EINTR 4
40949 EBADF 9
40950 EACCES 13
40951 EFAULT 14
40952 EBUSY 16
40953 EEXIST 17
40954 ENODEV 19
40955 ENOTDIR 20
40956 EISDIR 21
40957 EINVAL 22
40958 ENFILE 23
40959 EMFILE 24
40960 EFBIG 27
40961 ENOSPC 28
40962 ESPIPE 29
40963 EROFS 30
40964 ENAMETOOLONG 91
40965 EUNKNOWN 9999
40966 @end smallexample
40967
40968 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
40969 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
40970
40971 @node Lseek Flags
40972 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
40973 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
40974
40975 @smallexample
40976 SEEK_SET 0
40977 SEEK_CUR 1
40978 SEEK_END 2
40979 @end smallexample
40980
40981 @node Limits
40982 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
40983 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
40984
40985 All values are given in decimal representation.
40986
40987 @smallexample
40988 INT_MIN -2147483648
40989 INT_MAX 2147483647
40990 UINT_MAX 4294967295
40991 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
40992 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
40993 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
40994 @end smallexample
40995
40996 @node File-I/O Examples
40997 @subsection File-I/O Examples
40998 @cindex file-i/o examples
40999
41000 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41001 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41002
41003 @smallexample
41004 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41005 @emph{request memory read from target}
41006 -> @code{m1234,6}
41007 <- XXXXXX
41008 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41009 -> @code{F6}
41010 @end smallexample
41011
41012 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41013 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41014
41015 @smallexample
41016 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41017 @emph{request memory write to target}
41018 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41019 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41020 -> @code{F6}
41021 @end smallexample
41022
41023 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41024 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41025
41026 @smallexample
41027 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41028 -> @code{F-1,9}
41029 @end smallexample
41030
41031 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41032 host is called:
41033
41034 @smallexample
41035 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41036 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41037 <- @code{T02}
41038 @end smallexample
41039
41040 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41041 host is called:
41042
41043 @smallexample
41044 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41045 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41046 <- @code{T02}
41047 @end smallexample
41048
41049 @node Library List Format
41050 @section Library List Format
41051 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41052
41053 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41054 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41055 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41056 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41057 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41058 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41059 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41060 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41061 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41062 are loaded.
41063
41064 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41065 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41066 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41067 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41068
41069 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41070 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41071 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41072 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41073 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41074 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41075
41076 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41077 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41078
41079 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41080 offset, looks like this:
41081
41082 @smallexample
41083 <library-list>
41084 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41085 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41086 </library>
41087 </library-list>
41088 @end smallexample
41089
41090 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41091 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41092
41093 @smallexample
41094 <library-list>
41095 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41096 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41097 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41098 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41099 </library>
41100 </library-list>
41101 @end smallexample
41102
41103 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41104
41105 @smallexample
41106 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41107 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41108 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41109 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41110 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41111 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41112 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41113 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41114 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41115 @end smallexample
41116
41117 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41118 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41119 section for each library.
41120
41121 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41122 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41123 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41124
41125 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41126 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41127 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41128 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41129
41130 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41131 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41132 target, the following parameters are reported:
41133
41134 @itemize @minus
41135 @item
41136 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41137 @code{struct link_map}.
41138 @item
41139 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41140 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41141 @item
41142 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41143 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41144 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41145 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41146 @item
41147 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41148 @end itemize
41149
41150 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41151 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41152 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41153
41154 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41155 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41156
41157 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41158 looks like this:
41159
41160 @smallexample
41161 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41162 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41163 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41164 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41165 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41166 </library-list-svr>
41167 @end smallexample
41168
41169 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41170
41171 @smallexample
41172 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41173 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41174 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41175 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41176 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41177 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41178 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41179 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41180 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41181 @end smallexample
41182
41183 @node Memory Map Format
41184 @section Memory Map Format
41185 @cindex memory map format
41186
41187 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41188 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41189 memory map.
41190
41191 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41192 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41193 lists memory regions.
41194
41195 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41196 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41197
41198 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41199
41200 @smallexample
41201 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41202 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41203 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41204 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41205 <memory-map>
41206 region...
41207 </memory-map>
41208 @end smallexample
41209
41210 Each region can be either:
41211
41212 @itemize
41213
41214 @item
41215 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41216 bytes from there:
41217
41218 @smallexample
41219 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41220 @end smallexample
41221
41222
41223 @item
41224 A region of read-only memory:
41225
41226 @smallexample
41227 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41228 @end smallexample
41229
41230
41231 @item
41232 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41233 bytes in length:
41234
41235 @smallexample
41236 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41237 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41238 </memory>
41239 @end smallexample
41240
41241 @end itemize
41242
41243 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41244 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41245 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41246
41247 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41248
41249 @smallexample
41250 <!-- ................................................... -->
41251 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
41252 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
41253 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
41254 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
41255 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
41256 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
41257 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
41258 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
41259 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
41260 and its type, or device. -->
41261 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
41262 start CDATA #REQUIRED
41263 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41264 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
41265 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
41266 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
41267 @end smallexample
41268
41269 @node Thread List Format
41270 @section Thread List Format
41271 @cindex thread list format
41272
41273 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
41274 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41275 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
41276 the following structure:
41277
41278 @smallexample
41279 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41280 <threads>
41281 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
41282 ... description ...
41283 </thread>
41284 </threads>
41285 @end smallexample
41286
41287 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
41288 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
41289 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
41290 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
41291 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
41292 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
41293 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
41294 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
41295
41296
41297 @node Traceframe Info Format
41298 @section Traceframe Info Format
41299 @cindex traceframe info format
41300
41301 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41302 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41303 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41304 collected in a traceframe.
41305
41306 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41307 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41308
41309 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41310 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41311
41312 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41313
41314 @smallexample
41315 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41316 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41317 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41318 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41319 <traceframe-info>
41320 block...
41321 </traceframe-info>
41322 @end smallexample
41323
41324 Each traceframe block can be either:
41325
41326 @itemize
41327
41328 @item
41329 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41330 @var{length} bytes from there:
41331
41332 @smallexample
41333 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41334 @end smallexample
41335
41336 @item
41337 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
41338 collected:
41339
41340 @smallexample
41341 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
41342 @end smallexample
41343
41344 @end itemize
41345
41346 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41347
41348 @smallexample
41349 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
41350 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41351
41352 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41353 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41354 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41355 <!ELEMENT tvar>
41356 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
41357 @end smallexample
41358
41359 @node Branch Trace Format
41360 @section Branch Trace Format
41361 @cindex branch trace format
41362
41363 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41364 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41365 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41366 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41367
41368 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41369 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41370
41371 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41372 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41373
41374 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41375
41376 @smallexample
41377 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41378 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41379 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41380 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41381 <btrace>
41382 block...
41383 </btrace>
41384 @end smallexample
41385
41386 @itemize
41387
41388 @item
41389 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41390 and ending at @var{end}:
41391
41392 @smallexample
41393 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41394 @end smallexample
41395
41396 @end itemize
41397
41398 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41399
41400 @smallexample
41401 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41402 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41403
41404 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41405 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41406 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41407
41408 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41409
41410 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41411
41412 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41413 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41414 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41415 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41416 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41417
41418 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41419 @end smallexample
41420
41421 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41422 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41423 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41424
41425 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41426 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41427 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41428
41429 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41430 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41431
41432 @table @code
41433 @item bts
41434 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41435 @table @code
41436 @item size
41437 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41438 @end table
41439 @item pt
41440 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41441 PT}) format.
41442 @table @code
41443 @item size
41444 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41445 @end table
41446 @end table
41447
41448 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41449 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41450
41451 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41452
41453 @smallexample
41454 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41455 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41456
41457 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41458 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41459
41460 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41461 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41462 @end smallexample
41463
41464 @include agentexpr.texi
41465
41466 @node Target Descriptions
41467 @appendix Target Descriptions
41468 @cindex target descriptions
41469
41470 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41471 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41472 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41473 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41474 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41475 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41476 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41477
41478 @itemize @bullet
41479 @item
41480 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41481 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41482 @item
41483 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41484 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41485 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41486 @item
41487 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41488 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41489 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41490 @end itemize
41491
41492 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41493 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41494 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41495 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41496 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41497
41498 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41499 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41500
41501 @menu
41502 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41503 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41504 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41505 descriptions.
41506 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41507 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41508 @end menu
41509
41510 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41511 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41512
41513 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41514 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41515 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41516 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41517 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41518 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41519 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41520 Format}.
41521
41522 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41523 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41524 specify a file are:
41525
41526 @table @code
41527 @cindex set tdesc filename
41528 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41529 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41530
41531 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41532 @item unset tdesc filename
41533 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41534 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41535
41536 @cindex show tdesc filename
41537 @item show tdesc filename
41538 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41539 @end table
41540
41541
41542 @node Target Description Format
41543 @section Target Description Format
41544 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41545
41546 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41547 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41548 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41549 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41550 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41551 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41552 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41553
41554 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41555 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41556 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41557 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41558 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41559
41560 Here is a simple target description:
41561
41562 @smallexample
41563 <target version="1.0">
41564 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41565 </target>
41566 @end smallexample
41567
41568 @noindent
41569 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41570 the x86-64 architecture.
41571
41572 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41573 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41574 are explained further below.
41575
41576 @smallexample
41577 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41578 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41579 <target version="1.0">
41580 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41581 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41582 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41583 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41584 </target>
41585 @end smallexample
41586
41587 @noindent
41588 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41589 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41590 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41591 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41592 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
41593 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
41594 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
41595 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
41596 the version mismatch.
41597
41598 @subsection Inclusion
41599 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
41600 @cindex XInclude
41601 @ifnotinfo
41602 @cindex <xi:include>
41603 @end ifnotinfo
41604
41605 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
41606 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
41607 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
41608 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
41609 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
41610
41611 @smallexample
41612 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
41613 @end smallexample
41614
41615 @noindent
41616 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
41617 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
41618 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
41619 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
41620 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
41621 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
41622 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
41623 original description.
41624
41625 @subsection Architecture
41626 @cindex <architecture>
41627
41628 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
41629
41630 @smallexample
41631 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
41632 @end smallexample
41633
41634 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41635 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41636
41637 @subsection OS ABI
41638 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
41639
41640 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41641 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41642
41643 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
41644
41645 @smallexample
41646 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
41647 @end smallexample
41648
41649 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
41650 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
41651
41652 @subsection Compatible Architecture
41653 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
41654
41655 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
41656 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
41657
41658 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
41659
41660 @smallexample
41661 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
41662 @end smallexample
41663
41664 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
41665 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
41666
41667 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
41668 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
41669 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
41670 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
41671 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
41672 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
41673 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
41674
41675 @smallexample
41676 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
41677 <compatible>spu</compatible>
41678 @end smallexample
41679
41680 @subsection Features
41681 @cindex <feature>
41682
41683 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
41684 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
41685 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
41686 has this form:
41687
41688 @smallexample
41689 <feature name="@var{name}">
41690 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
41691 @var{reg}@dots{}
41692 </feature>
41693 @end smallexample
41694
41695 @noindent
41696 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
41697 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
41698 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
41699 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
41700
41701 @subsection Types
41702
41703 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
41704 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
41705 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
41706 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
41707 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
41708 and enum types.
41709
41710 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
41711 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
41712 Types must be defined before they are used.
41713
41714 @cindex <vector>
41715 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
41716 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
41717 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
41718 @var{count}:
41719
41720 @smallexample
41721 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
41722 @end smallexample
41723
41724 @cindex <union>
41725 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
41726 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
41727 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
41728 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
41729
41730 @smallexample
41731 <union id="@var{id}">
41732 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41733 @dots{}
41734 </union>
41735 @end smallexample
41736
41737 @cindex <struct>
41738 @cindex <flags>
41739 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
41740 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
41741 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
41742 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
41743 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
41744 specified.
41745
41746 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
41747
41748 @smallexample
41749 <struct id="@var{id}">
41750 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
41751 @dots{}
41752 </struct>
41753 @end smallexample
41754
41755 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
41756 No implicit padding is added.
41757
41758 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
41759
41760 @smallexample
41761 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41762 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41763 @dots{}
41764 </struct>
41765 @end smallexample
41766
41767 @smallexample
41768 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41769 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
41770 @dots{}
41771 </flags>
41772 @end smallexample
41773
41774 The @var{name} value is required.
41775 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
41776 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
41777 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
41778
41779 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
41780 is optional.
41781 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
41782 and zero represents the least significant bit.
41783
41784 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
41785 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
41786
41787 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
41788
41789 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
41790 defining them with @samp{struct}:
41791
41792 @itemize @bullet
41793 @item
41794 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
41795 @item
41796 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
41797 @end itemize
41798
41799 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
41800 defining them with @samp{flags}:
41801
41802 @itemize @bullet
41803 @item
41804 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
41805
41806 @smallexample
41807 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
41808 $1 = 42
41809 @end smallexample
41810
41811 @end itemize
41812
41813 @subsection Registers
41814 @cindex <reg>
41815
41816 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
41817
41818 @smallexample
41819 <reg name="@var{name}"
41820 bitsize="@var{size}"
41821 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
41822 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
41823 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
41824 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
41825 @end smallexample
41826
41827 @noindent
41828 The components are as follows:
41829
41830 @table @var
41831
41832 @item name
41833 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
41834
41835 @item bitsize
41836 The register's size, in bits.
41837
41838 @item regnum
41839 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
41840 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
41841 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
41842 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
41843 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
41844 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
41845 in order of increasing register number.
41846
41847 @item save-restore
41848 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
41849 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
41850 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
41851 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
41852 ABI.
41853
41854 @item type
41855 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
41856 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
41857 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
41858 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
41859 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
41860 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
41861
41862 @item group
41863 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
41864 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
41865 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
41866 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
41867 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
41868 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
41869 @code{info registers}.
41870
41871 @end table
41872
41873 @node Predefined Target Types
41874 @section Predefined Target Types
41875 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
41876
41877 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
41878 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
41879 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
41880 types. The currently supported types are:
41881
41882 @table @code
41883
41884 @item bool
41885 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
41886
41887 @item int8
41888 @itemx int16
41889 @itemx int32
41890 @itemx int64
41891 @itemx int128
41892 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41893
41894 @item uint8
41895 @itemx uint16
41896 @itemx uint32
41897 @itemx uint64
41898 @itemx uint128
41899 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
41900
41901 @item code_ptr
41902 @itemx data_ptr
41903 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
41904 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
41905 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
41906 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
41907 may be marked as data pointers.
41908
41909 @item ieee_single
41910 Single precision IEEE floating point.
41911
41912 @item ieee_double
41913 Double precision IEEE floating point.
41914
41915 @item arm_fpa_ext
41916 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
41917
41918 @item i387_ext
41919 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
41920
41921 @item i386_eflags
41922 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
41923
41924 @item i386_mxcsr
41925 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
41926
41927 @end table
41928
41929 @node Enum Target Types
41930 @section Enum Target Types
41931 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
41932
41933 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
41934 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
41935
41936 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
41937
41938 @smallexample
41939 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
41940 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
41941 @dots{}
41942 </enum>
41943 @end smallexample
41944
41945 Enums must be defined before they are used.
41946
41947 @smallexample
41948 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
41949 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
41950 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
41951 </enum>
41952 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
41953 <field name="X" start="0"/>
41954 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
41955 </flags>
41956 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
41957 @end smallexample
41958
41959 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
41960 would be printed as:
41961
41962 @smallexample
41963 (gdb) info register flags
41964 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
41965 @end smallexample
41966
41967 @node Standard Target Features
41968 @section Standard Target Features
41969 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
41970
41971 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
41972 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
41973 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
41974 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
41975 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
41976 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
41977 can recognize them.
41978
41979 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
41980 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
41981 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
41982 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
41983 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
41984 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
41985 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
41986 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
41987
41988 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
41989 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
41990 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
41991
41992 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
41993 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
41994 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
41995 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
41996
41997 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
41998 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
41999 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42000
42001 @menu
42002 * AArch64 Features::
42003 * ARC Features::
42004 * ARM Features::
42005 * i386 Features::
42006 * MicroBlaze Features::
42007 * MIPS Features::
42008 * M68K Features::
42009 * NDS32 Features::
42010 * Nios II Features::
42011 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42012 * PowerPC Features::
42013 * S/390 and System z Features::
42014 * Sparc Features::
42015 * TIC6x Features::
42016 @end menu
42017
42018
42019 @node AArch64 Features
42020 @subsection AArch64 Features
42021 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42022
42023 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42024 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42025 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42026
42027 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42028 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42029 and @samp{fpcr}.
42030
42031 @node ARC Features
42032 @subsection ARC Features
42033 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42034
42035 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42036 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42037 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42038 that one of the core registers features is present.
42039 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42040
42041 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42042 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42043 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42044 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42045 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42046 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42047 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42048
42049 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42050 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42051 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42052 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42053 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42054 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42055
42056 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42057 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42058 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42059 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42060 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42061 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42062 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42063 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42064 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42065 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42066
42067 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42068 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42069
42070 @node ARM Features
42071 @subsection ARM Features
42072 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42073
42074 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42075 ARM targets.
42076 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42077 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42078
42079 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42080 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42081 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42082 and @samp{xpsr}.
42083
42084 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42085 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42086
42087 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42088 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42089 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42090 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42091
42092 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42093 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42094 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42095 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42096 halves of the double-precision registers.
42097
42098 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42099 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42100 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42101 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42102 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42103 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42104
42105 @node i386 Features
42106 @subsection i386 Features
42107 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42108
42109 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42110 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42111
42112 @itemize @minus
42113 @item
42114 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42115 @item
42116 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42117 @item
42118 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42119 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42120 @item
42121 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42122 @item
42123 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42124 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42125 @end itemize
42126
42127 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42128
42129 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42130 describe registers:
42131
42132 @itemize @minus
42133 @item
42134 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42135 @item
42136 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42137 @item
42138 @samp{mxcsr}
42139 @end itemize
42140
42141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42142 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42143 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42144
42145 @itemize @minus
42146 @item
42147 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42148 @item
42149 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42150 @end itemize
42151
42152 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42153 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42154
42155 @itemize @minus
42156 @item
42157 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42158 @item
42159 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42160 @end itemize
42161
42162 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42163 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42164
42165 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42166 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42167
42168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42169 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42170 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42171
42172 @itemize @minus
42173 @item
42174 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42175 @end itemize
42176
42177 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42178
42179 @itemize @minus
42180 @item
42181 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42182 @end itemize
42183
42184 It should
42185 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
42186
42187 @itemize @minus
42188 @item
42189 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
42190 @item
42191 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
42192 @end itemize
42193
42194 It should
42195 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
42196
42197 @itemize @minus
42198 @item
42199 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42200 @end itemize
42201
42202 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
42203 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
42204 valid for i386 and amd64.
42205
42206 @node MicroBlaze Features
42207 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
42208 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
42209
42210 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
42211 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42212 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
42213 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
42214 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
42215
42216 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
42217 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
42218
42219 @node MIPS Features
42220 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42221 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42222
42223 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42224 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42225 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42226 on the target.
42227
42228 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42229 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42230 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42231
42232 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42233 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42234 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42235 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42236
42237 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42238 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42239 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42240 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42241
42242 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
42243 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
42244 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
42245
42246 @node M68K Features
42247 @subsection M68K Features
42248 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
42249
42250 @table @code
42251 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
42252 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
42253 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
42254 One of those features must be always present.
42255 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
42256 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
42257 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
42258 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
42259
42260 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
42261 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
42262 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
42263 @samp{fpiaddr}.
42264 @end table
42265
42266 @node NDS32 Features
42267 @subsection NDS32 Features
42268 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
42269
42270 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
42271 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
42272 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
42273 and @samp{pc}.
42274
42275 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42276 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
42277 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
42278 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
42279
42280 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
42281 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
42282 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
42283 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
42284 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
42285 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
42286 support to it could be totally removed some day.
42287
42288 @node Nios II Features
42289 @subsection Nios II Features
42290 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
42291
42292 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
42293 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
42294 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
42295 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
42296 @samp{mpuacc}).
42297
42298 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
42299 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
42300 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
42301
42302 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
42303 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
42304 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
42305
42306 @node PowerPC Features
42307 @subsection PowerPC Features
42308 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42309
42310 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42311 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42312 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42313 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42314
42315 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42316 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42317
42318 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42319 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42320 and @samp{vrsave}.
42321
42322 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42323 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42324 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42325 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42326 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42327 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42328
42329 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42330 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42331 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42332 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42333 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42334 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42335 user.
42336
42337 @node S/390 and System z Features
42338 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
42339 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
42340 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
42341
42342 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
42343 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
42344 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
42345 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
42346 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
42347 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
42348 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
42349 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
42350 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
42351
42352 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
42353 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
42354 @samp{fpc}.
42355
42356 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
42357 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
42358
42359 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
42360 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
42361 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
42362 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
42363 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
42364 32-bit wide.
42365
42366 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
42367 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
42368 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
42369
42370 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
42371 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
42372 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
42373 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
42374 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
42375 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42376 @samp{v31}.
42377
42378 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42379 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42380 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42381
42382 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42383 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42384 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42385
42386 @node Sparc Features
42387 @subsection Sparc Features
42388 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42389 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42390 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42391 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42392
42393 @itemize @minus
42394 @item
42395 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42396 @item
42397 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42398 @item
42399 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42400 @item
42401 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42402 @end itemize
42403
42404 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42405
42406 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42407 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42408
42409 @itemize @minus
42410 @item
42411 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42412 @item
42413 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42414 @end itemize
42415
42416 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42417 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42418
42419 @itemize @minus
42420 @item
42421 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42422 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42423 @item
42424 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42425 for sparc64
42426 @end itemize
42427
42428 @node TIC6x Features
42429 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42430 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42431 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42432 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42433 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42434 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42435
42436 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42437 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42438 through @samp{B31}.
42439
42440 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42441 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42442
42443 @node Operating System Information
42444 @appendix Operating System Information
42445 @cindex operating system information
42446
42447 @menu
42448 * Process list::
42449 @end menu
42450
42451 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42452 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42453 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42454 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42455 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42456 on a different aspect of target.
42457
42458 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42459 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42460 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42461 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42462
42463 @node Process list
42464 @appendixsection Process list
42465 @cindex operating system information, process list
42466
42467 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42468 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42469 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42470 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42471
42472 An example document is:
42473
42474 @smallexample
42475 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42476 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42477 <osdata type="processes">
42478 <item>
42479 <column name="pid">1</column>
42480 <column name="user">root</column>
42481 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42482 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42483 </item>
42484 </osdata>
42485 @end smallexample
42486
42487 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42488 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42489 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42490 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42491 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42492 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42493 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42494
42495 @node Trace File Format
42496 @appendix Trace File Format
42497 @cindex trace file format
42498
42499 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42500 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42501
42502 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42503 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42504 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42505 in the future.
42506
42507 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42508 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42509 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42510 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42511 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42512 of this section.
42513
42514 @table @code
42515 @item R @var{size}
42516 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42517 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42518 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42519 a single trace file.
42520
42521 @item status @var{status}
42522 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42523 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42524 file.
42525
42526 @item tp @var{payload}
42527 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42528 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42529 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42530 reply packets.
42531
42532 @item tsv @var{payload}
42533 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42534 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42535 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42536 reply packets.
42537
42538 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42539 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42540 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42541 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42542 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42543 file. Includes are not allowed.
42544
42545 @end table
42546
42547 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42548 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42549 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42550 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42551 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42552 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42553 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42554 endianness.
42555
42556 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42557
42558 @table @code
42559 @item R @var{bytes}
42560 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42561 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42562 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42563
42564 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42565 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42566 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42567 @var{length} bytes.
42568
42569 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42570 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42571 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42572
42573 @end table
42574
42575 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42576 of blocks.
42577
42578 @node Index Section Format
42579 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42580 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42581 @cindex index section format
42582
42583 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42584 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42585 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42586 description.
42587
42588 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
42589 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
42590 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
42591 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
42592 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
42593 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
42594
42595 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
42596
42597 @enumerate
42598 @item
42599 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
42600 unless otherwise noted:
42601
42602 @enumerate
42603 @item
42604 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
42605 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
42606 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
42607 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
42608 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
42609 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
42610 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
42611
42612 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
42613 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
42614 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
42615 currently not flagged as deprecated.
42616
42617 @item
42618 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
42619
42620 @item
42621 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
42622 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
42623 to the next offset.
42624
42625 @item
42626 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
42627
42628 @item
42629 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
42630
42631 @item
42632 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
42633 @end enumerate
42634
42635 @item
42636 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
42637 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
42638 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
42639 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
42640 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
42641 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
42642 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
42643 CU indices.
42644
42645 @item
42646 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
42647 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
42648 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
42649 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
42650
42651 @item
42652 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
42653 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
42654
42655 @enumerate
42656 @item
42657 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
42658
42659 @item
42660 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
42661 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
42662
42663 @item
42664 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
42665 @end enumerate
42666
42667 @item
42668 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
42669 the hash table is always a power of 2.
42670
42671 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
42672 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
42673 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
42674 constant pool.
42675
42676 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
42677 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
42678 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
42679
42680 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
42681 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
42682 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
42683 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
42684 index version:
42685
42686 @table @asis
42687 @item Version 4
42688 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
42689
42690 @item Versions 5 to 7
42691 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
42692 @end table
42693
42694 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
42695
42696 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
42697 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
42698 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
42699 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
42700 collision.
42701
42702 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
42703 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
42704 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
42705 the code.
42706
42707 @item
42708 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
42709 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
42710 strings.
42711
42712 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
42713 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
42714 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
42715 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
42716 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
42717 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
42718
42719 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
42720 @end enumerate
42721
42722 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
42723 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
42724 CU index+attributes value for each use.
42725
42726 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
42727 (bit 0 = LSB):
42728
42729 @table @asis
42730
42731 @item Bits 0-23
42732 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
42733 @item Bits 24-27
42734 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
42735 @item Bits 28-30
42736 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
42737
42738 @table @asis
42739 @item 0
42740 This value is reserved and should not be used.
42741 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
42742 with previous versions of the index.
42743 @item 1
42744 The symbol is a type.
42745 @item 2
42746 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
42747 @item 3
42748 The symbol is a function.
42749 @item 4
42750 Any other kind of symbol.
42751 @item 5,6,7
42752 These values are reserved.
42753 @end table
42754
42755 @item Bit 31
42756 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
42757
42758 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
42759 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
42760 @value{GDBN} sources.
42761
42762 @end table
42763
42764 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
42765 global/static attributes in the index.
42766
42767 @smallexample
42768 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
42769 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
42770 switch (die->tag)
42771 @{
42772 case DW_TAG_typedef:
42773 case DW_TAG_base_type:
42774 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
42775 kind = TYPE;
42776 is_static = 1;
42777 break;
42778 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
42779 kind = VARIABLE;
42780 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42781 break;
42782 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
42783 kind = FUNCTION;
42784 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
42785 break;
42786 case DW_TAG_constant:
42787 kind = VARIABLE;
42788 is_static = ! is_external;
42789 break;
42790 case DW_TAG_variable:
42791 kind = VARIABLE;
42792 is_static = ! is_external;
42793 break;
42794 case DW_TAG_namespace:
42795 kind = TYPE;
42796 is_static = 0;
42797 break;
42798 case DW_TAG_class_type:
42799 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
42800 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
42801 case DW_TAG_union_type:
42802 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
42803 kind = TYPE;
42804 is_static = language != CPLUS;
42805 break;
42806 default:
42807 assert (0);
42808 @}
42809 @end smallexample
42810
42811 @node Man Pages
42812 @appendix Manual pages
42813 @cindex Man pages
42814
42815 @menu
42816 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
42817 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
42818 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
42819 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
42820 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
42821 @end menu
42822
42823 @node gdb man
42824 @heading gdb man
42825
42826 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
42827
42828 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
42829 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
42830 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
42831 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
42832 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
42833 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
42834 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
42835 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
42836 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
42837 @c man end
42838
42839 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
42840 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
42841 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
42842 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
42843
42844 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
42845 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
42846
42847 @itemize @bullet
42848 @item
42849 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
42850
42851 @item
42852 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
42853
42854 @item
42855 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
42856
42857 @item
42858 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
42859 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
42860 @end itemize
42861
42862 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
42863 Modula-2.
42864
42865 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
42866 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
42867 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
42868 by using the command @code{help}.
42869
42870 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
42871 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
42872 executable program as the argument:
42873
42874 @smallexample
42875 gdb program
42876 @end smallexample
42877
42878 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
42879
42880 @smallexample
42881 gdb program core
42882 @end smallexample
42883
42884 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
42885 to debug a running process:
42886
42887 @smallexample
42888 gdb program 1234
42889 gdb -p 1234
42890 @end smallexample
42891
42892 @noindent
42893 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
42894 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
42895 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
42896
42897 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
42898
42899 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
42900 @table @env
42901 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42902 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
42903
42904 @item run [@var{arglist}]
42905 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
42906
42907 @item bt
42908 Backtrace: display the program stack.
42909
42910 @item print @var{expr}
42911 Display the value of an expression.
42912
42913 @item c
42914 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
42915
42916 @item next
42917 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
42918 function calls in the line.
42919
42920 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42921 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
42922
42923 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
42924 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
42925
42926 @item step
42927 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
42928 function calls in the line.
42929
42930 @item help [@var{name}]
42931 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
42932 about using @value{GDBN}.
42933
42934 @item quit
42935 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
42936 @end table
42937
42938 @ifset man
42939 For full details on @value{GDBN},
42940 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
42941 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
42942 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
42943 @end ifset
42944 @c man end
42945
42946 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
42947 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
42948 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
42949 encountered with no
42950 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
42951 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
42952 Many options have
42953 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
42954 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
42955 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
42956 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
42957 more usual convention.)
42958
42959 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
42960 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
42961 option is used.
42962
42963 @table @env
42964 @item -help
42965 @itemx -h
42966 List all options, with brief explanations.
42967
42968 @item -symbols=@var{file}
42969 @itemx -s @var{file}
42970 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
42971
42972 @item -write
42973 Enable writing into executable and core files.
42974
42975 @item -exec=@var{file}
42976 @itemx -e @var{file}
42977 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
42978 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
42979 dump.
42980
42981 @item -se=@var{file}
42982 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
42983 file.
42984
42985 @item -core=@var{file}
42986 @itemx -c @var{file}
42987 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
42988
42989 @item -command=@var{file}
42990 @itemx -x @var{file}
42991 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
42992
42993 @item -ex @var{command}
42994 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
42995
42996 @item -directory=@var{directory}
42997 @itemx -d @var{directory}
42998 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
42999
43000 @item -nh
43001 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43002
43003 @item -nx
43004 @itemx -n
43005 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43006
43007 @item -quiet
43008 @itemx -q
43009 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43010 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43011
43012 @item -batch
43013 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43014 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43015 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43016 commands in the command files.
43017
43018 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43019 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43020 more useful, the message
43021
43022 @smallexample
43023 Program exited normally.
43024 @end smallexample
43025
43026 @noindent
43027 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43028 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43029
43030 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43031 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43032 instead of the current directory.
43033
43034 @item -fullname
43035 @itemx -f
43036 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43037 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43038 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43039 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43040 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43041 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43042 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43043 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43044
43045 @item -b @var{bps}
43046 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43047 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43048
43049 @item -tty=@var{device}
43050 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43051 @end table
43052 @c man end
43053
43054 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43055 @ifset man
43056 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43057 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43058 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43059
43060 @smallexample
43061 info gdb
43062 @end smallexample
43063
43064 @noindent
43065 should give you access to the complete manual.
43066
43067 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43068 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43069 @end ifset
43070 @c man end
43071
43072 @node gdbserver man
43073 @heading gdbserver man
43074
43075 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43076 @format
43077 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43078 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43079
43080 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43081
43082 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43083 @c man end
43084 @end format
43085
43086 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43087 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43088 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43089
43090 @ifclear man
43091 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43092 @end ifclear
43093 @ifset man
43094 Usage (server (target) side):
43095 @end ifset
43096
43097 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43098 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43099 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43100 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43101
43102 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43103 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43104 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43105
43106 @smallexample
43107 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43108 @end smallexample
43109
43110 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43111
43112 @smallexample
43113 @ifset man
43114 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43115 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43116 @end ifset
43117 @ifclear man
43118 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43119 @end ifclear
43120 @end smallexample
43121
43122 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43123 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43124 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43125
43126 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43127
43128 @smallexample
43129 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43130 @end smallexample
43131
43132 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43133 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43134 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43135 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43136 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43137 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43138 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43139 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43140 print an error message and exit.
43141
43142 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43143 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43144
43145 @smallexample
43146 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43147 @end smallexample
43148
43149 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43150 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43151
43152 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43153 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43154 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43155 the program you want to debug.
43156
43157 @smallexample
43158 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43159 @end smallexample
43160
43161 @ifclear man
43162 @subheading Usage (host side)
43163 @end ifclear
43164 @ifset man
43165 Usage (host side):
43166 @end ifset
43167
43168 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43169 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43170 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43171 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43172 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43173 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43174 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43175 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43176 descriptor. For example:
43177
43178 @smallexample
43179 @ifset man
43180 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43181 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43182 @end ifset
43183 @ifclear man
43184 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43185 @end ifclear
43186 @end smallexample
43187
43188 @noindent
43189 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43190
43191 @smallexample
43192 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43193 @end smallexample
43194
43195 @noindent
43196 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43197 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43198 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43199 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43200 `Connection refused'.
43201
43202 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43203 described in
43204 @ifset man
43205 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43206 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43207 @end ifset
43208 @ifclear man
43209 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43210 @end ifclear
43211 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43212
43213 @smallexample
43214 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43215 @end smallexample
43216
43217 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43218 case.
43219 @c man end
43220
43221 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43222 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43223
43224 @itemize @bullet
43225
43226 @item
43227 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43228
43229 @smallexample
43230 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43231 @end smallexample
43232
43233 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43234 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43235 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43236 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43237 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43238 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43239 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43240
43241 @item
43242 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
43243 program:
43244
43245 @smallexample
43246 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43247 @end smallexample
43248
43249 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
43250 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
43251 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
43252 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43253
43254 @item
43255 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
43256
43257 @smallexample
43258 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43259 @end smallexample
43260
43261 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
43262 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
43263 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
43264 debug several processes in the same session.
43265 @end itemize
43266
43267 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
43268
43269 @table @env
43270
43271 @item --help
43272 List all options, with brief explanations.
43273
43274 @item --version
43275 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
43276
43277 @item --attach
43278 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
43279
43280 @smallexample
43281 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43282 @end smallexample
43283
43284 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43285 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43286
43287 @item --multi
43288 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43289 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
43290 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
43291 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
43292
43293 @smallexample
43294 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43295 @end smallexample
43296
43297 @item --debug
43298 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
43299 process.
43300 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43301 the developers.
43302
43303 @item --remote-debug
43304 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
43305 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43306 the developers.
43307
43308 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
43309 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
43310 of debugging output.
43311 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
43312
43313 @item --wrapper
43314 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43315 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43316 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43317 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43318
43319 @item --once
43320 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43321 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43322 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43323 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43324
43325 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43326
43327 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43328 @c QDisableRandomization.
43329
43330 @end table
43331 @c man end
43332
43333 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43334 @ifset man
43335 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43336 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43337 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43338
43339 @smallexample
43340 info gdb
43341 @end smallexample
43342
43343 should give you access to the complete manual.
43344
43345 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43346 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43347 @end ifset
43348 @c man end
43349
43350 @node gcore man
43351 @heading gcore
43352
43353 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43354
43355 @format
43356 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43357 gcore [-a] [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
43358 @c man end
43359 @end format
43360
43361 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43362 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
43363 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
43364 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
43365 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
43366 running without any change.
43367 @c man end
43368
43369 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43370 @table @env
43371 @item -a
43372 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
43373 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
43374 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
43375 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
43376 dump-excluded-mappings}).
43377
43378 @item -o @var{filename}
43379 The optional argument
43380 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
43381 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
43382 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
43383 @end table
43384 @c man end
43385
43386 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43387 @ifset man
43388 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43389 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43390 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43391
43392 @smallexample
43393 info gdb
43394 @end smallexample
43395
43396 @noindent
43397 should give you access to the complete manual.
43398
43399 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43400 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43401 @end ifset
43402 @c man end
43403
43404 @node gdbinit man
43405 @heading gdbinit
43406
43407 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43408
43409 @format
43410 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43411 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43412 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43413 @end ifset
43414
43415 ~/.gdbinit
43416
43417 ./.gdbinit
43418 @c man end
43419 @end format
43420
43421 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43422 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43423 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43424 described in
43425 @ifset man
43426 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43427 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43428 @end ifset
43429 @ifclear man
43430 @ref{Sequences}.
43431 @end ifclear
43432
43433 Please read more in
43434 @ifset man
43435 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43436 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43437 @end ifset
43438 @ifclear man
43439 @ref{Startup}.
43440 @end ifclear
43441
43442 @table @env
43443 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43444 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43445 @end ifset
43446 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43447 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43448 @end ifclear
43449 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43450 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43451 See more in
43452 @ifset man
43453 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43454 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43455 @end ifset
43456 @ifclear man
43457 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43458 @end ifclear
43459
43460 @item ~/.gdbinit
43461 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43462 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43463
43464 @item ./.gdbinit
43465 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43466 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43467 See more in
43468 @ifset man
43469 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43470 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43471 @end ifset
43472 @ifclear man
43473 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43474 @end ifclear
43475 @end table
43476 @c man end
43477
43478 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43479 @ifset man
43480 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43481
43482 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43483 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43484 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43485
43486 @smallexample
43487 info gdb
43488 @end smallexample
43489
43490 should give you access to the complete manual.
43491
43492 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43493 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43494 @end ifset
43495 @c man end
43496
43497 @node gdb-add-index man
43498 @heading gdb-add-index
43499 @pindex gdb-add-index
43500 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
43501
43502 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
43503
43504 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
43505 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
43506 @c man end
43507
43508 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
43509 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
43510 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
43511 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
43512 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
43513 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
43514
43515 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
43516 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
43517 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
43518 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
43519 named @code{.debug_*}).
43520
43521 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
43522 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
43523 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
43524 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
43525
43526 See more in
43527 @ifset man
43528 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
43529 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
43530 @end ifset
43531 @ifclear man
43532 @ref{Index Files}.
43533 @end ifclear
43534 @c man end
43535
43536 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
43537 @ifset man
43538 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43539 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43540 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43541
43542 @smallexample
43543 info gdb
43544 @end smallexample
43545
43546 should give you access to the complete manual.
43547
43548 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43549 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43550 @end ifset
43551 @c man end
43552
43553 @include gpl.texi
43554
43555 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43556 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43557 @include fdl.texi
43558
43559 @node Concept Index
43560 @unnumbered Concept Index
43561
43562 @printindex cp
43563
43564 @node Command and Variable Index
43565 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43566
43567 @printindex fn
43568
43569 @tex
43570 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43571 % meantime:
43572 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43573 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43574 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43575 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43576 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43577 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43578 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43579 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43580 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43581 \page\colophon
43582 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43583 @end tex
43584
43585 @bye
This page took 1.099086 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.